1 //===--- SemaDecl.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Declarations ----------------===// 2 // 3 // Part of the LLVM Project, under the Apache License v2.0 with LLVM Exceptions. 4 // See https://llvm.org/LICENSE.txt for license information. 5 // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 WITH LLVM-exception 6 // 7 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 8 // 9 // This file implements semantic analysis for declarations. 10 // 11 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 12 13 #include "TypeLocBuilder.h" 14 #include "clang/AST/ASTConsumer.h" 15 #include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h" 16 #include "clang/AST/ASTLambda.h" 17 #include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h" 18 #include "clang/AST/CharUnits.h" 19 #include "clang/AST/CommentDiagnostic.h" 20 #include "clang/AST/DeclCXX.h" 21 #include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h" 22 #include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h" 23 #include "clang/AST/EvaluatedExprVisitor.h" 24 #include "clang/AST/Expr.h" 25 #include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h" 26 #include "clang/AST/NonTrivialTypeVisitor.h" 27 #include "clang/AST/StmtCXX.h" 28 #include "clang/Basic/Builtins.h" 29 #include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h" 30 #include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h" 31 #include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h" 32 #include "clang/Lex/HeaderSearch.h" // TODO: Sema shouldn't depend on Lex 33 #include "clang/Lex/Lexer.h" // TODO: Extract static functions to fix layering. 34 #include "clang/Lex/ModuleLoader.h" // TODO: Sema shouldn't depend on Lex 35 #include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h" // Included for isCodeCompletionEnabled() 36 #include "clang/Sema/CXXFieldCollector.h" 37 #include "clang/Sema/DeclSpec.h" 38 #include "clang/Sema/DelayedDiagnostic.h" 39 #include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h" 40 #include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h" 41 #include "clang/Sema/ParsedTemplate.h" 42 #include "clang/Sema/Scope.h" 43 #include "clang/Sema/ScopeInfo.h" 44 #include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h" 45 #include "clang/Sema/Template.h" 46 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h" 47 #include "llvm/ADT/Triple.h" 48 #include <algorithm> 49 #include <cstring> 50 #include <functional> 51 #include <unordered_map> 52 53 using namespace clang; 54 using namespace sema; 55 56 Sema::DeclGroupPtrTy Sema::ConvertDeclToDeclGroup(Decl *Ptr, Decl *OwnedType) { 57 if (OwnedType) { 58 Decl *Group[2] = { OwnedType, Ptr }; 59 return DeclGroupPtrTy::make(DeclGroupRef::Create(Context, Group, 2)); 60 } 61 62 return DeclGroupPtrTy::make(DeclGroupRef(Ptr)); 63 } 64 65 namespace { 66 67 class TypeNameValidatorCCC final : public CorrectionCandidateCallback { 68 public: 69 TypeNameValidatorCCC(bool AllowInvalid, bool WantClass = false, 70 bool AllowTemplates = false, 71 bool AllowNonTemplates = true) 72 : AllowInvalidDecl(AllowInvalid), WantClassName(WantClass), 73 AllowTemplates(AllowTemplates), AllowNonTemplates(AllowNonTemplates) { 74 WantExpressionKeywords = false; 75 WantCXXNamedCasts = false; 76 WantRemainingKeywords = false; 77 } 78 79 bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) override { 80 if (NamedDecl *ND = candidate.getCorrectionDecl()) { 81 if (!AllowInvalidDecl && ND->isInvalidDecl()) 82 return false; 83 84 if (getAsTypeTemplateDecl(ND)) 85 return AllowTemplates; 86 87 bool IsType = isa<TypeDecl>(ND) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(ND); 88 if (!IsType) 89 return false; 90 91 if (AllowNonTemplates) 92 return true; 93 94 // An injected-class-name of a class template (specialization) is valid 95 // as a template or as a non-template. 96 if (AllowTemplates) { 97 auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ND); 98 if (!RD || !RD->isInjectedClassName()) 99 return false; 100 RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD->getDeclContext()); 101 return RD->getDescribedClassTemplate() || 102 isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RD); 103 } 104 105 return false; 106 } 107 108 return !WantClassName && candidate.isKeyword(); 109 } 110 111 std::unique_ptr<CorrectionCandidateCallback> clone() override { 112 return std::make_unique<TypeNameValidatorCCC>(*this); 113 } 114 115 private: 116 bool AllowInvalidDecl; 117 bool WantClassName; 118 bool AllowTemplates; 119 bool AllowNonTemplates; 120 }; 121 122 } // end anonymous namespace 123 124 /// Determine whether the token kind starts a simple-type-specifier. 125 bool Sema::isSimpleTypeSpecifier(tok::TokenKind Kind) const { 126 switch (Kind) { 127 // FIXME: Take into account the current language when deciding whether a 128 // token kind is a valid type specifier 129 case tok::kw_short: 130 case tok::kw_long: 131 case tok::kw___int64: 132 case tok::kw___int128: 133 case tok::kw_signed: 134 case tok::kw_unsigned: 135 case tok::kw_void: 136 case tok::kw_char: 137 case tok::kw_int: 138 case tok::kw_half: 139 case tok::kw_float: 140 case tok::kw_double: 141 case tok::kw___bf16: 142 case tok::kw__Float16: 143 case tok::kw___float128: 144 case tok::kw_wchar_t: 145 case tok::kw_bool: 146 case tok::kw___underlying_type: 147 case tok::kw___auto_type: 148 return true; 149 150 case tok::annot_typename: 151 case tok::kw_char16_t: 152 case tok::kw_char32_t: 153 case tok::kw_typeof: 154 case tok::annot_decltype: 155 case tok::kw_decltype: 156 return getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 157 158 case tok::kw_char8_t: 159 return getLangOpts().Char8; 160 161 default: 162 break; 163 } 164 165 return false; 166 } 167 168 namespace { 169 enum class UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult { 170 NotFound, 171 FoundNonType, 172 FoundType 173 }; 174 } // end anonymous namespace 175 176 /// Tries to perform unqualified lookup of the type decls in bases for 177 /// dependent class. 178 /// \return \a NotFound if no any decls is found, \a FoundNotType if found not a 179 /// type decl, \a FoundType if only type decls are found. 180 static UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult 181 lookupUnqualifiedTypeNameInBase(Sema &S, const IdentifierInfo &II, 182 SourceLocation NameLoc, 183 const CXXRecordDecl *RD) { 184 if (!RD->hasDefinition()) 185 return UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound; 186 // Look for type decls in base classes. 187 UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult FoundTypeDecl = 188 UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound; 189 for (const auto &Base : RD->bases()) { 190 const CXXRecordDecl *BaseRD = nullptr; 191 if (auto *BaseTT = Base.getType()->getAs<TagType>()) 192 BaseRD = BaseTT->getAsCXXRecordDecl(); 193 else if (auto *TST = Base.getType()->getAs<TemplateSpecializationType>()) { 194 // Look for type decls in dependent base classes that have known primary 195 // templates. 196 if (!TST || !TST->isDependentType()) 197 continue; 198 auto *TD = TST->getTemplateName().getAsTemplateDecl(); 199 if (!TD) 200 continue; 201 if (auto *BasePrimaryTemplate = 202 dyn_cast_or_null<CXXRecordDecl>(TD->getTemplatedDecl())) { 203 if (BasePrimaryTemplate->getCanonicalDecl() != RD->getCanonicalDecl()) 204 BaseRD = BasePrimaryTemplate; 205 else if (auto *CTD = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateDecl>(TD)) { 206 if (const ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *PS = 207 CTD->findPartialSpecialization(Base.getType())) 208 if (PS->getCanonicalDecl() != RD->getCanonicalDecl()) 209 BaseRD = PS; 210 } 211 } 212 } 213 if (BaseRD) { 214 for (NamedDecl *ND : BaseRD->lookup(&II)) { 215 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(ND)) 216 return UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundNonType; 217 FoundTypeDecl = UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundType; 218 } 219 if (FoundTypeDecl == UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound) { 220 switch (lookupUnqualifiedTypeNameInBase(S, II, NameLoc, BaseRD)) { 221 case UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundNonType: 222 return UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundNonType; 223 case UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundType: 224 FoundTypeDecl = UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundType; 225 break; 226 case UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound: 227 break; 228 } 229 } 230 } 231 } 232 233 return FoundTypeDecl; 234 } 235 236 static ParsedType recoverFromTypeInKnownDependentBase(Sema &S, 237 const IdentifierInfo &II, 238 SourceLocation NameLoc) { 239 // Lookup in the parent class template context, if any. 240 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = nullptr; 241 UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult FoundTypeDecl = 242 UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound; 243 for (DeclContext *DC = S.CurContext; 244 DC && FoundTypeDecl == UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound; 245 DC = DC->getParent()) { 246 // Look for type decls in dependent base classes that have known primary 247 // templates. 248 RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC); 249 if (RD && RD->getDescribedClassTemplate()) 250 FoundTypeDecl = lookupUnqualifiedTypeNameInBase(S, II, NameLoc, RD); 251 } 252 if (FoundTypeDecl != UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundType) 253 return nullptr; 254 255 // We found some types in dependent base classes. Recover as if the user 256 // wrote 'typename MyClass::II' instead of 'II'. We'll fully resolve the 257 // lookup during template instantiation. 258 S.Diag(NameLoc, diag::ext_found_via_dependent_bases_lookup) << &II; 259 260 ASTContext &Context = S.Context; 261 auto *NNS = NestedNameSpecifier::Create(Context, nullptr, false, 262 cast<Type>(Context.getRecordType(RD))); 263 QualType T = Context.getDependentNameType(ETK_Typename, NNS, &II); 264 265 CXXScopeSpec SS; 266 SS.MakeTrivial(Context, NNS, SourceRange(NameLoc)); 267 268 TypeLocBuilder Builder; 269 DependentNameTypeLoc DepTL = Builder.push<DependentNameTypeLoc>(T); 270 DepTL.setNameLoc(NameLoc); 271 DepTL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation()); 272 DepTL.setQualifierLoc(SS.getWithLocInContext(Context)); 273 return S.CreateParsedType(T, Builder.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, T)); 274 } 275 276 /// If the identifier refers to a type name within this scope, 277 /// return the declaration of that type. 278 /// 279 /// This routine performs ordinary name lookup of the identifier II 280 /// within the given scope, with optional C++ scope specifier SS, to 281 /// determine whether the name refers to a type. If so, returns an 282 /// opaque pointer (actually a QualType) corresponding to that 283 /// type. Otherwise, returns NULL. 284 ParsedType Sema::getTypeName(const IdentifierInfo &II, SourceLocation NameLoc, 285 Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec *SS, 286 bool isClassName, bool HasTrailingDot, 287 ParsedType ObjectTypePtr, 288 bool IsCtorOrDtorName, 289 bool WantNontrivialTypeSourceInfo, 290 bool IsClassTemplateDeductionContext, 291 IdentifierInfo **CorrectedII) { 292 // FIXME: Consider allowing this outside C++1z mode as an extension. 293 bool AllowDeducedTemplate = IsClassTemplateDeductionContext && 294 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 && !IsCtorOrDtorName && 295 !isClassName && !HasTrailingDot; 296 297 // Determine where we will perform name lookup. 298 DeclContext *LookupCtx = nullptr; 299 if (ObjectTypePtr) { 300 QualType ObjectType = ObjectTypePtr.get(); 301 if (ObjectType->isRecordType()) 302 LookupCtx = computeDeclContext(ObjectType); 303 } else if (SS && SS->isNotEmpty()) { 304 LookupCtx = computeDeclContext(*SS, false); 305 306 if (!LookupCtx) { 307 if (isDependentScopeSpecifier(*SS)) { 308 // C++ [temp.res]p3: 309 // A qualified-id that refers to a type and in which the 310 // nested-name-specifier depends on a template-parameter (14.6.2) 311 // shall be prefixed by the keyword typename to indicate that the 312 // qualified-id denotes a type, forming an 313 // elaborated-type-specifier (7.1.5.3). 314 // 315 // We therefore do not perform any name lookup if the result would 316 // refer to a member of an unknown specialization. 317 if (!isClassName && !IsCtorOrDtorName) 318 return nullptr; 319 320 // We know from the grammar that this name refers to a type, 321 // so build a dependent node to describe the type. 322 if (WantNontrivialTypeSourceInfo) 323 return ActOnTypenameType(S, SourceLocation(), *SS, II, NameLoc).get(); 324 325 NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc = SS->getWithLocInContext(Context); 326 QualType T = CheckTypenameType(ETK_None, SourceLocation(), QualifierLoc, 327 II, NameLoc); 328 return ParsedType::make(T); 329 } 330 331 return nullptr; 332 } 333 334 if (!LookupCtx->isDependentContext() && 335 RequireCompleteDeclContext(*SS, LookupCtx)) 336 return nullptr; 337 } 338 339 // FIXME: LookupNestedNameSpecifierName isn't the right kind of 340 // lookup for class-names. 341 LookupNameKind Kind = isClassName ? LookupNestedNameSpecifierName : 342 LookupOrdinaryName; 343 LookupResult Result(*this, &II, NameLoc, Kind); 344 if (LookupCtx) { 345 // Perform "qualified" name lookup into the declaration context we 346 // computed, which is either the type of the base of a member access 347 // expression or the declaration context associated with a prior 348 // nested-name-specifier. 349 LookupQualifiedName(Result, LookupCtx); 350 351 if (ObjectTypePtr && Result.empty()) { 352 // C++ [basic.lookup.classref]p3: 353 // If the unqualified-id is ~type-name, the type-name is looked up 354 // in the context of the entire postfix-expression. If the type T of 355 // the object expression is of a class type C, the type-name is also 356 // looked up in the scope of class C. At least one of the lookups shall 357 // find a name that refers to (possibly cv-qualified) T. 358 LookupName(Result, S); 359 } 360 } else { 361 // Perform unqualified name lookup. 362 LookupName(Result, S); 363 364 // For unqualified lookup in a class template in MSVC mode, look into 365 // dependent base classes where the primary class template is known. 366 if (Result.empty() && getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && (!SS || SS->isEmpty())) { 367 if (ParsedType TypeInBase = 368 recoverFromTypeInKnownDependentBase(*this, II, NameLoc)) 369 return TypeInBase; 370 } 371 } 372 373 NamedDecl *IIDecl = nullptr; 374 switch (Result.getResultKind()) { 375 case LookupResult::NotFound: 376 case LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation: 377 if (CorrectedII) { 378 TypeNameValidatorCCC CCC(/*AllowInvalid=*/true, isClassName, 379 AllowDeducedTemplate); 380 TypoCorrection Correction = CorrectTypo(Result.getLookupNameInfo(), Kind, 381 S, SS, CCC, CTK_ErrorRecovery); 382 IdentifierInfo *NewII = Correction.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo(); 383 TemplateTy Template; 384 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization; 385 UnqualifiedId TemplateName; 386 TemplateName.setIdentifier(NewII, NameLoc); 387 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS = Correction.getCorrectionSpecifier(); 388 CXXScopeSpec NewSS, *NewSSPtr = SS; 389 if (SS && NNS) { 390 NewSS.MakeTrivial(Context, NNS, SourceRange(NameLoc)); 391 NewSSPtr = &NewSS; 392 } 393 if (Correction && (NNS || NewII != &II) && 394 // Ignore a correction to a template type as the to-be-corrected 395 // identifier is not a template (typo correction for template names 396 // is handled elsewhere). 397 !(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NewSSPtr && 398 isTemplateName(S, *NewSSPtr, false, TemplateName, nullptr, false, 399 Template, MemberOfUnknownSpecialization))) { 400 ParsedType Ty = getTypeName(*NewII, NameLoc, S, NewSSPtr, 401 isClassName, HasTrailingDot, ObjectTypePtr, 402 IsCtorOrDtorName, 403 WantNontrivialTypeSourceInfo, 404 IsClassTemplateDeductionContext); 405 if (Ty) { 406 diagnoseTypo(Correction, 407 PDiag(diag::err_unknown_type_or_class_name_suggest) 408 << Result.getLookupName() << isClassName); 409 if (SS && NNS) 410 SS->MakeTrivial(Context, NNS, SourceRange(NameLoc)); 411 *CorrectedII = NewII; 412 return Ty; 413 } 414 } 415 } 416 // If typo correction failed or was not performed, fall through 417 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 418 case LookupResult::FoundOverloaded: 419 case LookupResult::FoundUnresolvedValue: 420 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 421 return nullptr; 422 423 case LookupResult::Ambiguous: 424 // Recover from type-hiding ambiguities by hiding the type. We'll 425 // do the lookup again when looking for an object, and we can 426 // diagnose the error then. If we don't do this, then the error 427 // about hiding the type will be immediately followed by an error 428 // that only makes sense if the identifier was treated like a type. 429 if (Result.getAmbiguityKind() == LookupResult::AmbiguousTagHiding) { 430 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 431 return nullptr; 432 } 433 434 // Look to see if we have a type anywhere in the list of results. 435 for (LookupResult::iterator Res = Result.begin(), ResEnd = Result.end(); 436 Res != ResEnd; ++Res) { 437 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*Res) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*Res) || 438 (AllowDeducedTemplate && getAsTypeTemplateDecl(*Res))) { 439 if (!IIDecl || 440 (*Res)->getLocation().getRawEncoding() < 441 IIDecl->getLocation().getRawEncoding()) 442 IIDecl = *Res; 443 } 444 } 445 446 if (!IIDecl) { 447 // None of the entities we found is a type, so there is no way 448 // to even assume that the result is a type. In this case, don't 449 // complain about the ambiguity. The parser will either try to 450 // perform this lookup again (e.g., as an object name), which 451 // will produce the ambiguity, or will complain that it expected 452 // a type name. 453 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 454 return nullptr; 455 } 456 457 // We found a type within the ambiguous lookup; diagnose the 458 // ambiguity and then return that type. This might be the right 459 // answer, or it might not be, but it suppresses any attempt to 460 // perform the name lookup again. 461 break; 462 463 case LookupResult::Found: 464 IIDecl = Result.getFoundDecl(); 465 break; 466 } 467 468 assert(IIDecl && "Didn't find decl"); 469 470 QualType T; 471 if (TypeDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypeDecl>(IIDecl)) { 472 // C++ [class.qual]p2: A lookup that would find the injected-class-name 473 // instead names the constructors of the class, except when naming a class. 474 // This is ill-formed when we're not actually forming a ctor or dtor name. 475 auto *LookupRD = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXRecordDecl>(LookupCtx); 476 auto *FoundRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TD); 477 if (!isClassName && !IsCtorOrDtorName && LookupRD && FoundRD && 478 FoundRD->isInjectedClassName() && 479 declaresSameEntity(LookupRD, cast<Decl>(FoundRD->getParent()))) 480 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_out_of_line_qualified_id_type_names_constructor) 481 << &II << /*Type*/1; 482 483 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IIDecl, NameLoc); 484 485 T = Context.getTypeDeclType(TD); 486 MarkAnyDeclReferenced(TD->getLocation(), TD, /*OdrUse=*/false); 487 } else if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(IIDecl)) { 488 (void)DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IDecl, NameLoc); 489 if (!HasTrailingDot) 490 T = Context.getObjCInterfaceType(IDecl); 491 } else if (AllowDeducedTemplate) { 492 if (auto *TD = getAsTypeTemplateDecl(IIDecl)) 493 T = Context.getDeducedTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName(TD), 494 QualType(), false); 495 } 496 497 if (T.isNull()) { 498 // If it's not plausibly a type, suppress diagnostics. 499 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 500 return nullptr; 501 } 502 503 // NOTE: avoid constructing an ElaboratedType(Loc) if this is a 504 // constructor or destructor name (in such a case, the scope specifier 505 // will be attached to the enclosing Expr or Decl node). 506 if (SS && SS->isNotEmpty() && !IsCtorOrDtorName && 507 !isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(IIDecl)) { 508 if (WantNontrivialTypeSourceInfo) { 509 // Construct a type with type-source information. 510 TypeLocBuilder Builder; 511 Builder.pushTypeSpec(T).setNameLoc(NameLoc); 512 513 T = getElaboratedType(ETK_None, *SS, T); 514 ElaboratedTypeLoc ElabTL = Builder.push<ElaboratedTypeLoc>(T); 515 ElabTL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation()); 516 ElabTL.setQualifierLoc(SS->getWithLocInContext(Context)); 517 return CreateParsedType(T, Builder.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, T)); 518 } else { 519 T = getElaboratedType(ETK_None, *SS, T); 520 } 521 } 522 523 return ParsedType::make(T); 524 } 525 526 // Builds a fake NNS for the given decl context. 527 static NestedNameSpecifier * 528 synthesizeCurrentNestedNameSpecifier(ASTContext &Context, DeclContext *DC) { 529 for (;; DC = DC->getLookupParent()) { 530 DC = DC->getPrimaryContext(); 531 auto *ND = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(DC); 532 if (ND && !ND->isInline() && !ND->isAnonymousNamespace()) 533 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(Context, nullptr, ND); 534 else if (auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) 535 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(Context, nullptr, RD->isTemplateDecl(), 536 RD->getTypeForDecl()); 537 else if (isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(DC)) 538 return NestedNameSpecifier::GlobalSpecifier(Context); 539 } 540 llvm_unreachable("something isn't in TU scope?"); 541 } 542 543 /// Find the parent class with dependent bases of the innermost enclosing method 544 /// context. Do not look for enclosing CXXRecordDecls directly, or we will end 545 /// up allowing unqualified dependent type names at class-level, which MSVC 546 /// correctly rejects. 547 static const CXXRecordDecl * 548 findRecordWithDependentBasesOfEnclosingMethod(const DeclContext *DC) { 549 for (; DC && DC->isDependentContext(); DC = DC->getLookupParent()) { 550 DC = DC->getPrimaryContext(); 551 if (const auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) 552 if (MD->getParent()->hasAnyDependentBases()) 553 return MD->getParent(); 554 } 555 return nullptr; 556 } 557 558 ParsedType Sema::ActOnMSVCUnknownTypeName(const IdentifierInfo &II, 559 SourceLocation NameLoc, 560 bool IsTemplateTypeArg) { 561 assert(getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && "shouldn't be called in non-MSVC mode"); 562 563 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS = nullptr; 564 if (IsTemplateTypeArg && getCurScope()->isTemplateParamScope()) { 565 // If we weren't able to parse a default template argument, delay lookup 566 // until instantiation time by making a non-dependent DependentTypeName. We 567 // pretend we saw a NestedNameSpecifier referring to the current scope, and 568 // lookup is retried. 569 // FIXME: This hurts our diagnostic quality, since we get errors like "no 570 // type named 'Foo' in 'current_namespace'" when the user didn't write any 571 // name specifiers. 572 NNS = synthesizeCurrentNestedNameSpecifier(Context, CurContext); 573 Diag(NameLoc, diag::ext_ms_delayed_template_argument) << &II; 574 } else if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = 575 findRecordWithDependentBasesOfEnclosingMethod(CurContext)) { 576 // Build a DependentNameType that will perform lookup into RD at 577 // instantiation time. 578 NNS = NestedNameSpecifier::Create(Context, nullptr, RD->isTemplateDecl(), 579 RD->getTypeForDecl()); 580 581 // Diagnose that this identifier was undeclared, and retry the lookup during 582 // template instantiation. 583 Diag(NameLoc, diag::ext_undeclared_unqual_id_with_dependent_base) << &II 584 << RD; 585 } else { 586 // This is not a situation that we should recover from. 587 return ParsedType(); 588 } 589 590 QualType T = Context.getDependentNameType(ETK_None, NNS, &II); 591 592 // Build type location information. We synthesized the qualifier, so we have 593 // to build a fake NestedNameSpecifierLoc. 594 NestedNameSpecifierLocBuilder NNSLocBuilder; 595 NNSLocBuilder.MakeTrivial(Context, NNS, SourceRange(NameLoc)); 596 NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc = NNSLocBuilder.getWithLocInContext(Context); 597 598 TypeLocBuilder Builder; 599 DependentNameTypeLoc DepTL = Builder.push<DependentNameTypeLoc>(T); 600 DepTL.setNameLoc(NameLoc); 601 DepTL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation()); 602 DepTL.setQualifierLoc(QualifierLoc); 603 return CreateParsedType(T, Builder.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, T)); 604 } 605 606 /// isTagName() - This method is called *for error recovery purposes only* 607 /// to determine if the specified name is a valid tag name ("struct foo"). If 608 /// so, this returns the TST for the tag corresponding to it (TST_enum, 609 /// TST_union, TST_struct, TST_interface, TST_class). This is used to diagnose 610 /// cases in C where the user forgot to specify the tag. 611 DeclSpec::TST Sema::isTagName(IdentifierInfo &II, Scope *S) { 612 // Do a tag name lookup in this scope. 613 LookupResult R(*this, &II, SourceLocation(), LookupTagName); 614 LookupName(R, S, false); 615 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 616 if (R.getResultKind() == LookupResult::Found) 617 if (const TagDecl *TD = R.getAsSingle<TagDecl>()) { 618 switch (TD->getTagKind()) { 619 case TTK_Struct: return DeclSpec::TST_struct; 620 case TTK_Interface: return DeclSpec::TST_interface; 621 case TTK_Union: return DeclSpec::TST_union; 622 case TTK_Class: return DeclSpec::TST_class; 623 case TTK_Enum: return DeclSpec::TST_enum; 624 } 625 } 626 627 return DeclSpec::TST_unspecified; 628 } 629 630 /// isMicrosoftMissingTypename - In Microsoft mode, within class scope, 631 /// if a CXXScopeSpec's type is equal to the type of one of the base classes 632 /// then downgrade the missing typename error to a warning. 633 /// This is needed for MSVC compatibility; Example: 634 /// @code 635 /// template<class T> class A { 636 /// public: 637 /// typedef int TYPE; 638 /// }; 639 /// template<class T> class B : public A<T> { 640 /// public: 641 /// A<T>::TYPE a; // no typename required because A<T> is a base class. 642 /// }; 643 /// @endcode 644 bool Sema::isMicrosoftMissingTypename(const CXXScopeSpec *SS, Scope *S) { 645 if (CurContext->isRecord()) { 646 if (SS->getScopeRep()->getKind() == NestedNameSpecifier::Super) 647 return true; 648 649 const Type *Ty = SS->getScopeRep()->getAsType(); 650 651 CXXRecordDecl *RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext); 652 for (const auto &Base : RD->bases()) 653 if (Ty && Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(QualType(Ty, 1), Base.getType())) 654 return true; 655 return S->isFunctionPrototypeScope(); 656 } 657 return CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod() || S->isFunctionPrototypeScope(); 658 } 659 660 void Sema::DiagnoseUnknownTypeName(IdentifierInfo *&II, 661 SourceLocation IILoc, 662 Scope *S, 663 CXXScopeSpec *SS, 664 ParsedType &SuggestedType, 665 bool IsTemplateName) { 666 // Don't report typename errors for editor placeholders. 667 if (II->isEditorPlaceholder()) 668 return; 669 // We don't have anything to suggest (yet). 670 SuggestedType = nullptr; 671 672 // There may have been a typo in the name of the type. Look up typo 673 // results, in case we have something that we can suggest. 674 TypeNameValidatorCCC CCC(/*AllowInvalid=*/false, /*WantClass=*/false, 675 /*AllowTemplates=*/IsTemplateName, 676 /*AllowNonTemplates=*/!IsTemplateName); 677 if (TypoCorrection Corrected = 678 CorrectTypo(DeclarationNameInfo(II, IILoc), LookupOrdinaryName, S, SS, 679 CCC, CTK_ErrorRecovery)) { 680 // FIXME: Support error recovery for the template-name case. 681 bool CanRecover = !IsTemplateName; 682 if (Corrected.isKeyword()) { 683 // We corrected to a keyword. 684 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, 685 PDiag(IsTemplateName ? diag::err_no_template_suggest 686 : diag::err_unknown_typename_suggest) 687 << II); 688 II = Corrected.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo(); 689 } else { 690 // We found a similarly-named type or interface; suggest that. 691 if (!SS || !SS->isSet()) { 692 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, 693 PDiag(IsTemplateName ? diag::err_no_template_suggest 694 : diag::err_unknown_typename_suggest) 695 << II, CanRecover); 696 } else if (DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(*SS, false)) { 697 std::string CorrectedStr(Corrected.getAsString(getLangOpts())); 698 bool DroppedSpecifier = Corrected.WillReplaceSpecifier() && 699 II->getName().equals(CorrectedStr); 700 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, 701 PDiag(IsTemplateName 702 ? diag::err_no_member_template_suggest 703 : diag::err_unknown_nested_typename_suggest) 704 << II << DC << DroppedSpecifier << SS->getRange(), 705 CanRecover); 706 } else { 707 llvm_unreachable("could not have corrected a typo here"); 708 } 709 710 if (!CanRecover) 711 return; 712 713 CXXScopeSpec tmpSS; 714 if (Corrected.getCorrectionSpecifier()) 715 tmpSS.MakeTrivial(Context, Corrected.getCorrectionSpecifier(), 716 SourceRange(IILoc)); 717 // FIXME: Support class template argument deduction here. 718 SuggestedType = 719 getTypeName(*Corrected.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo(), IILoc, S, 720 tmpSS.isSet() ? &tmpSS : SS, false, false, nullptr, 721 /*IsCtorOrDtorName=*/false, 722 /*WantNontrivialTypeSourceInfo=*/true); 723 } 724 return; 725 } 726 727 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !IsTemplateName) { 728 // See if II is a class template that the user forgot to pass arguments to. 729 UnqualifiedId Name; 730 Name.setIdentifier(II, IILoc); 731 CXXScopeSpec EmptySS; 732 TemplateTy TemplateResult; 733 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization; 734 if (isTemplateName(S, SS ? *SS : EmptySS, /*hasTemplateKeyword=*/false, 735 Name, nullptr, true, TemplateResult, 736 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization) == TNK_Type_template) { 737 diagnoseMissingTemplateArguments(TemplateResult.get(), IILoc); 738 return; 739 } 740 } 741 742 // FIXME: Should we move the logic that tries to recover from a missing tag 743 // (struct, union, enum) from Parser::ParseImplicitInt here, instead? 744 745 if (!SS || (!SS->isSet() && !SS->isInvalid())) 746 Diag(IILoc, IsTemplateName ? diag::err_no_template 747 : diag::err_unknown_typename) 748 << II; 749 else if (DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(*SS, false)) 750 Diag(IILoc, IsTemplateName ? diag::err_no_member_template 751 : diag::err_typename_nested_not_found) 752 << II << DC << SS->getRange(); 753 else if (SS->isValid() && SS->getScopeRep()->containsErrors()) { 754 SuggestedType = 755 ActOnTypenameType(S, SourceLocation(), *SS, *II, IILoc).get(); 756 } else if (isDependentScopeSpecifier(*SS)) { 757 unsigned DiagID = diag::err_typename_missing; 758 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && isMicrosoftMissingTypename(SS, S)) 759 DiagID = diag::ext_typename_missing; 760 761 Diag(SS->getRange().getBegin(), DiagID) 762 << SS->getScopeRep() << II->getName() 763 << SourceRange(SS->getRange().getBegin(), IILoc) 764 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SS->getRange().getBegin(), "typename "); 765 SuggestedType = ActOnTypenameType(S, SourceLocation(), 766 *SS, *II, IILoc).get(); 767 } else { 768 assert(SS && SS->isInvalid() && 769 "Invalid scope specifier has already been diagnosed"); 770 } 771 } 772 773 /// Determine whether the given result set contains either a type name 774 /// or 775 static bool isResultTypeOrTemplate(LookupResult &R, const Token &NextToken) { 776 bool CheckTemplate = R.getSema().getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 777 NextToken.is(tok::less); 778 779 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), IEnd = R.end(); I != IEnd; ++I) { 780 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*I) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*I)) 781 return true; 782 783 if (CheckTemplate && isa<TemplateDecl>(*I)) 784 return true; 785 } 786 787 return false; 788 } 789 790 static bool isTagTypeWithMissingTag(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &Result, 791 Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, 792 IdentifierInfo *&Name, 793 SourceLocation NameLoc) { 794 LookupResult R(SemaRef, Name, NameLoc, Sema::LookupTagName); 795 SemaRef.LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS); 796 if (TagDecl *Tag = R.getAsSingle<TagDecl>()) { 797 StringRef FixItTagName; 798 switch (Tag->getTagKind()) { 799 case TTK_Class: 800 FixItTagName = "class "; 801 break; 802 803 case TTK_Enum: 804 FixItTagName = "enum "; 805 break; 806 807 case TTK_Struct: 808 FixItTagName = "struct "; 809 break; 810 811 case TTK_Interface: 812 FixItTagName = "__interface "; 813 break; 814 815 case TTK_Union: 816 FixItTagName = "union "; 817 break; 818 } 819 820 StringRef TagName = FixItTagName.drop_back(); 821 SemaRef.Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_use_of_tag_name_without_tag) 822 << Name << TagName << SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 823 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(NameLoc, FixItTagName); 824 825 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Result.begin(), IEnd = Result.end(); 826 I != IEnd; ++I) 827 SemaRef.Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_decl_hiding_tag_type) 828 << Name << TagName; 829 830 // Replace lookup results with just the tag decl. 831 Result.clear(Sema::LookupTagName); 832 SemaRef.LookupParsedName(Result, S, &SS); 833 return true; 834 } 835 836 return false; 837 } 838 839 /// Build a ParsedType for a simple-type-specifier with a nested-name-specifier. 840 static ParsedType buildNestedType(Sema &S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, 841 QualType T, SourceLocation NameLoc) { 842 ASTContext &Context = S.Context; 843 844 TypeLocBuilder Builder; 845 Builder.pushTypeSpec(T).setNameLoc(NameLoc); 846 847 T = S.getElaboratedType(ETK_None, SS, T); 848 ElaboratedTypeLoc ElabTL = Builder.push<ElaboratedTypeLoc>(T); 849 ElabTL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation()); 850 ElabTL.setQualifierLoc(SS.getWithLocInContext(Context)); 851 return S.CreateParsedType(T, Builder.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, T)); 852 } 853 854 Sema::NameClassification Sema::ClassifyName(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, 855 IdentifierInfo *&Name, 856 SourceLocation NameLoc, 857 const Token &NextToken, 858 CorrectionCandidateCallback *CCC) { 859 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(Name, NameLoc); 860 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl(); 861 862 assert(NextToken.isNot(tok::coloncolon) && 863 "parse nested name specifiers before calling ClassifyName"); 864 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && SS.isSet() && 865 isCurrentClassName(*Name, S, &SS)) { 866 // Per [class.qual]p2, this names the constructors of SS, not the 867 // injected-class-name. We don't have a classification for that. 868 // There's not much point caching this result, since the parser 869 // will reject it later. 870 return NameClassification::Unknown(); 871 } 872 873 LookupResult Result(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 874 LookupParsedName(Result, S, &SS, !CurMethod); 875 876 if (SS.isInvalid()) 877 return NameClassification::Error(); 878 879 // For unqualified lookup in a class template in MSVC mode, look into 880 // dependent base classes where the primary class template is known. 881 if (Result.empty() && SS.isEmpty() && getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) { 882 if (ParsedType TypeInBase = 883 recoverFromTypeInKnownDependentBase(*this, *Name, NameLoc)) 884 return TypeInBase; 885 } 886 887 // Perform lookup for Objective-C instance variables (including automatically 888 // synthesized instance variables), if we're in an Objective-C method. 889 // FIXME: This lookup really, really needs to be folded in to the normal 890 // unqualified lookup mechanism. 891 if (SS.isEmpty() && CurMethod && !isResultTypeOrTemplate(Result, NextToken)) { 892 DeclResult Ivar = LookupIvarInObjCMethod(Result, S, Name); 893 if (Ivar.isInvalid()) 894 return NameClassification::Error(); 895 if (Ivar.isUsable()) 896 return NameClassification::NonType(cast<NamedDecl>(Ivar.get())); 897 898 // We defer builtin creation until after ivar lookup inside ObjC methods. 899 if (Result.empty()) 900 LookupBuiltin(Result); 901 } 902 903 bool SecondTry = false; 904 bool IsFilteredTemplateName = false; 905 906 Corrected: 907 switch (Result.getResultKind()) { 908 case LookupResult::NotFound: 909 // If an unqualified-id is followed by a '(', then we have a function 910 // call. 911 if (SS.isEmpty() && NextToken.is(tok::l_paren)) { 912 // In C++, this is an ADL-only call. 913 // FIXME: Reference? 914 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 915 return NameClassification::UndeclaredNonType(); 916 917 // C90 6.3.2.2: 918 // If the expression that precedes the parenthesized argument list in a 919 // function call consists solely of an identifier, and if no 920 // declaration is visible for this identifier, the identifier is 921 // implicitly declared exactly as if, in the innermost block containing 922 // the function call, the declaration 923 // 924 // extern int identifier (); 925 // 926 // appeared. 927 // 928 // We also allow this in C99 as an extension. 929 if (NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *Name, S)) 930 return NameClassification::NonType(D); 931 } 932 933 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20 && SS.isEmpty() && NextToken.is(tok::less)) { 934 // In C++20 onwards, this could be an ADL-only call to a function 935 // template, and we're required to assume that this is a template name. 936 // 937 // FIXME: Find a way to still do typo correction in this case. 938 TemplateName Template = 939 Context.getAssumedTemplateName(NameInfo.getName()); 940 return NameClassification::UndeclaredTemplate(Template); 941 } 942 943 // In C, we first see whether there is a tag type by the same name, in 944 // which case it's likely that the user just forgot to write "enum", 945 // "struct", or "union". 946 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !SecondTry && 947 isTagTypeWithMissingTag(*this, Result, S, SS, Name, NameLoc)) { 948 break; 949 } 950 951 // Perform typo correction to determine if there is another name that is 952 // close to this name. 953 if (!SecondTry && CCC) { 954 SecondTry = true; 955 if (TypoCorrection Corrected = 956 CorrectTypo(Result.getLookupNameInfo(), Result.getLookupKind(), S, 957 &SS, *CCC, CTK_ErrorRecovery)) { 958 unsigned UnqualifiedDiag = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest; 959 unsigned QualifiedDiag = diag::err_no_member_suggest; 960 961 NamedDecl *FirstDecl = Corrected.getFoundDecl(); 962 NamedDecl *UnderlyingFirstDecl = Corrected.getCorrectionDecl(); 963 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NextToken.is(tok::less) && 964 UnderlyingFirstDecl && isa<TemplateDecl>(UnderlyingFirstDecl)) { 965 UnqualifiedDiag = diag::err_no_template_suggest; 966 QualifiedDiag = diag::err_no_member_template_suggest; 967 } else if (UnderlyingFirstDecl && 968 (isa<TypeDecl>(UnderlyingFirstDecl) || 969 isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(UnderlyingFirstDecl) || 970 isa<ObjCCompatibleAliasDecl>(UnderlyingFirstDecl))) { 971 UnqualifiedDiag = diag::err_unknown_typename_suggest; 972 QualifiedDiag = diag::err_unknown_nested_typename_suggest; 973 } 974 975 if (SS.isEmpty()) { 976 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(UnqualifiedDiag) << Name); 977 } else {// FIXME: is this even reachable? Test it. 978 std::string CorrectedStr(Corrected.getAsString(getLangOpts())); 979 bool DroppedSpecifier = Corrected.WillReplaceSpecifier() && 980 Name->getName().equals(CorrectedStr); 981 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(QualifiedDiag) 982 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) 983 << DroppedSpecifier << SS.getRange()); 984 } 985 986 // Update the name, so that the caller has the new name. 987 Name = Corrected.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo(); 988 989 // Typo correction corrected to a keyword. 990 if (Corrected.isKeyword()) 991 return Name; 992 993 // Also update the LookupResult... 994 // FIXME: This should probably go away at some point 995 Result.clear(); 996 Result.setLookupName(Corrected.getCorrection()); 997 if (FirstDecl) 998 Result.addDecl(FirstDecl); 999 1000 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let 1001 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to 1002 // reference the ivar. 1003 // FIXME: This is a gross hack. 1004 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = Result.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) { 1005 DeclResult R = 1006 LookupIvarInObjCMethod(Result, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()); 1007 if (R.isInvalid()) 1008 return NameClassification::Error(); 1009 if (R.isUsable()) 1010 return NameClassification::NonType(Ivar); 1011 } 1012 1013 goto Corrected; 1014 } 1015 } 1016 1017 // We failed to correct; just fall through and let the parser deal with it. 1018 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 1019 return NameClassification::Unknown(); 1020 1021 case LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation: { 1022 // We performed name lookup into the current instantiation, and there were 1023 // dependent bases, so we treat this result the same way as any other 1024 // dependent nested-name-specifier. 1025 1026 // C++ [temp.res]p2: 1027 // A name used in a template declaration or definition and that is 1028 // dependent on a template-parameter is assumed not to name a type 1029 // unless the applicable name lookup finds a type name or the name is 1030 // qualified by the keyword typename. 1031 // 1032 // FIXME: If the next token is '<', we might want to ask the parser to 1033 // perform some heroics to see if we actually have a 1034 // template-argument-list, which would indicate a missing 'template' 1035 // keyword here. 1036 return NameClassification::DependentNonType(); 1037 } 1038 1039 case LookupResult::Found: 1040 case LookupResult::FoundOverloaded: 1041 case LookupResult::FoundUnresolvedValue: 1042 break; 1043 1044 case LookupResult::Ambiguous: 1045 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NextToken.is(tok::less) && 1046 hasAnyAcceptableTemplateNames(Result, /*AllowFunctionTemplates=*/true, 1047 /*AllowDependent=*/false)) { 1048 // C++ [temp.local]p3: 1049 // A lookup that finds an injected-class-name (10.2) can result in an 1050 // ambiguity in certain cases (for example, if it is found in more than 1051 // one base class). If all of the injected-class-names that are found 1052 // refer to specializations of the same class template, and if the name 1053 // is followed by a template-argument-list, the reference refers to the 1054 // class template itself and not a specialization thereof, and is not 1055 // ambiguous. 1056 // 1057 // This filtering can make an ambiguous result into an unambiguous one, 1058 // so try again after filtering out template names. 1059 FilterAcceptableTemplateNames(Result); 1060 if (!Result.isAmbiguous()) { 1061 IsFilteredTemplateName = true; 1062 break; 1063 } 1064 } 1065 1066 // Diagnose the ambiguity and return an error. 1067 return NameClassification::Error(); 1068 } 1069 1070 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NextToken.is(tok::less) && 1071 (IsFilteredTemplateName || 1072 hasAnyAcceptableTemplateNames( 1073 Result, /*AllowFunctionTemplates=*/true, 1074 /*AllowDependent=*/false, 1075 /*AllowNonTemplateFunctions*/ SS.isEmpty() && 1076 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20))) { 1077 // C++ [temp.names]p3: 1078 // After name lookup (3.4) finds that a name is a template-name or that 1079 // an operator-function-id or a literal- operator-id refers to a set of 1080 // overloaded functions any member of which is a function template if 1081 // this is followed by a <, the < is always taken as the delimiter of a 1082 // template-argument-list and never as the less-than operator. 1083 // C++2a [temp.names]p2: 1084 // A name is also considered to refer to a template if it is an 1085 // unqualified-id followed by a < and name lookup finds either one 1086 // or more functions or finds nothing. 1087 if (!IsFilteredTemplateName) 1088 FilterAcceptableTemplateNames(Result); 1089 1090 bool IsFunctionTemplate; 1091 bool IsVarTemplate; 1092 TemplateName Template; 1093 if (Result.end() - Result.begin() > 1) { 1094 IsFunctionTemplate = true; 1095 Template = Context.getOverloadedTemplateName(Result.begin(), 1096 Result.end()); 1097 } else if (!Result.empty()) { 1098 auto *TD = cast<TemplateDecl>(getAsTemplateNameDecl( 1099 *Result.begin(), /*AllowFunctionTemplates=*/true, 1100 /*AllowDependent=*/false)); 1101 IsFunctionTemplate = isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(TD); 1102 IsVarTemplate = isa<VarTemplateDecl>(TD); 1103 1104 if (SS.isNotEmpty()) 1105 Template = 1106 Context.getQualifiedTemplateName(SS.getScopeRep(), 1107 /*TemplateKeyword=*/false, TD); 1108 else 1109 Template = TemplateName(TD); 1110 } else { 1111 // All results were non-template functions. This is a function template 1112 // name. 1113 IsFunctionTemplate = true; 1114 Template = Context.getAssumedTemplateName(NameInfo.getName()); 1115 } 1116 1117 if (IsFunctionTemplate) { 1118 // Function templates always go through overload resolution, at which 1119 // point we'll perform the various checks (e.g., accessibility) we need 1120 // to based on which function we selected. 1121 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 1122 1123 return NameClassification::FunctionTemplate(Template); 1124 } 1125 1126 return IsVarTemplate ? NameClassification::VarTemplate(Template) 1127 : NameClassification::TypeTemplate(Template); 1128 } 1129 1130 NamedDecl *FirstDecl = (*Result.begin())->getUnderlyingDecl(); 1131 if (TypeDecl *Type = dyn_cast<TypeDecl>(FirstDecl)) { 1132 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Type, NameLoc); 1133 MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Type->getLocation(), Type, /*OdrUse=*/false); 1134 QualType T = Context.getTypeDeclType(Type); 1135 if (SS.isNotEmpty()) 1136 return buildNestedType(*this, SS, T, NameLoc); 1137 return ParsedType::make(T); 1138 } 1139 1140 ObjCInterfaceDecl *Class = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(FirstDecl); 1141 if (!Class) { 1142 // FIXME: It's unfortunate that we don't have a Type node for handling this. 1143 if (ObjCCompatibleAliasDecl *Alias = 1144 dyn_cast<ObjCCompatibleAliasDecl>(FirstDecl)) 1145 Class = Alias->getClassInterface(); 1146 } 1147 1148 if (Class) { 1149 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Class, NameLoc); 1150 1151 if (NextToken.is(tok::period)) { 1152 // Interface. <something> is parsed as a property reference expression. 1153 // Just return "unknown" as a fall-through for now. 1154 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 1155 return NameClassification::Unknown(); 1156 } 1157 1158 QualType T = Context.getObjCInterfaceType(Class); 1159 return ParsedType::make(T); 1160 } 1161 1162 if (isa<ConceptDecl>(FirstDecl)) 1163 return NameClassification::Concept( 1164 TemplateName(cast<TemplateDecl>(FirstDecl))); 1165 1166 // We can have a type template here if we're classifying a template argument. 1167 if (isa<TemplateDecl>(FirstDecl) && !isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(FirstDecl) && 1168 !isa<VarTemplateDecl>(FirstDecl)) 1169 return NameClassification::TypeTemplate( 1170 TemplateName(cast<TemplateDecl>(FirstDecl))); 1171 1172 // Check for a tag type hidden by a non-type decl in a few cases where it 1173 // seems likely a type is wanted instead of the non-type that was found. 1174 bool NextIsOp = NextToken.isOneOf(tok::amp, tok::star); 1175 if ((NextToken.is(tok::identifier) || 1176 (NextIsOp && 1177 FirstDecl->getUnderlyingDecl()->isFunctionOrFunctionTemplate())) && 1178 isTagTypeWithMissingTag(*this, Result, S, SS, Name, NameLoc)) { 1179 TypeDecl *Type = Result.getAsSingle<TypeDecl>(); 1180 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Type, NameLoc); 1181 QualType T = Context.getTypeDeclType(Type); 1182 if (SS.isNotEmpty()) 1183 return buildNestedType(*this, SS, T, NameLoc); 1184 return ParsedType::make(T); 1185 } 1186 1187 // If we already know which single declaration is referenced, just annotate 1188 // that declaration directly. Defer resolving even non-overloaded class 1189 // member accesses, as we need to defer certain access checks until we know 1190 // the context. 1191 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, Result, NextToken.is(tok::l_paren)); 1192 if (Result.isSingleResult() && !ADL && !FirstDecl->isCXXClassMember()) 1193 return NameClassification::NonType(Result.getRepresentativeDecl()); 1194 1195 // Otherwise, this is an overload set that we will need to resolve later. 1196 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 1197 return NameClassification::OverloadSet(UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create( 1198 Context, Result.getNamingClass(), SS.getWithLocInContext(Context), 1199 Result.getLookupNameInfo(), ADL, Result.isOverloadedResult(), 1200 Result.begin(), Result.end())); 1201 } 1202 1203 ExprResult 1204 Sema::ActOnNameClassifiedAsUndeclaredNonType(IdentifierInfo *Name, 1205 SourceLocation NameLoc) { 1206 assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "ADL-only call in C?"); 1207 CXXScopeSpec SS; 1208 LookupResult Result(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 1209 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, Result, /*ADL=*/true); 1210 } 1211 1212 ExprResult 1213 Sema::ActOnNameClassifiedAsDependentNonType(const CXXScopeSpec &SS, 1214 IdentifierInfo *Name, 1215 SourceLocation NameLoc, 1216 bool IsAddressOfOperand) { 1217 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(Name, NameLoc); 1218 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(), 1219 NameInfo, IsAddressOfOperand, 1220 /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr); 1221 } 1222 1223 ExprResult Sema::ActOnNameClassifiedAsNonType(Scope *S, const CXXScopeSpec &SS, 1224 NamedDecl *Found, 1225 SourceLocation NameLoc, 1226 const Token &NextToken) { 1227 if (getCurMethodDecl() && SS.isEmpty()) 1228 if (auto *Ivar = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl())) 1229 return BuildIvarRefExpr(S, NameLoc, Ivar); 1230 1231 // Reconstruct the lookup result. 1232 LookupResult Result(*this, Found->getDeclName(), NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 1233 Result.addDecl(Found); 1234 Result.resolveKind(); 1235 1236 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, Result, NextToken.is(tok::l_paren)); 1237 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, Result, ADL); 1238 } 1239 1240 ExprResult Sema::ActOnNameClassifiedAsOverloadSet(Scope *S, Expr *E) { 1241 // For an implicit class member access, transform the result into a member 1242 // access expression if necessary. 1243 auto *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E); 1244 if ((*ULE->decls_begin())->isCXXClassMember()) { 1245 CXXScopeSpec SS; 1246 SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc()); 1247 1248 // Reconstruct the lookup result. 1249 LookupResult Result(*this, ULE->getName(), ULE->getNameLoc(), 1250 LookupOrdinaryName); 1251 Result.setNamingClass(ULE->getNamingClass()); 1252 for (auto I = ULE->decls_begin(), E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) 1253 Result.addDecl(*I, I.getAccess()); 1254 Result.resolveKind(); 1255 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, SourceLocation(), Result, 1256 nullptr, S); 1257 } 1258 1259 // Otherwise, this is already in the form we needed, and no further checks 1260 // are necessary. 1261 return ULE; 1262 } 1263 1264 Sema::TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics 1265 Sema::getTemplateNameKindForDiagnostics(TemplateName Name) { 1266 auto *TD = Name.getAsTemplateDecl(); 1267 if (!TD) 1268 return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::DependentTemplate; 1269 if (isa<ClassTemplateDecl>(TD)) 1270 return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::ClassTemplate; 1271 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(TD)) 1272 return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::FunctionTemplate; 1273 if (isa<VarTemplateDecl>(TD)) 1274 return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::VarTemplate; 1275 if (isa<TypeAliasTemplateDecl>(TD)) 1276 return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::AliasTemplate; 1277 if (isa<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(TD)) 1278 return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::TemplateTemplateParam; 1279 if (isa<ConceptDecl>(TD)) 1280 return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::Concept; 1281 return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::DependentTemplate; 1282 } 1283 1284 void Sema::PushDeclContext(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC) { 1285 assert(DC->getLexicalParent() == CurContext && 1286 "The next DeclContext should be lexically contained in the current one."); 1287 CurContext = DC; 1288 S->setEntity(DC); 1289 } 1290 1291 void Sema::PopDeclContext() { 1292 assert(CurContext && "DeclContext imbalance!"); 1293 1294 CurContext = CurContext->getLexicalParent(); 1295 assert(CurContext && "Popped translation unit!"); 1296 } 1297 1298 Sema::SkippedDefinitionContext Sema::ActOnTagStartSkippedDefinition(Scope *S, 1299 Decl *D) { 1300 // Unlike PushDeclContext, the context to which we return is not necessarily 1301 // the containing DC of TD, because the new context will be some pre-existing 1302 // TagDecl definition instead of a fresh one. 1303 auto Result = static_cast<SkippedDefinitionContext>(CurContext); 1304 CurContext = cast<TagDecl>(D)->getDefinition(); 1305 assert(CurContext && "skipping definition of undefined tag"); 1306 // Start lookups from the parent of the current context; we don't want to look 1307 // into the pre-existing complete definition. 1308 S->setEntity(CurContext->getLookupParent()); 1309 return Result; 1310 } 1311 1312 void Sema::ActOnTagFinishSkippedDefinition(SkippedDefinitionContext Context) { 1313 CurContext = static_cast<decltype(CurContext)>(Context); 1314 } 1315 1316 /// EnterDeclaratorContext - Used when we must lookup names in the context 1317 /// of a declarator's nested name specifier. 1318 /// 1319 void Sema::EnterDeclaratorContext(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC) { 1320 // C++0x [basic.lookup.unqual]p13: 1321 // A name used in the definition of a static data member of class 1322 // X (after the qualified-id of the static member) is looked up as 1323 // if the name was used in a member function of X. 1324 // C++0x [basic.lookup.unqual]p14: 1325 // If a variable member of a namespace is defined outside of the 1326 // scope of its namespace then any name used in the definition of 1327 // the variable member (after the declarator-id) is looked up as 1328 // if the definition of the variable member occurred in its 1329 // namespace. 1330 // Both of these imply that we should push a scope whose context 1331 // is the semantic context of the declaration. We can't use 1332 // PushDeclContext here because that context is not necessarily 1333 // lexically contained in the current context. Fortunately, 1334 // the containing scope should have the appropriate information. 1335 1336 assert(!S->getEntity() && "scope already has entity"); 1337 1338 #ifndef NDEBUG 1339 Scope *Ancestor = S->getParent(); 1340 while (!Ancestor->getEntity()) Ancestor = Ancestor->getParent(); 1341 assert(Ancestor->getEntity() == CurContext && "ancestor context mismatch"); 1342 #endif 1343 1344 CurContext = DC; 1345 S->setEntity(DC); 1346 1347 if (S->getParent()->isTemplateParamScope()) { 1348 // Also set the corresponding entities for all immediately-enclosing 1349 // template parameter scopes. 1350 EnterTemplatedContext(S->getParent(), DC); 1351 } 1352 } 1353 1354 void Sema::ExitDeclaratorContext(Scope *S) { 1355 assert(S->getEntity() == CurContext && "Context imbalance!"); 1356 1357 // Switch back to the lexical context. The safety of this is 1358 // enforced by an assert in EnterDeclaratorContext. 1359 Scope *Ancestor = S->getParent(); 1360 while (!Ancestor->getEntity()) Ancestor = Ancestor->getParent(); 1361 CurContext = Ancestor->getEntity(); 1362 1363 // We don't need to do anything with the scope, which is going to 1364 // disappear. 1365 } 1366 1367 void Sema::EnterTemplatedContext(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC) { 1368 assert(S->isTemplateParamScope() && 1369 "expected to be initializing a template parameter scope"); 1370 1371 // C++20 [temp.local]p7: 1372 // In the definition of a member of a class template that appears outside 1373 // of the class template definition, the name of a member of the class 1374 // template hides the name of a template-parameter of any enclosing class 1375 // templates (but not a template-parameter of the member if the member is a 1376 // class or function template). 1377 // C++20 [temp.local]p9: 1378 // In the definition of a class template or in the definition of a member 1379 // of such a template that appears outside of the template definition, for 1380 // each non-dependent base class (13.8.2.1), if the name of the base class 1381 // or the name of a member of the base class is the same as the name of a 1382 // template-parameter, the base class name or member name hides the 1383 // template-parameter name (6.4.10). 1384 // 1385 // This means that a template parameter scope should be searched immediately 1386 // after searching the DeclContext for which it is a template parameter 1387 // scope. For example, for 1388 // template<typename T> template<typename U> template<typename V> 1389 // void N::A<T>::B<U>::f(...) 1390 // we search V then B<U> (and base classes) then U then A<T> (and base 1391 // classes) then T then N then ::. 1392 unsigned ScopeDepth = getTemplateDepth(S); 1393 for (; S && S->isTemplateParamScope(); S = S->getParent(), --ScopeDepth) { 1394 DeclContext *SearchDCAfterScope = DC; 1395 for (; DC; DC = DC->getLookupParent()) { 1396 if (const TemplateParameterList *TPL = 1397 cast<Decl>(DC)->getDescribedTemplateParams()) { 1398 unsigned DCDepth = TPL->getDepth() + 1; 1399 if (DCDepth > ScopeDepth) 1400 continue; 1401 if (ScopeDepth == DCDepth) 1402 SearchDCAfterScope = DC = DC->getLookupParent(); 1403 break; 1404 } 1405 } 1406 S->setLookupEntity(SearchDCAfterScope); 1407 } 1408 } 1409 1410 void Sema::ActOnReenterFunctionContext(Scope* S, Decl *D) { 1411 // We assume that the caller has already called 1412 // ActOnReenterTemplateScope so getTemplatedDecl() works. 1413 FunctionDecl *FD = D->getAsFunction(); 1414 if (!FD) 1415 return; 1416 1417 // Same implementation as PushDeclContext, but enters the context 1418 // from the lexical parent, rather than the top-level class. 1419 assert(CurContext == FD->getLexicalParent() && 1420 "The next DeclContext should be lexically contained in the current one."); 1421 CurContext = FD; 1422 S->setEntity(CurContext); 1423 1424 for (unsigned P = 0, NumParams = FD->getNumParams(); P < NumParams; ++P) { 1425 ParmVarDecl *Param = FD->getParamDecl(P); 1426 // If the parameter has an identifier, then add it to the scope 1427 if (Param->getIdentifier()) { 1428 S->AddDecl(Param); 1429 IdResolver.AddDecl(Param); 1430 } 1431 } 1432 } 1433 1434 void Sema::ActOnExitFunctionContext() { 1435 // Same implementation as PopDeclContext, but returns to the lexical parent, 1436 // rather than the top-level class. 1437 assert(CurContext && "DeclContext imbalance!"); 1438 CurContext = CurContext->getLexicalParent(); 1439 assert(CurContext && "Popped translation unit!"); 1440 } 1441 1442 /// Determine whether we allow overloading of the function 1443 /// PrevDecl with another declaration. 1444 /// 1445 /// This routine determines whether overloading is possible, not 1446 /// whether some new function is actually an overload. It will return 1447 /// true in C++ (where we can always provide overloads) or, as an 1448 /// extension, in C when the previous function is already an 1449 /// overloaded function declaration or has the "overloadable" 1450 /// attribute. 1451 static bool AllowOverloadingOfFunction(LookupResult &Previous, 1452 ASTContext &Context, 1453 const FunctionDecl *New) { 1454 if (Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 1455 return true; 1456 1457 if (Previous.getResultKind() == LookupResult::FoundOverloaded) 1458 return true; 1459 1460 return Previous.getResultKind() == LookupResult::Found && 1461 (Previous.getFoundDecl()->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>() || 1462 New->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>()); 1463 } 1464 1465 /// Add this decl to the scope shadowed decl chains. 1466 void Sema::PushOnScopeChains(NamedDecl *D, Scope *S, bool AddToContext) { 1467 // Move up the scope chain until we find the nearest enclosing 1468 // non-transparent context. The declaration will be introduced into this 1469 // scope. 1470 while (S->getEntity() && S->getEntity()->isTransparentContext()) 1471 S = S->getParent(); 1472 1473 // Add scoped declarations into their context, so that they can be 1474 // found later. Declarations without a context won't be inserted 1475 // into any context. 1476 if (AddToContext) 1477 CurContext->addDecl(D); 1478 1479 // Out-of-line definitions shouldn't be pushed into scope in C++, unless they 1480 // are function-local declarations. 1481 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && D->isOutOfLine() && !S->getFnParent()) 1482 return; 1483 1484 // Template instantiations should also not be pushed into scope. 1485 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D) && 1486 cast<FunctionDecl>(D)->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization()) 1487 return; 1488 1489 // If this replaces anything in the current scope, 1490 IdentifierResolver::iterator I = IdResolver.begin(D->getDeclName()), 1491 IEnd = IdResolver.end(); 1492 for (; I != IEnd; ++I) { 1493 if (S->isDeclScope(*I) && D->declarationReplaces(*I)) { 1494 S->RemoveDecl(*I); 1495 IdResolver.RemoveDecl(*I); 1496 1497 // Should only need to replace one decl. 1498 break; 1499 } 1500 } 1501 1502 S->AddDecl(D); 1503 1504 if (isa<LabelDecl>(D) && !cast<LabelDecl>(D)->isGnuLocal()) { 1505 // Implicitly-generated labels may end up getting generated in an order that 1506 // isn't strictly lexical, which breaks name lookup. Be careful to insert 1507 // the label at the appropriate place in the identifier chain. 1508 for (I = IdResolver.begin(D->getDeclName()); I != IEnd; ++I) { 1509 DeclContext *IDC = (*I)->getLexicalDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 1510 if (IDC == CurContext) { 1511 if (!S->isDeclScope(*I)) 1512 continue; 1513 } else if (IDC->Encloses(CurContext)) 1514 break; 1515 } 1516 1517 IdResolver.InsertDeclAfter(I, D); 1518 } else { 1519 IdResolver.AddDecl(D); 1520 } 1521 } 1522 1523 bool Sema::isDeclInScope(NamedDecl *D, DeclContext *Ctx, Scope *S, 1524 bool AllowInlineNamespace) { 1525 return IdResolver.isDeclInScope(D, Ctx, S, AllowInlineNamespace); 1526 } 1527 1528 Scope *Sema::getScopeForDeclContext(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC) { 1529 DeclContext *TargetDC = DC->getPrimaryContext(); 1530 do { 1531 if (DeclContext *ScopeDC = S->getEntity()) 1532 if (ScopeDC->getPrimaryContext() == TargetDC) 1533 return S; 1534 } while ((S = S->getParent())); 1535 1536 return nullptr; 1537 } 1538 1539 static bool isOutOfScopePreviousDeclaration(NamedDecl *, 1540 DeclContext*, 1541 ASTContext&); 1542 1543 /// Filters out lookup results that don't fall within the given scope 1544 /// as determined by isDeclInScope. 1545 void Sema::FilterLookupForScope(LookupResult &R, DeclContext *Ctx, Scope *S, 1546 bool ConsiderLinkage, 1547 bool AllowInlineNamespace) { 1548 LookupResult::Filter F = R.makeFilter(); 1549 while (F.hasNext()) { 1550 NamedDecl *D = F.next(); 1551 1552 if (isDeclInScope(D, Ctx, S, AllowInlineNamespace)) 1553 continue; 1554 1555 if (ConsiderLinkage && isOutOfScopePreviousDeclaration(D, Ctx, Context)) 1556 continue; 1557 1558 F.erase(); 1559 } 1560 1561 F.done(); 1562 } 1563 1564 /// We've determined that \p New is a redeclaration of \p Old. Check that they 1565 /// have compatible owning modules. 1566 bool Sema::CheckRedeclarationModuleOwnership(NamedDecl *New, NamedDecl *Old) { 1567 // FIXME: The Modules TS is not clear about how friend declarations are 1568 // to be treated. It's not meaningful to have different owning modules for 1569 // linkage in redeclarations of the same entity, so for now allow the 1570 // redeclaration and change the owning modules to match. 1571 if (New->getFriendObjectKind() && 1572 Old->getOwningModuleForLinkage() != New->getOwningModuleForLinkage()) { 1573 New->setLocalOwningModule(Old->getOwningModule()); 1574 makeMergedDefinitionVisible(New); 1575 return false; 1576 } 1577 1578 Module *NewM = New->getOwningModule(); 1579 Module *OldM = Old->getOwningModule(); 1580 1581 if (NewM && NewM->Kind == Module::PrivateModuleFragment) 1582 NewM = NewM->Parent; 1583 if (OldM && OldM->Kind == Module::PrivateModuleFragment) 1584 OldM = OldM->Parent; 1585 1586 if (NewM == OldM) 1587 return false; 1588 1589 bool NewIsModuleInterface = NewM && NewM->isModulePurview(); 1590 bool OldIsModuleInterface = OldM && OldM->isModulePurview(); 1591 if (NewIsModuleInterface || OldIsModuleInterface) { 1592 // C++ Modules TS [basic.def.odr] 6.2/6.7 [sic]: 1593 // if a declaration of D [...] appears in the purview of a module, all 1594 // other such declarations shall appear in the purview of the same module 1595 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_mismatched_owning_module) 1596 << New 1597 << NewIsModuleInterface 1598 << (NewIsModuleInterface ? NewM->getFullModuleName() : "") 1599 << OldIsModuleInterface 1600 << (OldIsModuleInterface ? OldM->getFullModuleName() : ""); 1601 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 1602 New->setInvalidDecl(); 1603 return true; 1604 } 1605 1606 return false; 1607 } 1608 1609 static bool isUsingDecl(NamedDecl *D) { 1610 return isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D) || 1611 isa<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(D) || 1612 isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(D); 1613 } 1614 1615 /// Removes using shadow declarations from the lookup results. 1616 static void RemoveUsingDecls(LookupResult &R) { 1617 LookupResult::Filter F = R.makeFilter(); 1618 while (F.hasNext()) 1619 if (isUsingDecl(F.next())) 1620 F.erase(); 1621 1622 F.done(); 1623 } 1624 1625 /// Check for this common pattern: 1626 /// @code 1627 /// class S { 1628 /// S(const S&); // DO NOT IMPLEMENT 1629 /// void operator=(const S&); // DO NOT IMPLEMENT 1630 /// }; 1631 /// @endcode 1632 static bool IsDisallowedCopyOrAssign(const CXXMethodDecl *D) { 1633 // FIXME: Should check for private access too but access is set after we get 1634 // the decl here. 1635 if (D->doesThisDeclarationHaveABody()) 1636 return false; 1637 1638 if (const CXXConstructorDecl *CD = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) 1639 return CD->isCopyConstructor(); 1640 return D->isCopyAssignmentOperator(); 1641 } 1642 1643 // We need this to handle 1644 // 1645 // typedef struct { 1646 // void *foo() { return 0; } 1647 // } A; 1648 // 1649 // When we see foo we don't know if after the typedef we will get 'A' or '*A' 1650 // for example. If 'A', foo will have external linkage. If we have '*A', 1651 // foo will have no linkage. Since we can't know until we get to the end 1652 // of the typedef, this function finds out if D might have non-external linkage. 1653 // Callers should verify at the end of the TU if it D has external linkage or 1654 // not. 1655 bool Sema::mightHaveNonExternalLinkage(const DeclaratorDecl *D) { 1656 const DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext(); 1657 while (!DC->isTranslationUnit()) { 1658 if (const RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(DC)){ 1659 if (!RD->hasNameForLinkage()) 1660 return true; 1661 } 1662 DC = DC->getParent(); 1663 } 1664 1665 return !D->isExternallyVisible(); 1666 } 1667 1668 // FIXME: This needs to be refactored; some other isInMainFile users want 1669 // these semantics. 1670 static bool isMainFileLoc(const Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) { 1671 if (S.TUKind != TU_Complete) 1672 return false; 1673 return S.SourceMgr.isInMainFile(Loc); 1674 } 1675 1676 bool Sema::ShouldWarnIfUnusedFileScopedDecl(const DeclaratorDecl *D) const { 1677 assert(D); 1678 1679 if (D->isInvalidDecl() || D->isUsed() || D->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>()) 1680 return false; 1681 1682 // Ignore all entities declared within templates, and out-of-line definitions 1683 // of members of class templates. 1684 if (D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext() || 1685 D->getLexicalDeclContext()->isDependentContext()) 1686 return false; 1687 1688 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 1689 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) 1690 return false; 1691 // A non-out-of-line declaration of a member specialization was implicitly 1692 // instantiated; it's the out-of-line declaration that we're interested in. 1693 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ExplicitSpecialization && 1694 FD->getMemberSpecializationInfo() && !FD->isOutOfLine()) 1695 return false; 1696 1697 if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) { 1698 if (MD->isVirtual() || IsDisallowedCopyOrAssign(MD)) 1699 return false; 1700 } else { 1701 // 'static inline' functions are defined in headers; don't warn. 1702 if (FD->isInlined() && !isMainFileLoc(*this, FD->getLocation())) 1703 return false; 1704 } 1705 1706 if (FD->doesThisDeclarationHaveABody() && 1707 Context.DeclMustBeEmitted(FD)) 1708 return false; 1709 } else if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 1710 // Constants and utility variables are defined in headers with internal 1711 // linkage; don't warn. (Unlike functions, there isn't a convenient marker 1712 // like "inline".) 1713 if (!isMainFileLoc(*this, VD->getLocation())) 1714 return false; 1715 1716 if (Context.DeclMustBeEmitted(VD)) 1717 return false; 1718 1719 if (VD->isStaticDataMember() && 1720 VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) 1721 return false; 1722 if (VD->isStaticDataMember() && 1723 VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ExplicitSpecialization && 1724 VD->getMemberSpecializationInfo() && !VD->isOutOfLine()) 1725 return false; 1726 1727 if (VD->isInline() && !isMainFileLoc(*this, VD->getLocation())) 1728 return false; 1729 } else { 1730 return false; 1731 } 1732 1733 // Only warn for unused decls internal to the translation unit. 1734 // FIXME: This seems like a bogus check; it suppresses -Wunused-function 1735 // for inline functions defined in the main source file, for instance. 1736 return mightHaveNonExternalLinkage(D); 1737 } 1738 1739 void Sema::MarkUnusedFileScopedDecl(const DeclaratorDecl *D) { 1740 if (!D) 1741 return; 1742 1743 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 1744 const FunctionDecl *First = FD->getFirstDecl(); 1745 if (FD != First && ShouldWarnIfUnusedFileScopedDecl(First)) 1746 return; // First should already be in the vector. 1747 } 1748 1749 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 1750 const VarDecl *First = VD->getFirstDecl(); 1751 if (VD != First && ShouldWarnIfUnusedFileScopedDecl(First)) 1752 return; // First should already be in the vector. 1753 } 1754 1755 if (ShouldWarnIfUnusedFileScopedDecl(D)) 1756 UnusedFileScopedDecls.push_back(D); 1757 } 1758 1759 static bool ShouldDiagnoseUnusedDecl(const NamedDecl *D) { 1760 if (D->isInvalidDecl()) 1761 return false; 1762 1763 if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(D)) { 1764 // For a decomposition declaration, warn if none of the bindings are 1765 // referenced, instead of if the variable itself is referenced (which 1766 // it is, by the bindings' expressions). 1767 for (auto *BD : DD->bindings()) 1768 if (BD->isReferenced()) 1769 return false; 1770 } else if (!D->getDeclName()) { 1771 return false; 1772 } else if (D->isReferenced() || D->isUsed()) { 1773 return false; 1774 } 1775 1776 if (D->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>() || D->hasAttr<ObjCPreciseLifetimeAttr>()) 1777 return false; 1778 1779 if (isa<LabelDecl>(D)) 1780 return true; 1781 1782 // Except for labels, we only care about unused decls that are local to 1783 // functions. 1784 bool WithinFunction = D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod(); 1785 if (const auto *R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext())) 1786 // For dependent types, the diagnostic is deferred. 1787 WithinFunction = 1788 WithinFunction || (R->isLocalClass() && !R->isDependentType()); 1789 if (!WithinFunction) 1790 return false; 1791 1792 if (isa<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) 1793 return true; 1794 1795 // White-list anything that isn't a local variable. 1796 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) || isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) || isa<ImplicitParamDecl>(D)) 1797 return false; 1798 1799 // Types of valid local variables should be complete, so this should succeed. 1800 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 1801 1802 // White-list anything with an __attribute__((unused)) type. 1803 const auto *Ty = VD->getType().getTypePtr(); 1804 1805 // Only look at the outermost level of typedef. 1806 if (const TypedefType *TT = Ty->getAs<TypedefType>()) { 1807 if (TT->getDecl()->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>()) 1808 return false; 1809 } 1810 1811 // If we failed to complete the type for some reason, or if the type is 1812 // dependent, don't diagnose the variable. 1813 if (Ty->isIncompleteType() || Ty->isDependentType()) 1814 return false; 1815 1816 // Look at the element type to ensure that the warning behaviour is 1817 // consistent for both scalars and arrays. 1818 Ty = Ty->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe(); 1819 1820 if (const TagType *TT = Ty->getAs<TagType>()) { 1821 const TagDecl *Tag = TT->getDecl(); 1822 if (Tag->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>()) 1823 return false; 1824 1825 if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Tag)) { 1826 if (!RD->hasTrivialDestructor() && !RD->hasAttr<WarnUnusedAttr>()) 1827 return false; 1828 1829 if (const Expr *Init = VD->getInit()) { 1830 if (const ExprWithCleanups *Cleanups = 1831 dyn_cast<ExprWithCleanups>(Init)) 1832 Init = Cleanups->getSubExpr(); 1833 const CXXConstructExpr *Construct = 1834 dyn_cast<CXXConstructExpr>(Init); 1835 if (Construct && !Construct->isElidable()) { 1836 CXXConstructorDecl *CD = Construct->getConstructor(); 1837 if (!CD->isTrivial() && !RD->hasAttr<WarnUnusedAttr>() && 1838 (VD->getInit()->isValueDependent() || !VD->evaluateValue())) 1839 return false; 1840 } 1841 1842 // Suppress the warning if we don't know how this is constructed, and 1843 // it could possibly be non-trivial constructor. 1844 if (Init->isTypeDependent()) 1845 for (const CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor : RD->ctors()) 1846 if (!Ctor->isTrivial()) 1847 return false; 1848 } 1849 } 1850 } 1851 1852 // TODO: __attribute__((unused)) templates? 1853 } 1854 1855 return true; 1856 } 1857 1858 static void GenerateFixForUnusedDecl(const NamedDecl *D, ASTContext &Ctx, 1859 FixItHint &Hint) { 1860 if (isa<LabelDecl>(D)) { 1861 SourceLocation AfterColon = Lexer::findLocationAfterToken( 1862 D->getEndLoc(), tok::colon, Ctx.getSourceManager(), Ctx.getLangOpts(), 1863 true); 1864 if (AfterColon.isInvalid()) 1865 return; 1866 Hint = FixItHint::CreateRemoval( 1867 CharSourceRange::getCharRange(D->getBeginLoc(), AfterColon)); 1868 } 1869 } 1870 1871 void Sema::DiagnoseUnusedNestedTypedefs(const RecordDecl *D) { 1872 if (D->getTypeForDecl()->isDependentType()) 1873 return; 1874 1875 for (auto *TmpD : D->decls()) { 1876 if (const auto *T = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(TmpD)) 1877 DiagnoseUnusedDecl(T); 1878 else if(const auto *R = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(TmpD)) 1879 DiagnoseUnusedNestedTypedefs(R); 1880 } 1881 } 1882 1883 /// DiagnoseUnusedDecl - Emit warnings about declarations that are not used 1884 /// unless they are marked attr(unused). 1885 void Sema::DiagnoseUnusedDecl(const NamedDecl *D) { 1886 if (!ShouldDiagnoseUnusedDecl(D)) 1887 return; 1888 1889 if (auto *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) { 1890 // typedefs can be referenced later on, so the diagnostics are emitted 1891 // at end-of-translation-unit. 1892 UnusedLocalTypedefNameCandidates.insert(TD); 1893 return; 1894 } 1895 1896 FixItHint Hint; 1897 GenerateFixForUnusedDecl(D, Context, Hint); 1898 1899 unsigned DiagID; 1900 if (isa<VarDecl>(D) && cast<VarDecl>(D)->isExceptionVariable()) 1901 DiagID = diag::warn_unused_exception_param; 1902 else if (isa<LabelDecl>(D)) 1903 DiagID = diag::warn_unused_label; 1904 else 1905 DiagID = diag::warn_unused_variable; 1906 1907 Diag(D->getLocation(), DiagID) << D << Hint; 1908 } 1909 1910 static void CheckPoppedLabel(LabelDecl *L, Sema &S) { 1911 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto 1912 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it. Label fwd 1913 // definitions are indicated with a null substmt which is also not a resolved 1914 // MS inline assembly label name. 1915 bool Diagnose = false; 1916 if (L->isMSAsmLabel()) 1917 Diagnose = !L->isResolvedMSAsmLabel(); 1918 else 1919 Diagnose = L->getStmt() == nullptr; 1920 if (Diagnose) 1921 S.Diag(L->getLocation(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L; 1922 } 1923 1924 void Sema::ActOnPopScope(SourceLocation Loc, Scope *S) { 1925 S->mergeNRVOIntoParent(); 1926 1927 if (S->decl_empty()) return; 1928 assert((S->getFlags() & (Scope::DeclScope | Scope::TemplateParamScope)) && 1929 "Scope shouldn't contain decls!"); 1930 1931 for (auto *TmpD : S->decls()) { 1932 assert(TmpD && "This decl didn't get pushed??"); 1933 1934 assert(isa<NamedDecl>(TmpD) && "Decl isn't NamedDecl?"); 1935 NamedDecl *D = cast<NamedDecl>(TmpD); 1936 1937 // Diagnose unused variables in this scope. 1938 if (!S->hasUnrecoverableErrorOccurred()) { 1939 DiagnoseUnusedDecl(D); 1940 if (const auto *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(D)) 1941 DiagnoseUnusedNestedTypedefs(RD); 1942 } 1943 1944 if (!D->getDeclName()) continue; 1945 1946 // If this was a forward reference to a label, verify it was defined. 1947 if (LabelDecl *LD = dyn_cast<LabelDecl>(D)) 1948 CheckPoppedLabel(LD, *this); 1949 1950 // Remove this name from our lexical scope, and warn on it if we haven't 1951 // already. 1952 IdResolver.RemoveDecl(D); 1953 auto ShadowI = ShadowingDecls.find(D); 1954 if (ShadowI != ShadowingDecls.end()) { 1955 if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(ShadowI->second)) { 1956 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::warn_ctor_parm_shadows_field) 1957 << D << FD << FD->getParent(); 1958 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 1959 } 1960 ShadowingDecls.erase(ShadowI); 1961 } 1962 } 1963 } 1964 1965 /// Look for an Objective-C class in the translation unit. 1966 /// 1967 /// \param Id The name of the Objective-C class we're looking for. If 1968 /// typo-correction fixes this name, the Id will be updated 1969 /// to the fixed name. 1970 /// 1971 /// \param IdLoc The location of the name in the translation unit. 1972 /// 1973 /// \param DoTypoCorrection If true, this routine will attempt typo correction 1974 /// if there is no class with the given name. 1975 /// 1976 /// \returns The declaration of the named Objective-C class, or NULL if the 1977 /// class could not be found. 1978 ObjCInterfaceDecl *Sema::getObjCInterfaceDecl(IdentifierInfo *&Id, 1979 SourceLocation IdLoc, 1980 bool DoTypoCorrection) { 1981 // The third "scope" argument is 0 since we aren't enabling lazy built-in 1982 // creation from this context. 1983 NamedDecl *IDecl = LookupSingleName(TUScope, Id, IdLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 1984 1985 if (!IDecl && DoTypoCorrection) { 1986 // Perform typo correction at the given location, but only if we 1987 // find an Objective-C class name. 1988 DeclFilterCCC<ObjCInterfaceDecl> CCC{}; 1989 if (TypoCorrection C = 1990 CorrectTypo(DeclarationNameInfo(Id, IdLoc), LookupOrdinaryName, 1991 TUScope, nullptr, CCC, CTK_ErrorRecovery)) { 1992 diagnoseTypo(C, PDiag(diag::err_undef_interface_suggest) << Id); 1993 IDecl = C.getCorrectionDeclAs<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(); 1994 Id = IDecl->getIdentifier(); 1995 } 1996 } 1997 ObjCInterfaceDecl *Def = dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(IDecl); 1998 // This routine must always return a class definition, if any. 1999 if (Def && Def->getDefinition()) 2000 Def = Def->getDefinition(); 2001 return Def; 2002 } 2003 2004 /// getNonFieldDeclScope - Retrieves the innermost scope, starting 2005 /// from S, where a non-field would be declared. This routine copes 2006 /// with the difference between C and C++ scoping rules in structs and 2007 /// unions. For example, the following code is well-formed in C but 2008 /// ill-formed in C++: 2009 /// @code 2010 /// struct S6 { 2011 /// enum { BAR } e; 2012 /// }; 2013 /// 2014 /// void test_S6() { 2015 /// struct S6 a; 2016 /// a.e = BAR; 2017 /// } 2018 /// @endcode 2019 /// For the declaration of BAR, this routine will return a different 2020 /// scope. The scope S will be the scope of the unnamed enumeration 2021 /// within S6. In C++, this routine will return the scope associated 2022 /// with S6, because the enumeration's scope is a transparent 2023 /// context but structures can contain non-field names. In C, this 2024 /// routine will return the translation unit scope, since the 2025 /// enumeration's scope is a transparent context and structures cannot 2026 /// contain non-field names. 2027 Scope *Sema::getNonFieldDeclScope(Scope *S) { 2028 while (((S->getFlags() & Scope::DeclScope) == 0) || 2029 (S->getEntity() && S->getEntity()->isTransparentContext()) || 2030 (S->isClassScope() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)) 2031 S = S->getParent(); 2032 return S; 2033 } 2034 2035 static StringRef getHeaderName(Builtin::Context &BuiltinInfo, unsigned ID, 2036 ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError Error) { 2037 switch (Error) { 2038 case ASTContext::GE_None: 2039 return ""; 2040 case ASTContext::GE_Missing_type: 2041 return BuiltinInfo.getHeaderName(ID); 2042 case ASTContext::GE_Missing_stdio: 2043 return "stdio.h"; 2044 case ASTContext::GE_Missing_setjmp: 2045 return "setjmp.h"; 2046 case ASTContext::GE_Missing_ucontext: 2047 return "ucontext.h"; 2048 } 2049 llvm_unreachable("unhandled error kind"); 2050 } 2051 2052 FunctionDecl *Sema::CreateBuiltin(IdentifierInfo *II, QualType Type, 2053 unsigned ID, SourceLocation Loc) { 2054 DeclContext *Parent = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl(); 2055 2056 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 2057 LinkageSpecDecl *CLinkageDecl = LinkageSpecDecl::Create( 2058 Context, Parent, Loc, Loc, LinkageSpecDecl::lang_c, false); 2059 CLinkageDecl->setImplicit(); 2060 Parent->addDecl(CLinkageDecl); 2061 Parent = CLinkageDecl; 2062 } 2063 2064 FunctionDecl *New = FunctionDecl::Create(Context, Parent, Loc, Loc, II, Type, 2065 /*TInfo=*/nullptr, SC_Extern, false, 2066 Type->isFunctionProtoType()); 2067 New->setImplicit(); 2068 New->addAttr(BuiltinAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, ID)); 2069 2070 // Create Decl objects for each parameter, adding them to the 2071 // FunctionDecl. 2072 if (const FunctionProtoType *FT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Type)) { 2073 SmallVector<ParmVarDecl *, 16> Params; 2074 for (unsigned i = 0, e = FT->getNumParams(); i != e; ++i) { 2075 ParmVarDecl *parm = ParmVarDecl::Create( 2076 Context, New, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(), nullptr, 2077 FT->getParamType(i), /*TInfo=*/nullptr, SC_None, nullptr); 2078 parm->setScopeInfo(0, i); 2079 Params.push_back(parm); 2080 } 2081 New->setParams(Params); 2082 } 2083 2084 AddKnownFunctionAttributes(New); 2085 return New; 2086 } 2087 2088 /// LazilyCreateBuiltin - The specified Builtin-ID was first used at 2089 /// file scope. lazily create a decl for it. ForRedeclaration is true 2090 /// if we're creating this built-in in anticipation of redeclaring the 2091 /// built-in. 2092 NamedDecl *Sema::LazilyCreateBuiltin(IdentifierInfo *II, unsigned ID, 2093 Scope *S, bool ForRedeclaration, 2094 SourceLocation Loc) { 2095 LookupNecessaryTypesForBuiltin(S, ID); 2096 2097 ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError Error; 2098 QualType R = Context.GetBuiltinType(ID, Error); 2099 if (Error) { 2100 if (!ForRedeclaration) 2101 return nullptr; 2102 2103 // If we have a builtin without an associated type we should not emit a 2104 // warning when we were not able to find a type for it. 2105 if (Error == ASTContext::GE_Missing_type || 2106 Context.BuiltinInfo.allowTypeMismatch(ID)) 2107 return nullptr; 2108 2109 // If we could not find a type for setjmp it is because the jmp_buf type was 2110 // not defined prior to the setjmp declaration. 2111 if (Error == ASTContext::GE_Missing_setjmp) { 2112 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_implicit_decl_no_jmp_buf) 2113 << Context.BuiltinInfo.getName(ID); 2114 return nullptr; 2115 } 2116 2117 // Generally, we emit a warning that the declaration requires the 2118 // appropriate header. 2119 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_implicit_decl_requires_sysheader) 2120 << getHeaderName(Context.BuiltinInfo, ID, Error) 2121 << Context.BuiltinInfo.getName(ID); 2122 return nullptr; 2123 } 2124 2125 if (!ForRedeclaration && 2126 (Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(ID) || 2127 Context.BuiltinInfo.isHeaderDependentFunction(ID))) { 2128 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_implicit_lib_function_decl) 2129 << Context.BuiltinInfo.getName(ID) << R; 2130 if (const char *Header = Context.BuiltinInfo.getHeaderName(ID)) 2131 Diag(Loc, diag::note_include_header_or_declare) 2132 << Header << Context.BuiltinInfo.getName(ID); 2133 } 2134 2135 if (R.isNull()) 2136 return nullptr; 2137 2138 FunctionDecl *New = CreateBuiltin(II, R, ID, Loc); 2139 RegisterLocallyScopedExternCDecl(New, S); 2140 2141 // TUScope is the translation-unit scope to insert this function into. 2142 // FIXME: This is hideous. We need to teach PushOnScopeChains to 2143 // relate Scopes to DeclContexts, and probably eliminate CurContext 2144 // entirely, but we're not there yet. 2145 DeclContext *SavedContext = CurContext; 2146 CurContext = New->getDeclContext(); 2147 PushOnScopeChains(New, TUScope); 2148 CurContext = SavedContext; 2149 return New; 2150 } 2151 2152 /// Typedef declarations don't have linkage, but they still denote the same 2153 /// entity if their types are the same. 2154 /// FIXME: This is notionally doing the same thing as ASTReaderDecl's 2155 /// isSameEntity. 2156 static void filterNonConflictingPreviousTypedefDecls(Sema &S, 2157 TypedefNameDecl *Decl, 2158 LookupResult &Previous) { 2159 // This is only interesting when modules are enabled. 2160 if (!S.getLangOpts().Modules && !S.getLangOpts().ModulesLocalVisibility) 2161 return; 2162 2163 // Empty sets are uninteresting. 2164 if (Previous.empty()) 2165 return; 2166 2167 LookupResult::Filter Filter = Previous.makeFilter(); 2168 while (Filter.hasNext()) { 2169 NamedDecl *Old = Filter.next(); 2170 2171 // Non-hidden declarations are never ignored. 2172 if (S.isVisible(Old)) 2173 continue; 2174 2175 // Declarations of the same entity are not ignored, even if they have 2176 // different linkages. 2177 if (auto *OldTD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Old)) { 2178 if (S.Context.hasSameType(OldTD->getUnderlyingType(), 2179 Decl->getUnderlyingType())) 2180 continue; 2181 2182 // If both declarations give a tag declaration a typedef name for linkage 2183 // purposes, then they declare the same entity. 2184 if (OldTD->getAnonDeclWithTypedefName(/*AnyRedecl*/true) && 2185 Decl->getAnonDeclWithTypedefName()) 2186 continue; 2187 } 2188 2189 Filter.erase(); 2190 } 2191 2192 Filter.done(); 2193 } 2194 2195 bool Sema::isIncompatibleTypedef(TypeDecl *Old, TypedefNameDecl *New) { 2196 QualType OldType; 2197 if (TypedefNameDecl *OldTypedef = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Old)) 2198 OldType = OldTypedef->getUnderlyingType(); 2199 else 2200 OldType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Old); 2201 QualType NewType = New->getUnderlyingType(); 2202 2203 if (NewType->isVariablyModifiedType()) { 2204 // Must not redefine a typedef with a variably-modified type. 2205 int Kind = isa<TypeAliasDecl>(Old) ? 1 : 0; 2206 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_variably_modified_typedef) 2207 << Kind << NewType; 2208 if (Old->getLocation().isValid()) 2209 notePreviousDefinition(Old, New->getLocation()); 2210 New->setInvalidDecl(); 2211 return true; 2212 } 2213 2214 if (OldType != NewType && 2215 !OldType->isDependentType() && 2216 !NewType->isDependentType() && 2217 !Context.hasSameType(OldType, NewType)) { 2218 int Kind = isa<TypeAliasDecl>(Old) ? 1 : 0; 2219 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_different_typedef) 2220 << Kind << NewType << OldType; 2221 if (Old->getLocation().isValid()) 2222 notePreviousDefinition(Old, New->getLocation()); 2223 New->setInvalidDecl(); 2224 return true; 2225 } 2226 return false; 2227 } 2228 2229 /// MergeTypedefNameDecl - We just parsed a typedef 'New' which has the 2230 /// same name and scope as a previous declaration 'Old'. Figure out 2231 /// how to resolve this situation, merging decls or emitting 2232 /// diagnostics as appropriate. If there was an error, set New to be invalid. 2233 /// 2234 void Sema::MergeTypedefNameDecl(Scope *S, TypedefNameDecl *New, 2235 LookupResult &OldDecls) { 2236 // If the new decl is known invalid already, don't bother doing any 2237 // merging checks. 2238 if (New->isInvalidDecl()) return; 2239 2240 // Allow multiple definitions for ObjC built-in typedefs. 2241 // FIXME: Verify the underlying types are equivalent! 2242 if (getLangOpts().ObjC) { 2243 const IdentifierInfo *TypeID = New->getIdentifier(); 2244 switch (TypeID->getLength()) { 2245 default: break; 2246 case 2: 2247 { 2248 if (!TypeID->isStr("id")) 2249 break; 2250 QualType T = New->getUnderlyingType(); 2251 if (!T->isPointerType()) 2252 break; 2253 if (!T->isVoidPointerType()) { 2254 QualType PT = T->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 2255 if (!PT->isStructureType()) 2256 break; 2257 } 2258 Context.setObjCIdRedefinitionType(T); 2259 // Install the built-in type for 'id', ignoring the current definition. 2260 New->setTypeForDecl(Context.getObjCIdType().getTypePtr()); 2261 return; 2262 } 2263 case 5: 2264 if (!TypeID->isStr("Class")) 2265 break; 2266 Context.setObjCClassRedefinitionType(New->getUnderlyingType()); 2267 // Install the built-in type for 'Class', ignoring the current definition. 2268 New->setTypeForDecl(Context.getObjCClassType().getTypePtr()); 2269 return; 2270 case 3: 2271 if (!TypeID->isStr("SEL")) 2272 break; 2273 Context.setObjCSelRedefinitionType(New->getUnderlyingType()); 2274 // Install the built-in type for 'SEL', ignoring the current definition. 2275 New->setTypeForDecl(Context.getObjCSelType().getTypePtr()); 2276 return; 2277 } 2278 // Fall through - the typedef name was not a builtin type. 2279 } 2280 2281 // Verify the old decl was also a type. 2282 TypeDecl *Old = OldDecls.getAsSingle<TypeDecl>(); 2283 if (!Old) { 2284 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_different_kind) 2285 << New->getDeclName(); 2286 2287 NamedDecl *OldD = OldDecls.getRepresentativeDecl(); 2288 if (OldD->getLocation().isValid()) 2289 notePreviousDefinition(OldD, New->getLocation()); 2290 2291 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 2292 } 2293 2294 // If the old declaration is invalid, just give up here. 2295 if (Old->isInvalidDecl()) 2296 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 2297 2298 if (auto *OldTD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Old)) { 2299 auto *OldTag = OldTD->getAnonDeclWithTypedefName(/*AnyRedecl*/true); 2300 auto *NewTag = New->getAnonDeclWithTypedefName(); 2301 NamedDecl *Hidden = nullptr; 2302 if (OldTag && NewTag && 2303 OldTag->getCanonicalDecl() != NewTag->getCanonicalDecl() && 2304 !hasVisibleDefinition(OldTag, &Hidden)) { 2305 // There is a definition of this tag, but it is not visible. Use it 2306 // instead of our tag. 2307 New->setTypeForDecl(OldTD->getTypeForDecl()); 2308 if (OldTD->isModed()) 2309 New->setModedTypeSourceInfo(OldTD->getTypeSourceInfo(), 2310 OldTD->getUnderlyingType()); 2311 else 2312 New->setTypeSourceInfo(OldTD->getTypeSourceInfo()); 2313 2314 // Make the old tag definition visible. 2315 makeMergedDefinitionVisible(Hidden); 2316 2317 // If this was an unscoped enumeration, yank all of its enumerators 2318 // out of the scope. 2319 if (isa<EnumDecl>(NewTag)) { 2320 Scope *EnumScope = getNonFieldDeclScope(S); 2321 for (auto *D : NewTag->decls()) { 2322 auto *ED = cast<EnumConstantDecl>(D); 2323 assert(EnumScope->isDeclScope(ED)); 2324 EnumScope->RemoveDecl(ED); 2325 IdResolver.RemoveDecl(ED); 2326 ED->getLexicalDeclContext()->removeDecl(ED); 2327 } 2328 } 2329 } 2330 } 2331 2332 // If the typedef types are not identical, reject them in all languages and 2333 // with any extensions enabled. 2334 if (isIncompatibleTypedef(Old, New)) 2335 return; 2336 2337 // The types match. Link up the redeclaration chain and merge attributes if 2338 // the old declaration was a typedef. 2339 if (TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Old)) { 2340 New->setPreviousDecl(Typedef); 2341 mergeDeclAttributes(New, Old); 2342 } 2343 2344 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt) 2345 return; 2346 2347 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 2348 // C++ [dcl.typedef]p2: 2349 // In a given non-class scope, a typedef specifier can be used to 2350 // redefine the name of any type declared in that scope to refer 2351 // to the type to which it already refers. 2352 if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext)) 2353 return; 2354 2355 // C++0x [dcl.typedef]p4: 2356 // In a given class scope, a typedef specifier can be used to redefine 2357 // any class-name declared in that scope that is not also a typedef-name 2358 // to refer to the type to which it already refers. 2359 // 2360 // This wording came in via DR424, which was a correction to the 2361 // wording in DR56, which accidentally banned code like: 2362 // 2363 // struct S { 2364 // typedef struct A { } A; 2365 // }; 2366 // 2367 // in the C++03 standard. We implement the C++0x semantics, which 2368 // allow the above but disallow 2369 // 2370 // struct S { 2371 // typedef int I; 2372 // typedef int I; 2373 // }; 2374 // 2375 // since that was the intent of DR56. 2376 if (!isa<TypedefNameDecl>(Old)) 2377 return; 2378 2379 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition) 2380 << New->getDeclName(); 2381 notePreviousDefinition(Old, New->getLocation()); 2382 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 2383 } 2384 2385 // Modules always permit redefinition of typedefs, as does C11. 2386 if (getLangOpts().Modules || getLangOpts().C11) 2387 return; 2388 2389 // If we have a redefinition of a typedef in C, emit a warning. This warning 2390 // is normally mapped to an error, but can be controlled with 2391 // -Wtypedef-redefinition. If either the original or the redefinition is 2392 // in a system header, don't emit this for compatibility with GCC. 2393 if (getDiagnostics().getSuppressSystemWarnings() && 2394 // Some standard types are defined implicitly in Clang (e.g. OpenCL). 2395 (Old->isImplicit() || 2396 Context.getSourceManager().isInSystemHeader(Old->getLocation()) || 2397 Context.getSourceManager().isInSystemHeader(New->getLocation()))) 2398 return; 2399 2400 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::ext_redefinition_of_typedef) 2401 << New->getDeclName(); 2402 notePreviousDefinition(Old, New->getLocation()); 2403 } 2404 2405 /// DeclhasAttr - returns true if decl Declaration already has the target 2406 /// attribute. 2407 static bool DeclHasAttr(const Decl *D, const Attr *A) { 2408 const OwnershipAttr *OA = dyn_cast<OwnershipAttr>(A); 2409 const AnnotateAttr *Ann = dyn_cast<AnnotateAttr>(A); 2410 for (const auto *i : D->attrs()) 2411 if (i->getKind() == A->getKind()) { 2412 if (Ann) { 2413 if (Ann->getAnnotation() == cast<AnnotateAttr>(i)->getAnnotation()) 2414 return true; 2415 continue; 2416 } 2417 // FIXME: Don't hardcode this check 2418 if (OA && isa<OwnershipAttr>(i)) 2419 return OA->getOwnKind() == cast<OwnershipAttr>(i)->getOwnKind(); 2420 return true; 2421 } 2422 2423 return false; 2424 } 2425 2426 static bool isAttributeTargetADefinition(Decl *D) { 2427 if (VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) 2428 return VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition(); 2429 if (TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) 2430 return TD->isCompleteDefinition() || TD->isBeingDefined(); 2431 return true; 2432 } 2433 2434 /// Merge alignment attributes from \p Old to \p New, taking into account the 2435 /// special semantics of C11's _Alignas specifier and C++11's alignas attribute. 2436 /// 2437 /// \return \c true if any attributes were added to \p New. 2438 static bool mergeAlignedAttrs(Sema &S, NamedDecl *New, Decl *Old) { 2439 // Look for alignas attributes on Old, and pick out whichever attribute 2440 // specifies the strictest alignment requirement. 2441 AlignedAttr *OldAlignasAttr = nullptr; 2442 AlignedAttr *OldStrictestAlignAttr = nullptr; 2443 unsigned OldAlign = 0; 2444 for (auto *I : Old->specific_attrs<AlignedAttr>()) { 2445 // FIXME: We have no way of representing inherited dependent alignments 2446 // in a case like: 2447 // template<int A, int B> struct alignas(A) X; 2448 // template<int A, int B> struct alignas(B) X {}; 2449 // For now, we just ignore any alignas attributes which are not on the 2450 // definition in such a case. 2451 if (I->isAlignmentDependent()) 2452 return false; 2453 2454 if (I->isAlignas()) 2455 OldAlignasAttr = I; 2456 2457 unsigned Align = I->getAlignment(S.Context); 2458 if (Align > OldAlign) { 2459 OldAlign = Align; 2460 OldStrictestAlignAttr = I; 2461 } 2462 } 2463 2464 // Look for alignas attributes on New. 2465 AlignedAttr *NewAlignasAttr = nullptr; 2466 unsigned NewAlign = 0; 2467 for (auto *I : New->specific_attrs<AlignedAttr>()) { 2468 if (I->isAlignmentDependent()) 2469 return false; 2470 2471 if (I->isAlignas()) 2472 NewAlignasAttr = I; 2473 2474 unsigned Align = I->getAlignment(S.Context); 2475 if (Align > NewAlign) 2476 NewAlign = Align; 2477 } 2478 2479 if (OldAlignasAttr && NewAlignasAttr && OldAlign != NewAlign) { 2480 // Both declarations have 'alignas' attributes. We require them to match. 2481 // C++11 [dcl.align]p6 and C11 6.7.5/7 both come close to saying this, but 2482 // fall short. (If two declarations both have alignas, they must both match 2483 // every definition, and so must match each other if there is a definition.) 2484 2485 // If either declaration only contains 'alignas(0)' specifiers, then it 2486 // specifies the natural alignment for the type. 2487 if (OldAlign == 0 || NewAlign == 0) { 2488 QualType Ty; 2489 if (ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(New)) 2490 Ty = VD->getType(); 2491 else 2492 Ty = S.Context.getTagDeclType(cast<TagDecl>(New)); 2493 2494 if (OldAlign == 0) 2495 OldAlign = S.Context.getTypeAlign(Ty); 2496 if (NewAlign == 0) 2497 NewAlign = S.Context.getTypeAlign(Ty); 2498 } 2499 2500 if (OldAlign != NewAlign) { 2501 S.Diag(NewAlignasAttr->getLocation(), diag::err_alignas_mismatch) 2502 << (unsigned)S.Context.toCharUnitsFromBits(OldAlign).getQuantity() 2503 << (unsigned)S.Context.toCharUnitsFromBits(NewAlign).getQuantity(); 2504 S.Diag(OldAlignasAttr->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 2505 } 2506 } 2507 2508 if (OldAlignasAttr && !NewAlignasAttr && isAttributeTargetADefinition(New)) { 2509 // C++11 [dcl.align]p6: 2510 // if any declaration of an entity has an alignment-specifier, 2511 // every defining declaration of that entity shall specify an 2512 // equivalent alignment. 2513 // C11 6.7.5/7: 2514 // If the definition of an object does not have an alignment 2515 // specifier, any other declaration of that object shall also 2516 // have no alignment specifier. 2517 S.Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_alignas_missing_on_definition) 2518 << OldAlignasAttr; 2519 S.Diag(OldAlignasAttr->getLocation(), diag::note_alignas_on_declaration) 2520 << OldAlignasAttr; 2521 } 2522 2523 bool AnyAdded = false; 2524 2525 // Ensure we have an attribute representing the strictest alignment. 2526 if (OldAlign > NewAlign) { 2527 AlignedAttr *Clone = OldStrictestAlignAttr->clone(S.Context); 2528 Clone->setInherited(true); 2529 New->addAttr(Clone); 2530 AnyAdded = true; 2531 } 2532 2533 // Ensure we have an alignas attribute if the old declaration had one. 2534 if (OldAlignasAttr && !NewAlignasAttr && 2535 !(AnyAdded && OldStrictestAlignAttr->isAlignas())) { 2536 AlignedAttr *Clone = OldAlignasAttr->clone(S.Context); 2537 Clone->setInherited(true); 2538 New->addAttr(Clone); 2539 AnyAdded = true; 2540 } 2541 2542 return AnyAdded; 2543 } 2544 2545 static bool mergeDeclAttribute(Sema &S, NamedDecl *D, 2546 const InheritableAttr *Attr, 2547 Sema::AvailabilityMergeKind AMK) { 2548 // This function copies an attribute Attr from a previous declaration to the 2549 // new declaration D if the new declaration doesn't itself have that attribute 2550 // yet or if that attribute allows duplicates. 2551 // If you're adding a new attribute that requires logic different from 2552 // "use explicit attribute on decl if present, else use attribute from 2553 // previous decl", for example if the attribute needs to be consistent 2554 // between redeclarations, you need to call a custom merge function here. 2555 InheritableAttr *NewAttr = nullptr; 2556 if (const auto *AA = dyn_cast<AvailabilityAttr>(Attr)) 2557 NewAttr = S.mergeAvailabilityAttr( 2558 D, *AA, AA->getPlatform(), AA->isImplicit(), AA->getIntroduced(), 2559 AA->getDeprecated(), AA->getObsoleted(), AA->getUnavailable(), 2560 AA->getMessage(), AA->getStrict(), AA->getReplacement(), AMK, 2561 AA->getPriority()); 2562 else if (const auto *VA = dyn_cast<VisibilityAttr>(Attr)) 2563 NewAttr = S.mergeVisibilityAttr(D, *VA, VA->getVisibility()); 2564 else if (const auto *VA = dyn_cast<TypeVisibilityAttr>(Attr)) 2565 NewAttr = S.mergeTypeVisibilityAttr(D, *VA, VA->getVisibility()); 2566 else if (const auto *ImportA = dyn_cast<DLLImportAttr>(Attr)) 2567 NewAttr = S.mergeDLLImportAttr(D, *ImportA); 2568 else if (const auto *ExportA = dyn_cast<DLLExportAttr>(Attr)) 2569 NewAttr = S.mergeDLLExportAttr(D, *ExportA); 2570 else if (const auto *FA = dyn_cast<FormatAttr>(Attr)) 2571 NewAttr = S.mergeFormatAttr(D, *FA, FA->getType(), FA->getFormatIdx(), 2572 FA->getFirstArg()); 2573 else if (const auto *SA = dyn_cast<SectionAttr>(Attr)) 2574 NewAttr = S.mergeSectionAttr(D, *SA, SA->getName()); 2575 else if (const auto *CSA = dyn_cast<CodeSegAttr>(Attr)) 2576 NewAttr = S.mergeCodeSegAttr(D, *CSA, CSA->getName()); 2577 else if (const auto *IA = dyn_cast<MSInheritanceAttr>(Attr)) 2578 NewAttr = S.mergeMSInheritanceAttr(D, *IA, IA->getBestCase(), 2579 IA->getInheritanceModel()); 2580 else if (const auto *AA = dyn_cast<AlwaysInlineAttr>(Attr)) 2581 NewAttr = S.mergeAlwaysInlineAttr(D, *AA, 2582 &S.Context.Idents.get(AA->getSpelling())); 2583 else if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && isa<FunctionDecl>(D) && 2584 (isa<CUDAHostAttr>(Attr) || isa<CUDADeviceAttr>(Attr) || 2585 isa<CUDAGlobalAttr>(Attr))) { 2586 // CUDA target attributes are part of function signature for 2587 // overloading purposes and must not be merged. 2588 return false; 2589 } else if (const auto *MA = dyn_cast<MinSizeAttr>(Attr)) 2590 NewAttr = S.mergeMinSizeAttr(D, *MA); 2591 else if (const auto *SNA = dyn_cast<SwiftNameAttr>(Attr)) 2592 NewAttr = S.mergeSwiftNameAttr(D, *SNA, SNA->getName()); 2593 else if (const auto *OA = dyn_cast<OptimizeNoneAttr>(Attr)) 2594 NewAttr = S.mergeOptimizeNoneAttr(D, *OA); 2595 else if (const auto *InternalLinkageA = dyn_cast<InternalLinkageAttr>(Attr)) 2596 NewAttr = S.mergeInternalLinkageAttr(D, *InternalLinkageA); 2597 else if (const auto *CommonA = dyn_cast<CommonAttr>(Attr)) 2598 NewAttr = S.mergeCommonAttr(D, *CommonA); 2599 else if (isa<AlignedAttr>(Attr)) 2600 // AlignedAttrs are handled separately, because we need to handle all 2601 // such attributes on a declaration at the same time. 2602 NewAttr = nullptr; 2603 else if ((isa<DeprecatedAttr>(Attr) || isa<UnavailableAttr>(Attr)) && 2604 (AMK == Sema::AMK_Override || 2605 AMK == Sema::AMK_ProtocolImplementation)) 2606 NewAttr = nullptr; 2607 else if (const auto *UA = dyn_cast<UuidAttr>(Attr)) 2608 NewAttr = S.mergeUuidAttr(D, *UA, UA->getGuid(), UA->getGuidDecl()); 2609 else if (const auto *SLHA = dyn_cast<SpeculativeLoadHardeningAttr>(Attr)) 2610 NewAttr = S.mergeSpeculativeLoadHardeningAttr(D, *SLHA); 2611 else if (const auto *SLHA = dyn_cast<NoSpeculativeLoadHardeningAttr>(Attr)) 2612 NewAttr = S.mergeNoSpeculativeLoadHardeningAttr(D, *SLHA); 2613 else if (const auto *IMA = dyn_cast<WebAssemblyImportModuleAttr>(Attr)) 2614 NewAttr = S.mergeImportModuleAttr(D, *IMA); 2615 else if (const auto *INA = dyn_cast<WebAssemblyImportNameAttr>(Attr)) 2616 NewAttr = S.mergeImportNameAttr(D, *INA); 2617 else if (Attr->shouldInheritEvenIfAlreadyPresent() || !DeclHasAttr(D, Attr)) 2618 NewAttr = cast<InheritableAttr>(Attr->clone(S.Context)); 2619 2620 if (NewAttr) { 2621 NewAttr->setInherited(true); 2622 D->addAttr(NewAttr); 2623 if (isa<MSInheritanceAttr>(NewAttr)) 2624 S.Consumer.AssignInheritanceModel(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)); 2625 return true; 2626 } 2627 2628 return false; 2629 } 2630 2631 static const NamedDecl *getDefinition(const Decl *D) { 2632 if (const TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) 2633 return TD->getDefinition(); 2634 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 2635 const VarDecl *Def = VD->getDefinition(); 2636 if (Def) 2637 return Def; 2638 return VD->getActingDefinition(); 2639 } 2640 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 2641 const FunctionDecl *Def = nullptr; 2642 if (FD->isDefined(Def, true)) 2643 return Def; 2644 } 2645 return nullptr; 2646 } 2647 2648 static bool hasAttribute(const Decl *D, attr::Kind Kind) { 2649 for (const auto *Attribute : D->attrs()) 2650 if (Attribute->getKind() == Kind) 2651 return true; 2652 return false; 2653 } 2654 2655 /// checkNewAttributesAfterDef - If we already have a definition, check that 2656 /// there are no new attributes in this declaration. 2657 static void checkNewAttributesAfterDef(Sema &S, Decl *New, const Decl *Old) { 2658 if (!New->hasAttrs()) 2659 return; 2660 2661 const NamedDecl *Def = getDefinition(Old); 2662 if (!Def || Def == New) 2663 return; 2664 2665 AttrVec &NewAttributes = New->getAttrs(); 2666 for (unsigned I = 0, E = NewAttributes.size(); I != E;) { 2667 const Attr *NewAttribute = NewAttributes[I]; 2668 2669 if (isa<AliasAttr>(NewAttribute) || isa<IFuncAttr>(NewAttribute)) { 2670 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(New)) { 2671 Sema::SkipBodyInfo SkipBody; 2672 S.CheckForFunctionRedefinition(FD, cast<FunctionDecl>(Def), &SkipBody); 2673 2674 // If we're skipping this definition, drop the "alias" attribute. 2675 if (SkipBody.ShouldSkip) { 2676 NewAttributes.erase(NewAttributes.begin() + I); 2677 --E; 2678 continue; 2679 } 2680 } else { 2681 VarDecl *VD = cast<VarDecl>(New); 2682 unsigned Diag = cast<VarDecl>(Def)->isThisDeclarationADefinition() == 2683 VarDecl::TentativeDefinition 2684 ? diag::err_alias_after_tentative 2685 : diag::err_redefinition; 2686 S.Diag(VD->getLocation(), Diag) << VD->getDeclName(); 2687 if (Diag == diag::err_redefinition) 2688 S.notePreviousDefinition(Def, VD->getLocation()); 2689 else 2690 S.Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 2691 VD->setInvalidDecl(); 2692 } 2693 ++I; 2694 continue; 2695 } 2696 2697 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Def)) { 2698 // Tentative definitions are only interesting for the alias check above. 2699 if (VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() != VarDecl::Definition) { 2700 ++I; 2701 continue; 2702 } 2703 } 2704 2705 if (hasAttribute(Def, NewAttribute->getKind())) { 2706 ++I; 2707 continue; // regular attr merging will take care of validating this. 2708 } 2709 2710 if (isa<C11NoReturnAttr>(NewAttribute)) { 2711 // C's _Noreturn is allowed to be added to a function after it is defined. 2712 ++I; 2713 continue; 2714 } else if (isa<UuidAttr>(NewAttribute)) { 2715 // msvc will allow a subsequent definition to add an uuid to a class 2716 ++I; 2717 continue; 2718 } else if (const AlignedAttr *AA = dyn_cast<AlignedAttr>(NewAttribute)) { 2719 if (AA->isAlignas()) { 2720 // C++11 [dcl.align]p6: 2721 // if any declaration of an entity has an alignment-specifier, 2722 // every defining declaration of that entity shall specify an 2723 // equivalent alignment. 2724 // C11 6.7.5/7: 2725 // If the definition of an object does not have an alignment 2726 // specifier, any other declaration of that object shall also 2727 // have no alignment specifier. 2728 S.Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::err_alignas_missing_on_definition) 2729 << AA; 2730 S.Diag(NewAttribute->getLocation(), diag::note_alignas_on_declaration) 2731 << AA; 2732 NewAttributes.erase(NewAttributes.begin() + I); 2733 --E; 2734 continue; 2735 } 2736 } else if (isa<LoaderUninitializedAttr>(NewAttribute)) { 2737 // If there is a C definition followed by a redeclaration with this 2738 // attribute then there are two different definitions. In C++, prefer the 2739 // standard diagnostics. 2740 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 2741 S.Diag(NewAttribute->getLocation(), 2742 diag::err_loader_uninitialized_redeclaration); 2743 S.Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 2744 NewAttributes.erase(NewAttributes.begin() + I); 2745 --E; 2746 continue; 2747 } 2748 } else if (isa<SelectAnyAttr>(NewAttribute) && 2749 cast<VarDecl>(New)->isInline() && 2750 !cast<VarDecl>(New)->isInlineSpecified()) { 2751 // Don't warn about applying selectany to implicitly inline variables. 2752 // Older compilers and language modes would require the use of selectany 2753 // to make such variables inline, and it would have no effect if we 2754 // honored it. 2755 ++I; 2756 continue; 2757 } else if (isa<OMPDeclareVariantAttr>(NewAttribute)) { 2758 // We allow to add OMP[Begin]DeclareVariantAttr to be added to 2759 // declarations after defintions. 2760 ++I; 2761 continue; 2762 } 2763 2764 S.Diag(NewAttribute->getLocation(), 2765 diag::warn_attribute_precede_definition); 2766 S.Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 2767 NewAttributes.erase(NewAttributes.begin() + I); 2768 --E; 2769 } 2770 } 2771 2772 static void diagnoseMissingConstinit(Sema &S, const VarDecl *InitDecl, 2773 const ConstInitAttr *CIAttr, 2774 bool AttrBeforeInit) { 2775 SourceLocation InsertLoc = InitDecl->getInnerLocStart(); 2776 2777 // Figure out a good way to write this specifier on the old declaration. 2778 // FIXME: We should just use the spelling of CIAttr, but we don't preserve 2779 // enough of the attribute list spelling information to extract that without 2780 // heroics. 2781 std::string SuitableSpelling; 2782 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20) 2783 SuitableSpelling = std::string( 2784 S.PP.getLastMacroWithSpelling(InsertLoc, {tok::kw_constinit})); 2785 if (SuitableSpelling.empty() && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) 2786 SuitableSpelling = std::string(S.PP.getLastMacroWithSpelling( 2787 InsertLoc, {tok::l_square, tok::l_square, 2788 S.PP.getIdentifierInfo("clang"), tok::coloncolon, 2789 S.PP.getIdentifierInfo("require_constant_initialization"), 2790 tok::r_square, tok::r_square})); 2791 if (SuitableSpelling.empty()) 2792 SuitableSpelling = std::string(S.PP.getLastMacroWithSpelling( 2793 InsertLoc, {tok::kw___attribute, tok::l_paren, tok::r_paren, 2794 S.PP.getIdentifierInfo("require_constant_initialization"), 2795 tok::r_paren, tok::r_paren})); 2796 if (SuitableSpelling.empty() && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20) 2797 SuitableSpelling = "constinit"; 2798 if (SuitableSpelling.empty() && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) 2799 SuitableSpelling = "[[clang::require_constant_initialization]]"; 2800 if (SuitableSpelling.empty()) 2801 SuitableSpelling = "__attribute__((require_constant_initialization))"; 2802 SuitableSpelling += " "; 2803 2804 if (AttrBeforeInit) { 2805 // extern constinit int a; 2806 // int a = 0; // error (missing 'constinit'), accepted as extension 2807 assert(CIAttr->isConstinit() && "should not diagnose this for attribute"); 2808 S.Diag(InitDecl->getLocation(), diag::ext_constinit_missing) 2809 << InitDecl << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(InsertLoc, SuitableSpelling); 2810 S.Diag(CIAttr->getLocation(), diag::note_constinit_specified_here); 2811 } else { 2812 // int a = 0; 2813 // constinit extern int a; // error (missing 'constinit') 2814 S.Diag(CIAttr->getLocation(), 2815 CIAttr->isConstinit() ? diag::err_constinit_added_too_late 2816 : diag::warn_require_const_init_added_too_late) 2817 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(SourceRange(CIAttr->getLocation())); 2818 S.Diag(InitDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_constinit_missing_here) 2819 << CIAttr->isConstinit() 2820 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(InsertLoc, SuitableSpelling); 2821 } 2822 } 2823 2824 /// mergeDeclAttributes - Copy attributes from the Old decl to the New one. 2825 void Sema::mergeDeclAttributes(NamedDecl *New, Decl *Old, 2826 AvailabilityMergeKind AMK) { 2827 if (UsedAttr *OldAttr = Old->getMostRecentDecl()->getAttr<UsedAttr>()) { 2828 UsedAttr *NewAttr = OldAttr->clone(Context); 2829 NewAttr->setInherited(true); 2830 New->addAttr(NewAttr); 2831 } 2832 2833 if (!Old->hasAttrs() && !New->hasAttrs()) 2834 return; 2835 2836 // [dcl.constinit]p1: 2837 // If the [constinit] specifier is applied to any declaration of a 2838 // variable, it shall be applied to the initializing declaration. 2839 const auto *OldConstInit = Old->getAttr<ConstInitAttr>(); 2840 const auto *NewConstInit = New->getAttr<ConstInitAttr>(); 2841 if (bool(OldConstInit) != bool(NewConstInit)) { 2842 const auto *OldVD = cast<VarDecl>(Old); 2843 auto *NewVD = cast<VarDecl>(New); 2844 2845 // Find the initializing declaration. Note that we might not have linked 2846 // the new declaration into the redeclaration chain yet. 2847 const VarDecl *InitDecl = OldVD->getInitializingDeclaration(); 2848 if (!InitDecl && 2849 (NewVD->hasInit() || NewVD->isThisDeclarationADefinition())) 2850 InitDecl = NewVD; 2851 2852 if (InitDecl == NewVD) { 2853 // This is the initializing declaration. If it would inherit 'constinit', 2854 // that's ill-formed. (Note that we do not apply this to the attribute 2855 // form). 2856 if (OldConstInit && OldConstInit->isConstinit()) 2857 diagnoseMissingConstinit(*this, NewVD, OldConstInit, 2858 /*AttrBeforeInit=*/true); 2859 } else if (NewConstInit) { 2860 // This is the first time we've been told that this declaration should 2861 // have a constant initializer. If we already saw the initializing 2862 // declaration, this is too late. 2863 if (InitDecl && InitDecl != NewVD) { 2864 diagnoseMissingConstinit(*this, InitDecl, NewConstInit, 2865 /*AttrBeforeInit=*/false); 2866 NewVD->dropAttr<ConstInitAttr>(); 2867 } 2868 } 2869 } 2870 2871 // Attributes declared post-definition are currently ignored. 2872 checkNewAttributesAfterDef(*this, New, Old); 2873 2874 if (AsmLabelAttr *NewA = New->getAttr<AsmLabelAttr>()) { 2875 if (AsmLabelAttr *OldA = Old->getAttr<AsmLabelAttr>()) { 2876 if (!OldA->isEquivalent(NewA)) { 2877 // This redeclaration changes __asm__ label. 2878 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_different_asm_label); 2879 Diag(OldA->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 2880 } 2881 } else if (Old->isUsed()) { 2882 // This redeclaration adds an __asm__ label to a declaration that has 2883 // already been ODR-used. 2884 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_late_asm_label_name) 2885 << isa<FunctionDecl>(Old) << New->getAttr<AsmLabelAttr>()->getRange(); 2886 } 2887 } 2888 2889 // Re-declaration cannot add abi_tag's. 2890 if (const auto *NewAbiTagAttr = New->getAttr<AbiTagAttr>()) { 2891 if (const auto *OldAbiTagAttr = Old->getAttr<AbiTagAttr>()) { 2892 for (const auto &NewTag : NewAbiTagAttr->tags()) { 2893 if (std::find(OldAbiTagAttr->tags_begin(), OldAbiTagAttr->tags_end(), 2894 NewTag) == OldAbiTagAttr->tags_end()) { 2895 Diag(NewAbiTagAttr->getLocation(), 2896 diag::err_new_abi_tag_on_redeclaration) 2897 << NewTag; 2898 Diag(OldAbiTagAttr->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 2899 } 2900 } 2901 } else { 2902 Diag(NewAbiTagAttr->getLocation(), diag::err_abi_tag_on_redeclaration); 2903 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 2904 } 2905 } 2906 2907 // This redeclaration adds a section attribute. 2908 if (New->hasAttr<SectionAttr>() && !Old->hasAttr<SectionAttr>()) { 2909 if (auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(New)) { 2910 if (VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() == VarDecl::DeclarationOnly) { 2911 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::warn_attribute_section_on_redeclaration); 2912 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 2913 } 2914 } 2915 } 2916 2917 // Redeclaration adds code-seg attribute. 2918 const auto *NewCSA = New->getAttr<CodeSegAttr>(); 2919 if (NewCSA && !Old->hasAttr<CodeSegAttr>() && 2920 !NewCSA->isImplicit() && isa<CXXMethodDecl>(New)) { 2921 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::warn_mismatched_section) 2922 << 0 /*codeseg*/; 2923 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 2924 } 2925 2926 if (!Old->hasAttrs()) 2927 return; 2928 2929 bool foundAny = New->hasAttrs(); 2930 2931 // Ensure that any moving of objects within the allocated map is done before 2932 // we process them. 2933 if (!foundAny) New->setAttrs(AttrVec()); 2934 2935 for (auto *I : Old->specific_attrs<InheritableAttr>()) { 2936 // Ignore deprecated/unavailable/availability attributes if requested. 2937 AvailabilityMergeKind LocalAMK = AMK_None; 2938 if (isa<DeprecatedAttr>(I) || 2939 isa<UnavailableAttr>(I) || 2940 isa<AvailabilityAttr>(I)) { 2941 switch (AMK) { 2942 case AMK_None: 2943 continue; 2944 2945 case AMK_Redeclaration: 2946 case AMK_Override: 2947 case AMK_ProtocolImplementation: 2948 LocalAMK = AMK; 2949 break; 2950 } 2951 } 2952 2953 // Already handled. 2954 if (isa<UsedAttr>(I)) 2955 continue; 2956 2957 if (mergeDeclAttribute(*this, New, I, LocalAMK)) 2958 foundAny = true; 2959 } 2960 2961 if (mergeAlignedAttrs(*this, New, Old)) 2962 foundAny = true; 2963 2964 if (!foundAny) New->dropAttrs(); 2965 } 2966 2967 /// mergeParamDeclAttributes - Copy attributes from the old parameter 2968 /// to the new one. 2969 static void mergeParamDeclAttributes(ParmVarDecl *newDecl, 2970 const ParmVarDecl *oldDecl, 2971 Sema &S) { 2972 // C++11 [dcl.attr.depend]p2: 2973 // The first declaration of a function shall specify the 2974 // carries_dependency attribute for its declarator-id if any declaration 2975 // of the function specifies the carries_dependency attribute. 2976 const CarriesDependencyAttr *CDA = newDecl->getAttr<CarriesDependencyAttr>(); 2977 if (CDA && !oldDecl->hasAttr<CarriesDependencyAttr>()) { 2978 S.Diag(CDA->getLocation(), 2979 diag::err_carries_dependency_missing_on_first_decl) << 1/*Param*/; 2980 // Find the first declaration of the parameter. 2981 // FIXME: Should we build redeclaration chains for function parameters? 2982 const FunctionDecl *FirstFD = 2983 cast<FunctionDecl>(oldDecl->getDeclContext())->getFirstDecl(); 2984 const ParmVarDecl *FirstVD = 2985 FirstFD->getParamDecl(oldDecl->getFunctionScopeIndex()); 2986 S.Diag(FirstVD->getLocation(), 2987 diag::note_carries_dependency_missing_first_decl) << 1/*Param*/; 2988 } 2989 2990 if (!oldDecl->hasAttrs()) 2991 return; 2992 2993 bool foundAny = newDecl->hasAttrs(); 2994 2995 // Ensure that any moving of objects within the allocated map is 2996 // done before we process them. 2997 if (!foundAny) newDecl->setAttrs(AttrVec()); 2998 2999 for (const auto *I : oldDecl->specific_attrs<InheritableParamAttr>()) { 3000 if (!DeclHasAttr(newDecl, I)) { 3001 InheritableAttr *newAttr = 3002 cast<InheritableParamAttr>(I->clone(S.Context)); 3003 newAttr->setInherited(true); 3004 newDecl->addAttr(newAttr); 3005 foundAny = true; 3006 } 3007 } 3008 3009 if (!foundAny) newDecl->dropAttrs(); 3010 } 3011 3012 static void mergeParamDeclTypes(ParmVarDecl *NewParam, 3013 const ParmVarDecl *OldParam, 3014 Sema &S) { 3015 if (auto Oldnullability = OldParam->getType()->getNullability(S.Context)) { 3016 if (auto Newnullability = NewParam->getType()->getNullability(S.Context)) { 3017 if (*Oldnullability != *Newnullability) { 3018 S.Diag(NewParam->getLocation(), diag::warn_mismatched_nullability_attr) 3019 << DiagNullabilityKind( 3020 *Newnullability, 3021 ((NewParam->getObjCDeclQualifier() & Decl::OBJC_TQ_CSNullability) 3022 != 0)) 3023 << DiagNullabilityKind( 3024 *Oldnullability, 3025 ((OldParam->getObjCDeclQualifier() & Decl::OBJC_TQ_CSNullability) 3026 != 0)); 3027 S.Diag(OldParam->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 3028 } 3029 } else { 3030 QualType NewT = NewParam->getType(); 3031 NewT = S.Context.getAttributedType( 3032 AttributedType::getNullabilityAttrKind(*Oldnullability), 3033 NewT, NewT); 3034 NewParam->setType(NewT); 3035 } 3036 } 3037 } 3038 3039 namespace { 3040 3041 /// Used in MergeFunctionDecl to keep track of function parameters in 3042 /// C. 3043 struct GNUCompatibleParamWarning { 3044 ParmVarDecl *OldParm; 3045 ParmVarDecl *NewParm; 3046 QualType PromotedType; 3047 }; 3048 3049 } // end anonymous namespace 3050 3051 // Determine whether the previous declaration was a definition, implicit 3052 // declaration, or a declaration. 3053 template <typename T> 3054 static std::pair<diag::kind, SourceLocation> 3055 getNoteDiagForInvalidRedeclaration(const T *Old, const T *New) { 3056 diag::kind PrevDiag; 3057 SourceLocation OldLocation = Old->getLocation(); 3058 if (Old->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) 3059 PrevDiag = diag::note_previous_definition; 3060 else if (Old->isImplicit()) { 3061 PrevDiag = diag::note_previous_implicit_declaration; 3062 if (OldLocation.isInvalid()) 3063 OldLocation = New->getLocation(); 3064 } else 3065 PrevDiag = diag::note_previous_declaration; 3066 return std::make_pair(PrevDiag, OldLocation); 3067 } 3068 3069 /// canRedefineFunction - checks if a function can be redefined. Currently, 3070 /// only extern inline functions can be redefined, and even then only in 3071 /// GNU89 mode. 3072 static bool canRedefineFunction(const FunctionDecl *FD, 3073 const LangOptions& LangOpts) { 3074 return ((FD->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>() || LangOpts.GNUInline) && 3075 !LangOpts.CPlusPlus && 3076 FD->isInlineSpecified() && 3077 FD->getStorageClass() == SC_Extern); 3078 } 3079 3080 const AttributedType *Sema::getCallingConvAttributedType(QualType T) const { 3081 const AttributedType *AT = T->getAs<AttributedType>(); 3082 while (AT && !AT->isCallingConv()) 3083 AT = AT->getModifiedType()->getAs<AttributedType>(); 3084 return AT; 3085 } 3086 3087 template <typename T> 3088 static bool haveIncompatibleLanguageLinkages(const T *Old, const T *New) { 3089 const DeclContext *DC = Old->getDeclContext(); 3090 if (DC->isRecord()) 3091 return false; 3092 3093 LanguageLinkage OldLinkage = Old->getLanguageLinkage(); 3094 if (OldLinkage == CXXLanguageLinkage && New->isInExternCContext()) 3095 return true; 3096 if (OldLinkage == CLanguageLinkage && New->isInExternCXXContext()) 3097 return true; 3098 return false; 3099 } 3100 3101 template<typename T> static bool isExternC(T *D) { return D->isExternC(); } 3102 static bool isExternC(VarTemplateDecl *) { return false; } 3103 3104 /// Check whether a redeclaration of an entity introduced by a 3105 /// using-declaration is valid, given that we know it's not an overload 3106 /// (nor a hidden tag declaration). 3107 template<typename ExpectedDecl> 3108 static bool checkUsingShadowRedecl(Sema &S, UsingShadowDecl *OldS, 3109 ExpectedDecl *New) { 3110 // C++11 [basic.scope.declarative]p4: 3111 // Given a set of declarations in a single declarative region, each of 3112 // which specifies the same unqualified name, 3113 // -- they shall all refer to the same entity, or all refer to functions 3114 // and function templates; or 3115 // -- exactly one declaration shall declare a class name or enumeration 3116 // name that is not a typedef name and the other declarations shall all 3117 // refer to the same variable or enumerator, or all refer to functions 3118 // and function templates; in this case the class name or enumeration 3119 // name is hidden (3.3.10). 3120 3121 // C++11 [namespace.udecl]p14: 3122 // If a function declaration in namespace scope or block scope has the 3123 // same name and the same parameter-type-list as a function introduced 3124 // by a using-declaration, and the declarations do not declare the same 3125 // function, the program is ill-formed. 3126 3127 auto *Old = dyn_cast<ExpectedDecl>(OldS->getTargetDecl()); 3128 if (Old && 3129 !Old->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->Equals( 3130 New->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()) && 3131 !(isExternC(Old) && isExternC(New))) 3132 Old = nullptr; 3133 3134 if (!Old) { 3135 S.Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_using_decl_conflict_reverse); 3136 S.Diag(OldS->getTargetDecl()->getLocation(), diag::note_using_decl_target); 3137 S.Diag(OldS->getUsingDecl()->getLocation(), diag::note_using_decl) << 0; 3138 return true; 3139 } 3140 return false; 3141 } 3142 3143 static bool hasIdenticalPassObjectSizeAttrs(const FunctionDecl *A, 3144 const FunctionDecl *B) { 3145 assert(A->getNumParams() == B->getNumParams()); 3146 3147 auto AttrEq = [](const ParmVarDecl *A, const ParmVarDecl *B) { 3148 const auto *AttrA = A->getAttr<PassObjectSizeAttr>(); 3149 const auto *AttrB = B->getAttr<PassObjectSizeAttr>(); 3150 if (AttrA == AttrB) 3151 return true; 3152 return AttrA && AttrB && AttrA->getType() == AttrB->getType() && 3153 AttrA->isDynamic() == AttrB->isDynamic(); 3154 }; 3155 3156 return std::equal(A->param_begin(), A->param_end(), B->param_begin(), AttrEq); 3157 } 3158 3159 /// If necessary, adjust the semantic declaration context for a qualified 3160 /// declaration to name the correct inline namespace within the qualifier. 3161 static void adjustDeclContextForDeclaratorDecl(DeclaratorDecl *NewD, 3162 DeclaratorDecl *OldD) { 3163 // The only case where we need to update the DeclContext is when 3164 // redeclaration lookup for a qualified name finds a declaration 3165 // in an inline namespace within the context named by the qualifier: 3166 // 3167 // inline namespace N { int f(); } 3168 // int ::f(); // Sema DC needs adjusting from :: to N::. 3169 // 3170 // For unqualified declarations, the semantic context *can* change 3171 // along the redeclaration chain (for local extern declarations, 3172 // extern "C" declarations, and friend declarations in particular). 3173 if (!NewD->getQualifier()) 3174 return; 3175 3176 // NewD is probably already in the right context. 3177 auto *NamedDC = NewD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 3178 auto *SemaDC = OldD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 3179 if (NamedDC->Equals(SemaDC)) 3180 return; 3181 3182 assert((NamedDC->InEnclosingNamespaceSetOf(SemaDC) || 3183 NewD->isInvalidDecl() || OldD->isInvalidDecl()) && 3184 "unexpected context for redeclaration"); 3185 3186 auto *LexDC = NewD->getLexicalDeclContext(); 3187 auto FixSemaDC = [=](NamedDecl *D) { 3188 if (!D) 3189 return; 3190 D->setDeclContext(SemaDC); 3191 D->setLexicalDeclContext(LexDC); 3192 }; 3193 3194 FixSemaDC(NewD); 3195 if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(NewD)) 3196 FixSemaDC(FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()); 3197 else if (auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(NewD)) 3198 FixSemaDC(VD->getDescribedVarTemplate()); 3199 } 3200 3201 /// MergeFunctionDecl - We just parsed a function 'New' from 3202 /// declarator D which has the same name and scope as a previous 3203 /// declaration 'Old'. Figure out how to resolve this situation, 3204 /// merging decls or emitting diagnostics as appropriate. 3205 /// 3206 /// In C++, New and Old must be declarations that are not 3207 /// overloaded. Use IsOverload to determine whether New and Old are 3208 /// overloaded, and to select the Old declaration that New should be 3209 /// merged with. 3210 /// 3211 /// Returns true if there was an error, false otherwise. 3212 bool Sema::MergeFunctionDecl(FunctionDecl *New, NamedDecl *&OldD, 3213 Scope *S, bool MergeTypeWithOld) { 3214 // Verify the old decl was also a function. 3215 FunctionDecl *Old = OldD->getAsFunction(); 3216 if (!Old) { 3217 if (UsingShadowDecl *Shadow = dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)) { 3218 if (New->getFriendObjectKind()) { 3219 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_using_decl_friend); 3220 Diag(Shadow->getTargetDecl()->getLocation(), 3221 diag::note_using_decl_target); 3222 Diag(Shadow->getUsingDecl()->getLocation(), 3223 diag::note_using_decl) << 0; 3224 return true; 3225 } 3226 3227 // Check whether the two declarations might declare the same function. 3228 if (checkUsingShadowRedecl<FunctionDecl>(*this, Shadow, New)) 3229 return true; 3230 OldD = Old = cast<FunctionDecl>(Shadow->getTargetDecl()); 3231 } else { 3232 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_different_kind) 3233 << New->getDeclName(); 3234 notePreviousDefinition(OldD, New->getLocation()); 3235 return true; 3236 } 3237 } 3238 3239 // If the old declaration is invalid, just give up here. 3240 if (Old->isInvalidDecl()) 3241 return true; 3242 3243 // Disallow redeclaration of some builtins. 3244 if (!getASTContext().canBuiltinBeRedeclared(Old)) { 3245 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_builtin_redeclare) << Old->getDeclName(); 3246 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_builtin_declaration) 3247 << Old << Old->getType(); 3248 return true; 3249 } 3250 3251 diag::kind PrevDiag; 3252 SourceLocation OldLocation; 3253 std::tie(PrevDiag, OldLocation) = 3254 getNoteDiagForInvalidRedeclaration(Old, New); 3255 3256 // Don't complain about this if we're in GNU89 mode and the old function 3257 // is an extern inline function. 3258 // Don't complain about specializations. They are not supposed to have 3259 // storage classes. 3260 if (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(New) && !isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Old) && 3261 New->getStorageClass() == SC_Static && 3262 Old->hasExternalFormalLinkage() && 3263 !New->getTemplateSpecializationInfo() && 3264 !canRedefineFunction(Old, getLangOpts())) { 3265 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt) { 3266 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::ext_static_non_static) << New; 3267 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 3268 } else { 3269 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_static_non_static) << New; 3270 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 3271 return true; 3272 } 3273 } 3274 3275 if (New->hasAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>() && 3276 !Old->hasAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>()) { 3277 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_internal_linkage_redeclaration) 3278 << New->getDeclName(); 3279 notePreviousDefinition(Old, New->getLocation()); 3280 New->dropAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>(); 3281 } 3282 3283 if (CheckRedeclarationModuleOwnership(New, Old)) 3284 return true; 3285 3286 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 3287 bool OldOvl = Old->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>(); 3288 if (OldOvl != New->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>() && !Old->isImplicit()) { 3289 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_overloadable_mismatch) 3290 << New << OldOvl; 3291 3292 // Try our best to find a decl that actually has the overloadable 3293 // attribute for the note. In most cases (e.g. programs with only one 3294 // broken declaration/definition), this won't matter. 3295 // 3296 // FIXME: We could do this if we juggled some extra state in 3297 // OverloadableAttr, rather than just removing it. 3298 const Decl *DiagOld = Old; 3299 if (OldOvl) { 3300 auto OldIter = llvm::find_if(Old->redecls(), [](const Decl *D) { 3301 const auto *A = D->getAttr<OverloadableAttr>(); 3302 return A && !A->isImplicit(); 3303 }); 3304 // If we've implicitly added *all* of the overloadable attrs to this 3305 // chain, emitting a "previous redecl" note is pointless. 3306 DiagOld = OldIter == Old->redecls_end() ? nullptr : *OldIter; 3307 } 3308 3309 if (DiagOld) 3310 Diag(DiagOld->getLocation(), 3311 diag::note_attribute_overloadable_prev_overload) 3312 << OldOvl; 3313 3314 if (OldOvl) 3315 New->addAttr(OverloadableAttr::CreateImplicit(Context)); 3316 else 3317 New->dropAttr<OverloadableAttr>(); 3318 } 3319 } 3320 3321 // If a function is first declared with a calling convention, but is later 3322 // declared or defined without one, all following decls assume the calling 3323 // convention of the first. 3324 // 3325 // It's OK if a function is first declared without a calling convention, 3326 // but is later declared or defined with the default calling convention. 3327 // 3328 // To test if either decl has an explicit calling convention, we look for 3329 // AttributedType sugar nodes on the type as written. If they are missing or 3330 // were canonicalized away, we assume the calling convention was implicit. 3331 // 3332 // Note also that we DO NOT return at this point, because we still have 3333 // other tests to run. 3334 QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType()); 3335 QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType()); 3336 const FunctionType *OldType = cast<FunctionType>(OldQType); 3337 const FunctionType *NewType = cast<FunctionType>(NewQType); 3338 FunctionType::ExtInfo OldTypeInfo = OldType->getExtInfo(); 3339 FunctionType::ExtInfo NewTypeInfo = NewType->getExtInfo(); 3340 bool RequiresAdjustment = false; 3341 3342 if (OldTypeInfo.getCC() != NewTypeInfo.getCC()) { 3343 FunctionDecl *First = Old->getFirstDecl(); 3344 const FunctionType *FT = 3345 First->getType().getCanonicalType()->castAs<FunctionType>(); 3346 FunctionType::ExtInfo FI = FT->getExtInfo(); 3347 bool NewCCExplicit = getCallingConvAttributedType(New->getType()); 3348 if (!NewCCExplicit) { 3349 // Inherit the CC from the previous declaration if it was specified 3350 // there but not here. 3351 NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withCallingConv(OldTypeInfo.getCC()); 3352 RequiresAdjustment = true; 3353 } else if (Old->getBuiltinID()) { 3354 // Builtin attribute isn't propagated to the new one yet at this point, 3355 // so we check if the old one is a builtin. 3356 3357 // Calling Conventions on a Builtin aren't really useful and setting a 3358 // default calling convention and cdecl'ing some builtin redeclarations is 3359 // common, so warn and ignore the calling convention on the redeclaration. 3360 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::warn_cconv_unsupported) 3361 << FunctionType::getNameForCallConv(NewTypeInfo.getCC()) 3362 << (int)CallingConventionIgnoredReason::BuiltinFunction; 3363 NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withCallingConv(OldTypeInfo.getCC()); 3364 RequiresAdjustment = true; 3365 } else { 3366 // Calling conventions aren't compatible, so complain. 3367 bool FirstCCExplicit = getCallingConvAttributedType(First->getType()); 3368 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_cconv_change) 3369 << FunctionType::getNameForCallConv(NewTypeInfo.getCC()) 3370 << !FirstCCExplicit 3371 << (!FirstCCExplicit ? "" : 3372 FunctionType::getNameForCallConv(FI.getCC())); 3373 3374 // Put the note on the first decl, since it is the one that matters. 3375 Diag(First->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 3376 return true; 3377 } 3378 } 3379 3380 // FIXME: diagnose the other way around? 3381 if (OldTypeInfo.getNoReturn() && !NewTypeInfo.getNoReturn()) { 3382 NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withNoReturn(true); 3383 RequiresAdjustment = true; 3384 } 3385 3386 // Merge regparm attribute. 3387 if (OldTypeInfo.getHasRegParm() != NewTypeInfo.getHasRegParm() || 3388 OldTypeInfo.getRegParm() != NewTypeInfo.getRegParm()) { 3389 if (NewTypeInfo.getHasRegParm()) { 3390 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_regparm_mismatch) 3391 << NewType->getRegParmType() 3392 << OldType->getRegParmType(); 3393 Diag(OldLocation, diag::note_previous_declaration); 3394 return true; 3395 } 3396 3397 NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withRegParm(OldTypeInfo.getRegParm()); 3398 RequiresAdjustment = true; 3399 } 3400 3401 // Merge ns_returns_retained attribute. 3402 if (OldTypeInfo.getProducesResult() != NewTypeInfo.getProducesResult()) { 3403 if (NewTypeInfo.getProducesResult()) { 3404 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_function_attribute_mismatch) 3405 << "'ns_returns_retained'"; 3406 Diag(OldLocation, diag::note_previous_declaration); 3407 return true; 3408 } 3409 3410 NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withProducesResult(true); 3411 RequiresAdjustment = true; 3412 } 3413 3414 if (OldTypeInfo.getNoCallerSavedRegs() != 3415 NewTypeInfo.getNoCallerSavedRegs()) { 3416 if (NewTypeInfo.getNoCallerSavedRegs()) { 3417 AnyX86NoCallerSavedRegistersAttr *Attr = 3418 New->getAttr<AnyX86NoCallerSavedRegistersAttr>(); 3419 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_function_attribute_mismatch) << Attr; 3420 Diag(OldLocation, diag::note_previous_declaration); 3421 return true; 3422 } 3423 3424 NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withNoCallerSavedRegs(true); 3425 RequiresAdjustment = true; 3426 } 3427 3428 if (RequiresAdjustment) { 3429 const FunctionType *AdjustedType = New->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>(); 3430 AdjustedType = Context.adjustFunctionType(AdjustedType, NewTypeInfo); 3431 New->setType(QualType(AdjustedType, 0)); 3432 NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType()); 3433 } 3434 3435 // If this redeclaration makes the function inline, we may need to add it to 3436 // UndefinedButUsed. 3437 if (!Old->isInlined() && New->isInlined() && 3438 !New->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>() && 3439 !getLangOpts().GNUInline && 3440 Old->isUsed(false) && 3441 !Old->isDefined() && !New->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) 3442 UndefinedButUsed.insert(std::make_pair(Old->getCanonicalDecl(), 3443 SourceLocation())); 3444 3445 // If this redeclaration makes it newly gnu_inline, we don't want to warn 3446 // about it. 3447 if (New->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>() && 3448 Old->isInlined() && !Old->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>()) { 3449 UndefinedButUsed.erase(Old->getCanonicalDecl()); 3450 } 3451 3452 // If pass_object_size params don't match up perfectly, this isn't a valid 3453 // redeclaration. 3454 if (Old->getNumParams() > 0 && Old->getNumParams() == New->getNumParams() && 3455 !hasIdenticalPassObjectSizeAttrs(Old, New)) { 3456 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_different_pass_object_size_params) 3457 << New->getDeclName(); 3458 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType(); 3459 return true; 3460 } 3461 3462 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 3463 // C++1z [over.load]p2 3464 // Certain function declarations cannot be overloaded: 3465 // -- Function declarations that differ only in the return type, 3466 // the exception specification, or both cannot be overloaded. 3467 3468 // Check the exception specifications match. This may recompute the type of 3469 // both Old and New if it resolved exception specifications, so grab the 3470 // types again after this. Because this updates the type, we do this before 3471 // any of the other checks below, which may update the "de facto" NewQType 3472 // but do not necessarily update the type of New. 3473 if (CheckEquivalentExceptionSpec(Old, New)) 3474 return true; 3475 OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType()); 3476 NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType()); 3477 3478 // Go back to the type source info to compare the declared return types, 3479 // per C++1y [dcl.type.auto]p13: 3480 // Redeclarations or specializations of a function or function template 3481 // with a declared return type that uses a placeholder type shall also 3482 // use that placeholder, not a deduced type. 3483 QualType OldDeclaredReturnType = Old->getDeclaredReturnType(); 3484 QualType NewDeclaredReturnType = New->getDeclaredReturnType(); 3485 if (!Context.hasSameType(OldDeclaredReturnType, NewDeclaredReturnType) && 3486 canFullyTypeCheckRedeclaration(New, Old, NewDeclaredReturnType, 3487 OldDeclaredReturnType)) { 3488 QualType ResQT; 3489 if (NewDeclaredReturnType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 3490 OldDeclaredReturnType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) 3491 // FIXME: This does the wrong thing for a deduced return type. 3492 ResQT = Context.mergeObjCGCQualifiers(NewQType, OldQType); 3493 if (ResQT.isNull()) { 3494 if (New->isCXXClassMember() && New->isOutOfLine()) 3495 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_member_def_does_not_match_ret_type) 3496 << New << New->getReturnTypeSourceRange(); 3497 else 3498 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_ovl_diff_return_type) 3499 << New->getReturnTypeSourceRange(); 3500 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType() 3501 << Old->getReturnTypeSourceRange(); 3502 return true; 3503 } 3504 else 3505 NewQType = ResQT; 3506 } 3507 3508 QualType OldReturnType = OldType->getReturnType(); 3509 QualType NewReturnType = cast<FunctionType>(NewQType)->getReturnType(); 3510 if (OldReturnType != NewReturnType) { 3511 // If this function has a deduced return type and has already been 3512 // defined, copy the deduced value from the old declaration. 3513 AutoType *OldAT = Old->getReturnType()->getContainedAutoType(); 3514 if (OldAT && OldAT->isDeduced()) { 3515 New->setType( 3516 SubstAutoType(New->getType(), 3517 OldAT->isDependentType() ? Context.DependentTy 3518 : OldAT->getDeducedType())); 3519 NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType( 3520 SubstAutoType(NewQType, 3521 OldAT->isDependentType() ? Context.DependentTy 3522 : OldAT->getDeducedType())); 3523 } 3524 } 3525 3526 const CXXMethodDecl *OldMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Old); 3527 CXXMethodDecl *NewMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(New); 3528 if (OldMethod && NewMethod) { 3529 // Preserve triviality. 3530 NewMethod->setTrivial(OldMethod->isTrivial()); 3531 3532 // MSVC allows explicit template specialization at class scope: 3533 // 2 CXXMethodDecls referring to the same function will be injected. 3534 // We don't want a redeclaration error. 3535 bool IsClassScopeExplicitSpecialization = 3536 OldMethod->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization() && 3537 NewMethod->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization(); 3538 bool isFriend = NewMethod->getFriendObjectKind(); 3539 3540 if (!isFriend && NewMethod->getLexicalDeclContext()->isRecord() && 3541 !IsClassScopeExplicitSpecialization) { 3542 // -- Member function declarations with the same name and the 3543 // same parameter types cannot be overloaded if any of them 3544 // is a static member function declaration. 3545 if (OldMethod->isStatic() != NewMethod->isStatic()) { 3546 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_ovl_static_nonstatic_member); 3547 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType(); 3548 return true; 3549 } 3550 3551 // C++ [class.mem]p1: 3552 // [...] A member shall not be declared twice in the 3553 // member-specification, except that a nested class or member 3554 // class template can be declared and then later defined. 3555 if (!inTemplateInstantiation()) { 3556 unsigned NewDiag; 3557 if (isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(OldMethod)) 3558 NewDiag = diag::err_constructor_redeclared; 3559 else if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(NewMethod)) 3560 NewDiag = diag::err_destructor_redeclared; 3561 else if (isa<CXXConversionDecl>(NewMethod)) 3562 NewDiag = diag::err_conv_function_redeclared; 3563 else 3564 NewDiag = diag::err_member_redeclared; 3565 3566 Diag(New->getLocation(), NewDiag); 3567 } else { 3568 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_member_redeclared_in_instantiation) 3569 << New << New->getType(); 3570 } 3571 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType(); 3572 return true; 3573 3574 // Complain if this is an explicit declaration of a special 3575 // member that was initially declared implicitly. 3576 // 3577 // As an exception, it's okay to befriend such methods in order 3578 // to permit the implicit constructor/destructor/operator calls. 3579 } else if (OldMethod->isImplicit()) { 3580 if (isFriend) { 3581 NewMethod->setImplicit(); 3582 } else { 3583 Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(), 3584 diag::err_definition_of_implicitly_declared_member) 3585 << New << getSpecialMember(OldMethod); 3586 return true; 3587 } 3588 } else if (OldMethod->getFirstDecl()->isExplicitlyDefaulted() && !isFriend) { 3589 Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(), 3590 diag::err_definition_of_explicitly_defaulted_member) 3591 << getSpecialMember(OldMethod); 3592 return true; 3593 } 3594 } 3595 3596 // C++11 [dcl.attr.noreturn]p1: 3597 // The first declaration of a function shall specify the noreturn 3598 // attribute if any declaration of that function specifies the noreturn 3599 // attribute. 3600 const CXX11NoReturnAttr *NRA = New->getAttr<CXX11NoReturnAttr>(); 3601 if (NRA && !Old->hasAttr<CXX11NoReturnAttr>()) { 3602 Diag(NRA->getLocation(), diag::err_noreturn_missing_on_first_decl); 3603 Diag(Old->getFirstDecl()->getLocation(), 3604 diag::note_noreturn_missing_first_decl); 3605 } 3606 3607 // C++11 [dcl.attr.depend]p2: 3608 // The first declaration of a function shall specify the 3609 // carries_dependency attribute for its declarator-id if any declaration 3610 // of the function specifies the carries_dependency attribute. 3611 const CarriesDependencyAttr *CDA = New->getAttr<CarriesDependencyAttr>(); 3612 if (CDA && !Old->hasAttr<CarriesDependencyAttr>()) { 3613 Diag(CDA->getLocation(), 3614 diag::err_carries_dependency_missing_on_first_decl) << 0/*Function*/; 3615 Diag(Old->getFirstDecl()->getLocation(), 3616 diag::note_carries_dependency_missing_first_decl) << 0/*Function*/; 3617 } 3618 3619 // (C++98 8.3.5p3): 3620 // All declarations for a function shall agree exactly in both the 3621 // return type and the parameter-type-list. 3622 // We also want to respect all the extended bits except noreturn. 3623 3624 // noreturn should now match unless the old type info didn't have it. 3625 QualType OldQTypeForComparison = OldQType; 3626 if (!OldTypeInfo.getNoReturn() && NewTypeInfo.getNoReturn()) { 3627 auto *OldType = OldQType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 3628 const FunctionType *OldTypeForComparison 3629 = Context.adjustFunctionType(OldType, OldTypeInfo.withNoReturn(true)); 3630 OldQTypeForComparison = QualType(OldTypeForComparison, 0); 3631 assert(OldQTypeForComparison.isCanonical()); 3632 } 3633 3634 if (haveIncompatibleLanguageLinkages(Old, New)) { 3635 // As a special case, retain the language linkage from previous 3636 // declarations of a friend function as an extension. 3637 // 3638 // This liberal interpretation of C++ [class.friend]p3 matches GCC/MSVC 3639 // and is useful because there's otherwise no way to specify language 3640 // linkage within class scope. 3641 // 3642 // Check cautiously as the friend object kind isn't yet complete. 3643 if (New->getFriendObjectKind() != Decl::FOK_None) { 3644 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::ext_retained_language_linkage) << New; 3645 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 3646 } else { 3647 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_different_language_linkage) << New; 3648 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 3649 return true; 3650 } 3651 } 3652 3653 // If the function types are compatible, merge the declarations. Ignore the 3654 // exception specifier because it was already checked above in 3655 // CheckEquivalentExceptionSpec, and we don't want follow-on diagnostics 3656 // about incompatible types under -fms-compatibility. 3657 if (Context.hasSameFunctionTypeIgnoringExceptionSpec(OldQTypeForComparison, 3658 NewQType)) 3659 return MergeCompatibleFunctionDecls(New, Old, S, MergeTypeWithOld); 3660 3661 // If the types are imprecise (due to dependent constructs in friends or 3662 // local extern declarations), it's OK if they differ. We'll check again 3663 // during instantiation. 3664 if (!canFullyTypeCheckRedeclaration(New, Old, NewQType, OldQType)) 3665 return false; 3666 3667 // Fall through for conflicting redeclarations and redefinitions. 3668 } 3669 3670 // C: Function types need to be compatible, not identical. This handles 3671 // duplicate function decls like "void f(int); void f(enum X);" properly. 3672 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 3673 Context.typesAreCompatible(OldQType, NewQType)) { 3674 const FunctionType *OldFuncType = OldQType->getAs<FunctionType>(); 3675 const FunctionType *NewFuncType = NewQType->getAs<FunctionType>(); 3676 const FunctionProtoType *OldProto = nullptr; 3677 if (MergeTypeWithOld && isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(NewFuncType) && 3678 (OldProto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(OldFuncType))) { 3679 // The old declaration provided a function prototype, but the 3680 // new declaration does not. Merge in the prototype. 3681 assert(!OldProto->hasExceptionSpec() && "Exception spec in C"); 3682 SmallVector<QualType, 16> ParamTypes(OldProto->param_types()); 3683 NewQType = 3684 Context.getFunctionType(NewFuncType->getReturnType(), ParamTypes, 3685 OldProto->getExtProtoInfo()); 3686 New->setType(NewQType); 3687 New->setHasInheritedPrototype(); 3688 3689 // Synthesize parameters with the same types. 3690 SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 16> Params; 3691 for (const auto &ParamType : OldProto->param_types()) { 3692 ParmVarDecl *Param = ParmVarDecl::Create(Context, New, SourceLocation(), 3693 SourceLocation(), nullptr, 3694 ParamType, /*TInfo=*/nullptr, 3695 SC_None, nullptr); 3696 Param->setScopeInfo(0, Params.size()); 3697 Param->setImplicit(); 3698 Params.push_back(Param); 3699 } 3700 3701 New->setParams(Params); 3702 } 3703 3704 return MergeCompatibleFunctionDecls(New, Old, S, MergeTypeWithOld); 3705 } 3706 3707 // Check if the function types are compatible when pointer size address 3708 // spaces are ignored. 3709 if (Context.hasSameFunctionTypeIgnoringPtrSizes(OldQType, NewQType)) 3710 return false; 3711 3712 // GNU C permits a K&R definition to follow a prototype declaration 3713 // if the declared types of the parameters in the K&R definition 3714 // match the types in the prototype declaration, even when the 3715 // promoted types of the parameters from the K&R definition differ 3716 // from the types in the prototype. GCC then keeps the types from 3717 // the prototype. 3718 // 3719 // If a variadic prototype is followed by a non-variadic K&R definition, 3720 // the K&R definition becomes variadic. This is sort of an edge case, but 3721 // it's legal per the standard depending on how you read C99 6.7.5.3p15 and 3722 // C99 6.9.1p8. 3723 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 3724 Old->hasPrototype() && !New->hasPrototype() && 3725 New->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>() && 3726 Old->getNumParams() == New->getNumParams()) { 3727 SmallVector<QualType, 16> ArgTypes; 3728 SmallVector<GNUCompatibleParamWarning, 16> Warnings; 3729 const FunctionProtoType *OldProto 3730 = Old->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 3731 const FunctionProtoType *NewProto 3732 = New->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 3733 3734 // Determine whether this is the GNU C extension. 3735 QualType MergedReturn = Context.mergeTypes(OldProto->getReturnType(), 3736 NewProto->getReturnType()); 3737 bool LooseCompatible = !MergedReturn.isNull(); 3738 for (unsigned Idx = 0, End = Old->getNumParams(); 3739 LooseCompatible && Idx != End; ++Idx) { 3740 ParmVarDecl *OldParm = Old->getParamDecl(Idx); 3741 ParmVarDecl *NewParm = New->getParamDecl(Idx); 3742 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(OldParm->getType(), 3743 NewProto->getParamType(Idx))) { 3744 ArgTypes.push_back(NewParm->getType()); 3745 } else if (Context.typesAreCompatible(OldParm->getType(), 3746 NewParm->getType(), 3747 /*CompareUnqualified=*/true)) { 3748 GNUCompatibleParamWarning Warn = { OldParm, NewParm, 3749 NewProto->getParamType(Idx) }; 3750 Warnings.push_back(Warn); 3751 ArgTypes.push_back(NewParm->getType()); 3752 } else 3753 LooseCompatible = false; 3754 } 3755 3756 if (LooseCompatible) { 3757 for (unsigned Warn = 0; Warn < Warnings.size(); ++Warn) { 3758 Diag(Warnings[Warn].NewParm->getLocation(), 3759 diag::ext_param_promoted_not_compatible_with_prototype) 3760 << Warnings[Warn].PromotedType 3761 << Warnings[Warn].OldParm->getType(); 3762 if (Warnings[Warn].OldParm->getLocation().isValid()) 3763 Diag(Warnings[Warn].OldParm->getLocation(), 3764 diag::note_previous_declaration); 3765 } 3766 3767 if (MergeTypeWithOld) 3768 New->setType(Context.getFunctionType(MergedReturn, ArgTypes, 3769 OldProto->getExtProtoInfo())); 3770 return MergeCompatibleFunctionDecls(New, Old, S, MergeTypeWithOld); 3771 } 3772 3773 // Fall through to diagnose conflicting types. 3774 } 3775 3776 // A function that has already been declared has been redeclared or 3777 // defined with a different type; show an appropriate diagnostic. 3778 3779 // If the previous declaration was an implicitly-generated builtin 3780 // declaration, then at the very least we should use a specialized note. 3781 unsigned BuiltinID; 3782 if (Old->isImplicit() && (BuiltinID = Old->getBuiltinID())) { 3783 // If it's actually a library-defined builtin function like 'malloc' 3784 // or 'printf', just warn about the incompatible redeclaration. 3785 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID)) { 3786 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::warn_redecl_library_builtin) << New; 3787 Diag(OldLocation, diag::note_previous_builtin_declaration) 3788 << Old << Old->getType(); 3789 return false; 3790 } 3791 3792 PrevDiag = diag::note_previous_builtin_declaration; 3793 } 3794 3795 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_conflicting_types) << New->getDeclName(); 3796 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType(); 3797 return true; 3798 } 3799 3800 /// Completes the merge of two function declarations that are 3801 /// known to be compatible. 3802 /// 3803 /// This routine handles the merging of attributes and other 3804 /// properties of function declarations from the old declaration to 3805 /// the new declaration, once we know that New is in fact a 3806 /// redeclaration of Old. 3807 /// 3808 /// \returns false 3809 bool Sema::MergeCompatibleFunctionDecls(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old, 3810 Scope *S, bool MergeTypeWithOld) { 3811 // Merge the attributes 3812 mergeDeclAttributes(New, Old); 3813 3814 // Merge "pure" flag. 3815 if (Old->isPure()) 3816 New->setPure(); 3817 3818 // Merge "used" flag. 3819 if (Old->getMostRecentDecl()->isUsed(false)) 3820 New->setIsUsed(); 3821 3822 // Merge attributes from the parameters. These can mismatch with K&R 3823 // declarations. 3824 if (New->getNumParams() == Old->getNumParams()) 3825 for (unsigned i = 0, e = New->getNumParams(); i != e; ++i) { 3826 ParmVarDecl *NewParam = New->getParamDecl(i); 3827 ParmVarDecl *OldParam = Old->getParamDecl(i); 3828 mergeParamDeclAttributes(NewParam, OldParam, *this); 3829 mergeParamDeclTypes(NewParam, OldParam, *this); 3830 } 3831 3832 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 3833 return MergeCXXFunctionDecl(New, Old, S); 3834 3835 // Merge the function types so the we get the composite types for the return 3836 // and argument types. Per C11 6.2.7/4, only update the type if the old decl 3837 // was visible. 3838 QualType Merged = Context.mergeTypes(Old->getType(), New->getType()); 3839 if (!Merged.isNull() && MergeTypeWithOld) 3840 New->setType(Merged); 3841 3842 return false; 3843 } 3844 3845 void Sema::mergeObjCMethodDecls(ObjCMethodDecl *newMethod, 3846 ObjCMethodDecl *oldMethod) { 3847 // Merge the attributes, including deprecated/unavailable 3848 AvailabilityMergeKind MergeKind = 3849 isa<ObjCProtocolDecl>(oldMethod->getDeclContext()) 3850 ? AMK_ProtocolImplementation 3851 : isa<ObjCImplDecl>(newMethod->getDeclContext()) ? AMK_Redeclaration 3852 : AMK_Override; 3853 3854 mergeDeclAttributes(newMethod, oldMethod, MergeKind); 3855 3856 // Merge attributes from the parameters. 3857 ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator oi = oldMethod->param_begin(), 3858 oe = oldMethod->param_end(); 3859 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator 3860 ni = newMethod->param_begin(), ne = newMethod->param_end(); 3861 ni != ne && oi != oe; ++ni, ++oi) 3862 mergeParamDeclAttributes(*ni, *oi, *this); 3863 3864 CheckObjCMethodOverride(newMethod, oldMethod); 3865 } 3866 3867 static void diagnoseVarDeclTypeMismatch(Sema &S, VarDecl *New, VarDecl* Old) { 3868 assert(!S.Context.hasSameType(New->getType(), Old->getType())); 3869 3870 S.Diag(New->getLocation(), New->isThisDeclarationADefinition() 3871 ? diag::err_redefinition_different_type 3872 : diag::err_redeclaration_different_type) 3873 << New->getDeclName() << New->getType() << Old->getType(); 3874 3875 diag::kind PrevDiag; 3876 SourceLocation OldLocation; 3877 std::tie(PrevDiag, OldLocation) 3878 = getNoteDiagForInvalidRedeclaration(Old, New); 3879 S.Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 3880 New->setInvalidDecl(); 3881 } 3882 3883 /// MergeVarDeclTypes - We parsed a variable 'New' which has the same name and 3884 /// scope as a previous declaration 'Old'. Figure out how to merge their types, 3885 /// emitting diagnostics as appropriate. 3886 /// 3887 /// Declarations using the auto type specifier (C++ [decl.spec.auto]) call back 3888 /// to here in AddInitializerToDecl. We can't check them before the initializer 3889 /// is attached. 3890 void Sema::MergeVarDeclTypes(VarDecl *New, VarDecl *Old, 3891 bool MergeTypeWithOld) { 3892 if (New->isInvalidDecl() || Old->isInvalidDecl()) 3893 return; 3894 3895 QualType MergedT; 3896 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 3897 if (New->getType()->isUndeducedType()) { 3898 // We don't know what the new type is until the initializer is attached. 3899 return; 3900 } else if (Context.hasSameType(New->getType(), Old->getType())) { 3901 // These could still be something that needs exception specs checked. 3902 return MergeVarDeclExceptionSpecs(New, Old); 3903 } 3904 // C++ [basic.link]p10: 3905 // [...] the types specified by all declarations referring to a given 3906 // object or function shall be identical, except that declarations for an 3907 // array object can specify array types that differ by the presence or 3908 // absence of a major array bound (8.3.4). 3909 else if (Old->getType()->isArrayType() && New->getType()->isArrayType()) { 3910 const ArrayType *OldArray = Context.getAsArrayType(Old->getType()); 3911 const ArrayType *NewArray = Context.getAsArrayType(New->getType()); 3912 3913 // We are merging a variable declaration New into Old. If it has an array 3914 // bound, and that bound differs from Old's bound, we should diagnose the 3915 // mismatch. 3916 if (!NewArray->isIncompleteArrayType() && !NewArray->isDependentType()) { 3917 for (VarDecl *PrevVD = Old->getMostRecentDecl(); PrevVD; 3918 PrevVD = PrevVD->getPreviousDecl()) { 3919 QualType PrevVDTy = PrevVD->getType(); 3920 if (PrevVDTy->isIncompleteArrayType() || PrevVDTy->isDependentType()) 3921 continue; 3922 3923 if (!Context.hasSameType(New->getType(), PrevVDTy)) 3924 return diagnoseVarDeclTypeMismatch(*this, New, PrevVD); 3925 } 3926 } 3927 3928 if (OldArray->isIncompleteArrayType() && NewArray->isArrayType()) { 3929 if (Context.hasSameType(OldArray->getElementType(), 3930 NewArray->getElementType())) 3931 MergedT = New->getType(); 3932 } 3933 // FIXME: Check visibility. New is hidden but has a complete type. If New 3934 // has no array bound, it should not inherit one from Old, if Old is not 3935 // visible. 3936 else if (OldArray->isArrayType() && NewArray->isIncompleteArrayType()) { 3937 if (Context.hasSameType(OldArray->getElementType(), 3938 NewArray->getElementType())) 3939 MergedT = Old->getType(); 3940 } 3941 } 3942 else if (New->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 3943 Old->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 3944 MergedT = Context.mergeObjCGCQualifiers(New->getType(), 3945 Old->getType()); 3946 } 3947 } else { 3948 // C 6.2.7p2: 3949 // All declarations that refer to the same object or function shall have 3950 // compatible type. 3951 MergedT = Context.mergeTypes(New->getType(), Old->getType()); 3952 } 3953 if (MergedT.isNull()) { 3954 // It's OK if we couldn't merge types if either type is dependent, for a 3955 // block-scope variable. In other cases (static data members of class 3956 // templates, variable templates, ...), we require the types to be 3957 // equivalent. 3958 // FIXME: The C++ standard doesn't say anything about this. 3959 if ((New->getType()->isDependentType() || 3960 Old->getType()->isDependentType()) && New->isLocalVarDecl()) { 3961 // If the old type was dependent, we can't merge with it, so the new type 3962 // becomes dependent for now. We'll reproduce the original type when we 3963 // instantiate the TypeSourceInfo for the variable. 3964 if (!New->getType()->isDependentType() && MergeTypeWithOld) 3965 New->setType(Context.DependentTy); 3966 return; 3967 } 3968 return diagnoseVarDeclTypeMismatch(*this, New, Old); 3969 } 3970 3971 // Don't actually update the type on the new declaration if the old 3972 // declaration was an extern declaration in a different scope. 3973 if (MergeTypeWithOld) 3974 New->setType(MergedT); 3975 } 3976 3977 static bool mergeTypeWithPrevious(Sema &S, VarDecl *NewVD, VarDecl *OldVD, 3978 LookupResult &Previous) { 3979 // C11 6.2.7p4: 3980 // For an identifier with internal or external linkage declared 3981 // in a scope in which a prior declaration of that identifier is 3982 // visible, if the prior declaration specifies internal or 3983 // external linkage, the type of the identifier at the later 3984 // declaration becomes the composite type. 3985 // 3986 // If the variable isn't visible, we do not merge with its type. 3987 if (Previous.isShadowed()) 3988 return false; 3989 3990 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 3991 // C++11 [dcl.array]p3: 3992 // If there is a preceding declaration of the entity in the same 3993 // scope in which the bound was specified, an omitted array bound 3994 // is taken to be the same as in that earlier declaration. 3995 return NewVD->isPreviousDeclInSameBlockScope() || 3996 (!OldVD->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod() && 3997 !NewVD->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()); 3998 } else { 3999 // If the old declaration was function-local, don't merge with its 4000 // type unless we're in the same function. 4001 return !OldVD->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod() || 4002 OldVD->getLexicalDeclContext() == NewVD->getLexicalDeclContext(); 4003 } 4004 } 4005 4006 /// MergeVarDecl - We just parsed a variable 'New' which has the same name 4007 /// and scope as a previous declaration 'Old'. Figure out how to resolve this 4008 /// situation, merging decls or emitting diagnostics as appropriate. 4009 /// 4010 /// Tentative definition rules (C99 6.9.2p2) are checked by 4011 /// FinalizeDeclaratorGroup. Unfortunately, we can't analyze tentative 4012 /// definitions here, since the initializer hasn't been attached. 4013 /// 4014 void Sema::MergeVarDecl(VarDecl *New, LookupResult &Previous) { 4015 // If the new decl is already invalid, don't do any other checking. 4016 if (New->isInvalidDecl()) 4017 return; 4018 4019 if (!shouldLinkPossiblyHiddenDecl(Previous, New)) 4020 return; 4021 4022 VarTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = New->getDescribedVarTemplate(); 4023 4024 // Verify the old decl was also a variable or variable template. 4025 VarDecl *Old = nullptr; 4026 VarTemplateDecl *OldTemplate = nullptr; 4027 if (Previous.isSingleResult()) { 4028 if (NewTemplate) { 4029 OldTemplate = dyn_cast<VarTemplateDecl>(Previous.getFoundDecl()); 4030 Old = OldTemplate ? OldTemplate->getTemplatedDecl() : nullptr; 4031 4032 if (auto *Shadow = 4033 dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Previous.getRepresentativeDecl())) 4034 if (checkUsingShadowRedecl<VarTemplateDecl>(*this, Shadow, NewTemplate)) 4035 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4036 } else { 4037 Old = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Previous.getFoundDecl()); 4038 4039 if (auto *Shadow = 4040 dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Previous.getRepresentativeDecl())) 4041 if (checkUsingShadowRedecl<VarDecl>(*this, Shadow, New)) 4042 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4043 } 4044 } 4045 if (!Old) { 4046 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_different_kind) 4047 << New->getDeclName(); 4048 notePreviousDefinition(Previous.getRepresentativeDecl(), 4049 New->getLocation()); 4050 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4051 } 4052 4053 // Ensure the template parameters are compatible. 4054 if (NewTemplate && 4055 !TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(NewTemplate->getTemplateParameters(), 4056 OldTemplate->getTemplateParameters(), 4057 /*Complain=*/true, TPL_TemplateMatch)) 4058 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4059 4060 // C++ [class.mem]p1: 4061 // A member shall not be declared twice in the member-specification [...] 4062 // 4063 // Here, we need only consider static data members. 4064 if (Old->isStaticDataMember() && !New->isOutOfLine()) { 4065 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_duplicate_member) 4066 << New->getIdentifier(); 4067 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 4068 New->setInvalidDecl(); 4069 } 4070 4071 mergeDeclAttributes(New, Old); 4072 // Warn if an already-declared variable is made a weak_import in a subsequent 4073 // declaration 4074 if (New->hasAttr<WeakImportAttr>() && 4075 Old->getStorageClass() == SC_None && 4076 !Old->hasAttr<WeakImportAttr>()) { 4077 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::warn_weak_import) << New->getDeclName(); 4078 notePreviousDefinition(Old, New->getLocation()); 4079 // Remove weak_import attribute on new declaration. 4080 New->dropAttr<WeakImportAttr>(); 4081 } 4082 4083 if (New->hasAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>() && 4084 !Old->hasAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>()) { 4085 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_internal_linkage_redeclaration) 4086 << New->getDeclName(); 4087 notePreviousDefinition(Old, New->getLocation()); 4088 New->dropAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>(); 4089 } 4090 4091 // Merge the types. 4092 VarDecl *MostRecent = Old->getMostRecentDecl(); 4093 if (MostRecent != Old) { 4094 MergeVarDeclTypes(New, MostRecent, 4095 mergeTypeWithPrevious(*this, New, MostRecent, Previous)); 4096 if (New->isInvalidDecl()) 4097 return; 4098 } 4099 4100 MergeVarDeclTypes(New, Old, mergeTypeWithPrevious(*this, New, Old, Previous)); 4101 if (New->isInvalidDecl()) 4102 return; 4103 4104 diag::kind PrevDiag; 4105 SourceLocation OldLocation; 4106 std::tie(PrevDiag, OldLocation) = 4107 getNoteDiagForInvalidRedeclaration(Old, New); 4108 4109 // [dcl.stc]p8: Check if we have a non-static decl followed by a static. 4110 if (New->getStorageClass() == SC_Static && 4111 !New->isStaticDataMember() && 4112 Old->hasExternalFormalLinkage()) { 4113 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt) { 4114 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::ext_static_non_static) 4115 << New->getDeclName(); 4116 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4117 } else { 4118 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_static_non_static) 4119 << New->getDeclName(); 4120 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4121 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4122 } 4123 } 4124 // C99 6.2.2p4: 4125 // For an identifier declared with the storage-class specifier 4126 // extern in a scope in which a prior declaration of that 4127 // identifier is visible,23) if the prior declaration specifies 4128 // internal or external linkage, the linkage of the identifier at 4129 // the later declaration is the same as the linkage specified at 4130 // the prior declaration. If no prior declaration is visible, or 4131 // if the prior declaration specifies no linkage, then the 4132 // identifier has external linkage. 4133 if (New->hasExternalStorage() && Old->hasLinkage()) 4134 /* Okay */; 4135 else if (New->getCanonicalDecl()->getStorageClass() != SC_Static && 4136 !New->isStaticDataMember() && 4137 Old->getCanonicalDecl()->getStorageClass() == SC_Static) { 4138 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_non_static_static) << New->getDeclName(); 4139 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4140 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4141 } 4142 4143 // Check if extern is followed by non-extern and vice-versa. 4144 if (New->hasExternalStorage() && 4145 !Old->hasLinkage() && Old->isLocalVarDeclOrParm()) { 4146 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_extern_non_extern) << New->getDeclName(); 4147 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4148 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4149 } 4150 if (Old->hasLinkage() && New->isLocalVarDeclOrParm() && 4151 !New->hasExternalStorage()) { 4152 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_non_extern_extern) << New->getDeclName(); 4153 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4154 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4155 } 4156 4157 if (CheckRedeclarationModuleOwnership(New, Old)) 4158 return; 4159 4160 // Variables with external linkage are analyzed in FinalizeDeclaratorGroup. 4161 4162 // FIXME: The test for external storage here seems wrong? We still 4163 // need to check for mismatches. 4164 if (!New->hasExternalStorage() && !New->isFileVarDecl() && 4165 // Don't complain about out-of-line definitions of static members. 4166 !(Old->getLexicalDeclContext()->isRecord() && 4167 !New->getLexicalDeclContext()->isRecord())) { 4168 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition) << New->getDeclName(); 4169 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4170 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 4171 } 4172 4173 if (New->isInline() && !Old->getMostRecentDecl()->isInline()) { 4174 if (VarDecl *Def = Old->getDefinition()) { 4175 // C++1z [dcl.fcn.spec]p4: 4176 // If the definition of a variable appears in a translation unit before 4177 // its first declaration as inline, the program is ill-formed. 4178 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_inline_decl_follows_def) << New; 4179 Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 4180 } 4181 } 4182 4183 // If this redeclaration makes the variable inline, we may need to add it to 4184 // UndefinedButUsed. 4185 if (!Old->isInline() && New->isInline() && Old->isUsed(false) && 4186 !Old->getDefinition() && !New->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) 4187 UndefinedButUsed.insert(std::make_pair(Old->getCanonicalDecl(), 4188 SourceLocation())); 4189 4190 if (New->getTLSKind() != Old->getTLSKind()) { 4191 if (!Old->getTLSKind()) { 4192 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_thread_non_thread) << New->getDeclName(); 4193 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4194 } else if (!New->getTLSKind()) { 4195 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_non_thread_thread) << New->getDeclName(); 4196 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4197 } else { 4198 // Do not allow redeclaration to change the variable between requiring 4199 // static and dynamic initialization. 4200 // FIXME: GCC allows this, but uses the TLS keyword on the first 4201 // declaration to determine the kind. Do we need to be compatible here? 4202 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_thread_thread_different_kind) 4203 << New->getDeclName() << (New->getTLSKind() == VarDecl::TLS_Dynamic); 4204 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4205 } 4206 } 4207 4208 // C++ doesn't have tentative definitions, so go right ahead and check here. 4209 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 4210 New->isThisDeclarationADefinition() == VarDecl::Definition) { 4211 if (Old->isStaticDataMember() && Old->getCanonicalDecl()->isInline() && 4212 Old->getCanonicalDecl()->isConstexpr()) { 4213 // This definition won't be a definition any more once it's been merged. 4214 Diag(New->getLocation(), 4215 diag::warn_deprecated_redundant_constexpr_static_def); 4216 } else if (VarDecl *Def = Old->getDefinition()) { 4217 if (checkVarDeclRedefinition(Def, New)) 4218 return; 4219 } 4220 } 4221 4222 if (haveIncompatibleLanguageLinkages(Old, New)) { 4223 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_different_language_linkage) << New; 4224 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 4225 New->setInvalidDecl(); 4226 return; 4227 } 4228 4229 // Merge "used" flag. 4230 if (Old->getMostRecentDecl()->isUsed(false)) 4231 New->setIsUsed(); 4232 4233 // Keep a chain of previous declarations. 4234 New->setPreviousDecl(Old); 4235 if (NewTemplate) 4236 NewTemplate->setPreviousDecl(OldTemplate); 4237 adjustDeclContextForDeclaratorDecl(New, Old); 4238 4239 // Inherit access appropriately. 4240 New->setAccess(Old->getAccess()); 4241 if (NewTemplate) 4242 NewTemplate->setAccess(New->getAccess()); 4243 4244 if (Old->isInline()) 4245 New->setImplicitlyInline(); 4246 } 4247 4248 void Sema::notePreviousDefinition(const NamedDecl *Old, SourceLocation New) { 4249 SourceManager &SrcMgr = getSourceManager(); 4250 auto FNewDecLoc = SrcMgr.getDecomposedLoc(New); 4251 auto FOldDecLoc = SrcMgr.getDecomposedLoc(Old->getLocation()); 4252 auto *FNew = SrcMgr.getFileEntryForID(FNewDecLoc.first); 4253 auto *FOld = SrcMgr.getFileEntryForID(FOldDecLoc.first); 4254 auto &HSI = PP.getHeaderSearchInfo(); 4255 StringRef HdrFilename = 4256 SrcMgr.getFilename(SrcMgr.getSpellingLoc(Old->getLocation())); 4257 4258 auto noteFromModuleOrInclude = [&](Module *Mod, 4259 SourceLocation IncLoc) -> bool { 4260 // Redefinition errors with modules are common with non modular mapped 4261 // headers, example: a non-modular header H in module A that also gets 4262 // included directly in a TU. Pointing twice to the same header/definition 4263 // is confusing, try to get better diagnostics when modules is on. 4264 if (IncLoc.isValid()) { 4265 if (Mod) { 4266 Diag(IncLoc, diag::note_redefinition_modules_same_file) 4267 << HdrFilename.str() << Mod->getFullModuleName(); 4268 if (!Mod->DefinitionLoc.isInvalid()) 4269 Diag(Mod->DefinitionLoc, diag::note_defined_here) 4270 << Mod->getFullModuleName(); 4271 } else { 4272 Diag(IncLoc, diag::note_redefinition_include_same_file) 4273 << HdrFilename.str(); 4274 } 4275 return true; 4276 } 4277 4278 return false; 4279 }; 4280 4281 // Is it the same file and same offset? Provide more information on why 4282 // this leads to a redefinition error. 4283 if (FNew == FOld && FNewDecLoc.second == FOldDecLoc.second) { 4284 SourceLocation OldIncLoc = SrcMgr.getIncludeLoc(FOldDecLoc.first); 4285 SourceLocation NewIncLoc = SrcMgr.getIncludeLoc(FNewDecLoc.first); 4286 bool EmittedDiag = 4287 noteFromModuleOrInclude(Old->getOwningModule(), OldIncLoc); 4288 EmittedDiag |= noteFromModuleOrInclude(getCurrentModule(), NewIncLoc); 4289 4290 // If the header has no guards, emit a note suggesting one. 4291 if (FOld && !HSI.isFileMultipleIncludeGuarded(FOld)) 4292 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_use_ifdef_guards); 4293 4294 if (EmittedDiag) 4295 return; 4296 } 4297 4298 // Redefinition coming from different files or couldn't do better above. 4299 if (Old->getLocation().isValid()) 4300 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 4301 } 4302 4303 /// We've just determined that \p Old and \p New both appear to be definitions 4304 /// of the same variable. Either diagnose or fix the problem. 4305 bool Sema::checkVarDeclRedefinition(VarDecl *Old, VarDecl *New) { 4306 if (!hasVisibleDefinition(Old) && 4307 (New->getFormalLinkage() == InternalLinkage || 4308 New->isInline() || 4309 New->getDescribedVarTemplate() || 4310 New->getNumTemplateParameterLists() || 4311 New->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext())) { 4312 // The previous definition is hidden, and multiple definitions are 4313 // permitted (in separate TUs). Demote this to a declaration. 4314 New->demoteThisDefinitionToDeclaration(); 4315 4316 // Make the canonical definition visible. 4317 if (auto *OldTD = Old->getDescribedVarTemplate()) 4318 makeMergedDefinitionVisible(OldTD); 4319 makeMergedDefinitionVisible(Old); 4320 return false; 4321 } else { 4322 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition) << New; 4323 notePreviousDefinition(Old, New->getLocation()); 4324 New->setInvalidDecl(); 4325 return true; 4326 } 4327 } 4328 4329 /// ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec - This method is invoked when a declspec with 4330 /// no declarator (e.g. "struct foo;") is parsed. 4331 Decl * 4332 Sema::ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec(Scope *S, AccessSpecifier AS, DeclSpec &DS, 4333 RecordDecl *&AnonRecord) { 4334 return ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec(S, AS, DS, MultiTemplateParamsArg(), false, 4335 AnonRecord); 4336 } 4337 4338 // The MS ABI changed between VS2013 and VS2015 with regard to numbers used to 4339 // disambiguate entities defined in different scopes. 4340 // While the VS2015 ABI fixes potential miscompiles, it is also breaks 4341 // compatibility. 4342 // We will pick our mangling number depending on which version of MSVC is being 4343 // targeted. 4344 static unsigned getMSManglingNumber(const LangOptions &LO, Scope *S) { 4345 return LO.isCompatibleWithMSVC(LangOptions::MSVC2015) 4346 ? S->getMSCurManglingNumber() 4347 : S->getMSLastManglingNumber(); 4348 } 4349 4350 void Sema::handleTagNumbering(const TagDecl *Tag, Scope *TagScope) { 4351 if (!Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 4352 return; 4353 4354 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Tag->getParent())) { 4355 // If this tag is the direct child of a class, number it if 4356 // it is anonymous. 4357 if (!Tag->getName().empty() || Tag->getTypedefNameForAnonDecl()) 4358 return; 4359 MangleNumberingContext &MCtx = 4360 Context.getManglingNumberContext(Tag->getParent()); 4361 Context.setManglingNumber( 4362 Tag, MCtx.getManglingNumber( 4363 Tag, getMSManglingNumber(getLangOpts(), TagScope))); 4364 return; 4365 } 4366 4367 // If this tag isn't a direct child of a class, number it if it is local. 4368 MangleNumberingContext *MCtx; 4369 Decl *ManglingContextDecl; 4370 std::tie(MCtx, ManglingContextDecl) = 4371 getCurrentMangleNumberContext(Tag->getDeclContext()); 4372 if (MCtx) { 4373 Context.setManglingNumber( 4374 Tag, MCtx->getManglingNumber( 4375 Tag, getMSManglingNumber(getLangOpts(), TagScope))); 4376 } 4377 } 4378 4379 namespace { 4380 struct NonCLikeKind { 4381 enum { 4382 None, 4383 BaseClass, 4384 DefaultMemberInit, 4385 Lambda, 4386 Friend, 4387 OtherMember, 4388 Invalid, 4389 } Kind = None; 4390 SourceRange Range; 4391 4392 explicit operator bool() { return Kind != None; } 4393 }; 4394 } 4395 4396 /// Determine whether a class is C-like, according to the rules of C++ 4397 /// [dcl.typedef] for anonymous classes with typedef names for linkage. 4398 static NonCLikeKind getNonCLikeKindForAnonymousStruct(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) { 4399 if (RD->isInvalidDecl()) 4400 return {NonCLikeKind::Invalid, {}}; 4401 4402 // C++ [dcl.typedef]p9: [P1766R1] 4403 // An unnamed class with a typedef name for linkage purposes shall not 4404 // 4405 // -- have any base classes 4406 if (RD->getNumBases()) 4407 return {NonCLikeKind::BaseClass, 4408 SourceRange(RD->bases_begin()->getBeginLoc(), 4409 RD->bases_end()[-1].getEndLoc())}; 4410 bool Invalid = false; 4411 for (Decl *D : RD->decls()) { 4412 // Don't complain about things we already diagnosed. 4413 if (D->isInvalidDecl()) { 4414 Invalid = true; 4415 continue; 4416 } 4417 4418 // -- have any [...] default member initializers 4419 if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(D)) { 4420 if (FD->hasInClassInitializer()) { 4421 auto *Init = FD->getInClassInitializer(); 4422 return {NonCLikeKind::DefaultMemberInit, 4423 Init ? Init->getSourceRange() : D->getSourceRange()}; 4424 } 4425 continue; 4426 } 4427 4428 // FIXME: We don't allow friend declarations. This violates the wording of 4429 // P1766, but not the intent. 4430 if (isa<FriendDecl>(D)) 4431 return {NonCLikeKind::Friend, D->getSourceRange()}; 4432 4433 // -- declare any members other than non-static data members, member 4434 // enumerations, or member classes, 4435 if (isa<StaticAssertDecl>(D) || isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(D) || 4436 isa<EnumDecl>(D)) 4437 continue; 4438 auto *MemberRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D); 4439 if (!MemberRD) { 4440 if (D->isImplicit()) 4441 continue; 4442 return {NonCLikeKind::OtherMember, D->getSourceRange()}; 4443 } 4444 4445 // -- contain a lambda-expression, 4446 if (MemberRD->isLambda()) 4447 return {NonCLikeKind::Lambda, MemberRD->getSourceRange()}; 4448 4449 // and all member classes shall also satisfy these requirements 4450 // (recursively). 4451 if (MemberRD->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) { 4452 if (auto Kind = getNonCLikeKindForAnonymousStruct(MemberRD)) 4453 return Kind; 4454 } 4455 } 4456 4457 return {Invalid ? NonCLikeKind::Invalid : NonCLikeKind::None, {}}; 4458 } 4459 4460 void Sema::setTagNameForLinkagePurposes(TagDecl *TagFromDeclSpec, 4461 TypedefNameDecl *NewTD) { 4462 if (TagFromDeclSpec->isInvalidDecl()) 4463 return; 4464 4465 // Do nothing if the tag already has a name for linkage purposes. 4466 if (TagFromDeclSpec->hasNameForLinkage()) 4467 return; 4468 4469 // A well-formed anonymous tag must always be a TUK_Definition. 4470 assert(TagFromDeclSpec->isThisDeclarationADefinition()); 4471 4472 // The type must match the tag exactly; no qualifiers allowed. 4473 if (!Context.hasSameType(NewTD->getUnderlyingType(), 4474 Context.getTagDeclType(TagFromDeclSpec))) { 4475 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 4476 Context.addTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(TagFromDeclSpec, NewTD); 4477 return; 4478 } 4479 4480 // C++ [dcl.typedef]p9: [P1766R1, applied as DR] 4481 // An unnamed class with a typedef name for linkage purposes shall [be 4482 // C-like]. 4483 // 4484 // FIXME: Also diagnose if we've already computed the linkage. That ideally 4485 // shouldn't happen, but there are constructs that the language rule doesn't 4486 // disallow for which we can't reasonably avoid computing linkage early. 4487 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TagFromDeclSpec); 4488 NonCLikeKind NonCLike = RD ? getNonCLikeKindForAnonymousStruct(RD) 4489 : NonCLikeKind(); 4490 bool ChangesLinkage = TagFromDeclSpec->hasLinkageBeenComputed(); 4491 if (NonCLike || ChangesLinkage) { 4492 if (NonCLike.Kind == NonCLikeKind::Invalid) 4493 return; 4494 4495 unsigned DiagID = diag::ext_non_c_like_anon_struct_in_typedef; 4496 if (ChangesLinkage) { 4497 // If the linkage changes, we can't accept this as an extension. 4498 if (NonCLike.Kind == NonCLikeKind::None) 4499 DiagID = diag::err_typedef_changes_linkage; 4500 else 4501 DiagID = diag::err_non_c_like_anon_struct_in_typedef; 4502 } 4503 4504 SourceLocation FixitLoc = 4505 getLocForEndOfToken(TagFromDeclSpec->getInnerLocStart()); 4506 llvm::SmallString<40> TextToInsert; 4507 TextToInsert += ' '; 4508 TextToInsert += NewTD->getIdentifier()->getName(); 4509 4510 Diag(FixitLoc, DiagID) 4511 << isa<TypeAliasDecl>(NewTD) 4512 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FixitLoc, TextToInsert); 4513 if (NonCLike.Kind != NonCLikeKind::None) { 4514 Diag(NonCLike.Range.getBegin(), diag::note_non_c_like_anon_struct) 4515 << NonCLike.Kind - 1 << NonCLike.Range; 4516 } 4517 Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::note_typedef_for_linkage_here) 4518 << NewTD << isa<TypeAliasDecl>(NewTD); 4519 4520 if (ChangesLinkage) 4521 return; 4522 } 4523 4524 // Otherwise, set this as the anon-decl typedef for the tag. 4525 TagFromDeclSpec->setTypedefNameForAnonDecl(NewTD); 4526 } 4527 4528 static unsigned GetDiagnosticTypeSpecifierID(DeclSpec::TST T) { 4529 switch (T) { 4530 case DeclSpec::TST_class: 4531 return 0; 4532 case DeclSpec::TST_struct: 4533 return 1; 4534 case DeclSpec::TST_interface: 4535 return 2; 4536 case DeclSpec::TST_union: 4537 return 3; 4538 case DeclSpec::TST_enum: 4539 return 4; 4540 default: 4541 llvm_unreachable("unexpected type specifier"); 4542 } 4543 } 4544 4545 /// ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec - This method is invoked when a declspec with 4546 /// no declarator (e.g. "struct foo;") is parsed. It also accepts template 4547 /// parameters to cope with template friend declarations. 4548 Decl * 4549 Sema::ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec(Scope *S, AccessSpecifier AS, DeclSpec &DS, 4550 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParams, 4551 bool IsExplicitInstantiation, 4552 RecordDecl *&AnonRecord) { 4553 Decl *TagD = nullptr; 4554 TagDecl *Tag = nullptr; 4555 if (DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_class || 4556 DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_struct || 4557 DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_interface || 4558 DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_union || 4559 DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_enum) { 4560 TagD = DS.getRepAsDecl(); 4561 4562 if (!TagD) // We probably had an error 4563 return nullptr; 4564 4565 // Note that the above type specs guarantee that the 4566 // type rep is a Decl, whereas in many of the others 4567 // it's a Type. 4568 if (isa<TagDecl>(TagD)) 4569 Tag = cast<TagDecl>(TagD); 4570 else if (ClassTemplateDecl *CTD = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateDecl>(TagD)) 4571 Tag = CTD->getTemplatedDecl(); 4572 } 4573 4574 if (Tag) { 4575 handleTagNumbering(Tag, S); 4576 Tag->setFreeStanding(); 4577 if (Tag->isInvalidDecl()) 4578 return Tag; 4579 } 4580 4581 if (unsigned TypeQuals = DS.getTypeQualifiers()) { 4582 // Enforce C99 6.7.3p2: "Types other than pointer types derived from object 4583 // or incomplete types shall not be restrict-qualified." 4584 if (TypeQuals & DeclSpec::TQ_restrict) 4585 Diag(DS.getRestrictSpecLoc(), 4586 diag::err_typecheck_invalid_restrict_not_pointer_noarg) 4587 << DS.getSourceRange(); 4588 } 4589 4590 if (DS.isInlineSpecified()) 4591 Diag(DS.getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_non_function) 4592 << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17; 4593 4594 if (DS.hasConstexprSpecifier()) { 4595 // C++0x [dcl.constexpr]p1: constexpr can only be applied to declarations 4596 // and definitions of functions and variables. 4597 // C++2a [dcl.constexpr]p1: The consteval specifier shall be applied only to 4598 // the declaration of a function or function template 4599 if (Tag) 4600 Diag(DS.getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_constexpr_tag) 4601 << GetDiagnosticTypeSpecifierID(DS.getTypeSpecType()) 4602 << DS.getConstexprSpecifier(); 4603 else 4604 Diag(DS.getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_constexpr_wrong_decl_kind) 4605 << DS.getConstexprSpecifier(); 4606 // Don't emit warnings after this error. 4607 return TagD; 4608 } 4609 4610 DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(DS); 4611 4612 if (DS.isFriendSpecified()) { 4613 // If we're dealing with a decl but not a TagDecl, assume that 4614 // whatever routines created it handled the friendship aspect. 4615 if (TagD && !Tag) 4616 return nullptr; 4617 return ActOnFriendTypeDecl(S, DS, TemplateParams); 4618 } 4619 4620 const CXXScopeSpec &SS = DS.getTypeSpecScope(); 4621 bool IsExplicitSpecialization = 4622 !TemplateParams.empty() && TemplateParams.back()->size() == 0; 4623 if (Tag && SS.isNotEmpty() && !Tag->isCompleteDefinition() && 4624 !IsExplicitInstantiation && !IsExplicitSpecialization && 4625 !isa<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(Tag)) { 4626 // Per C++ [dcl.type.elab]p1, a class declaration cannot have a 4627 // nested-name-specifier unless it is an explicit instantiation 4628 // or an explicit specialization. 4629 // 4630 // FIXME: We allow class template partial specializations here too, per the 4631 // obvious intent of DR1819. 4632 // 4633 // Per C++ [dcl.enum]p1, an opaque-enum-declaration can't either. 4634 Diag(SS.getBeginLoc(), diag::err_standalone_class_nested_name_specifier) 4635 << GetDiagnosticTypeSpecifierID(DS.getTypeSpecType()) << SS.getRange(); 4636 return nullptr; 4637 } 4638 4639 // Track whether this decl-specifier declares anything. 4640 bool DeclaresAnything = true; 4641 4642 // Handle anonymous struct definitions. 4643 if (RecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast_or_null<RecordDecl>(Tag)) { 4644 if (!Record->getDeclName() && Record->isCompleteDefinition() && 4645 DS.getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_typedef) { 4646 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || 4647 Record->getDeclContext()->isRecord()) { 4648 // If CurContext is a DeclContext that can contain statements, 4649 // RecursiveASTVisitor won't visit the decls that 4650 // BuildAnonymousStructOrUnion() will put into CurContext. 4651 // Also store them here so that they can be part of the 4652 // DeclStmt that gets created in this case. 4653 // FIXME: Also return the IndirectFieldDecls created by 4654 // BuildAnonymousStructOr union, for the same reason? 4655 if (CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod()) 4656 AnonRecord = Record; 4657 return BuildAnonymousStructOrUnion(S, DS, AS, Record, 4658 Context.getPrintingPolicy()); 4659 } 4660 4661 DeclaresAnything = false; 4662 } 4663 } 4664 4665 // C11 6.7.2.1p2: 4666 // A struct-declaration that does not declare an anonymous structure or 4667 // anonymous union shall contain a struct-declarator-list. 4668 // 4669 // This rule also existed in C89 and C99; the grammar for struct-declaration 4670 // did not permit a struct-declaration without a struct-declarator-list. 4671 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && CurContext->isRecord() && 4672 DS.getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified) { 4673 // Check for Microsoft C extension: anonymous struct/union member. 4674 // Handle 2 kinds of anonymous struct/union: 4675 // struct STRUCT; 4676 // union UNION; 4677 // and 4678 // STRUCT_TYPE; <- where STRUCT_TYPE is a typedef struct. 4679 // UNION_TYPE; <- where UNION_TYPE is a typedef union. 4680 if ((Tag && Tag->getDeclName()) || 4681 DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_typename) { 4682 RecordDecl *Record = nullptr; 4683 if (Tag) 4684 Record = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Tag); 4685 else if (const RecordType *RT = 4686 DS.getRepAsType().get()->getAsStructureType()) 4687 Record = RT->getDecl(); 4688 else if (const RecordType *UT = DS.getRepAsType().get()->getAsUnionType()) 4689 Record = UT->getDecl(); 4690 4691 if (Record && getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt) { 4692 Diag(DS.getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_ms_anonymous_record) 4693 << Record->isUnion() << DS.getSourceRange(); 4694 return BuildMicrosoftCAnonymousStruct(S, DS, Record); 4695 } 4696 4697 DeclaresAnything = false; 4698 } 4699 } 4700 4701 // Skip all the checks below if we have a type error. 4702 if (DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_error || 4703 (TagD && TagD->isInvalidDecl())) 4704 return TagD; 4705 4706 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 4707 DS.getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_typedef) 4708 if (EnumDecl *Enum = dyn_cast_or_null<EnumDecl>(Tag)) 4709 if (Enum->enumerator_begin() == Enum->enumerator_end() && 4710 !Enum->getIdentifier() && !Enum->isInvalidDecl()) 4711 DeclaresAnything = false; 4712 4713 if (!DS.isMissingDeclaratorOk()) { 4714 // Customize diagnostic for a typedef missing a name. 4715 if (DS.getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_typedef) 4716 Diag(DS.getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_typedef_without_a_name) 4717 << DS.getSourceRange(); 4718 else 4719 DeclaresAnything = false; 4720 } 4721 4722 if (DS.isModulePrivateSpecified() && 4723 Tag && Tag->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()) 4724 Diag(DS.getModulePrivateSpecLoc(), diag::err_module_private_local_class) 4725 << Tag->getTagKind() 4726 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getModulePrivateSpecLoc()); 4727 4728 ActOnDocumentableDecl(TagD); 4729 4730 // C 6.7/2: 4731 // A declaration [...] shall declare at least a declarator [...], a tag, 4732 // or the members of an enumeration. 4733 // C++ [dcl.dcl]p3: 4734 // [If there are no declarators], and except for the declaration of an 4735 // unnamed bit-field, the decl-specifier-seq shall introduce one or more 4736 // names into the program, or shall redeclare a name introduced by a 4737 // previous declaration. 4738 if (!DeclaresAnything) { 4739 // In C, we allow this as a (popular) extension / bug. Don't bother 4740 // producing further diagnostics for redundant qualifiers after this. 4741 Diag(DS.getBeginLoc(), (IsExplicitInstantiation || !TemplateParams.empty()) 4742 ? diag::err_no_declarators 4743 : diag::ext_no_declarators) 4744 << DS.getSourceRange(); 4745 return TagD; 4746 } 4747 4748 // C++ [dcl.stc]p1: 4749 // If a storage-class-specifier appears in a decl-specifier-seq, [...] the 4750 // init-declarator-list of the declaration shall not be empty. 4751 // C++ [dcl.fct.spec]p1: 4752 // If a cv-qualifier appears in a decl-specifier-seq, the 4753 // init-declarator-list of the declaration shall not be empty. 4754 // 4755 // Spurious qualifiers here appear to be valid in C. 4756 unsigned DiagID = diag::warn_standalone_specifier; 4757 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 4758 DiagID = diag::ext_standalone_specifier; 4759 4760 // Note that a linkage-specification sets a storage class, but 4761 // 'extern "C" struct foo;' is actually valid and not theoretically 4762 // useless. 4763 if (DeclSpec::SCS SCS = DS.getStorageClassSpec()) { 4764 if (SCS == DeclSpec::SCS_mutable) 4765 // Since mutable is not a viable storage class specifier in C, there is 4766 // no reason to treat it as an extension. Instead, diagnose as an error. 4767 Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(), diag::err_mutable_nonmember); 4768 else if (!DS.isExternInLinkageSpec() && SCS != DeclSpec::SCS_typedef) 4769 Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(), DiagID) 4770 << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(SCS); 4771 } 4772 4773 if (DeclSpec::TSCS TSCS = DS.getThreadStorageClassSpec()) 4774 Diag(DS.getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), DiagID) 4775 << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSCS); 4776 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers()) { 4777 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_const) 4778 Diag(DS.getConstSpecLoc(), DiagID) << "const"; 4779 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_volatile) 4780 Diag(DS.getConstSpecLoc(), DiagID) << "volatile"; 4781 // Restrict is covered above. 4782 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_atomic) 4783 Diag(DS.getAtomicSpecLoc(), DiagID) << "_Atomic"; 4784 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_unaligned) 4785 Diag(DS.getUnalignedSpecLoc(), DiagID) << "__unaligned"; 4786 } 4787 4788 // Warn about ignored type attributes, for example: 4789 // __attribute__((aligned)) struct A; 4790 // Attributes should be placed after tag to apply to type declaration. 4791 if (!DS.getAttributes().empty()) { 4792 DeclSpec::TST TypeSpecType = DS.getTypeSpecType(); 4793 if (TypeSpecType == DeclSpec::TST_class || 4794 TypeSpecType == DeclSpec::TST_struct || 4795 TypeSpecType == DeclSpec::TST_interface || 4796 TypeSpecType == DeclSpec::TST_union || 4797 TypeSpecType == DeclSpec::TST_enum) { 4798 for (const ParsedAttr &AL : DS.getAttributes()) 4799 Diag(AL.getLoc(), diag::warn_declspec_attribute_ignored) 4800 << AL << GetDiagnosticTypeSpecifierID(TypeSpecType); 4801 } 4802 } 4803 4804 return TagD; 4805 } 4806 4807 /// We are trying to inject an anonymous member into the given scope; 4808 /// check if there's an existing declaration that can't be overloaded. 4809 /// 4810 /// \return true if this is a forbidden redeclaration 4811 static bool CheckAnonMemberRedeclaration(Sema &SemaRef, 4812 Scope *S, 4813 DeclContext *Owner, 4814 DeclarationName Name, 4815 SourceLocation NameLoc, 4816 bool IsUnion) { 4817 LookupResult R(SemaRef, Name, NameLoc, Sema::LookupMemberName, 4818 Sema::ForVisibleRedeclaration); 4819 if (!SemaRef.LookupName(R, S)) return false; 4820 4821 // Pick a representative declaration. 4822 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = R.getRepresentativeDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl(); 4823 assert(PrevDecl && "Expected a non-null Decl"); 4824 4825 if (!SemaRef.isDeclInScope(PrevDecl, Owner, S)) 4826 return false; 4827 4828 SemaRef.Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_anonymous_record_member_redecl) 4829 << IsUnion << Name; 4830 SemaRef.Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 4831 4832 return true; 4833 } 4834 4835 /// InjectAnonymousStructOrUnionMembers - Inject the members of the 4836 /// anonymous struct or union AnonRecord into the owning context Owner 4837 /// and scope S. This routine will be invoked just after we realize 4838 /// that an unnamed union or struct is actually an anonymous union or 4839 /// struct, e.g., 4840 /// 4841 /// @code 4842 /// union { 4843 /// int i; 4844 /// float f; 4845 /// }; // InjectAnonymousStructOrUnionMembers called here to inject i and 4846 /// // f into the surrounding scope.x 4847 /// @endcode 4848 /// 4849 /// This routine is recursive, injecting the names of nested anonymous 4850 /// structs/unions into the owning context and scope as well. 4851 static bool 4852 InjectAnonymousStructOrUnionMembers(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, DeclContext *Owner, 4853 RecordDecl *AnonRecord, AccessSpecifier AS, 4854 SmallVectorImpl<NamedDecl *> &Chaining) { 4855 bool Invalid = false; 4856 4857 // Look every FieldDecl and IndirectFieldDecl with a name. 4858 for (auto *D : AnonRecord->decls()) { 4859 if ((isa<FieldDecl>(D) || isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(D)) && 4860 cast<NamedDecl>(D)->getDeclName()) { 4861 ValueDecl *VD = cast<ValueDecl>(D); 4862 if (CheckAnonMemberRedeclaration(SemaRef, S, Owner, VD->getDeclName(), 4863 VD->getLocation(), 4864 AnonRecord->isUnion())) { 4865 // C++ [class.union]p2: 4866 // The names of the members of an anonymous union shall be 4867 // distinct from the names of any other entity in the 4868 // scope in which the anonymous union is declared. 4869 Invalid = true; 4870 } else { 4871 // C++ [class.union]p2: 4872 // For the purpose of name lookup, after the anonymous union 4873 // definition, the members of the anonymous union are 4874 // considered to have been defined in the scope in which the 4875 // anonymous union is declared. 4876 unsigned OldChainingSize = Chaining.size(); 4877 if (IndirectFieldDecl *IF = dyn_cast<IndirectFieldDecl>(VD)) 4878 Chaining.append(IF->chain_begin(), IF->chain_end()); 4879 else 4880 Chaining.push_back(VD); 4881 4882 assert(Chaining.size() >= 2); 4883 NamedDecl **NamedChain = 4884 new (SemaRef.Context)NamedDecl*[Chaining.size()]; 4885 for (unsigned i = 0; i < Chaining.size(); i++) 4886 NamedChain[i] = Chaining[i]; 4887 4888 IndirectFieldDecl *IndirectField = IndirectFieldDecl::Create( 4889 SemaRef.Context, Owner, VD->getLocation(), VD->getIdentifier(), 4890 VD->getType(), {NamedChain, Chaining.size()}); 4891 4892 for (const auto *Attr : VD->attrs()) 4893 IndirectField->addAttr(Attr->clone(SemaRef.Context)); 4894 4895 IndirectField->setAccess(AS); 4896 IndirectField->setImplicit(); 4897 SemaRef.PushOnScopeChains(IndirectField, S); 4898 4899 // That includes picking up the appropriate access specifier. 4900 if (AS != AS_none) IndirectField->setAccess(AS); 4901 4902 Chaining.resize(OldChainingSize); 4903 } 4904 } 4905 } 4906 4907 return Invalid; 4908 } 4909 4910 /// StorageClassSpecToVarDeclStorageClass - Maps a DeclSpec::SCS to 4911 /// a VarDecl::StorageClass. Any error reporting is up to the caller: 4912 /// illegal input values are mapped to SC_None. 4913 static StorageClass 4914 StorageClassSpecToVarDeclStorageClass(const DeclSpec &DS) { 4915 DeclSpec::SCS StorageClassSpec = DS.getStorageClassSpec(); 4916 assert(StorageClassSpec != DeclSpec::SCS_typedef && 4917 "Parser allowed 'typedef' as storage class VarDecl."); 4918 switch (StorageClassSpec) { 4919 case DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified: return SC_None; 4920 case DeclSpec::SCS_extern: 4921 if (DS.isExternInLinkageSpec()) 4922 return SC_None; 4923 return SC_Extern; 4924 case DeclSpec::SCS_static: return SC_Static; 4925 case DeclSpec::SCS_auto: return SC_Auto; 4926 case DeclSpec::SCS_register: return SC_Register; 4927 case DeclSpec::SCS_private_extern: return SC_PrivateExtern; 4928 // Illegal SCSs map to None: error reporting is up to the caller. 4929 case DeclSpec::SCS_mutable: // Fall through. 4930 case DeclSpec::SCS_typedef: return SC_None; 4931 } 4932 llvm_unreachable("unknown storage class specifier"); 4933 } 4934 4935 static SourceLocation findDefaultInitializer(const CXXRecordDecl *Record) { 4936 assert(Record->hasInClassInitializer()); 4937 4938 for (const auto *I : Record->decls()) { 4939 const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(I); 4940 if (const auto *IFD = dyn_cast<IndirectFieldDecl>(I)) 4941 FD = IFD->getAnonField(); 4942 if (FD && FD->hasInClassInitializer()) 4943 return FD->getLocation(); 4944 } 4945 4946 llvm_unreachable("couldn't find in-class initializer"); 4947 } 4948 4949 static void checkDuplicateDefaultInit(Sema &S, CXXRecordDecl *Parent, 4950 SourceLocation DefaultInitLoc) { 4951 if (!Parent->isUnion() || !Parent->hasInClassInitializer()) 4952 return; 4953 4954 S.Diag(DefaultInitLoc, diag::err_multiple_mem_union_initialization); 4955 S.Diag(findDefaultInitializer(Parent), diag::note_previous_initializer) << 0; 4956 } 4957 4958 static void checkDuplicateDefaultInit(Sema &S, CXXRecordDecl *Parent, 4959 CXXRecordDecl *AnonUnion) { 4960 if (!Parent->isUnion() || !Parent->hasInClassInitializer()) 4961 return; 4962 4963 checkDuplicateDefaultInit(S, Parent, findDefaultInitializer(AnonUnion)); 4964 } 4965 4966 /// BuildAnonymousStructOrUnion - Handle the declaration of an 4967 /// anonymous structure or union. Anonymous unions are a C++ feature 4968 /// (C++ [class.union]) and a C11 feature; anonymous structures 4969 /// are a C11 feature and GNU C++ extension. 4970 Decl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructOrUnion(Scope *S, DeclSpec &DS, 4971 AccessSpecifier AS, 4972 RecordDecl *Record, 4973 const PrintingPolicy &Policy) { 4974 DeclContext *Owner = Record->getDeclContext(); 4975 4976 // Diagnose whether this anonymous struct/union is an extension. 4977 if (Record->isUnion() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !getLangOpts().C11) 4978 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::ext_anonymous_union); 4979 else if (!Record->isUnion() && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 4980 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::ext_gnu_anonymous_struct); 4981 else if (!Record->isUnion() && !getLangOpts().C11) 4982 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::ext_c11_anonymous_struct); 4983 4984 // C and C++ require different kinds of checks for anonymous 4985 // structs/unions. 4986 bool Invalid = false; 4987 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 4988 const char *PrevSpec = nullptr; 4989 if (Record->isUnion()) { 4990 // C++ [class.union]p6: 4991 // C++17 [class.union.anon]p2: 4992 // Anonymous unions declared in a named namespace or in the 4993 // global namespace shall be declared static. 4994 unsigned DiagID; 4995 DeclContext *OwnerScope = Owner->getRedeclContext(); 4996 if (DS.getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_static && 4997 (OwnerScope->isTranslationUnit() || 4998 (OwnerScope->isNamespace() && 4999 !cast<NamespaceDecl>(OwnerScope)->isAnonymousNamespace()))) { 5000 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::err_anonymous_union_not_static) 5001 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Record->getLocation(), "static "); 5002 5003 // Recover by adding 'static'. 5004 DS.SetStorageClassSpec(*this, DeclSpec::SCS_static, SourceLocation(), 5005 PrevSpec, DiagID, Policy); 5006 } 5007 // C++ [class.union]p6: 5008 // A storage class is not allowed in a declaration of an 5009 // anonymous union in a class scope. 5010 else if (DS.getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified && 5011 isa<RecordDecl>(Owner)) { 5012 Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 5013 diag::err_anonymous_union_with_storage_spec) 5014 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 5015 5016 // Recover by removing the storage specifier. 5017 DS.SetStorageClassSpec(*this, DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified, 5018 SourceLocation(), 5019 PrevSpec, DiagID, Context.getPrintingPolicy()); 5020 } 5021 } 5022 5023 // Ignore const/volatile/restrict qualifiers. 5024 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers()) { 5025 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_const) 5026 Diag(DS.getConstSpecLoc(), diag::ext_anonymous_struct_union_qualified) 5027 << Record->isUnion() << "const" 5028 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getConstSpecLoc()); 5029 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_volatile) 5030 Diag(DS.getVolatileSpecLoc(), 5031 diag::ext_anonymous_struct_union_qualified) 5032 << Record->isUnion() << "volatile" 5033 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getVolatileSpecLoc()); 5034 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_restrict) 5035 Diag(DS.getRestrictSpecLoc(), 5036 diag::ext_anonymous_struct_union_qualified) 5037 << Record->isUnion() << "restrict" 5038 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getRestrictSpecLoc()); 5039 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_atomic) 5040 Diag(DS.getAtomicSpecLoc(), 5041 diag::ext_anonymous_struct_union_qualified) 5042 << Record->isUnion() << "_Atomic" 5043 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getAtomicSpecLoc()); 5044 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_unaligned) 5045 Diag(DS.getUnalignedSpecLoc(), 5046 diag::ext_anonymous_struct_union_qualified) 5047 << Record->isUnion() << "__unaligned" 5048 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getUnalignedSpecLoc()); 5049 5050 DS.ClearTypeQualifiers(); 5051 } 5052 5053 // C++ [class.union]p2: 5054 // The member-specification of an anonymous union shall only 5055 // define non-static data members. [Note: nested types and 5056 // functions cannot be declared within an anonymous union. ] 5057 for (auto *Mem : Record->decls()) { 5058 // Ignore invalid declarations; we already diagnosed them. 5059 if (Mem->isInvalidDecl()) 5060 continue; 5061 5062 if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(Mem)) { 5063 // C++ [class.union]p3: 5064 // An anonymous union shall not have private or protected 5065 // members (clause 11). 5066 assert(FD->getAccess() != AS_none); 5067 if (FD->getAccess() != AS_public) { 5068 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_anonymous_record_nonpublic_member) 5069 << Record->isUnion() << (FD->getAccess() == AS_protected); 5070 Invalid = true; 5071 } 5072 5073 // C++ [class.union]p1 5074 // An object of a class with a non-trivial constructor, a non-trivial 5075 // copy constructor, a non-trivial destructor, or a non-trivial copy 5076 // assignment operator cannot be a member of a union, nor can an 5077 // array of such objects. 5078 if (CheckNontrivialField(FD)) 5079 Invalid = true; 5080 } else if (Mem->isImplicit()) { 5081 // Any implicit members are fine. 5082 } else if (isa<TagDecl>(Mem) && Mem->getDeclContext() != Record) { 5083 // This is a type that showed up in an 5084 // elaborated-type-specifier inside the anonymous struct or 5085 // union, but which actually declares a type outside of the 5086 // anonymous struct or union. It's okay. 5087 } else if (auto *MemRecord = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Mem)) { 5088 if (!MemRecord->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() && 5089 MemRecord->getDeclName()) { 5090 // Visual C++ allows type definition in anonymous struct or union. 5091 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt) 5092 Diag(MemRecord->getLocation(), diag::ext_anonymous_record_with_type) 5093 << Record->isUnion(); 5094 else { 5095 // This is a nested type declaration. 5096 Diag(MemRecord->getLocation(), diag::err_anonymous_record_with_type) 5097 << Record->isUnion(); 5098 Invalid = true; 5099 } 5100 } else { 5101 // This is an anonymous type definition within another anonymous type. 5102 // This is a popular extension, provided by Plan9, MSVC and GCC, but 5103 // not part of standard C++. 5104 Diag(MemRecord->getLocation(), 5105 diag::ext_anonymous_record_with_anonymous_type) 5106 << Record->isUnion(); 5107 } 5108 } else if (isa<AccessSpecDecl>(Mem)) { 5109 // Any access specifier is fine. 5110 } else if (isa<StaticAssertDecl>(Mem)) { 5111 // In C++1z, static_assert declarations are also fine. 5112 } else { 5113 // We have something that isn't a non-static data 5114 // member. Complain about it. 5115 unsigned DK = diag::err_anonymous_record_bad_member; 5116 if (isa<TypeDecl>(Mem)) 5117 DK = diag::err_anonymous_record_with_type; 5118 else if (isa<FunctionDecl>(Mem)) 5119 DK = diag::err_anonymous_record_with_function; 5120 else if (isa<VarDecl>(Mem)) 5121 DK = diag::err_anonymous_record_with_static; 5122 5123 // Visual C++ allows type definition in anonymous struct or union. 5124 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && 5125 DK == diag::err_anonymous_record_with_type) 5126 Diag(Mem->getLocation(), diag::ext_anonymous_record_with_type) 5127 << Record->isUnion(); 5128 else { 5129 Diag(Mem->getLocation(), DK) << Record->isUnion(); 5130 Invalid = true; 5131 } 5132 } 5133 } 5134 5135 // C++11 [class.union]p8 (DR1460): 5136 // At most one variant member of a union may have a 5137 // brace-or-equal-initializer. 5138 if (cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record)->hasInClassInitializer() && 5139 Owner->isRecord()) 5140 checkDuplicateDefaultInit(*this, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Owner), 5141 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record)); 5142 } 5143 5144 if (!Record->isUnion() && !Owner->isRecord()) { 5145 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::err_anonymous_struct_not_member) 5146 << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 5147 Invalid = true; 5148 } 5149 5150 // C++ [dcl.dcl]p3: 5151 // [If there are no declarators], and except for the declaration of an 5152 // unnamed bit-field, the decl-specifier-seq shall introduce one or more 5153 // names into the program 5154 // C++ [class.mem]p2: 5155 // each such member-declaration shall either declare at least one member 5156 // name of the class or declare at least one unnamed bit-field 5157 // 5158 // For C this is an error even for a named struct, and is diagnosed elsewhere. 5159 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Record->field_empty()) 5160 Diag(DS.getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_no_declarators) << DS.getSourceRange(); 5161 5162 // Mock up a declarator. 5163 Declarator Dc(DS, DeclaratorContext::MemberContext); 5164 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(Dc, S); 5165 assert(TInfo && "couldn't build declarator info for anonymous struct/union"); 5166 5167 // Create a declaration for this anonymous struct/union. 5168 NamedDecl *Anon = nullptr; 5169 if (RecordDecl *OwningClass = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Owner)) { 5170 Anon = FieldDecl::Create( 5171 Context, OwningClass, DS.getBeginLoc(), Record->getLocation(), 5172 /*IdentifierInfo=*/nullptr, Context.getTypeDeclType(Record), TInfo, 5173 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, /*Mutable=*/false, 5174 /*InitStyle=*/ICIS_NoInit); 5175 Anon->setAccess(AS); 5176 ProcessDeclAttributes(S, Anon, Dc); 5177 5178 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 5179 FieldCollector->Add(cast<FieldDecl>(Anon)); 5180 } else { 5181 DeclSpec::SCS SCSpec = DS.getStorageClassSpec(); 5182 StorageClass SC = StorageClassSpecToVarDeclStorageClass(DS); 5183 if (SCSpec == DeclSpec::SCS_mutable) { 5184 // mutable can only appear on non-static class members, so it's always 5185 // an error here 5186 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::err_mutable_nonmember); 5187 Invalid = true; 5188 SC = SC_None; 5189 } 5190 5191 assert(DS.getAttributes().empty() && "No attribute expected"); 5192 Anon = VarDecl::Create(Context, Owner, DS.getBeginLoc(), 5193 Record->getLocation(), /*IdentifierInfo=*/nullptr, 5194 Context.getTypeDeclType(Record), TInfo, SC); 5195 5196 // Default-initialize the implicit variable. This initialization will be 5197 // trivial in almost all cases, except if a union member has an in-class 5198 // initializer: 5199 // union { int n = 0; }; 5200 ActOnUninitializedDecl(Anon); 5201 } 5202 Anon->setImplicit(); 5203 5204 // Mark this as an anonymous struct/union type. 5205 Record->setAnonymousStructOrUnion(true); 5206 5207 // Add the anonymous struct/union object to the current 5208 // context. We'll be referencing this object when we refer to one of 5209 // its members. 5210 Owner->addDecl(Anon); 5211 5212 // Inject the members of the anonymous struct/union into the owning 5213 // context and into the identifier resolver chain for name lookup 5214 // purposes. 5215 SmallVector<NamedDecl*, 2> Chain; 5216 Chain.push_back(Anon); 5217 5218 if (InjectAnonymousStructOrUnionMembers(*this, S, Owner, Record, AS, Chain)) 5219 Invalid = true; 5220 5221 if (VarDecl *NewVD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Anon)) { 5222 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NewVD->isStaticLocal()) { 5223 MangleNumberingContext *MCtx; 5224 Decl *ManglingContextDecl; 5225 std::tie(MCtx, ManglingContextDecl) = 5226 getCurrentMangleNumberContext(NewVD->getDeclContext()); 5227 if (MCtx) { 5228 Context.setManglingNumber( 5229 NewVD, MCtx->getManglingNumber( 5230 NewVD, getMSManglingNumber(getLangOpts(), S))); 5231 Context.setStaticLocalNumber(NewVD, MCtx->getStaticLocalNumber(NewVD)); 5232 } 5233 } 5234 } 5235 5236 if (Invalid) 5237 Anon->setInvalidDecl(); 5238 5239 return Anon; 5240 } 5241 5242 /// BuildMicrosoftCAnonymousStruct - Handle the declaration of an 5243 /// Microsoft C anonymous structure. 5244 /// Ref: http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/z2cx9y4f.aspx 5245 /// Example: 5246 /// 5247 /// struct A { int a; }; 5248 /// struct B { struct A; int b; }; 5249 /// 5250 /// void foo() { 5251 /// B var; 5252 /// var.a = 3; 5253 /// } 5254 /// 5255 Decl *Sema::BuildMicrosoftCAnonymousStruct(Scope *S, DeclSpec &DS, 5256 RecordDecl *Record) { 5257 assert(Record && "expected a record!"); 5258 5259 // Mock up a declarator. 5260 Declarator Dc(DS, DeclaratorContext::TypeNameContext); 5261 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(Dc, S); 5262 assert(TInfo && "couldn't build declarator info for anonymous struct"); 5263 5264 auto *ParentDecl = cast<RecordDecl>(CurContext); 5265 QualType RecTy = Context.getTypeDeclType(Record); 5266 5267 // Create a declaration for this anonymous struct. 5268 NamedDecl *Anon = 5269 FieldDecl::Create(Context, ParentDecl, DS.getBeginLoc(), DS.getBeginLoc(), 5270 /*IdentifierInfo=*/nullptr, RecTy, TInfo, 5271 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, /*Mutable=*/false, 5272 /*InitStyle=*/ICIS_NoInit); 5273 Anon->setImplicit(); 5274 5275 // Add the anonymous struct object to the current context. 5276 CurContext->addDecl(Anon); 5277 5278 // Inject the members of the anonymous struct into the current 5279 // context and into the identifier resolver chain for name lookup 5280 // purposes. 5281 SmallVector<NamedDecl*, 2> Chain; 5282 Chain.push_back(Anon); 5283 5284 RecordDecl *RecordDef = Record->getDefinition(); 5285 if (RequireCompleteSizedType(Anon->getLocation(), RecTy, 5286 diag::err_field_incomplete_or_sizeless) || 5287 InjectAnonymousStructOrUnionMembers(*this, S, CurContext, RecordDef, 5288 AS_none, Chain)) { 5289 Anon->setInvalidDecl(); 5290 ParentDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 5291 } 5292 5293 return Anon; 5294 } 5295 5296 /// GetNameForDeclarator - Determine the full declaration name for the 5297 /// given Declarator. 5298 DeclarationNameInfo Sema::GetNameForDeclarator(Declarator &D) { 5299 return GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(D.getName()); 5300 } 5301 5302 /// Retrieves the declaration name from a parsed unqualified-id. 5303 DeclarationNameInfo 5304 Sema::GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(const UnqualifiedId &Name) { 5305 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo; 5306 NameInfo.setLoc(Name.StartLocation); 5307 5308 switch (Name.getKind()) { 5309 5310 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ImplicitSelfParam: 5311 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_Identifier: 5312 NameInfo.setName(Name.Identifier); 5313 return NameInfo; 5314 5315 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_DeductionGuideName: { 5316 // C++ [temp.deduct.guide]p3: 5317 // The simple-template-id shall name a class template specialization. 5318 // The template-name shall be the same identifier as the template-name 5319 // of the simple-template-id. 5320 // These together intend to imply that the template-name shall name a 5321 // class template. 5322 // FIXME: template<typename T> struct X {}; 5323 // template<typename T> using Y = X<T>; 5324 // Y(int) -> Y<int>; 5325 // satisfies these rules but does not name a class template. 5326 TemplateName TN = Name.TemplateName.get().get(); 5327 auto *Template = TN.getAsTemplateDecl(); 5328 if (!Template || !isa<ClassTemplateDecl>(Template)) { 5329 Diag(Name.StartLocation, 5330 diag::err_deduction_guide_name_not_class_template) 5331 << (int)getTemplateNameKindForDiagnostics(TN) << TN; 5332 if (Template) 5333 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here); 5334 return DeclarationNameInfo(); 5335 } 5336 5337 NameInfo.setName( 5338 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXDeductionGuideName(Template)); 5339 return NameInfo; 5340 } 5341 5342 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_OperatorFunctionId: 5343 NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName( 5344 Name.OperatorFunctionId.Operator)); 5345 NameInfo.getInfo().CXXOperatorName.BeginOpNameLoc 5346 = Name.OperatorFunctionId.SymbolLocations[0]; 5347 NameInfo.getInfo().CXXOperatorName.EndOpNameLoc 5348 = Name.EndLocation.getRawEncoding(); 5349 return NameInfo; 5350 5351 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_LiteralOperatorId: 5352 NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXLiteralOperatorName( 5353 Name.Identifier)); 5354 NameInfo.setCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(Name.EndLocation); 5355 return NameInfo; 5356 5357 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConversionFunctionId: { 5358 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo; 5359 QualType Ty = GetTypeFromParser(Name.ConversionFunctionId, &TInfo); 5360 if (Ty.isNull()) 5361 return DeclarationNameInfo(); 5362 NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXConversionFunctionName( 5363 Context.getCanonicalType(Ty))); 5364 NameInfo.setNamedTypeInfo(TInfo); 5365 return NameInfo; 5366 } 5367 5368 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConstructorName: { 5369 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo; 5370 QualType Ty = GetTypeFromParser(Name.ConstructorName, &TInfo); 5371 if (Ty.isNull()) 5372 return DeclarationNameInfo(); 5373 NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXConstructorName( 5374 Context.getCanonicalType(Ty))); 5375 NameInfo.setNamedTypeInfo(TInfo); 5376 return NameInfo; 5377 } 5378 5379 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConstructorTemplateId: { 5380 // In well-formed code, we can only have a constructor 5381 // template-id that refers to the current context, so go there 5382 // to find the actual type being constructed. 5383 CXXRecordDecl *CurClass = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext); 5384 if (!CurClass || CurClass->getIdentifier() != Name.TemplateId->Name) 5385 return DeclarationNameInfo(); 5386 5387 // Determine the type of the class being constructed. 5388 QualType CurClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(CurClass); 5389 5390 // FIXME: Check two things: that the template-id names the same type as 5391 // CurClassType, and that the template-id does not occur when the name 5392 // was qualified. 5393 5394 NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXConstructorName( 5395 Context.getCanonicalType(CurClassType))); 5396 // FIXME: should we retrieve TypeSourceInfo? 5397 NameInfo.setNamedTypeInfo(nullptr); 5398 return NameInfo; 5399 } 5400 5401 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_DestructorName: { 5402 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo; 5403 QualType Ty = GetTypeFromParser(Name.DestructorName, &TInfo); 5404 if (Ty.isNull()) 5405 return DeclarationNameInfo(); 5406 NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXDestructorName( 5407 Context.getCanonicalType(Ty))); 5408 NameInfo.setNamedTypeInfo(TInfo); 5409 return NameInfo; 5410 } 5411 5412 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId: { 5413 TemplateName TName = Name.TemplateId->Template.get(); 5414 SourceLocation TNameLoc = Name.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc; 5415 return Context.getNameForTemplate(TName, TNameLoc); 5416 } 5417 5418 } // switch (Name.getKind()) 5419 5420 llvm_unreachable("Unknown name kind"); 5421 } 5422 5423 static QualType getCoreType(QualType Ty) { 5424 do { 5425 if (Ty->isPointerType() || Ty->isReferenceType()) 5426 Ty = Ty->getPointeeType(); 5427 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) 5428 Ty = Ty->castAsArrayTypeUnsafe()->getElementType(); 5429 else 5430 return Ty.withoutLocalFastQualifiers(); 5431 } while (true); 5432 } 5433 5434 /// hasSimilarParameters - Determine whether the C++ functions Declaration 5435 /// and Definition have "nearly" matching parameters. This heuristic is 5436 /// used to improve diagnostics in the case where an out-of-line function 5437 /// definition doesn't match any declaration within the class or namespace. 5438 /// Also sets Params to the list of indices to the parameters that differ 5439 /// between the declaration and the definition. If hasSimilarParameters 5440 /// returns true and Params is empty, then all of the parameters match. 5441 static bool hasSimilarParameters(ASTContext &Context, 5442 FunctionDecl *Declaration, 5443 FunctionDecl *Definition, 5444 SmallVectorImpl<unsigned> &Params) { 5445 Params.clear(); 5446 if (Declaration->param_size() != Definition->param_size()) 5447 return false; 5448 for (unsigned Idx = 0; Idx < Declaration->param_size(); ++Idx) { 5449 QualType DeclParamTy = Declaration->getParamDecl(Idx)->getType(); 5450 QualType DefParamTy = Definition->getParamDecl(Idx)->getType(); 5451 5452 // The parameter types are identical 5453 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(DefParamTy, DeclParamTy)) 5454 continue; 5455 5456 QualType DeclParamBaseTy = getCoreType(DeclParamTy); 5457 QualType DefParamBaseTy = getCoreType(DefParamTy); 5458 const IdentifierInfo *DeclTyName = DeclParamBaseTy.getBaseTypeIdentifier(); 5459 const IdentifierInfo *DefTyName = DefParamBaseTy.getBaseTypeIdentifier(); 5460 5461 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(DeclParamBaseTy, DefParamBaseTy) || 5462 (DeclTyName && DeclTyName == DefTyName)) 5463 Params.push_back(Idx); 5464 else // The two parameters aren't even close 5465 return false; 5466 } 5467 5468 return true; 5469 } 5470 5471 /// NeedsRebuildingInCurrentInstantiation - Checks whether the given 5472 /// declarator needs to be rebuilt in the current instantiation. 5473 /// Any bits of declarator which appear before the name are valid for 5474 /// consideration here. That's specifically the type in the decl spec 5475 /// and the base type in any member-pointer chunks. 5476 static bool RebuildDeclaratorInCurrentInstantiation(Sema &S, Declarator &D, 5477 DeclarationName Name) { 5478 // The types we specifically need to rebuild are: 5479 // - typenames, typeofs, and decltypes 5480 // - types which will become injected class names 5481 // Of course, we also need to rebuild any type referencing such a 5482 // type. It's safest to just say "dependent", but we call out a 5483 // few cases here. 5484 5485 DeclSpec &DS = D.getMutableDeclSpec(); 5486 switch (DS.getTypeSpecType()) { 5487 case DeclSpec::TST_typename: 5488 case DeclSpec::TST_typeofType: 5489 case DeclSpec::TST_underlyingType: 5490 case DeclSpec::TST_atomic: { 5491 // Grab the type from the parser. 5492 TypeSourceInfo *TSI = nullptr; 5493 QualType T = S.GetTypeFromParser(DS.getRepAsType(), &TSI); 5494 if (T.isNull() || !T->isDependentType()) break; 5495 5496 // Make sure there's a type source info. This isn't really much 5497 // of a waste; most dependent types should have type source info 5498 // attached already. 5499 if (!TSI) 5500 TSI = S.Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T, DS.getTypeSpecTypeLoc()); 5501 5502 // Rebuild the type in the current instantiation. 5503 TSI = S.RebuildTypeInCurrentInstantiation(TSI, D.getIdentifierLoc(), Name); 5504 if (!TSI) return true; 5505 5506 // Store the new type back in the decl spec. 5507 ParsedType LocType = S.CreateParsedType(TSI->getType(), TSI); 5508 DS.UpdateTypeRep(LocType); 5509 break; 5510 } 5511 5512 case DeclSpec::TST_decltype: 5513 case DeclSpec::TST_typeofExpr: { 5514 Expr *E = DS.getRepAsExpr(); 5515 ExprResult Result = S.RebuildExprInCurrentInstantiation(E); 5516 if (Result.isInvalid()) return true; 5517 DS.UpdateExprRep(Result.get()); 5518 break; 5519 } 5520 5521 default: 5522 // Nothing to do for these decl specs. 5523 break; 5524 } 5525 5526 // It doesn't matter what order we do this in. 5527 for (unsigned I = 0, E = D.getNumTypeObjects(); I != E; ++I) { 5528 DeclaratorChunk &Chunk = D.getTypeObject(I); 5529 5530 // The only type information in the declarator which can come 5531 // before the declaration name is the base type of a member 5532 // pointer. 5533 if (Chunk.Kind != DeclaratorChunk::MemberPointer) 5534 continue; 5535 5536 // Rebuild the scope specifier in-place. 5537 CXXScopeSpec &SS = Chunk.Mem.Scope(); 5538 if (S.RebuildNestedNameSpecifierInCurrentInstantiation(SS)) 5539 return true; 5540 } 5541 5542 return false; 5543 } 5544 5545 Decl *Sema::ActOnDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D) { 5546 D.setFunctionDefinitionKind(FDK_Declaration); 5547 Decl *Dcl = HandleDeclarator(S, D, MultiTemplateParamsArg()); 5548 5549 if (OriginalLexicalContext && OriginalLexicalContext->isObjCContainer() && 5550 Dcl && Dcl->getDeclContext()->isFileContext()) 5551 Dcl->setTopLevelDeclInObjCContainer(); 5552 5553 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) 5554 setCurrentOpenCLExtensionForDecl(Dcl); 5555 5556 return Dcl; 5557 } 5558 5559 /// DiagnoseClassNameShadow - Implement C++ [class.mem]p13: 5560 /// If T is the name of a class, then each of the following shall have a 5561 /// name different from T: 5562 /// - every static data member of class T; 5563 /// - every member function of class T 5564 /// - every member of class T that is itself a type; 5565 /// \returns true if the declaration name violates these rules. 5566 bool Sema::DiagnoseClassNameShadow(DeclContext *DC, 5567 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo) { 5568 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName(); 5569 5570 CXXRecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC); 5571 while (Record && Record->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) 5572 Record = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getParent()); 5573 if (Record && Record->getIdentifier() && Record->getDeclName() == Name) { 5574 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_member_name_of_class) << Name; 5575 return true; 5576 } 5577 5578 return false; 5579 } 5580 5581 /// Diagnose a declaration whose declarator-id has the given 5582 /// nested-name-specifier. 5583 /// 5584 /// \param SS The nested-name-specifier of the declarator-id. 5585 /// 5586 /// \param DC The declaration context to which the nested-name-specifier 5587 /// resolves. 5588 /// 5589 /// \param Name The name of the entity being declared. 5590 /// 5591 /// \param Loc The location of the name of the entity being declared. 5592 /// 5593 /// \param IsTemplateId Whether the name is a (simple-)template-id, and thus 5594 /// we're declaring an explicit / partial specialization / instantiation. 5595 /// 5596 /// \returns true if we cannot safely recover from this error, false otherwise. 5597 bool Sema::diagnoseQualifiedDeclaration(CXXScopeSpec &SS, DeclContext *DC, 5598 DeclarationName Name, 5599 SourceLocation Loc, bool IsTemplateId) { 5600 DeclContext *Cur = CurContext; 5601 while (isa<LinkageSpecDecl>(Cur) || isa<CapturedDecl>(Cur)) 5602 Cur = Cur->getParent(); 5603 5604 // If the user provided a superfluous scope specifier that refers back to the 5605 // class in which the entity is already declared, diagnose and ignore it. 5606 // 5607 // class X { 5608 // void X::f(); 5609 // }; 5610 // 5611 // Note, it was once ill-formed to give redundant qualification in all 5612 // contexts, but that rule was removed by DR482. 5613 if (Cur->Equals(DC)) { 5614 if (Cur->isRecord()) { 5615 Diag(Loc, LangOpts.MicrosoftExt ? diag::warn_member_extra_qualification 5616 : diag::err_member_extra_qualification) 5617 << Name << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(SS.getRange()); 5618 SS.clear(); 5619 } else { 5620 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_namespace_member_extra_qualification) << Name; 5621 } 5622 return false; 5623 } 5624 5625 // Check whether the qualifying scope encloses the scope of the original 5626 // declaration. For a template-id, we perform the checks in 5627 // CheckTemplateSpecializationScope. 5628 if (!Cur->Encloses(DC) && !IsTemplateId) { 5629 if (Cur->isRecord()) 5630 Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_qualification) 5631 << Name << SS.getRange(); 5632 else if (isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(DC)) 5633 Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_declarator_global_scope) 5634 << Name << SS.getRange(); 5635 else if (isa<FunctionDecl>(Cur)) 5636 Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_declarator_in_function) 5637 << Name << SS.getRange(); 5638 else if (isa<BlockDecl>(Cur)) 5639 Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_declarator_in_block) 5640 << Name << SS.getRange(); 5641 else 5642 Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_declarator_scope) 5643 << Name << cast<NamedDecl>(Cur) << cast<NamedDecl>(DC) << SS.getRange(); 5644 5645 return true; 5646 } 5647 5648 if (Cur->isRecord()) { 5649 // Cannot qualify members within a class. 5650 Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_qualification) 5651 << Name << SS.getRange(); 5652 SS.clear(); 5653 5654 // C++ constructors and destructors with incorrect scopes can break 5655 // our AST invariants by having the wrong underlying types. If 5656 // that's the case, then drop this declaration entirely. 5657 if ((Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConstructorName || 5658 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) && 5659 !Context.hasSameType(Name.getCXXNameType(), 5660 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Cur)))) 5661 return true; 5662 5663 return false; 5664 } 5665 5666 // C++11 [dcl.meaning]p1: 5667 // [...] "The nested-name-specifier of the qualified declarator-id shall 5668 // not begin with a decltype-specifer" 5669 NestedNameSpecifierLoc SpecLoc(SS.getScopeRep(), SS.location_data()); 5670 while (SpecLoc.getPrefix()) 5671 SpecLoc = SpecLoc.getPrefix(); 5672 if (dyn_cast_or_null<DecltypeType>( 5673 SpecLoc.getNestedNameSpecifier()->getAsType())) 5674 Diag(Loc, diag::err_decltype_in_declarator) 5675 << SpecLoc.getTypeLoc().getSourceRange(); 5676 5677 return false; 5678 } 5679 5680 NamedDecl *Sema::HandleDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D, 5681 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParamLists) { 5682 // TODO: consider using NameInfo for diagnostic. 5683 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo = GetNameForDeclarator(D); 5684 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName(); 5685 5686 // All of these full declarators require an identifier. If it doesn't have 5687 // one, the ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec action should be used. 5688 if (D.isDecompositionDeclarator()) { 5689 return ActOnDecompositionDeclarator(S, D, TemplateParamLists); 5690 } else if (!Name) { 5691 if (!D.isInvalidType()) // Reject this if we think it is valid. 5692 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getBeginLoc(), diag::err_declarator_need_ident) 5693 << D.getDeclSpec().getSourceRange() << D.getSourceRange(); 5694 return nullptr; 5695 } else if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(NameInfo, UPPC_DeclarationType)) 5696 return nullptr; 5697 5698 // The scope passed in may not be a decl scope. Zip up the scope tree until 5699 // we find one that is. 5700 while ((S->getFlags() & Scope::DeclScope) == 0 || 5701 (S->getFlags() & Scope::TemplateParamScope) != 0) 5702 S = S->getParent(); 5703 5704 DeclContext *DC = CurContext; 5705 if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isInvalid()) 5706 D.setInvalidType(); 5707 else if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) { 5708 if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(D.getCXXScopeSpec(), 5709 UPPC_DeclarationQualifier)) 5710 return nullptr; 5711 5712 bool EnteringContext = !D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified(); 5713 DC = computeDeclContext(D.getCXXScopeSpec(), EnteringContext); 5714 if (!DC || isa<EnumDecl>(DC)) { 5715 // If we could not compute the declaration context, it's because the 5716 // declaration context is dependent but does not refer to a class, 5717 // class template, or class template partial specialization. Complain 5718 // and return early, to avoid the coming semantic disaster. 5719 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 5720 diag::err_template_qualified_declarator_no_match) 5721 << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getScopeRep() 5722 << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange(); 5723 return nullptr; 5724 } 5725 bool IsDependentContext = DC->isDependentContext(); 5726 5727 if (!IsDependentContext && 5728 RequireCompleteDeclContext(D.getCXXScopeSpec(), DC)) 5729 return nullptr; 5730 5731 // If a class is incomplete, do not parse entities inside it. 5732 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC) && !cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->hasDefinition()) { 5733 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 5734 diag::err_member_def_undefined_record) 5735 << Name << DC << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange(); 5736 return nullptr; 5737 } 5738 if (!D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified()) { 5739 if (diagnoseQualifiedDeclaration( 5740 D.getCXXScopeSpec(), DC, Name, D.getIdentifierLoc(), 5741 D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId)) { 5742 if (DC->isRecord()) 5743 return nullptr; 5744 5745 D.setInvalidType(); 5746 } 5747 } 5748 5749 // Check whether we need to rebuild the type of the given 5750 // declaration in the current instantiation. 5751 if (EnteringContext && IsDependentContext && 5752 TemplateParamLists.size() != 0) { 5753 ContextRAII SavedContext(*this, DC); 5754 if (RebuildDeclaratorInCurrentInstantiation(*this, D, Name)) 5755 D.setInvalidType(); 5756 } 5757 } 5758 5759 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(D, S); 5760 QualType R = TInfo->getType(); 5761 5762 if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(D.getIdentifierLoc(), TInfo, 5763 UPPC_DeclarationType)) 5764 D.setInvalidType(); 5765 5766 LookupResult Previous(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName, 5767 forRedeclarationInCurContext()); 5768 5769 // See if this is a redefinition of a variable in the same scope. 5770 if (!D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) { 5771 bool IsLinkageLookup = false; 5772 bool CreateBuiltins = false; 5773 5774 // If the declaration we're planning to build will be a function 5775 // or object with linkage, then look for another declaration with 5776 // linkage (C99 6.2.2p4-5 and C++ [basic.link]p6). 5777 // 5778 // If the declaration we're planning to build will be declared with 5779 // external linkage in the translation unit, create any builtin with 5780 // the same name. 5781 if (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_typedef) 5782 /* Do nothing*/; 5783 else if (CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod() && 5784 (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_extern || 5785 R->isFunctionType())) { 5786 IsLinkageLookup = true; 5787 CreateBuiltins = 5788 CurContext->getEnclosingNamespaceContext()->isTranslationUnit(); 5789 } else if (CurContext->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit() && 5790 D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_static) 5791 CreateBuiltins = true; 5792 5793 if (IsLinkageLookup) { 5794 Previous.clear(LookupRedeclarationWithLinkage); 5795 Previous.setRedeclarationKind(ForExternalRedeclaration); 5796 } 5797 5798 LookupName(Previous, S, CreateBuiltins); 5799 } else { // Something like "int foo::x;" 5800 LookupQualifiedName(Previous, DC); 5801 5802 // C++ [dcl.meaning]p1: 5803 // When the declarator-id is qualified, the declaration shall refer to a 5804 // previously declared member of the class or namespace to which the 5805 // qualifier refers (or, in the case of a namespace, of an element of the 5806 // inline namespace set of that namespace (7.3.1)) or to a specialization 5807 // thereof; [...] 5808 // 5809 // Note that we already checked the context above, and that we do not have 5810 // enough information to make sure that Previous contains the declaration 5811 // we want to match. For example, given: 5812 // 5813 // class X { 5814 // void f(); 5815 // void f(float); 5816 // }; 5817 // 5818 // void X::f(int) { } // ill-formed 5819 // 5820 // In this case, Previous will point to the overload set 5821 // containing the two f's declared in X, but neither of them 5822 // matches. 5823 5824 // C++ [dcl.meaning]p1: 5825 // [...] the member shall not merely have been introduced by a 5826 // using-declaration in the scope of the class or namespace nominated by 5827 // the nested-name-specifier of the declarator-id. 5828 RemoveUsingDecls(Previous); 5829 } 5830 5831 if (Previous.isSingleResult() && 5832 Previous.getFoundDecl()->isTemplateParameter()) { 5833 // Maybe we will complain about the shadowed template parameter. 5834 if (!D.isInvalidType()) 5835 DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 5836 Previous.getFoundDecl()); 5837 5838 // Just pretend that we didn't see the previous declaration. 5839 Previous.clear(); 5840 } 5841 5842 if (!R->isFunctionType() && DiagnoseClassNameShadow(DC, NameInfo)) 5843 // Forget that the previous declaration is the injected-class-name. 5844 Previous.clear(); 5845 5846 // In C++, the previous declaration we find might be a tag type 5847 // (class or enum). In this case, the new declaration will hide the 5848 // tag type. Note that this applies to functions, function templates, and 5849 // variables, but not to typedefs (C++ [dcl.typedef]p4) or variable templates. 5850 if (Previous.isSingleTagDecl() && 5851 D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_typedef && 5852 (TemplateParamLists.size() == 0 || R->isFunctionType())) 5853 Previous.clear(); 5854 5855 // Check that there are no default arguments other than in the parameters 5856 // of a function declaration (C++ only). 5857 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 5858 CheckExtraCXXDefaultArguments(D); 5859 5860 NamedDecl *New; 5861 5862 bool AddToScope = true; 5863 if (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_typedef) { 5864 if (TemplateParamLists.size()) { 5865 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_template_typedef); 5866 return nullptr; 5867 } 5868 5869 New = ActOnTypedefDeclarator(S, D, DC, TInfo, Previous); 5870 } else if (R->isFunctionType()) { 5871 New = ActOnFunctionDeclarator(S, D, DC, TInfo, Previous, 5872 TemplateParamLists, 5873 AddToScope); 5874 } else { 5875 New = ActOnVariableDeclarator(S, D, DC, TInfo, Previous, TemplateParamLists, 5876 AddToScope); 5877 } 5878 5879 if (!New) 5880 return nullptr; 5881 5882 // If this has an identifier and is not a function template specialization, 5883 // add it to the scope stack. 5884 if (New->getDeclName() && AddToScope) 5885 PushOnScopeChains(New, S); 5886 5887 if (isInOpenMPDeclareTargetContext()) 5888 checkDeclIsAllowedInOpenMPTarget(nullptr, New); 5889 5890 return New; 5891 } 5892 5893 /// Helper method to turn variable array types into constant array 5894 /// types in certain situations which would otherwise be errors (for 5895 /// GCC compatibility). 5896 static QualType TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(QualType T, 5897 ASTContext &Context, 5898 bool &SizeIsNegative, 5899 llvm::APSInt &Oversized) { 5900 // This method tries to turn a variable array into a constant 5901 // array even when the size isn't an ICE. This is necessary 5902 // for compatibility with code that depends on gcc's buggy 5903 // constant expression folding, like struct {char x[(int)(char*)2];} 5904 SizeIsNegative = false; 5905 Oversized = 0; 5906 5907 if (T->isDependentType()) 5908 return QualType(); 5909 5910 QualifierCollector Qs; 5911 const Type *Ty = Qs.strip(T); 5912 5913 if (const PointerType* PTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(Ty)) { 5914 QualType Pointee = PTy->getPointeeType(); 5915 QualType FixedType = 5916 TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(Pointee, Context, SizeIsNegative, 5917 Oversized); 5918 if (FixedType.isNull()) return FixedType; 5919 FixedType = Context.getPointerType(FixedType); 5920 return Qs.apply(Context, FixedType); 5921 } 5922 if (const ParenType* PTy = dyn_cast<ParenType>(Ty)) { 5923 QualType Inner = PTy->getInnerType(); 5924 QualType FixedType = 5925 TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(Inner, Context, SizeIsNegative, 5926 Oversized); 5927 if (FixedType.isNull()) return FixedType; 5928 FixedType = Context.getParenType(FixedType); 5929 return Qs.apply(Context, FixedType); 5930 } 5931 5932 const VariableArrayType* VLATy = dyn_cast<VariableArrayType>(T); 5933 if (!VLATy) 5934 return QualType(); 5935 5936 QualType ElemTy = VLATy->getElementType(); 5937 if (ElemTy->isVariablyModifiedType()) { 5938 ElemTy = TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(ElemTy, Context, 5939 SizeIsNegative, Oversized); 5940 if (ElemTy.isNull()) 5941 return QualType(); 5942 } 5943 5944 Expr::EvalResult Result; 5945 if (!VLATy->getSizeExpr() || 5946 !VLATy->getSizeExpr()->EvaluateAsInt(Result, Context)) 5947 return QualType(); 5948 5949 llvm::APSInt Res = Result.Val.getInt(); 5950 5951 // Check whether the array size is negative. 5952 if (Res.isSigned() && Res.isNegative()) { 5953 SizeIsNegative = true; 5954 return QualType(); 5955 } 5956 5957 // Check whether the array is too large to be addressed. 5958 unsigned ActiveSizeBits = 5959 (!ElemTy->isDependentType() && !ElemTy->isVariablyModifiedType() && 5960 !ElemTy->isIncompleteType() && !ElemTy->isUndeducedType()) 5961 ? ConstantArrayType::getNumAddressingBits(Context, ElemTy, Res) 5962 : Res.getActiveBits(); 5963 if (ActiveSizeBits > ConstantArrayType::getMaxSizeBits(Context)) { 5964 Oversized = Res; 5965 return QualType(); 5966 } 5967 5968 return Context.getConstantArrayType(ElemTy, Res, VLATy->getSizeExpr(), 5969 ArrayType::Normal, 0); 5970 } 5971 5972 static void 5973 FixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeLoc(TypeLoc SrcTL, TypeLoc DstTL) { 5974 SrcTL = SrcTL.getUnqualifiedLoc(); 5975 DstTL = DstTL.getUnqualifiedLoc(); 5976 if (PointerTypeLoc SrcPTL = SrcTL.getAs<PointerTypeLoc>()) { 5977 PointerTypeLoc DstPTL = DstTL.castAs<PointerTypeLoc>(); 5978 FixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeLoc(SrcPTL.getPointeeLoc(), 5979 DstPTL.getPointeeLoc()); 5980 DstPTL.setStarLoc(SrcPTL.getStarLoc()); 5981 return; 5982 } 5983 if (ParenTypeLoc SrcPTL = SrcTL.getAs<ParenTypeLoc>()) { 5984 ParenTypeLoc DstPTL = DstTL.castAs<ParenTypeLoc>(); 5985 FixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeLoc(SrcPTL.getInnerLoc(), 5986 DstPTL.getInnerLoc()); 5987 DstPTL.setLParenLoc(SrcPTL.getLParenLoc()); 5988 DstPTL.setRParenLoc(SrcPTL.getRParenLoc()); 5989 return; 5990 } 5991 ArrayTypeLoc SrcATL = SrcTL.castAs<ArrayTypeLoc>(); 5992 ArrayTypeLoc DstATL = DstTL.castAs<ArrayTypeLoc>(); 5993 TypeLoc SrcElemTL = SrcATL.getElementLoc(); 5994 TypeLoc DstElemTL = DstATL.getElementLoc(); 5995 if (VariableArrayTypeLoc SrcElemATL = 5996 SrcElemTL.getAs<VariableArrayTypeLoc>()) { 5997 ConstantArrayTypeLoc DstElemATL = DstElemTL.castAs<ConstantArrayTypeLoc>(); 5998 FixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeLoc(SrcElemATL, DstElemATL); 5999 } else { 6000 DstElemTL.initializeFullCopy(SrcElemTL); 6001 } 6002 DstATL.setLBracketLoc(SrcATL.getLBracketLoc()); 6003 DstATL.setSizeExpr(SrcATL.getSizeExpr()); 6004 DstATL.setRBracketLoc(SrcATL.getRBracketLoc()); 6005 } 6006 6007 /// Helper method to turn variable array types into constant array 6008 /// types in certain situations which would otherwise be errors (for 6009 /// GCC compatibility). 6010 static TypeSourceInfo* 6011 TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeSourceInfo(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, 6012 ASTContext &Context, 6013 bool &SizeIsNegative, 6014 llvm::APSInt &Oversized) { 6015 QualType FixedTy 6016 = TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(TInfo->getType(), Context, 6017 SizeIsNegative, Oversized); 6018 if (FixedTy.isNull()) 6019 return nullptr; 6020 TypeSourceInfo *FixedTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(FixedTy); 6021 FixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeLoc(TInfo->getTypeLoc(), 6022 FixedTInfo->getTypeLoc()); 6023 return FixedTInfo; 6024 } 6025 6026 /// Register the given locally-scoped extern "C" declaration so 6027 /// that it can be found later for redeclarations. We include any extern "C" 6028 /// declaration that is not visible in the translation unit here, not just 6029 /// function-scope declarations. 6030 void 6031 Sema::RegisterLocallyScopedExternCDecl(NamedDecl *ND, Scope *S) { 6032 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 6033 ND->getLexicalDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) 6034 // Don't need to track declarations in the TU in C. 6035 return; 6036 6037 // Note that we have a locally-scoped external with this name. 6038 Context.getExternCContextDecl()->makeDeclVisibleInContext(ND); 6039 } 6040 6041 NamedDecl *Sema::findLocallyScopedExternCDecl(DeclarationName Name) { 6042 // FIXME: We can have multiple results via __attribute__((overloadable)). 6043 auto Result = Context.getExternCContextDecl()->lookup(Name); 6044 return Result.empty() ? nullptr : *Result.begin(); 6045 } 6046 6047 /// Diagnose function specifiers on a declaration of an identifier that 6048 /// does not identify a function. 6049 void Sema::DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(const DeclSpec &DS) { 6050 // FIXME: We should probably indicate the identifier in question to avoid 6051 // confusion for constructs like "virtual int a(), b;" 6052 if (DS.isVirtualSpecified()) 6053 Diag(DS.getVirtualSpecLoc(), 6054 diag::err_virtual_non_function); 6055 6056 if (DS.hasExplicitSpecifier()) 6057 Diag(DS.getExplicitSpecLoc(), 6058 diag::err_explicit_non_function); 6059 6060 if (DS.isNoreturnSpecified()) 6061 Diag(DS.getNoreturnSpecLoc(), 6062 diag::err_noreturn_non_function); 6063 } 6064 6065 NamedDecl* 6066 Sema::ActOnTypedefDeclarator(Scope* S, Declarator& D, DeclContext* DC, 6067 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, LookupResult &Previous) { 6068 // Typedef declarators cannot be qualified (C++ [dcl.meaning]p1). 6069 if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) { 6070 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_qualified_typedef_declarator) 6071 << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange(); 6072 D.setInvalidType(); 6073 // Pretend we didn't see the scope specifier. 6074 DC = CurContext; 6075 Previous.clear(); 6076 } 6077 6078 DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(D.getDeclSpec()); 6079 6080 if (D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified()) 6081 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_non_function) 6082 << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17; 6083 if (D.getDeclSpec().hasConstexprSpecifier()) 6084 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_invalid_constexpr) 6085 << 1 << D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier(); 6086 6087 if (D.getName().Kind != UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_Identifier) { 6088 if (D.getName().Kind == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_DeductionGuideName) 6089 Diag(D.getName().StartLocation, 6090 diag::err_deduction_guide_invalid_specifier) 6091 << "typedef"; 6092 else 6093 Diag(D.getName().StartLocation, diag::err_typedef_not_identifier) 6094 << D.getName().getSourceRange(); 6095 return nullptr; 6096 } 6097 6098 TypedefDecl *NewTD = ParseTypedefDecl(S, D, TInfo->getType(), TInfo); 6099 if (!NewTD) return nullptr; 6100 6101 // Handle attributes prior to checking for duplicates in MergeVarDecl 6102 ProcessDeclAttributes(S, NewTD, D); 6103 6104 CheckTypedefForVariablyModifiedType(S, NewTD); 6105 6106 bool Redeclaration = D.isRedeclaration(); 6107 NamedDecl *ND = ActOnTypedefNameDecl(S, DC, NewTD, Previous, Redeclaration); 6108 D.setRedeclaration(Redeclaration); 6109 return ND; 6110 } 6111 6112 void 6113 Sema::CheckTypedefForVariablyModifiedType(Scope *S, TypedefNameDecl *NewTD) { 6114 // C99 6.7.7p2: If a typedef name specifies a variably modified type 6115 // then it shall have block scope. 6116 // Note that variably modified types must be fixed before merging the decl so 6117 // that redeclarations will match. 6118 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = NewTD->getTypeSourceInfo(); 6119 QualType T = TInfo->getType(); 6120 if (T->isVariablyModifiedType()) { 6121 setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope(); 6122 6123 if (S->getFnParent() == nullptr) { 6124 bool SizeIsNegative; 6125 llvm::APSInt Oversized; 6126 TypeSourceInfo *FixedTInfo = 6127 TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeSourceInfo(TInfo, Context, 6128 SizeIsNegative, 6129 Oversized); 6130 if (FixedTInfo) { 6131 Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::ext_vla_folded_to_constant); 6132 NewTD->setTypeSourceInfo(FixedTInfo); 6133 } else { 6134 if (SizeIsNegative) 6135 Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::err_typecheck_negative_array_size); 6136 else if (T->isVariableArrayType()) 6137 Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::err_vla_decl_in_file_scope); 6138 else if (Oversized.getBoolValue()) 6139 Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::err_array_too_large) 6140 << Oversized.toString(10); 6141 else 6142 Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::err_vm_decl_in_file_scope); 6143 NewTD->setInvalidDecl(); 6144 } 6145 } 6146 } 6147 } 6148 6149 /// ActOnTypedefNameDecl - Perform semantic checking for a declaration which 6150 /// declares a typedef-name, either using the 'typedef' type specifier or via 6151 /// a C++0x [dcl.typedef]p2 alias-declaration: 'using T = A;'. 6152 NamedDecl* 6153 Sema::ActOnTypedefNameDecl(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC, TypedefNameDecl *NewTD, 6154 LookupResult &Previous, bool &Redeclaration) { 6155 6156 // Find the shadowed declaration before filtering for scope. 6157 NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = getShadowedDeclaration(NewTD, Previous); 6158 6159 // Merge the decl with the existing one if appropriate. If the decl is 6160 // in an outer scope, it isn't the same thing. 6161 FilterLookupForScope(Previous, DC, S, /*ConsiderLinkage*/false, 6162 /*AllowInlineNamespace*/false); 6163 filterNonConflictingPreviousTypedefDecls(*this, NewTD, Previous); 6164 if (!Previous.empty()) { 6165 Redeclaration = true; 6166 MergeTypedefNameDecl(S, NewTD, Previous); 6167 } else { 6168 inferGslPointerAttribute(NewTD); 6169 } 6170 6171 if (ShadowedDecl && !Redeclaration) 6172 CheckShadow(NewTD, ShadowedDecl, Previous); 6173 6174 // If this is the C FILE type, notify the AST context. 6175 if (IdentifierInfo *II = NewTD->getIdentifier()) 6176 if (!NewTD->isInvalidDecl() && 6177 NewTD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) { 6178 if (II->isStr("FILE")) 6179 Context.setFILEDecl(NewTD); 6180 else if (II->isStr("jmp_buf")) 6181 Context.setjmp_bufDecl(NewTD); 6182 else if (II->isStr("sigjmp_buf")) 6183 Context.setsigjmp_bufDecl(NewTD); 6184 else if (II->isStr("ucontext_t")) 6185 Context.setucontext_tDecl(NewTD); 6186 } 6187 6188 return NewTD; 6189 } 6190 6191 /// Determines whether the given declaration is an out-of-scope 6192 /// previous declaration. 6193 /// 6194 /// This routine should be invoked when name lookup has found a 6195 /// previous declaration (PrevDecl) that is not in the scope where a 6196 /// new declaration by the same name is being introduced. If the new 6197 /// declaration occurs in a local scope, previous declarations with 6198 /// linkage may still be considered previous declarations (C99 6199 /// 6.2.2p4-5, C++ [basic.link]p6). 6200 /// 6201 /// \param PrevDecl the previous declaration found by name 6202 /// lookup 6203 /// 6204 /// \param DC the context in which the new declaration is being 6205 /// declared. 6206 /// 6207 /// \returns true if PrevDecl is an out-of-scope previous declaration 6208 /// for a new delcaration with the same name. 6209 static bool 6210 isOutOfScopePreviousDeclaration(NamedDecl *PrevDecl, DeclContext *DC, 6211 ASTContext &Context) { 6212 if (!PrevDecl) 6213 return false; 6214 6215 if (!PrevDecl->hasLinkage()) 6216 return false; 6217 6218 if (Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 6219 // C++ [basic.link]p6: 6220 // If there is a visible declaration of an entity with linkage 6221 // having the same name and type, ignoring entities declared 6222 // outside the innermost enclosing namespace scope, the block 6223 // scope declaration declares that same entity and receives the 6224 // linkage of the previous declaration. 6225 DeclContext *OuterContext = DC->getRedeclContext(); 6226 if (!OuterContext->isFunctionOrMethod()) 6227 // This rule only applies to block-scope declarations. 6228 return false; 6229 6230 DeclContext *PrevOuterContext = PrevDecl->getDeclContext(); 6231 if (PrevOuterContext->isRecord()) 6232 // We found a member function: ignore it. 6233 return false; 6234 6235 // Find the innermost enclosing namespace for the new and 6236 // previous declarations. 6237 OuterContext = OuterContext->getEnclosingNamespaceContext(); 6238 PrevOuterContext = PrevOuterContext->getEnclosingNamespaceContext(); 6239 6240 // The previous declaration is in a different namespace, so it 6241 // isn't the same function. 6242 if (!OuterContext->Equals(PrevOuterContext)) 6243 return false; 6244 } 6245 6246 return true; 6247 } 6248 6249 static void SetNestedNameSpecifier(Sema &S, DeclaratorDecl *DD, Declarator &D) { 6250 CXXScopeSpec &SS = D.getCXXScopeSpec(); 6251 if (!SS.isSet()) return; 6252 DD->setQualifierInfo(SS.getWithLocInContext(S.Context)); 6253 } 6254 6255 bool Sema::inferObjCARCLifetime(ValueDecl *decl) { 6256 QualType type = decl->getType(); 6257 Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime lifetime = type.getObjCLifetime(); 6258 if (lifetime == Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing) { 6259 // Various kinds of declaration aren't allowed to be __autoreleasing. 6260 unsigned kind = -1U; 6261 if (VarDecl *var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(decl)) { 6262 if (var->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) 6263 kind = 0; // __block 6264 else if (!var->hasLocalStorage()) 6265 kind = 1; // global 6266 } else if (isa<ObjCIvarDecl>(decl)) { 6267 kind = 3; // ivar 6268 } else if (isa<FieldDecl>(decl)) { 6269 kind = 2; // field 6270 } 6271 6272 if (kind != -1U) { 6273 Diag(decl->getLocation(), diag::err_arc_autoreleasing_var) 6274 << kind; 6275 } 6276 } else if (lifetime == Qualifiers::OCL_None) { 6277 // Try to infer lifetime. 6278 if (!type->isObjCLifetimeType()) 6279 return false; 6280 6281 lifetime = type->getObjCARCImplicitLifetime(); 6282 type = Context.getLifetimeQualifiedType(type, lifetime); 6283 decl->setType(type); 6284 } 6285 6286 if (VarDecl *var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(decl)) { 6287 // Thread-local variables cannot have lifetime. 6288 if (lifetime && lifetime != Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone && 6289 var->getTLSKind()) { 6290 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::err_arc_thread_ownership) 6291 << var->getType(); 6292 return true; 6293 } 6294 } 6295 6296 return false; 6297 } 6298 6299 void Sema::deduceOpenCLAddressSpace(ValueDecl *Decl) { 6300 if (Decl->getType().hasAddressSpace()) 6301 return; 6302 if (Decl->getType()->isDependentType()) 6303 return; 6304 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Decl)) { 6305 QualType Type = Var->getType(); 6306 if (Type->isSamplerT() || Type->isVoidType()) 6307 return; 6308 LangAS ImplAS = LangAS::opencl_private; 6309 if ((getLangOpts().OpenCLCPlusPlus || getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion >= 200) && 6310 Var->hasGlobalStorage()) 6311 ImplAS = LangAS::opencl_global; 6312 // If the original type from a decayed type is an array type and that array 6313 // type has no address space yet, deduce it now. 6314 if (auto DT = dyn_cast<DecayedType>(Type)) { 6315 auto OrigTy = DT->getOriginalType(); 6316 if (!OrigTy.hasAddressSpace() && OrigTy->isArrayType()) { 6317 // Add the address space to the original array type and then propagate 6318 // that to the element type through `getAsArrayType`. 6319 OrigTy = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(OrigTy, ImplAS); 6320 OrigTy = QualType(Context.getAsArrayType(OrigTy), 0); 6321 // Re-generate the decayed type. 6322 Type = Context.getDecayedType(OrigTy); 6323 } 6324 } 6325 Type = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(Type, ImplAS); 6326 // Apply any qualifiers (including address space) from the array type to 6327 // the element type. This implements C99 6.7.3p8: "If the specification of 6328 // an array type includes any type qualifiers, the element type is so 6329 // qualified, not the array type." 6330 if (Type->isArrayType()) 6331 Type = QualType(Context.getAsArrayType(Type), 0); 6332 Decl->setType(Type); 6333 } 6334 } 6335 6336 static void checkAttributesAfterMerging(Sema &S, NamedDecl &ND) { 6337 // Ensure that an auto decl is deduced otherwise the checks below might cache 6338 // the wrong linkage. 6339 assert(S.ParsingInitForAutoVars.count(&ND) == 0); 6340 6341 // 'weak' only applies to declarations with external linkage. 6342 if (WeakAttr *Attr = ND.getAttr<WeakAttr>()) { 6343 if (!ND.isExternallyVisible()) { 6344 S.Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_weak_static); 6345 ND.dropAttr<WeakAttr>(); 6346 } 6347 } 6348 if (WeakRefAttr *Attr = ND.getAttr<WeakRefAttr>()) { 6349 if (ND.isExternallyVisible()) { 6350 S.Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_weakref_not_static); 6351 ND.dropAttr<WeakRefAttr>(); 6352 ND.dropAttr<AliasAttr>(); 6353 } 6354 } 6355 6356 if (auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(&ND)) { 6357 if (VD->hasInit()) { 6358 if (const auto *Attr = VD->getAttr<AliasAttr>()) { 6359 assert(VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() && 6360 !VD->isExternallyVisible() && "Broken AliasAttr handled late!"); 6361 S.Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::err_alias_is_definition) << VD << 0; 6362 VD->dropAttr<AliasAttr>(); 6363 } 6364 } 6365 } 6366 6367 // 'selectany' only applies to externally visible variable declarations. 6368 // It does not apply to functions. 6369 if (SelectAnyAttr *Attr = ND.getAttr<SelectAnyAttr>()) { 6370 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(ND) || !ND.isExternallyVisible()) { 6371 S.Diag(Attr->getLocation(), 6372 diag::err_attribute_selectany_non_extern_data); 6373 ND.dropAttr<SelectAnyAttr>(); 6374 } 6375 } 6376 6377 if (const InheritableAttr *Attr = getDLLAttr(&ND)) { 6378 auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(&ND); 6379 bool IsAnonymousNS = false; 6380 bool IsMicrosoft = S.Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft(); 6381 if (VD) { 6382 const NamespaceDecl *NS = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(VD->getDeclContext()); 6383 while (NS && !IsAnonymousNS) { 6384 IsAnonymousNS = NS->isAnonymousNamespace(); 6385 NS = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(NS->getParent()); 6386 } 6387 } 6388 // dll attributes require external linkage. Static locals may have external 6389 // linkage but still cannot be explicitly imported or exported. 6390 // In Microsoft mode, a variable defined in anonymous namespace must have 6391 // external linkage in order to be exported. 6392 bool AnonNSInMicrosoftMode = IsAnonymousNS && IsMicrosoft; 6393 if ((ND.isExternallyVisible() && AnonNSInMicrosoftMode) || 6394 (!AnonNSInMicrosoftMode && 6395 (!ND.isExternallyVisible() || (VD && VD->isStaticLocal())))) { 6396 S.Diag(ND.getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_dll_not_extern) 6397 << &ND << Attr; 6398 ND.setInvalidDecl(); 6399 } 6400 } 6401 6402 // Virtual functions cannot be marked as 'notail'. 6403 if (auto *Attr = ND.getAttr<NotTailCalledAttr>()) 6404 if (auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(&ND)) 6405 if (MD->isVirtual()) { 6406 S.Diag(ND.getLocation(), 6407 diag::err_invalid_attribute_on_virtual_function) 6408 << Attr; 6409 ND.dropAttr<NotTailCalledAttr>(); 6410 } 6411 6412 // Check the attributes on the function type, if any. 6413 if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(&ND)) { 6414 // Don't declare this variable in the second operand of the for-statement; 6415 // GCC miscompiles that by ending its lifetime before evaluating the 6416 // third operand. See gcc.gnu.org/PR86769. 6417 AttributedTypeLoc ATL; 6418 for (TypeLoc TL = FD->getTypeSourceInfo()->getTypeLoc(); 6419 (ATL = TL.getAsAdjusted<AttributedTypeLoc>()); 6420 TL = ATL.getModifiedLoc()) { 6421 // The [[lifetimebound]] attribute can be applied to the implicit object 6422 // parameter of a non-static member function (other than a ctor or dtor) 6423 // by applying it to the function type. 6424 if (const auto *A = ATL.getAttrAs<LifetimeBoundAttr>()) { 6425 const auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD); 6426 if (!MD || MD->isStatic()) { 6427 S.Diag(A->getLocation(), diag::err_lifetimebound_no_object_param) 6428 << !MD << A->getRange(); 6429 } else if (isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(MD) || isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(MD)) { 6430 S.Diag(A->getLocation(), diag::err_lifetimebound_ctor_dtor) 6431 << isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(MD) << A->getRange(); 6432 } 6433 } 6434 } 6435 } 6436 } 6437 6438 static void checkDLLAttributeRedeclaration(Sema &S, NamedDecl *OldDecl, 6439 NamedDecl *NewDecl, 6440 bool IsSpecialization, 6441 bool IsDefinition) { 6442 if (OldDecl->isInvalidDecl() || NewDecl->isInvalidDecl()) 6443 return; 6444 6445 bool IsTemplate = false; 6446 if (TemplateDecl *OldTD = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(OldDecl)) { 6447 OldDecl = OldTD->getTemplatedDecl(); 6448 IsTemplate = true; 6449 if (!IsSpecialization) 6450 IsDefinition = false; 6451 } 6452 if (TemplateDecl *NewTD = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(NewDecl)) { 6453 NewDecl = NewTD->getTemplatedDecl(); 6454 IsTemplate = true; 6455 } 6456 6457 if (!OldDecl || !NewDecl) 6458 return; 6459 6460 const DLLImportAttr *OldImportAttr = OldDecl->getAttr<DLLImportAttr>(); 6461 const DLLExportAttr *OldExportAttr = OldDecl->getAttr<DLLExportAttr>(); 6462 const DLLImportAttr *NewImportAttr = NewDecl->getAttr<DLLImportAttr>(); 6463 const DLLExportAttr *NewExportAttr = NewDecl->getAttr<DLLExportAttr>(); 6464 6465 // dllimport and dllexport are inheritable attributes so we have to exclude 6466 // inherited attribute instances. 6467 bool HasNewAttr = (NewImportAttr && !NewImportAttr->isInherited()) || 6468 (NewExportAttr && !NewExportAttr->isInherited()); 6469 6470 // A redeclaration is not allowed to add a dllimport or dllexport attribute, 6471 // the only exception being explicit specializations. 6472 // Implicitly generated declarations are also excluded for now because there 6473 // is no other way to switch these to use dllimport or dllexport. 6474 bool AddsAttr = !(OldImportAttr || OldExportAttr) && HasNewAttr; 6475 6476 if (AddsAttr && !IsSpecialization && !OldDecl->isImplicit()) { 6477 // Allow with a warning for free functions and global variables. 6478 bool JustWarn = false; 6479 if (!OldDecl->isCXXClassMember()) { 6480 auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(OldDecl); 6481 if (VD && !VD->getDescribedVarTemplate()) 6482 JustWarn = true; 6483 auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(OldDecl); 6484 if (FD && FD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_NonTemplate) 6485 JustWarn = true; 6486 } 6487 6488 // We cannot change a declaration that's been used because IR has already 6489 // been emitted. Dllimported functions will still work though (modulo 6490 // address equality) as they can use the thunk. 6491 if (OldDecl->isUsed()) 6492 if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(OldDecl) || !NewImportAttr) 6493 JustWarn = false; 6494 6495 unsigned DiagID = JustWarn ? diag::warn_attribute_dll_redeclaration 6496 : diag::err_attribute_dll_redeclaration; 6497 S.Diag(NewDecl->getLocation(), DiagID) 6498 << NewDecl 6499 << (NewImportAttr ? (const Attr *)NewImportAttr : NewExportAttr); 6500 S.Diag(OldDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 6501 if (!JustWarn) { 6502 NewDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 6503 return; 6504 } 6505 } 6506 6507 // A redeclaration is not allowed to drop a dllimport attribute, the only 6508 // exceptions being inline function definitions (except for function 6509 // templates), local extern declarations, qualified friend declarations or 6510 // special MSVC extension: in the last case, the declaration is treated as if 6511 // it were marked dllexport. 6512 bool IsInline = false, IsStaticDataMember = false, IsQualifiedFriend = false; 6513 bool IsMicrosoft = 6514 S.Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() || 6515 S.Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isWindowsItaniumEnvironment(); 6516 if (const auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(NewDecl)) { 6517 // Ignore static data because out-of-line definitions are diagnosed 6518 // separately. 6519 IsStaticDataMember = VD->isStaticDataMember(); 6520 IsDefinition = VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition(S.Context) != 6521 VarDecl::DeclarationOnly; 6522 } else if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(NewDecl)) { 6523 IsInline = FD->isInlined(); 6524 IsQualifiedFriend = FD->getQualifier() && 6525 FD->getFriendObjectKind() == Decl::FOK_Declared; 6526 } 6527 6528 if (OldImportAttr && !HasNewAttr && 6529 (!IsInline || (IsMicrosoft && IsTemplate)) && !IsStaticDataMember && 6530 !NewDecl->isLocalExternDecl() && !IsQualifiedFriend) { 6531 if (IsMicrosoft && IsDefinition) { 6532 S.Diag(NewDecl->getLocation(), 6533 diag::warn_redeclaration_without_import_attribute) 6534 << NewDecl; 6535 S.Diag(OldDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 6536 NewDecl->dropAttr<DLLImportAttr>(); 6537 NewDecl->addAttr( 6538 DLLExportAttr::CreateImplicit(S.Context, NewImportAttr->getRange())); 6539 } else { 6540 S.Diag(NewDecl->getLocation(), 6541 diag::warn_redeclaration_without_attribute_prev_attribute_ignored) 6542 << NewDecl << OldImportAttr; 6543 S.Diag(OldDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 6544 S.Diag(OldImportAttr->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_attribute); 6545 OldDecl->dropAttr<DLLImportAttr>(); 6546 NewDecl->dropAttr<DLLImportAttr>(); 6547 } 6548 } else if (IsInline && OldImportAttr && !IsMicrosoft) { 6549 // In MinGW, seeing a function declared inline drops the dllimport 6550 // attribute. 6551 OldDecl->dropAttr<DLLImportAttr>(); 6552 NewDecl->dropAttr<DLLImportAttr>(); 6553 S.Diag(NewDecl->getLocation(), 6554 diag::warn_dllimport_dropped_from_inline_function) 6555 << NewDecl << OldImportAttr; 6556 } 6557 6558 // A specialization of a class template member function is processed here 6559 // since it's a redeclaration. If the parent class is dllexport, the 6560 // specialization inherits that attribute. This doesn't happen automatically 6561 // since the parent class isn't instantiated until later. 6562 if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewDecl)) { 6563 if (MD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_MemberSpecialization && 6564 !NewImportAttr && !NewExportAttr) { 6565 if (const DLLExportAttr *ParentExportAttr = 6566 MD->getParent()->getAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) { 6567 DLLExportAttr *NewAttr = ParentExportAttr->clone(S.Context); 6568 NewAttr->setInherited(true); 6569 NewDecl->addAttr(NewAttr); 6570 } 6571 } 6572 } 6573 } 6574 6575 /// Given that we are within the definition of the given function, 6576 /// will that definition behave like C99's 'inline', where the 6577 /// definition is discarded except for optimization purposes? 6578 static bool isFunctionDefinitionDiscarded(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *FD) { 6579 // Try to avoid calling GetGVALinkageForFunction. 6580 6581 // All cases of this require the 'inline' keyword. 6582 if (!FD->isInlined()) return false; 6583 6584 // This is only possible in C++ with the gnu_inline attribute. 6585 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !FD->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>()) 6586 return false; 6587 6588 // Okay, go ahead and call the relatively-more-expensive function. 6589 return S.Context.GetGVALinkageForFunction(FD) == GVA_AvailableExternally; 6590 } 6591 6592 /// Determine whether a variable is extern "C" prior to attaching 6593 /// an initializer. We can't just call isExternC() here, because that 6594 /// will also compute and cache whether the declaration is externally 6595 /// visible, which might change when we attach the initializer. 6596 /// 6597 /// This can only be used if the declaration is known to not be a 6598 /// redeclaration of an internal linkage declaration. 6599 /// 6600 /// For instance: 6601 /// 6602 /// auto x = []{}; 6603 /// 6604 /// Attaching the initializer here makes this declaration not externally 6605 /// visible, because its type has internal linkage. 6606 /// 6607 /// FIXME: This is a hack. 6608 template<typename T> 6609 static bool isIncompleteDeclExternC(Sema &S, const T *D) { 6610 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 6611 // In C++, the overloadable attribute negates the effects of extern "C". 6612 if (!D->isInExternCContext() || D->template hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>()) 6613 return false; 6614 6615 // So do CUDA's host/device attributes. 6616 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && (D->template hasAttr<CUDADeviceAttr>() || 6617 D->template hasAttr<CUDAHostAttr>())) 6618 return false; 6619 } 6620 return D->isExternC(); 6621 } 6622 6623 static bool shouldConsiderLinkage(const VarDecl *VD) { 6624 const DeclContext *DC = VD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 6625 if (DC->isFunctionOrMethod() || isa<OMPDeclareReductionDecl>(DC) || 6626 isa<OMPDeclareMapperDecl>(DC)) 6627 return VD->hasExternalStorage(); 6628 if (DC->isFileContext()) 6629 return true; 6630 if (DC->isRecord()) 6631 return false; 6632 if (isa<RequiresExprBodyDecl>(DC)) 6633 return false; 6634 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected context"); 6635 } 6636 6637 static bool shouldConsiderLinkage(const FunctionDecl *FD) { 6638 const DeclContext *DC = FD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 6639 if (DC->isFileContext() || DC->isFunctionOrMethod() || 6640 isa<OMPDeclareReductionDecl>(DC) || isa<OMPDeclareMapperDecl>(DC)) 6641 return true; 6642 if (DC->isRecord()) 6643 return false; 6644 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected context"); 6645 } 6646 6647 static bool hasParsedAttr(Scope *S, const Declarator &PD, 6648 ParsedAttr::Kind Kind) { 6649 // Check decl attributes on the DeclSpec. 6650 if (PD.getDeclSpec().getAttributes().hasAttribute(Kind)) 6651 return true; 6652 6653 // Walk the declarator structure, checking decl attributes that were in a type 6654 // position to the decl itself. 6655 for (unsigned I = 0, E = PD.getNumTypeObjects(); I != E; ++I) { 6656 if (PD.getTypeObject(I).getAttrs().hasAttribute(Kind)) 6657 return true; 6658 } 6659 6660 // Finally, check attributes on the decl itself. 6661 return PD.getAttributes().hasAttribute(Kind); 6662 } 6663 6664 /// Adjust the \c DeclContext for a function or variable that might be a 6665 /// function-local external declaration. 6666 bool Sema::adjustContextForLocalExternDecl(DeclContext *&DC) { 6667 if (!DC->isFunctionOrMethod()) 6668 return false; 6669 6670 // If this is a local extern function or variable declared within a function 6671 // template, don't add it into the enclosing namespace scope until it is 6672 // instantiated; it might have a dependent type right now. 6673 if (DC->isDependentContext()) 6674 return true; 6675 6676 // C++11 [basic.link]p7: 6677 // When a block scope declaration of an entity with linkage is not found to 6678 // refer to some other declaration, then that entity is a member of the 6679 // innermost enclosing namespace. 6680 // 6681 // Per C++11 [namespace.def]p6, the innermost enclosing namespace is a 6682 // semantically-enclosing namespace, not a lexically-enclosing one. 6683 while (!DC->isFileContext() && !isa<LinkageSpecDecl>(DC)) 6684 DC = DC->getParent(); 6685 return true; 6686 } 6687 6688 /// Returns true if given declaration has external C language linkage. 6689 static bool isDeclExternC(const Decl *D) { 6690 if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) 6691 return FD->isExternC(); 6692 if (const auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) 6693 return VD->isExternC(); 6694 6695 llvm_unreachable("Unknown type of decl!"); 6696 } 6697 /// Returns true if there hasn't been any invalid type diagnosed. 6698 static bool diagnoseOpenCLTypes(Scope *S, Sema &Se, Declarator &D, 6699 DeclContext *DC, QualType R) { 6700 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.9.b - Image type can only be used as a function argument. 6701 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.13.16.1 - Pipe type can only be used as a function 6702 // argument. 6703 if (R->isImageType() || R->isPipeType()) { 6704 Se.Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 6705 diag::err_opencl_type_can_only_be_used_as_function_parameter) 6706 << R; 6707 D.setInvalidType(); 6708 return false; 6709 } 6710 6711 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.r: 6712 // The event type cannot be used to declare a program scope variable. 6713 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.9.q: 6714 // The clk_event_t and reserve_id_t types cannot be declared in program 6715 // scope. 6716 if (NULL == S->getParent()) { 6717 if (R->isReserveIDT() || R->isClkEventT() || R->isEventT()) { 6718 Se.Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 6719 diag::err_invalid_type_for_program_scope_var) 6720 << R; 6721 D.setInvalidType(); 6722 return false; 6723 } 6724 } 6725 6726 // OpenCL v1.0 s6.8.a.3: Pointers to functions are not allowed. 6727 QualType NR = R; 6728 while (NR->isPointerType()) { 6729 if (NR->isFunctionPointerType()) { 6730 Se.Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_opencl_function_pointer); 6731 D.setInvalidType(); 6732 return false; 6733 } 6734 NR = NR->getPointeeType(); 6735 } 6736 6737 if (!Se.getOpenCLOptions().isEnabled("cl_khr_fp16")) { 6738 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.1.1.1: reject declaring variables of the half and 6739 // half array type (unless the cl_khr_fp16 extension is enabled). 6740 if (Se.Context.getBaseElementType(R)->isHalfType()) { 6741 Se.Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_opencl_half_declaration) << R; 6742 D.setInvalidType(); 6743 return false; 6744 } 6745 } 6746 6747 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.r: 6748 // The event type cannot be used with the __local, __constant and __global 6749 // address space qualifiers. 6750 if (R->isEventT()) { 6751 if (R.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::opencl_private) { 6752 Se.Diag(D.getBeginLoc(), diag::err_event_t_addr_space_qual); 6753 D.setInvalidType(); 6754 return false; 6755 } 6756 } 6757 6758 // C++ for OpenCL does not allow the thread_local storage qualifier. 6759 // OpenCL C does not support thread_local either, and 6760 // also reject all other thread storage class specifiers. 6761 DeclSpec::TSCS TSC = D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpec(); 6762 if (TSC != TSCS_unspecified) { 6763 bool IsCXX = Se.getLangOpts().OpenCLCPlusPlus; 6764 Se.Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), 6765 diag::err_opencl_unknown_type_specifier) 6766 << IsCXX << Se.getLangOpts().getOpenCLVersionTuple().getAsString() 6767 << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSC) << 1; 6768 D.setInvalidType(); 6769 return false; 6770 } 6771 6772 if (R->isSamplerT()) { 6773 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.b p4: 6774 // The sampler type cannot be used with the __local and __global address 6775 // space qualifiers. 6776 if (R.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_local || 6777 R.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_global) { 6778 Se.Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_wrong_sampler_addressspace); 6779 D.setInvalidType(); 6780 } 6781 6782 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.12.14.1: 6783 // A global sampler must be declared with either the constant address 6784 // space qualifier or with the const qualifier. 6785 if (DC->isTranslationUnit() && 6786 !(R.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant || 6787 R.isConstQualified())) { 6788 Se.Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_opencl_nonconst_global_sampler); 6789 D.setInvalidType(); 6790 } 6791 if (D.isInvalidType()) 6792 return false; 6793 } 6794 return true; 6795 } 6796 6797 NamedDecl *Sema::ActOnVariableDeclarator( 6798 Scope *S, Declarator &D, DeclContext *DC, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, 6799 LookupResult &Previous, MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParamLists, 6800 bool &AddToScope, ArrayRef<BindingDecl *> Bindings) { 6801 QualType R = TInfo->getType(); 6802 DeclarationName Name = GetNameForDeclarator(D).getName(); 6803 6804 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo(); 6805 6806 if (D.isDecompositionDeclarator()) { 6807 // Take the name of the first declarator as our name for diagnostic 6808 // purposes. 6809 auto &Decomp = D.getDecompositionDeclarator(); 6810 if (!Decomp.bindings().empty()) { 6811 II = Decomp.bindings()[0].Name; 6812 Name = II; 6813 } 6814 } else if (!II) { 6815 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_bad_variable_name) << Name; 6816 return nullptr; 6817 } 6818 6819 6820 DeclSpec::SCS SCSpec = D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec(); 6821 StorageClass SC = StorageClassSpecToVarDeclStorageClass(D.getDeclSpec()); 6822 6823 // dllimport globals without explicit storage class are treated as extern. We 6824 // have to change the storage class this early to get the right DeclContext. 6825 if (SC == SC_None && !DC->isRecord() && 6826 hasParsedAttr(S, D, ParsedAttr::AT_DLLImport) && 6827 !hasParsedAttr(S, D, ParsedAttr::AT_DLLExport)) 6828 SC = SC_Extern; 6829 6830 DeclContext *OriginalDC = DC; 6831 bool IsLocalExternDecl = SC == SC_Extern && 6832 adjustContextForLocalExternDecl(DC); 6833 6834 if (SCSpec == DeclSpec::SCS_mutable) { 6835 // mutable can only appear on non-static class members, so it's always 6836 // an error here 6837 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_mutable_nonmember); 6838 D.setInvalidType(); 6839 SC = SC_None; 6840 } 6841 6842 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && SCSpec == DeclSpec::SCS_register && 6843 !D.getAsmLabel() && !getSourceManager().isInSystemMacro( 6844 D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc())) { 6845 // In C++11, the 'register' storage class specifier is deprecated. 6846 // Suppress the warning in system macros, it's used in macros in some 6847 // popular C system headers, such as in glibc's htonl() macro. 6848 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 6849 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 ? diag::ext_register_storage_class 6850 : diag::warn_deprecated_register) 6851 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 6852 } 6853 6854 DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(D.getDeclSpec()); 6855 6856 if (!DC->isRecord() && S->getFnParent() == nullptr) { 6857 // C99 6.9p2: The storage-class specifiers auto and register shall not 6858 // appear in the declaration specifiers in an external declaration. 6859 // Global Register+Asm is a GNU extension we support. 6860 if (SC == SC_Auto || (SC == SC_Register && !D.getAsmLabel())) { 6861 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_sclass_fscope); 6862 D.setInvalidType(); 6863 } 6864 } 6865 6866 bool IsMemberSpecialization = false; 6867 bool IsVariableTemplateSpecialization = false; 6868 bool IsPartialSpecialization = false; 6869 bool IsVariableTemplate = false; 6870 VarDecl *NewVD = nullptr; 6871 VarTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = nullptr; 6872 TemplateParameterList *TemplateParams = nullptr; 6873 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 6874 NewVD = VarDecl::Create(Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), D.getIdentifierLoc(), 6875 II, R, TInfo, SC); 6876 6877 if (R->getContainedDeducedType()) 6878 ParsingInitForAutoVars.insert(NewVD); 6879 6880 if (D.isInvalidType()) 6881 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 6882 6883 if (NewVD->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() && 6884 NewVD->hasLocalStorage()) 6885 checkNonTrivialCUnion(NewVD->getType(), NewVD->getLocation(), 6886 NTCUC_AutoVar, NTCUK_Destruct); 6887 } else { 6888 bool Invalid = false; 6889 6890 if (DC->isRecord() && !CurContext->isRecord()) { 6891 // This is an out-of-line definition of a static data member. 6892 switch (SC) { 6893 case SC_None: 6894 break; 6895 case SC_Static: 6896 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 6897 diag::err_static_out_of_line) 6898 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 6899 break; 6900 case SC_Auto: 6901 case SC_Register: 6902 case SC_Extern: 6903 // [dcl.stc] p2: The auto or register specifiers shall be applied only 6904 // to names of variables declared in a block or to function parameters. 6905 // [dcl.stc] p6: The extern specifier cannot be used in the declaration 6906 // of class members 6907 6908 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 6909 diag::err_storage_class_for_static_member) 6910 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 6911 break; 6912 case SC_PrivateExtern: 6913 llvm_unreachable("C storage class in c++!"); 6914 } 6915 } 6916 6917 if (SC == SC_Static && CurContext->isRecord()) { 6918 if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) { 6919 // Walk up the enclosing DeclContexts to check for any that are 6920 // incompatible with static data members. 6921 const DeclContext *FunctionOrMethod = nullptr; 6922 const CXXRecordDecl *AnonStruct = nullptr; 6923 for (DeclContext *Ctxt = DC; Ctxt; Ctxt = Ctxt->getParent()) { 6924 if (Ctxt->isFunctionOrMethod()) { 6925 FunctionOrMethod = Ctxt; 6926 break; 6927 } 6928 const CXXRecordDecl *ParentDecl = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Ctxt); 6929 if (ParentDecl && !ParentDecl->getDeclName()) { 6930 AnonStruct = ParentDecl; 6931 break; 6932 } 6933 } 6934 if (FunctionOrMethod) { 6935 // C++ [class.static.data]p5: A local class shall not have static data 6936 // members. 6937 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 6938 diag::err_static_data_member_not_allowed_in_local_class) 6939 << Name << RD->getDeclName() << RD->getTagKind(); 6940 } else if (AnonStruct) { 6941 // C++ [class.static.data]p4: Unnamed classes and classes contained 6942 // directly or indirectly within unnamed classes shall not contain 6943 // static data members. 6944 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 6945 diag::err_static_data_member_not_allowed_in_anon_struct) 6946 << Name << AnonStruct->getTagKind(); 6947 Invalid = true; 6948 } else if (RD->isUnion()) { 6949 // C++98 [class.union]p1: If a union contains a static data member, 6950 // the program is ill-formed. C++11 drops this restriction. 6951 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 6952 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 6953 ? diag::warn_cxx98_compat_static_data_member_in_union 6954 : diag::ext_static_data_member_in_union) << Name; 6955 } 6956 } 6957 } 6958 6959 // Match up the template parameter lists with the scope specifier, then 6960 // determine whether we have a template or a template specialization. 6961 bool InvalidScope = false; 6962 TemplateParams = MatchTemplateParametersToScopeSpecifier( 6963 D.getDeclSpec().getBeginLoc(), D.getIdentifierLoc(), 6964 D.getCXXScopeSpec(), 6965 D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId 6966 ? D.getName().TemplateId 6967 : nullptr, 6968 TemplateParamLists, 6969 /*never a friend*/ false, IsMemberSpecialization, InvalidScope); 6970 Invalid |= InvalidScope; 6971 6972 if (TemplateParams) { 6973 if (!TemplateParams->size() && 6974 D.getName().getKind() != UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId) { 6975 // There is an extraneous 'template<>' for this variable. Complain 6976 // about it, but allow the declaration of the variable. 6977 Diag(TemplateParams->getTemplateLoc(), 6978 diag::err_template_variable_noparams) 6979 << II 6980 << SourceRange(TemplateParams->getTemplateLoc(), 6981 TemplateParams->getRAngleLoc()); 6982 TemplateParams = nullptr; 6983 } else { 6984 // Check that we can declare a template here. 6985 if (CheckTemplateDeclScope(S, TemplateParams)) 6986 return nullptr; 6987 6988 if (D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId) { 6989 // This is an explicit specialization or a partial specialization. 6990 IsVariableTemplateSpecialization = true; 6991 IsPartialSpecialization = TemplateParams->size() > 0; 6992 } else { // if (TemplateParams->size() > 0) 6993 // This is a template declaration. 6994 IsVariableTemplate = true; 6995 6996 // Only C++1y supports variable templates (N3651). 6997 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 6998 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 6999 ? diag::warn_cxx11_compat_variable_template 7000 : diag::ext_variable_template); 7001 } 7002 } 7003 } else { 7004 // Check that we can declare a member specialization here. 7005 if (!TemplateParamLists.empty() && IsMemberSpecialization && 7006 CheckTemplateDeclScope(S, TemplateParamLists.back())) 7007 return nullptr; 7008 assert((Invalid || 7009 D.getName().getKind() != UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId) && 7010 "should have a 'template<>' for this decl"); 7011 } 7012 7013 if (IsVariableTemplateSpecialization) { 7014 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc = 7015 TemplateParamLists.size() > 0 7016 ? TemplateParamLists[0]->getTemplateLoc() 7017 : SourceLocation(); 7018 DeclResult Res = ActOnVarTemplateSpecialization( 7019 S, D, TInfo, TemplateKWLoc, TemplateParams, SC, 7020 IsPartialSpecialization); 7021 if (Res.isInvalid()) 7022 return nullptr; 7023 NewVD = cast<VarDecl>(Res.get()); 7024 AddToScope = false; 7025 } else if (D.isDecompositionDeclarator()) { 7026 NewVD = DecompositionDecl::Create(Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), 7027 D.getIdentifierLoc(), R, TInfo, SC, 7028 Bindings); 7029 } else 7030 NewVD = VarDecl::Create(Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), 7031 D.getIdentifierLoc(), II, R, TInfo, SC); 7032 7033 // If this is supposed to be a variable template, create it as such. 7034 if (IsVariableTemplate) { 7035 NewTemplate = 7036 VarTemplateDecl::Create(Context, DC, D.getIdentifierLoc(), Name, 7037 TemplateParams, NewVD); 7038 NewVD->setDescribedVarTemplate(NewTemplate); 7039 } 7040 7041 // If this decl has an auto type in need of deduction, make a note of the 7042 // Decl so we can diagnose uses of it in its own initializer. 7043 if (R->getContainedDeducedType()) 7044 ParsingInitForAutoVars.insert(NewVD); 7045 7046 if (D.isInvalidType() || Invalid) { 7047 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7048 if (NewTemplate) 7049 NewTemplate->setInvalidDecl(); 7050 } 7051 7052 SetNestedNameSpecifier(*this, NewVD, D); 7053 7054 // If we have any template parameter lists that don't directly belong to 7055 // the variable (matching the scope specifier), store them. 7056 unsigned VDTemplateParamLists = TemplateParams ? 1 : 0; 7057 if (TemplateParamLists.size() > VDTemplateParamLists) 7058 NewVD->setTemplateParameterListsInfo( 7059 Context, TemplateParamLists.drop_back(VDTemplateParamLists)); 7060 } 7061 7062 if (D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified()) { 7063 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 7064 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_non_function) 7065 << 0; 7066 } else if (CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod()) { 7067 // 'inline' is not allowed on block scope variable declaration. 7068 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), 7069 diag::err_inline_declaration_block_scope) << Name 7070 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc()); 7071 } else { 7072 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), 7073 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 ? diag::warn_cxx14_compat_inline_variable 7074 : diag::ext_inline_variable); 7075 NewVD->setInlineSpecified(); 7076 } 7077 } 7078 7079 // Set the lexical context. If the declarator has a C++ scope specifier, the 7080 // lexical context will be different from the semantic context. 7081 NewVD->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext); 7082 if (NewTemplate) 7083 NewTemplate->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext); 7084 7085 if (IsLocalExternDecl) { 7086 if (D.isDecompositionDeclarator()) 7087 for (auto *B : Bindings) 7088 B->setLocalExternDecl(); 7089 else 7090 NewVD->setLocalExternDecl(); 7091 } 7092 7093 bool EmitTLSUnsupportedError = false; 7094 if (DeclSpec::TSCS TSCS = D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpec()) { 7095 // C++11 [dcl.stc]p4: 7096 // When thread_local is applied to a variable of block scope the 7097 // storage-class-specifier static is implied if it does not appear 7098 // explicitly. 7099 // Core issue: 'static' is not implied if the variable is declared 7100 // 'extern'. 7101 if (NewVD->hasLocalStorage() && 7102 (SCSpec != DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified || 7103 TSCS != DeclSpec::TSCS_thread_local || 7104 !DC->isFunctionOrMethod())) 7105 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), 7106 diag::err_thread_non_global) 7107 << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSCS); 7108 else if (!Context.getTargetInfo().isTLSSupported()) { 7109 if (getLangOpts().CUDA || getLangOpts().OpenMPIsDevice || 7110 getLangOpts().SYCLIsDevice) { 7111 // Postpone error emission until we've collected attributes required to 7112 // figure out whether it's a host or device variable and whether the 7113 // error should be ignored. 7114 EmitTLSUnsupportedError = true; 7115 // We still need to mark the variable as TLS so it shows up in AST with 7116 // proper storage class for other tools to use even if we're not going 7117 // to emit any code for it. 7118 NewVD->setTSCSpec(TSCS); 7119 } else 7120 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), 7121 diag::err_thread_unsupported); 7122 } else 7123 NewVD->setTSCSpec(TSCS); 7124 } 7125 7126 switch (D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier()) { 7127 case CSK_unspecified: 7128 break; 7129 7130 case CSK_consteval: 7131 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(), 7132 diag::err_constexpr_wrong_decl_kind) 7133 << D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier(); 7134 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 7135 7136 case CSK_constexpr: 7137 NewVD->setConstexpr(true); 7138 MaybeAddCUDAConstantAttr(NewVD); 7139 // C++1z [dcl.spec.constexpr]p1: 7140 // A static data member declared with the constexpr specifier is 7141 // implicitly an inline variable. 7142 if (NewVD->isStaticDataMember() && 7143 (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 || 7144 Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft())) 7145 NewVD->setImplicitlyInline(); 7146 break; 7147 7148 case CSK_constinit: 7149 if (!NewVD->hasGlobalStorage()) 7150 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(), 7151 diag::err_constinit_local_variable); 7152 else 7153 NewVD->addAttr(ConstInitAttr::Create( 7154 Context, D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(), 7155 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Keyword, ConstInitAttr::Keyword_constinit)); 7156 break; 7157 } 7158 7159 // C99 6.7.4p3 7160 // An inline definition of a function with external linkage shall 7161 // not contain a definition of a modifiable object with static or 7162 // thread storage duration... 7163 // We only apply this when the function is required to be defined 7164 // elsewhere, i.e. when the function is not 'extern inline'. Note 7165 // that a local variable with thread storage duration still has to 7166 // be marked 'static'. Also note that it's possible to get these 7167 // semantics in C++ using __attribute__((gnu_inline)). 7168 if (SC == SC_Static && S->getFnParent() != nullptr && 7169 !NewVD->getType().isConstQualified()) { 7170 FunctionDecl *CurFD = getCurFunctionDecl(); 7171 if (CurFD && isFunctionDefinitionDiscarded(*this, CurFD)) { 7172 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 7173 diag::warn_static_local_in_extern_inline); 7174 MaybeSuggestAddingStaticToDecl(CurFD); 7175 } 7176 } 7177 7178 if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified()) { 7179 if (IsVariableTemplateSpecialization) 7180 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_specialization) 7181 << (IsPartialSpecialization ? 1 : 0) 7182 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval( 7183 D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()); 7184 else if (IsMemberSpecialization) 7185 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_specialization) 7186 << 2 7187 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()); 7188 else if (NewVD->hasLocalStorage()) 7189 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_local) 7190 << 0 << NewVD 7191 << SourceRange(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()) 7192 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval( 7193 D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()); 7194 else { 7195 NewVD->setModulePrivate(); 7196 if (NewTemplate) 7197 NewTemplate->setModulePrivate(); 7198 for (auto *B : Bindings) 7199 B->setModulePrivate(); 7200 } 7201 } 7202 7203 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 7204 7205 deduceOpenCLAddressSpace(NewVD); 7206 7207 diagnoseOpenCLTypes(S, *this, D, DC, NewVD->getType()); 7208 } 7209 7210 // Handle attributes prior to checking for duplicates in MergeVarDecl 7211 ProcessDeclAttributes(S, NewVD, D); 7212 7213 if (getLangOpts().CUDA || getLangOpts().OpenMPIsDevice || 7214 getLangOpts().SYCLIsDevice) { 7215 if (EmitTLSUnsupportedError && 7216 ((getLangOpts().CUDA && DeclAttrsMatchCUDAMode(getLangOpts(), NewVD)) || 7217 (getLangOpts().OpenMPIsDevice && 7218 OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::isDeclareTargetDeclaration(NewVD)))) 7219 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), 7220 diag::err_thread_unsupported); 7221 7222 if (EmitTLSUnsupportedError && 7223 (LangOpts.SYCLIsDevice || (LangOpts.OpenMP && LangOpts.OpenMPIsDevice))) 7224 targetDiag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_thread_unsupported); 7225 // CUDA B.2.5: "__shared__ and __constant__ variables have implied static 7226 // storage [duration]." 7227 if (SC == SC_None && S->getFnParent() != nullptr && 7228 (NewVD->hasAttr<CUDASharedAttr>() || 7229 NewVD->hasAttr<CUDAConstantAttr>())) { 7230 NewVD->setStorageClass(SC_Static); 7231 } 7232 } 7233 7234 // Ensure that dllimport globals without explicit storage class are treated as 7235 // extern. The storage class is set above using parsed attributes. Now we can 7236 // check the VarDecl itself. 7237 assert(!NewVD->hasAttr<DLLImportAttr>() || 7238 NewVD->getAttr<DLLImportAttr>()->isInherited() || 7239 NewVD->isStaticDataMember() || NewVD->getStorageClass() != SC_None); 7240 7241 // In auto-retain/release, infer strong retension for variables of 7242 // retainable type. 7243 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && inferObjCARCLifetime(NewVD)) 7244 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7245 7246 // Handle GNU asm-label extension (encoded as an attribute). 7247 if (Expr *E = (Expr*)D.getAsmLabel()) { 7248 // The parser guarantees this is a string. 7249 StringLiteral *SE = cast<StringLiteral>(E); 7250 StringRef Label = SE->getString(); 7251 if (S->getFnParent() != nullptr) { 7252 switch (SC) { 7253 case SC_None: 7254 case SC_Auto: 7255 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_asm_label_on_auto_decl) << Label; 7256 break; 7257 case SC_Register: 7258 // Local Named register 7259 if (!Context.getTargetInfo().isValidGCCRegisterName(Label) && 7260 DeclAttrsMatchCUDAMode(getLangOpts(), getCurFunctionDecl())) 7261 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_asm_unknown_register_name) << Label; 7262 break; 7263 case SC_Static: 7264 case SC_Extern: 7265 case SC_PrivateExtern: 7266 break; 7267 } 7268 } else if (SC == SC_Register) { 7269 // Global Named register 7270 if (DeclAttrsMatchCUDAMode(getLangOpts(), NewVD)) { 7271 const auto &TI = Context.getTargetInfo(); 7272 bool HasSizeMismatch; 7273 7274 if (!TI.isValidGCCRegisterName(Label)) 7275 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_asm_unknown_register_name) << Label; 7276 else if (!TI.validateGlobalRegisterVariable(Label, 7277 Context.getTypeSize(R), 7278 HasSizeMismatch)) 7279 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_asm_invalid_global_var_reg) << Label; 7280 else if (HasSizeMismatch) 7281 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_asm_register_size_mismatch) << Label; 7282 } 7283 7284 if (!R->isIntegralType(Context) && !R->isPointerType()) { 7285 Diag(D.getBeginLoc(), diag::err_asm_bad_register_type); 7286 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(true); 7287 } 7288 } 7289 7290 NewVD->addAttr(AsmLabelAttr::Create(Context, Label, 7291 /*IsLiteralLabel=*/true, 7292 SE->getStrTokenLoc(0))); 7293 } else if (!ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.empty()) { 7294 llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*,AsmLabelAttr*>::iterator I = 7295 ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.find(NewVD->getIdentifier()); 7296 if (I != ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.end()) { 7297 if (isDeclExternC(NewVD)) { 7298 NewVD->addAttr(I->second); 7299 ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.erase(I); 7300 } else 7301 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::warn_redefine_extname_not_applied) 7302 << /*Variable*/1 << NewVD; 7303 } 7304 } 7305 7306 // Find the shadowed declaration before filtering for scope. 7307 NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = D.getCXXScopeSpec().isEmpty() 7308 ? getShadowedDeclaration(NewVD, Previous) 7309 : nullptr; 7310 7311 // Don't consider existing declarations that are in a different 7312 // scope and are out-of-semantic-context declarations (if the new 7313 // declaration has linkage). 7314 FilterLookupForScope(Previous, OriginalDC, S, shouldConsiderLinkage(NewVD), 7315 D.getCXXScopeSpec().isNotEmpty() || 7316 IsMemberSpecialization || 7317 IsVariableTemplateSpecialization); 7318 7319 // Check whether the previous declaration is in the same block scope. This 7320 // affects whether we merge types with it, per C++11 [dcl.array]p3. 7321 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 7322 NewVD->isLocalVarDecl() && NewVD->hasExternalStorage()) 7323 NewVD->setPreviousDeclInSameBlockScope( 7324 Previous.isSingleResult() && !Previous.isShadowed() && 7325 isDeclInScope(Previous.getFoundDecl(), OriginalDC, S, false)); 7326 7327 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 7328 D.setRedeclaration(CheckVariableDeclaration(NewVD, Previous)); 7329 } else { 7330 // If this is an explicit specialization of a static data member, check it. 7331 if (IsMemberSpecialization && !NewVD->isInvalidDecl() && 7332 CheckMemberSpecialization(NewVD, Previous)) 7333 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7334 7335 // Merge the decl with the existing one if appropriate. 7336 if (!Previous.empty()) { 7337 if (Previous.isSingleResult() && 7338 isa<FieldDecl>(Previous.getFoundDecl()) && 7339 D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) { 7340 // The user tried to define a non-static data member 7341 // out-of-line (C++ [dcl.meaning]p1). 7342 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_nonstatic_member_out_of_line) 7343 << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange(); 7344 Previous.clear(); 7345 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7346 } 7347 } else if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) { 7348 // No previous declaration in the qualifying scope. 7349 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_no_member) 7350 << Name << computeDeclContext(D.getCXXScopeSpec(), true) 7351 << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange(); 7352 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7353 } 7354 7355 if (!IsVariableTemplateSpecialization) 7356 D.setRedeclaration(CheckVariableDeclaration(NewVD, Previous)); 7357 7358 if (NewTemplate) { 7359 VarTemplateDecl *PrevVarTemplate = 7360 NewVD->getPreviousDecl() 7361 ? NewVD->getPreviousDecl()->getDescribedVarTemplate() 7362 : nullptr; 7363 7364 // Check the template parameter list of this declaration, possibly 7365 // merging in the template parameter list from the previous variable 7366 // template declaration. 7367 if (CheckTemplateParameterList( 7368 TemplateParams, 7369 PrevVarTemplate ? PrevVarTemplate->getTemplateParameters() 7370 : nullptr, 7371 (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet() && DC && DC->isRecord() && 7372 DC->isDependentContext()) 7373 ? TPC_ClassTemplateMember 7374 : TPC_VarTemplate)) 7375 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7376 7377 // If we are providing an explicit specialization of a static variable 7378 // template, make a note of that. 7379 if (PrevVarTemplate && 7380 PrevVarTemplate->getInstantiatedFromMemberTemplate()) 7381 PrevVarTemplate->setMemberSpecialization(); 7382 } 7383 } 7384 7385 // Diagnose shadowed variables iff this isn't a redeclaration. 7386 if (ShadowedDecl && !D.isRedeclaration()) 7387 CheckShadow(NewVD, ShadowedDecl, Previous); 7388 7389 ProcessPragmaWeak(S, NewVD); 7390 7391 // If this is the first declaration of an extern C variable, update 7392 // the map of such variables. 7393 if (NewVD->isFirstDecl() && !NewVD->isInvalidDecl() && 7394 isIncompleteDeclExternC(*this, NewVD)) 7395 RegisterLocallyScopedExternCDecl(NewVD, S); 7396 7397 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NewVD->isStaticLocal()) { 7398 MangleNumberingContext *MCtx; 7399 Decl *ManglingContextDecl; 7400 std::tie(MCtx, ManglingContextDecl) = 7401 getCurrentMangleNumberContext(NewVD->getDeclContext()); 7402 if (MCtx) { 7403 Context.setManglingNumber( 7404 NewVD, MCtx->getManglingNumber( 7405 NewVD, getMSManglingNumber(getLangOpts(), S))); 7406 Context.setStaticLocalNumber(NewVD, MCtx->getStaticLocalNumber(NewVD)); 7407 } 7408 } 7409 7410 // Special handling of variable named 'main'. 7411 if (Name.getAsIdentifierInfo() && Name.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("main") && 7412 NewVD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit() && 7413 !getLangOpts().Freestanding && !NewVD->getDescribedVarTemplate()) { 7414 7415 // C++ [basic.start.main]p3 7416 // A program that declares a variable main at global scope is ill-formed. 7417 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 7418 Diag(D.getBeginLoc(), diag::err_main_global_variable); 7419 7420 // In C, and external-linkage variable named main results in undefined 7421 // behavior. 7422 else if (NewVD->hasExternalFormalLinkage()) 7423 Diag(D.getBeginLoc(), diag::warn_main_redefined); 7424 } 7425 7426 if (D.isRedeclaration() && !Previous.empty()) { 7427 NamedDecl *Prev = Previous.getRepresentativeDecl(); 7428 checkDLLAttributeRedeclaration(*this, Prev, NewVD, IsMemberSpecialization, 7429 D.isFunctionDefinition()); 7430 } 7431 7432 if (NewTemplate) { 7433 if (NewVD->isInvalidDecl()) 7434 NewTemplate->setInvalidDecl(); 7435 ActOnDocumentableDecl(NewTemplate); 7436 return NewTemplate; 7437 } 7438 7439 if (IsMemberSpecialization && !NewVD->isInvalidDecl()) 7440 CompleteMemberSpecialization(NewVD, Previous); 7441 7442 return NewVD; 7443 } 7444 7445 /// Enum describing the %select options in diag::warn_decl_shadow. 7446 enum ShadowedDeclKind { 7447 SDK_Local, 7448 SDK_Global, 7449 SDK_StaticMember, 7450 SDK_Field, 7451 SDK_Typedef, 7452 SDK_Using 7453 }; 7454 7455 /// Determine what kind of declaration we're shadowing. 7456 static ShadowedDeclKind computeShadowedDeclKind(const NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl, 7457 const DeclContext *OldDC) { 7458 if (isa<TypeAliasDecl>(ShadowedDecl)) 7459 return SDK_Using; 7460 else if (isa<TypedefDecl>(ShadowedDecl)) 7461 return SDK_Typedef; 7462 else if (isa<RecordDecl>(OldDC)) 7463 return isa<FieldDecl>(ShadowedDecl) ? SDK_Field : SDK_StaticMember; 7464 7465 return OldDC->isFileContext() ? SDK_Global : SDK_Local; 7466 } 7467 7468 /// Return the location of the capture if the given lambda captures the given 7469 /// variable \p VD, or an invalid source location otherwise. 7470 static SourceLocation getCaptureLocation(const LambdaScopeInfo *LSI, 7471 const VarDecl *VD) { 7472 for (const Capture &Capture : LSI->Captures) { 7473 if (Capture.isVariableCapture() && Capture.getVariable() == VD) 7474 return Capture.getLocation(); 7475 } 7476 return SourceLocation(); 7477 } 7478 7479 static bool shouldWarnIfShadowedDecl(const DiagnosticsEngine &Diags, 7480 const LookupResult &R) { 7481 // Only diagnose if we're shadowing an unambiguous field or variable. 7482 if (R.getResultKind() != LookupResult::Found) 7483 return false; 7484 7485 // Return false if warning is ignored. 7486 return !Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_decl_shadow, R.getNameLoc()); 7487 } 7488 7489 /// Return the declaration shadowed by the given variable \p D, or null 7490 /// if it doesn't shadow any declaration or shadowing warnings are disabled. 7491 NamedDecl *Sema::getShadowedDeclaration(const VarDecl *D, 7492 const LookupResult &R) { 7493 if (!shouldWarnIfShadowedDecl(Diags, R)) 7494 return nullptr; 7495 7496 // Don't diagnose declarations at file scope. 7497 if (D->hasGlobalStorage()) 7498 return nullptr; 7499 7500 NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = R.getFoundDecl(); 7501 return isa<VarDecl>(ShadowedDecl) || isa<FieldDecl>(ShadowedDecl) 7502 ? ShadowedDecl 7503 : nullptr; 7504 } 7505 7506 /// Return the declaration shadowed by the given typedef \p D, or null 7507 /// if it doesn't shadow any declaration or shadowing warnings are disabled. 7508 NamedDecl *Sema::getShadowedDeclaration(const TypedefNameDecl *D, 7509 const LookupResult &R) { 7510 // Don't warn if typedef declaration is part of a class 7511 if (D->getDeclContext()->isRecord()) 7512 return nullptr; 7513 7514 if (!shouldWarnIfShadowedDecl(Diags, R)) 7515 return nullptr; 7516 7517 NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = R.getFoundDecl(); 7518 return isa<TypedefNameDecl>(ShadowedDecl) ? ShadowedDecl : nullptr; 7519 } 7520 7521 /// Diagnose variable or built-in function shadowing. Implements 7522 /// -Wshadow. 7523 /// 7524 /// This method is called whenever a VarDecl is added to a "useful" 7525 /// scope. 7526 /// 7527 /// \param ShadowedDecl the declaration that is shadowed by the given variable 7528 /// \param R the lookup of the name 7529 /// 7530 void Sema::CheckShadow(NamedDecl *D, NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl, 7531 const LookupResult &R) { 7532 DeclContext *NewDC = D->getDeclContext(); 7533 7534 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(ShadowedDecl)) { 7535 // Fields are not shadowed by variables in C++ static methods. 7536 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewDC)) 7537 if (MD->isStatic()) 7538 return; 7539 7540 // Fields shadowed by constructor parameters are a special case. Usually 7541 // the constructor initializes the field with the parameter. 7542 if (isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewDC)) 7543 if (const auto PVD = dyn_cast<ParmVarDecl>(D)) { 7544 // Remember that this was shadowed so we can either warn about its 7545 // modification or its existence depending on warning settings. 7546 ShadowingDecls.insert({PVD->getCanonicalDecl(), FD}); 7547 return; 7548 } 7549 } 7550 7551 if (VarDecl *shadowedVar = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(ShadowedDecl)) 7552 if (shadowedVar->isExternC()) { 7553 // For shadowing external vars, make sure that we point to the global 7554 // declaration, not a locally scoped extern declaration. 7555 for (auto I : shadowedVar->redecls()) 7556 if (I->isFileVarDecl()) { 7557 ShadowedDecl = I; 7558 break; 7559 } 7560 } 7561 7562 DeclContext *OldDC = ShadowedDecl->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 7563 7564 unsigned WarningDiag = diag::warn_decl_shadow; 7565 SourceLocation CaptureLoc; 7566 if (isa<VarDecl>(D) && isa<VarDecl>(ShadowedDecl) && NewDC && 7567 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(NewDC)) { 7568 if (const auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(NewDC->getParent())) { 7569 if (RD->isLambda() && OldDC->Encloses(NewDC->getLexicalParent())) { 7570 if (RD->getLambdaCaptureDefault() == LCD_None) { 7571 // Try to avoid warnings for lambdas with an explicit capture list. 7572 const auto *LSI = cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(getCurFunction()); 7573 // Warn only when the lambda captures the shadowed decl explicitly. 7574 CaptureLoc = getCaptureLocation(LSI, cast<VarDecl>(ShadowedDecl)); 7575 if (CaptureLoc.isInvalid()) 7576 WarningDiag = diag::warn_decl_shadow_uncaptured_local; 7577 } else { 7578 // Remember that this was shadowed so we can avoid the warning if the 7579 // shadowed decl isn't captured and the warning settings allow it. 7580 cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(getCurFunction()) 7581 ->ShadowingDecls.push_back( 7582 {cast<VarDecl>(D), cast<VarDecl>(ShadowedDecl)}); 7583 return; 7584 } 7585 } 7586 7587 if (cast<VarDecl>(ShadowedDecl)->hasLocalStorage()) { 7588 // A variable can't shadow a local variable in an enclosing scope, if 7589 // they are separated by a non-capturing declaration context. 7590 for (DeclContext *ParentDC = NewDC; 7591 ParentDC && !ParentDC->Equals(OldDC); 7592 ParentDC = getLambdaAwareParentOfDeclContext(ParentDC)) { 7593 // Only block literals, captured statements, and lambda expressions 7594 // can capture; other scopes don't. 7595 if (!isa<BlockDecl>(ParentDC) && !isa<CapturedDecl>(ParentDC) && 7596 !isLambdaCallOperator(ParentDC)) { 7597 return; 7598 } 7599 } 7600 } 7601 } 7602 } 7603 7604 // Only warn about certain kinds of shadowing for class members. 7605 if (NewDC && NewDC->isRecord()) { 7606 // In particular, don't warn about shadowing non-class members. 7607 if (!OldDC->isRecord()) 7608 return; 7609 7610 // TODO: should we warn about static data members shadowing 7611 // static data members from base classes? 7612 7613 // TODO: don't diagnose for inaccessible shadowed members. 7614 // This is hard to do perfectly because we might friend the 7615 // shadowing context, but that's just a false negative. 7616 } 7617 7618 7619 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName(); 7620 7621 // Emit warning and note. 7622 if (getSourceManager().isInSystemMacro(R.getNameLoc())) 7623 return; 7624 ShadowedDeclKind Kind = computeShadowedDeclKind(ShadowedDecl, OldDC); 7625 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), WarningDiag) << Name << Kind << OldDC; 7626 if (!CaptureLoc.isInvalid()) 7627 Diag(CaptureLoc, diag::note_var_explicitly_captured_here) 7628 << Name << /*explicitly*/ 1; 7629 Diag(ShadowedDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 7630 } 7631 7632 /// Diagnose shadowing for variables shadowed in the lambda record \p LambdaRD 7633 /// when these variables are captured by the lambda. 7634 void Sema::DiagnoseShadowingLambdaDecls(const LambdaScopeInfo *LSI) { 7635 for (const auto &Shadow : LSI->ShadowingDecls) { 7636 const VarDecl *ShadowedDecl = Shadow.ShadowedDecl; 7637 // Try to avoid the warning when the shadowed decl isn't captured. 7638 SourceLocation CaptureLoc = getCaptureLocation(LSI, ShadowedDecl); 7639 const DeclContext *OldDC = ShadowedDecl->getDeclContext(); 7640 Diag(Shadow.VD->getLocation(), CaptureLoc.isInvalid() 7641 ? diag::warn_decl_shadow_uncaptured_local 7642 : diag::warn_decl_shadow) 7643 << Shadow.VD->getDeclName() 7644 << computeShadowedDeclKind(ShadowedDecl, OldDC) << OldDC; 7645 if (!CaptureLoc.isInvalid()) 7646 Diag(CaptureLoc, diag::note_var_explicitly_captured_here) 7647 << Shadow.VD->getDeclName() << /*explicitly*/ 0; 7648 Diag(ShadowedDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 7649 } 7650 } 7651 7652 /// Check -Wshadow without the advantage of a previous lookup. 7653 void Sema::CheckShadow(Scope *S, VarDecl *D) { 7654 if (Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_decl_shadow, D->getLocation())) 7655 return; 7656 7657 LookupResult R(*this, D->getDeclName(), D->getLocation(), 7658 Sema::LookupOrdinaryName, Sema::ForVisibleRedeclaration); 7659 LookupName(R, S); 7660 if (NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = getShadowedDeclaration(D, R)) 7661 CheckShadow(D, ShadowedDecl, R); 7662 } 7663 7664 /// Check if 'E', which is an expression that is about to be modified, refers 7665 /// to a constructor parameter that shadows a field. 7666 void Sema::CheckShadowingDeclModification(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc) { 7667 // Quickly ignore expressions that can't be shadowing ctor parameters. 7668 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || ShadowingDecls.empty()) 7669 return; 7670 E = E->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 7671 auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E); 7672 if (!DRE) 7673 return; 7674 const NamedDecl *D = cast<NamedDecl>(DRE->getDecl()->getCanonicalDecl()); 7675 auto I = ShadowingDecls.find(D); 7676 if (I == ShadowingDecls.end()) 7677 return; 7678 const NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = I->second; 7679 const DeclContext *OldDC = ShadowedDecl->getDeclContext(); 7680 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_modifying_shadowing_decl) << D << OldDC; 7681 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_var_declared_here) << D; 7682 Diag(ShadowedDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 7683 7684 // Avoid issuing multiple warnings about the same decl. 7685 ShadowingDecls.erase(I); 7686 } 7687 7688 /// Check for conflict between this global or extern "C" declaration and 7689 /// previous global or extern "C" declarations. This is only used in C++. 7690 template<typename T> 7691 static bool checkGlobalOrExternCConflict( 7692 Sema &S, const T *ND, bool IsGlobal, LookupResult &Previous) { 7693 assert(S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "only C++ has extern \"C\""); 7694 NamedDecl *Prev = S.findLocallyScopedExternCDecl(ND->getDeclName()); 7695 7696 if (!Prev && IsGlobal && !isIncompleteDeclExternC(S, ND)) { 7697 // The common case: this global doesn't conflict with any extern "C" 7698 // declaration. 7699 return false; 7700 } 7701 7702 if (Prev) { 7703 if (!IsGlobal || isIncompleteDeclExternC(S, ND)) { 7704 // Both the old and new declarations have C language linkage. This is a 7705 // redeclaration. 7706 Previous.clear(); 7707 Previous.addDecl(Prev); 7708 return true; 7709 } 7710 7711 // This is a global, non-extern "C" declaration, and there is a previous 7712 // non-global extern "C" declaration. Diagnose if this is a variable 7713 // declaration. 7714 if (!isa<VarDecl>(ND)) 7715 return false; 7716 } else { 7717 // The declaration is extern "C". Check for any declaration in the 7718 // translation unit which might conflict. 7719 if (IsGlobal) { 7720 // We have already performed the lookup into the translation unit. 7721 IsGlobal = false; 7722 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Previous.begin(), E = Previous.end(); 7723 I != E; ++I) { 7724 if (isa<VarDecl>(*I)) { 7725 Prev = *I; 7726 break; 7727 } 7728 } 7729 } else { 7730 DeclContext::lookup_result R = 7731 S.Context.getTranslationUnitDecl()->lookup(ND->getDeclName()); 7732 for (DeclContext::lookup_result::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); 7733 I != E; ++I) { 7734 if (isa<VarDecl>(*I)) { 7735 Prev = *I; 7736 break; 7737 } 7738 // FIXME: If we have any other entity with this name in global scope, 7739 // the declaration is ill-formed, but that is a defect: it breaks the 7740 // 'stat' hack, for instance. Only variables can have mangled name 7741 // clashes with extern "C" declarations, so only they deserve a 7742 // diagnostic. 7743 } 7744 } 7745 7746 if (!Prev) 7747 return false; 7748 } 7749 7750 // Use the first declaration's location to ensure we point at something which 7751 // is lexically inside an extern "C" linkage-spec. 7752 assert(Prev && "should have found a previous declaration to diagnose"); 7753 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Prev)) 7754 Prev = FD->getFirstDecl(); 7755 else 7756 Prev = cast<VarDecl>(Prev)->getFirstDecl(); 7757 7758 S.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::err_extern_c_global_conflict) 7759 << IsGlobal << ND; 7760 S.Diag(Prev->getLocation(), diag::note_extern_c_global_conflict) 7761 << IsGlobal; 7762 return false; 7763 } 7764 7765 /// Apply special rules for handling extern "C" declarations. Returns \c true 7766 /// if we have found that this is a redeclaration of some prior entity. 7767 /// 7768 /// Per C++ [dcl.link]p6: 7769 /// Two declarations [for a function or variable] with C language linkage 7770 /// with the same name that appear in different scopes refer to the same 7771 /// [entity]. An entity with C language linkage shall not be declared with 7772 /// the same name as an entity in global scope. 7773 template<typename T> 7774 static bool checkForConflictWithNonVisibleExternC(Sema &S, const T *ND, 7775 LookupResult &Previous) { 7776 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 7777 // In C, when declaring a global variable, look for a corresponding 'extern' 7778 // variable declared in function scope. We don't need this in C++, because 7779 // we find local extern decls in the surrounding file-scope DeclContext. 7780 if (ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) { 7781 if (NamedDecl *Prev = S.findLocallyScopedExternCDecl(ND->getDeclName())) { 7782 Previous.clear(); 7783 Previous.addDecl(Prev); 7784 return true; 7785 } 7786 } 7787 return false; 7788 } 7789 7790 // A declaration in the translation unit can conflict with an extern "C" 7791 // declaration. 7792 if (ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) 7793 return checkGlobalOrExternCConflict(S, ND, /*IsGlobal*/true, Previous); 7794 7795 // An extern "C" declaration can conflict with a declaration in the 7796 // translation unit or can be a redeclaration of an extern "C" declaration 7797 // in another scope. 7798 if (isIncompleteDeclExternC(S,ND)) 7799 return checkGlobalOrExternCConflict(S, ND, /*IsGlobal*/false, Previous); 7800 7801 // Neither global nor extern "C": nothing to do. 7802 return false; 7803 } 7804 7805 void Sema::CheckVariableDeclarationType(VarDecl *NewVD) { 7806 // If the decl is already known invalid, don't check it. 7807 if (NewVD->isInvalidDecl()) 7808 return; 7809 7810 QualType T = NewVD->getType(); 7811 7812 // Defer checking an 'auto' type until its initializer is attached. 7813 if (T->isUndeducedType()) 7814 return; 7815 7816 if (NewVD->hasAttrs()) 7817 CheckAlignasUnderalignment(NewVD); 7818 7819 if (T->isObjCObjectType()) { 7820 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_statically_allocated_object) 7821 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(NewVD->getLocation(), "*"); 7822 T = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(T); 7823 NewVD->setType(T); 7824 } 7825 7826 // Emit an error if an address space was applied to decl with local storage. 7827 // This includes arrays of objects with address space qualifiers, but not 7828 // automatic variables that point to other address spaces. 7829 // ISO/IEC TR 18037 S5.1.2 7830 if (!getLangOpts().OpenCL && NewVD->hasLocalStorage() && 7831 T.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::Default) { 7832 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_as_qualified_auto_decl) << 0; 7833 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7834 return; 7835 } 7836 7837 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.8 - The static qualifier is valid only in program 7838 // scope. 7839 if (getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion == 120 && 7840 !getOpenCLOptions().isEnabled("cl_clang_storage_class_specifiers") && 7841 NewVD->isStaticLocal()) { 7842 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_static_function_scope); 7843 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7844 return; 7845 } 7846 7847 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 7848 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.12.5 - The __block storage type is not supported. 7849 if (NewVD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) { 7850 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_block_storage_type); 7851 return; 7852 } 7853 7854 if (T->isBlockPointerType()) { 7855 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.12.5 - Any block declaration must be const qualified and 7856 // can't use 'extern' storage class. 7857 if (!T.isConstQualified()) { 7858 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_invalid_block_declaration) 7859 << 0 /*const*/; 7860 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7861 return; 7862 } 7863 if (NewVD->hasExternalStorage()) { 7864 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_extern_block_declaration); 7865 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7866 return; 7867 } 7868 } 7869 // OpenCL C v1.2 s6.5 - All program scope variables must be declared in the 7870 // __constant address space. 7871 // OpenCL C v2.0 s6.5.1 - Variables defined at program scope and static 7872 // variables inside a function can also be declared in the global 7873 // address space. 7874 // C++ for OpenCL inherits rule from OpenCL C v2.0. 7875 // FIXME: Adding local AS in C++ for OpenCL might make sense. 7876 if (NewVD->isFileVarDecl() || NewVD->isStaticLocal() || 7877 NewVD->hasExternalStorage()) { 7878 if (!T->isSamplerT() && 7879 !T->isDependentType() && 7880 !(T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant || 7881 (T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_global && 7882 (getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion == 200 || 7883 getLangOpts().OpenCLCPlusPlus)))) { 7884 int Scope = NewVD->isStaticLocal() | NewVD->hasExternalStorage() << 1; 7885 if (getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion == 200 || getLangOpts().OpenCLCPlusPlus) 7886 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_global_invalid_addr_space) 7887 << Scope << "global or constant"; 7888 else 7889 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_global_invalid_addr_space) 7890 << Scope << "constant"; 7891 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7892 return; 7893 } 7894 } else { 7895 if (T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_global) { 7896 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_function_variable) 7897 << 1 /*is any function*/ << "global"; 7898 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7899 return; 7900 } 7901 if (T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant || 7902 T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_local) { 7903 FunctionDecl *FD = getCurFunctionDecl(); 7904 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.5.2 and s6.5.3: no local or constant variables 7905 // in functions. 7906 if (FD && !FD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>()) { 7907 if (T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant) 7908 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_function_variable) 7909 << 0 /*non-kernel only*/ << "constant"; 7910 else 7911 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_function_variable) 7912 << 0 /*non-kernel only*/ << "local"; 7913 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7914 return; 7915 } 7916 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.5.2 and s6.5.3: local and constant variables must be 7917 // in the outermost scope of a kernel function. 7918 if (FD && FD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>()) { 7919 if (!getCurScope()->isFunctionScope()) { 7920 if (T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant) 7921 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_addrspace_scope) 7922 << "constant"; 7923 else 7924 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_addrspace_scope) 7925 << "local"; 7926 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7927 return; 7928 } 7929 } 7930 } else if (T.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::opencl_private && 7931 // If we are parsing a template we didn't deduce an addr 7932 // space yet. 7933 T.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::Default) { 7934 // Do not allow other address spaces on automatic variable. 7935 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_as_qualified_auto_decl) << 1; 7936 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7937 return; 7938 } 7939 } 7940 } 7941 7942 if (NewVD->hasLocalStorage() && T.isObjCGCWeak() 7943 && !NewVD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) { 7944 if (getLangOpts().getGC() != LangOptions::NonGC) 7945 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::warn_gc_attribute_weak_on_local); 7946 else { 7947 assert(!getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount); 7948 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::warn_attribute_weak_on_local); 7949 } 7950 } 7951 7952 bool isVM = T->isVariablyModifiedType(); 7953 if (isVM || NewVD->hasAttr<CleanupAttr>() || 7954 NewVD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) 7955 setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope(); 7956 7957 if ((isVM && NewVD->hasLinkage()) || 7958 (T->isVariableArrayType() && NewVD->hasGlobalStorage())) { 7959 bool SizeIsNegative; 7960 llvm::APSInt Oversized; 7961 TypeSourceInfo *FixedTInfo = TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeSourceInfo( 7962 NewVD->getTypeSourceInfo(), Context, SizeIsNegative, Oversized); 7963 QualType FixedT; 7964 if (FixedTInfo && T == NewVD->getTypeSourceInfo()->getType()) 7965 FixedT = FixedTInfo->getType(); 7966 else if (FixedTInfo) { 7967 // Type and type-as-written are canonically different. We need to fix up 7968 // both types separately. 7969 FixedT = TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(T, Context, SizeIsNegative, 7970 Oversized); 7971 } 7972 if ((!FixedTInfo || FixedT.isNull()) && T->isVariableArrayType()) { 7973 const VariableArrayType *VAT = Context.getAsVariableArrayType(T); 7974 // FIXME: This won't give the correct result for 7975 // int a[10][n]; 7976 SourceRange SizeRange = VAT->getSizeExpr()->getSourceRange(); 7977 7978 if (NewVD->isFileVarDecl()) 7979 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_vla_decl_in_file_scope) 7980 << SizeRange; 7981 else if (NewVD->isStaticLocal()) 7982 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_vla_decl_has_static_storage) 7983 << SizeRange; 7984 else 7985 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_vla_decl_has_extern_linkage) 7986 << SizeRange; 7987 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7988 return; 7989 } 7990 7991 if (!FixedTInfo) { 7992 if (NewVD->isFileVarDecl()) 7993 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_vm_decl_in_file_scope); 7994 else 7995 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_vm_decl_has_extern_linkage); 7996 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 7997 return; 7998 } 7999 8000 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::ext_vla_folded_to_constant); 8001 NewVD->setType(FixedT); 8002 NewVD->setTypeSourceInfo(FixedTInfo); 8003 } 8004 8005 if (T->isVoidType()) { 8006 // C++98 [dcl.stc]p5: The extern specifier can be applied only to the names 8007 // of objects and functions. 8008 if (NewVD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 8009 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type) 8010 << T; 8011 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8012 return; 8013 } 8014 } 8015 8016 if (!NewVD->hasLocalStorage() && NewVD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) { 8017 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_block_on_nonlocal); 8018 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8019 return; 8020 } 8021 8022 if (!NewVD->hasLocalStorage() && T->isSizelessType()) { 8023 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_sizeless_nonlocal) << T; 8024 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8025 return; 8026 } 8027 8028 if (isVM && NewVD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) { 8029 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_block_on_vm); 8030 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8031 return; 8032 } 8033 8034 if (NewVD->isConstexpr() && !T->isDependentType() && 8035 RequireLiteralType(NewVD->getLocation(), T, 8036 diag::err_constexpr_var_non_literal)) { 8037 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8038 return; 8039 } 8040 8041 // PPC MMA non-pointer types are not allowed as non-local variable types. 8042 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isPPC64() && 8043 !NewVD->isLocalVarDecl() && 8044 CheckPPCMMAType(T, NewVD->getLocation())) { 8045 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 8046 return; 8047 } 8048 } 8049 8050 /// Perform semantic checking on a newly-created variable 8051 /// declaration. 8052 /// 8053 /// This routine performs all of the type-checking required for a 8054 /// variable declaration once it has been built. It is used both to 8055 /// check variables after they have been parsed and their declarators 8056 /// have been translated into a declaration, and to check variables 8057 /// that have been instantiated from a template. 8058 /// 8059 /// Sets NewVD->isInvalidDecl() if an error was encountered. 8060 /// 8061 /// Returns true if the variable declaration is a redeclaration. 8062 bool Sema::CheckVariableDeclaration(VarDecl *NewVD, LookupResult &Previous) { 8063 CheckVariableDeclarationType(NewVD); 8064 8065 // If the decl is already known invalid, don't check it. 8066 if (NewVD->isInvalidDecl()) 8067 return false; 8068 8069 // If we did not find anything by this name, look for a non-visible 8070 // extern "C" declaration with the same name. 8071 if (Previous.empty() && 8072 checkForConflictWithNonVisibleExternC(*this, NewVD, Previous)) 8073 Previous.setShadowed(); 8074 8075 if (!Previous.empty()) { 8076 MergeVarDecl(NewVD, Previous); 8077 return true; 8078 } 8079 return false; 8080 } 8081 8082 namespace { 8083 struct FindOverriddenMethod { 8084 Sema *S; 8085 CXXMethodDecl *Method; 8086 8087 /// Member lookup function that determines whether a given C++ 8088 /// method overrides a method in a base class, to be used with 8089 /// CXXRecordDecl::lookupInBases(). 8090 bool operator()(const CXXBaseSpecifier *Specifier, CXXBasePath &Path) { 8091 RecordDecl *BaseRecord = 8092 Specifier->getType()->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl(); 8093 8094 DeclarationName Name = Method->getDeclName(); 8095 8096 // FIXME: Do we care about other names here too? 8097 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) { 8098 // We really want to find the base class destructor here. 8099 QualType T = S->Context.getTypeDeclType(BaseRecord); 8100 CanQualType CT = S->Context.getCanonicalType(T); 8101 8102 Name = S->Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXDestructorName(CT); 8103 } 8104 8105 for (Path.Decls = BaseRecord->lookup(Name); !Path.Decls.empty(); 8106 Path.Decls = Path.Decls.slice(1)) { 8107 NamedDecl *D = Path.Decls.front(); 8108 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) { 8109 if (MD->isVirtual() && 8110 !S->IsOverload( 8111 Method, MD, /*UseMemberUsingDeclRules=*/false, 8112 /*ConsiderCudaAttrs=*/true, 8113 // C++2a [class.virtual]p2 does not consider requires clauses 8114 // when overriding. 8115 /*ConsiderRequiresClauses=*/false)) 8116 return true; 8117 } 8118 } 8119 8120 return false; 8121 } 8122 }; 8123 } // end anonymous namespace 8124 8125 /// AddOverriddenMethods - See if a method overrides any in the base classes, 8126 /// and if so, check that it's a valid override and remember it. 8127 bool Sema::AddOverriddenMethods(CXXRecordDecl *DC, CXXMethodDecl *MD) { 8128 // Look for methods in base classes that this method might override. 8129 CXXBasePaths Paths; 8130 FindOverriddenMethod FOM; 8131 FOM.Method = MD; 8132 FOM.S = this; 8133 bool AddedAny = false; 8134 if (DC->lookupInBases(FOM, Paths)) { 8135 for (auto *I : Paths.found_decls()) { 8136 if (CXXMethodDecl *OldMD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(I)) { 8137 MD->addOverriddenMethod(OldMD->getCanonicalDecl()); 8138 if (!CheckOverridingFunctionReturnType(MD, OldMD) && 8139 !CheckOverridingFunctionAttributes(MD, OldMD) && 8140 !CheckOverridingFunctionExceptionSpec(MD, OldMD) && 8141 !CheckIfOverriddenFunctionIsMarkedFinal(MD, OldMD)) { 8142 AddedAny = true; 8143 } 8144 } 8145 } 8146 } 8147 8148 return AddedAny; 8149 } 8150 8151 namespace { 8152 // Struct for holding all of the extra arguments needed by 8153 // DiagnoseInvalidRedeclaration to call Sema::ActOnFunctionDeclarator. 8154 struct ActOnFDArgs { 8155 Scope *S; 8156 Declarator &D; 8157 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParamLists; 8158 bool AddToScope; 8159 }; 8160 } // end anonymous namespace 8161 8162 namespace { 8163 8164 // Callback to only accept typo corrections that have a non-zero edit distance. 8165 // Also only accept corrections that have the same parent decl. 8166 class DifferentNameValidatorCCC final : public CorrectionCandidateCallback { 8167 public: 8168 DifferentNameValidatorCCC(ASTContext &Context, FunctionDecl *TypoFD, 8169 CXXRecordDecl *Parent) 8170 : Context(Context), OriginalFD(TypoFD), 8171 ExpectedParent(Parent ? Parent->getCanonicalDecl() : nullptr) {} 8172 8173 bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) override { 8174 if (candidate.getEditDistance() == 0) 8175 return false; 8176 8177 SmallVector<unsigned, 1> MismatchedParams; 8178 for (TypoCorrection::const_decl_iterator CDecl = candidate.begin(), 8179 CDeclEnd = candidate.end(); 8180 CDecl != CDeclEnd; ++CDecl) { 8181 FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*CDecl); 8182 8183 if (FD && !FD->hasBody() && 8184 hasSimilarParameters(Context, FD, OriginalFD, MismatchedParams)) { 8185 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) { 8186 CXXRecordDecl *Parent = MD->getParent(); 8187 if (Parent && Parent->getCanonicalDecl() == ExpectedParent) 8188 return true; 8189 } else if (!ExpectedParent) { 8190 return true; 8191 } 8192 } 8193 } 8194 8195 return false; 8196 } 8197 8198 std::unique_ptr<CorrectionCandidateCallback> clone() override { 8199 return std::make_unique<DifferentNameValidatorCCC>(*this); 8200 } 8201 8202 private: 8203 ASTContext &Context; 8204 FunctionDecl *OriginalFD; 8205 CXXRecordDecl *ExpectedParent; 8206 }; 8207 8208 } // end anonymous namespace 8209 8210 void Sema::MarkTypoCorrectedFunctionDefinition(const NamedDecl *F) { 8211 TypoCorrectedFunctionDefinitions.insert(F); 8212 } 8213 8214 /// Generate diagnostics for an invalid function redeclaration. 8215 /// 8216 /// This routine handles generating the diagnostic messages for an invalid 8217 /// function redeclaration, including finding possible similar declarations 8218 /// or performing typo correction if there are no previous declarations with 8219 /// the same name. 8220 /// 8221 /// Returns a NamedDecl iff typo correction was performed and substituting in 8222 /// the new declaration name does not cause new errors. 8223 static NamedDecl *DiagnoseInvalidRedeclaration( 8224 Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &Previous, FunctionDecl *NewFD, 8225 ActOnFDArgs &ExtraArgs, bool IsLocalFriend, Scope *S) { 8226 DeclarationName Name = NewFD->getDeclName(); 8227 DeclContext *NewDC = NewFD->getDeclContext(); 8228 SmallVector<unsigned, 1> MismatchedParams; 8229 SmallVector<std::pair<FunctionDecl *, unsigned>, 1> NearMatches; 8230 TypoCorrection Correction; 8231 bool IsDefinition = ExtraArgs.D.isFunctionDefinition(); 8232 unsigned DiagMsg = 8233 IsLocalFriend ? diag::err_no_matching_local_friend : 8234 NewFD->getFriendObjectKind() ? diag::err_qualified_friend_no_match : 8235 diag::err_member_decl_does_not_match; 8236 LookupResult Prev(SemaRef, Name, NewFD->getLocation(), 8237 IsLocalFriend ? Sema::LookupLocalFriendName 8238 : Sema::LookupOrdinaryName, 8239 Sema::ForVisibleRedeclaration); 8240 8241 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 8242 if (IsLocalFriend) 8243 SemaRef.LookupName(Prev, S); 8244 else 8245 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(Prev, NewDC); 8246 assert(!Prev.isAmbiguous() && 8247 "Cannot have an ambiguity in previous-declaration lookup"); 8248 CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD); 8249 DifferentNameValidatorCCC CCC(SemaRef.Context, NewFD, 8250 MD ? MD->getParent() : nullptr); 8251 if (!Prev.empty()) { 8252 for (LookupResult::iterator Func = Prev.begin(), FuncEnd = Prev.end(); 8253 Func != FuncEnd; ++Func) { 8254 FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*Func); 8255 if (FD && 8256 hasSimilarParameters(SemaRef.Context, FD, NewFD, MismatchedParams)) { 8257 // Add 1 to the index so that 0 can mean the mismatch didn't 8258 // involve a parameter 8259 unsigned ParamNum = 8260 MismatchedParams.empty() ? 0 : MismatchedParams.front() + 1; 8261 NearMatches.push_back(std::make_pair(FD, ParamNum)); 8262 } 8263 } 8264 // If the qualified name lookup yielded nothing, try typo correction 8265 } else if ((Correction = SemaRef.CorrectTypo( 8266 Prev.getLookupNameInfo(), Prev.getLookupKind(), S, 8267 &ExtraArgs.D.getCXXScopeSpec(), CCC, Sema::CTK_ErrorRecovery, 8268 IsLocalFriend ? nullptr : NewDC))) { 8269 // Set up everything for the call to ActOnFunctionDeclarator 8270 ExtraArgs.D.SetIdentifier(Correction.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo(), 8271 ExtraArgs.D.getIdentifierLoc()); 8272 Previous.clear(); 8273 Previous.setLookupName(Correction.getCorrection()); 8274 for (TypoCorrection::decl_iterator CDecl = Correction.begin(), 8275 CDeclEnd = Correction.end(); 8276 CDecl != CDeclEnd; ++CDecl) { 8277 FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*CDecl); 8278 if (FD && !FD->hasBody() && 8279 hasSimilarParameters(SemaRef.Context, FD, NewFD, MismatchedParams)) { 8280 Previous.addDecl(FD); 8281 } 8282 } 8283 bool wasRedeclaration = ExtraArgs.D.isRedeclaration(); 8284 8285 NamedDecl *Result; 8286 // Retry building the function declaration with the new previous 8287 // declarations, and with errors suppressed. 8288 { 8289 // Trap errors. 8290 Sema::SFINAETrap Trap(SemaRef); 8291 8292 // TODO: Refactor ActOnFunctionDeclarator so that we can call only the 8293 // pieces need to verify the typo-corrected C++ declaration and hopefully 8294 // eliminate the need for the parameter pack ExtraArgs. 8295 Result = SemaRef.ActOnFunctionDeclarator( 8296 ExtraArgs.S, ExtraArgs.D, 8297 Correction.getCorrectionDecl()->getDeclContext(), 8298 NewFD->getTypeSourceInfo(), Previous, ExtraArgs.TemplateParamLists, 8299 ExtraArgs.AddToScope); 8300 8301 if (Trap.hasErrorOccurred()) 8302 Result = nullptr; 8303 } 8304 8305 if (Result) { 8306 // Determine which correction we picked. 8307 Decl *Canonical = Result->getCanonicalDecl(); 8308 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Previous.begin(), E = Previous.end(); 8309 I != E; ++I) 8310 if ((*I)->getCanonicalDecl() == Canonical) 8311 Correction.setCorrectionDecl(*I); 8312 8313 // Let Sema know about the correction. 8314 SemaRef.MarkTypoCorrectedFunctionDefinition(Result); 8315 SemaRef.diagnoseTypo( 8316 Correction, 8317 SemaRef.PDiag(IsLocalFriend 8318 ? diag::err_no_matching_local_friend_suggest 8319 : diag::err_member_decl_does_not_match_suggest) 8320 << Name << NewDC << IsDefinition); 8321 return Result; 8322 } 8323 8324 // Pretend the typo correction never occurred 8325 ExtraArgs.D.SetIdentifier(Name.getAsIdentifierInfo(), 8326 ExtraArgs.D.getIdentifierLoc()); 8327 ExtraArgs.D.setRedeclaration(wasRedeclaration); 8328 Previous.clear(); 8329 Previous.setLookupName(Name); 8330 } 8331 8332 SemaRef.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), DiagMsg) 8333 << Name << NewDC << IsDefinition << NewFD->getLocation(); 8334 8335 bool NewFDisConst = false; 8336 if (CXXMethodDecl *NewMD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD)) 8337 NewFDisConst = NewMD->isConst(); 8338 8339 for (SmallVectorImpl<std::pair<FunctionDecl *, unsigned> >::iterator 8340 NearMatch = NearMatches.begin(), NearMatchEnd = NearMatches.end(); 8341 NearMatch != NearMatchEnd; ++NearMatch) { 8342 FunctionDecl *FD = NearMatch->first; 8343 CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD); 8344 bool FDisConst = MD && MD->isConst(); 8345 bool IsMember = MD || !IsLocalFriend; 8346 8347 // FIXME: These notes are poorly worded for the local friend case. 8348 if (unsigned Idx = NearMatch->second) { 8349 ParmVarDecl *FDParam = FD->getParamDecl(Idx-1); 8350 SourceLocation Loc = FDParam->getTypeSpecStartLoc(); 8351 if (Loc.isInvalid()) Loc = FD->getLocation(); 8352 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, IsMember ? diag::note_member_def_close_param_match 8353 : diag::note_local_decl_close_param_match) 8354 << Idx << FDParam->getType() 8355 << NewFD->getParamDecl(Idx - 1)->getType(); 8356 } else if (FDisConst != NewFDisConst) { 8357 SemaRef.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_member_def_close_const_match) 8358 << NewFDisConst << FD->getSourceRange().getEnd(); 8359 } else 8360 SemaRef.Diag(FD->getLocation(), 8361 IsMember ? diag::note_member_def_close_match 8362 : diag::note_local_decl_close_match); 8363 } 8364 return nullptr; 8365 } 8366 8367 static StorageClass getFunctionStorageClass(Sema &SemaRef, Declarator &D) { 8368 switch (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec()) { 8369 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown storage class!"); 8370 case DeclSpec::SCS_auto: 8371 case DeclSpec::SCS_register: 8372 case DeclSpec::SCS_mutable: 8373 SemaRef.Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 8374 diag::err_typecheck_sclass_func); 8375 D.getMutableDeclSpec().ClearStorageClassSpecs(); 8376 D.setInvalidType(); 8377 break; 8378 case DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified: break; 8379 case DeclSpec::SCS_extern: 8380 if (D.getDeclSpec().isExternInLinkageSpec()) 8381 return SC_None; 8382 return SC_Extern; 8383 case DeclSpec::SCS_static: { 8384 if (SemaRef.CurContext->getRedeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()) { 8385 // C99 6.7.1p5: 8386 // The declaration of an identifier for a function that has 8387 // block scope shall have no explicit storage-class specifier 8388 // other than extern 8389 // See also (C++ [dcl.stc]p4). 8390 SemaRef.Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 8391 diag::err_static_block_func); 8392 break; 8393 } else 8394 return SC_Static; 8395 } 8396 case DeclSpec::SCS_private_extern: return SC_PrivateExtern; 8397 } 8398 8399 // No explicit storage class has already been returned 8400 return SC_None; 8401 } 8402 8403 static FunctionDecl *CreateNewFunctionDecl(Sema &SemaRef, Declarator &D, 8404 DeclContext *DC, QualType &R, 8405 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, 8406 StorageClass SC, 8407 bool &IsVirtualOkay) { 8408 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo = SemaRef.GetNameForDeclarator(D); 8409 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName(); 8410 8411 FunctionDecl *NewFD = nullptr; 8412 bool isInline = D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified(); 8413 8414 if (!SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 8415 // Determine whether the function was written with a 8416 // prototype. This true when: 8417 // - there is a prototype in the declarator, or 8418 // - the type R of the function is some kind of typedef or other non- 8419 // attributed reference to a type name (which eventually refers to a 8420 // function type). 8421 bool HasPrototype = 8422 (D.isFunctionDeclarator() && D.getFunctionTypeInfo().hasPrototype) || 8423 (!R->getAsAdjusted<FunctionType>() && R->isFunctionProtoType()); 8424 8425 NewFD = FunctionDecl::Create(SemaRef.Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, 8426 R, TInfo, SC, isInline, HasPrototype, 8427 CSK_unspecified, 8428 /*TrailingRequiresClause=*/nullptr); 8429 if (D.isInvalidType()) 8430 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 8431 8432 return NewFD; 8433 } 8434 8435 ExplicitSpecifier ExplicitSpecifier = D.getDeclSpec().getExplicitSpecifier(); 8436 8437 ConstexprSpecKind ConstexprKind = D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier(); 8438 if (ConstexprKind == CSK_constinit) { 8439 SemaRef.Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(), 8440 diag::err_constexpr_wrong_decl_kind) 8441 << ConstexprKind; 8442 ConstexprKind = CSK_unspecified; 8443 D.getMutableDeclSpec().ClearConstexprSpec(); 8444 } 8445 Expr *TrailingRequiresClause = D.getTrailingRequiresClause(); 8446 8447 // Check that the return type is not an abstract class type. 8448 // For record types, this is done by the AbstractClassUsageDiagnoser once 8449 // the class has been completely parsed. 8450 if (!DC->isRecord() && 8451 SemaRef.RequireNonAbstractType( 8452 D.getIdentifierLoc(), R->castAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(), 8453 diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, SemaRef.AbstractReturnType)) 8454 D.setInvalidType(); 8455 8456 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConstructorName) { 8457 // This is a C++ constructor declaration. 8458 assert(DC->isRecord() && 8459 "Constructors can only be declared in a member context"); 8460 8461 R = SemaRef.CheckConstructorDeclarator(D, R, SC); 8462 return CXXConstructorDecl::Create( 8463 SemaRef.Context, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC), D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R, 8464 TInfo, ExplicitSpecifier, isInline, 8465 /*isImplicitlyDeclared=*/false, ConstexprKind, InheritedConstructor(), 8466 TrailingRequiresClause); 8467 8468 } else if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) { 8469 // This is a C++ destructor declaration. 8470 if (DC->isRecord()) { 8471 R = SemaRef.CheckDestructorDeclarator(D, R, SC); 8472 CXXRecordDecl *Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC); 8473 CXXDestructorDecl *NewDD = CXXDestructorDecl::Create( 8474 SemaRef.Context, Record, D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R, TInfo, 8475 isInline, /*isImplicitlyDeclared=*/false, ConstexprKind, 8476 TrailingRequiresClause); 8477 8478 // If the destructor needs an implicit exception specification, set it 8479 // now. FIXME: It'd be nice to be able to create the right type to start 8480 // with, but the type needs to reference the destructor declaration. 8481 if (SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) 8482 SemaRef.AdjustDestructorExceptionSpec(NewDD); 8483 8484 IsVirtualOkay = true; 8485 return NewDD; 8486 8487 } else { 8488 SemaRef.Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_destructor_not_member); 8489 D.setInvalidType(); 8490 8491 // Create a FunctionDecl to satisfy the function definition parsing 8492 // code path. 8493 return FunctionDecl::Create(SemaRef.Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), 8494 D.getIdentifierLoc(), Name, R, TInfo, SC, 8495 isInline, 8496 /*hasPrototype=*/true, ConstexprKind, 8497 TrailingRequiresClause); 8498 } 8499 8500 } else if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) { 8501 if (!DC->isRecord()) { 8502 SemaRef.Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 8503 diag::err_conv_function_not_member); 8504 return nullptr; 8505 } 8506 8507 SemaRef.CheckConversionDeclarator(D, R, SC); 8508 if (D.isInvalidType()) 8509 return nullptr; 8510 8511 IsVirtualOkay = true; 8512 return CXXConversionDecl::Create( 8513 SemaRef.Context, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC), D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R, 8514 TInfo, isInline, ExplicitSpecifier, ConstexprKind, SourceLocation(), 8515 TrailingRequiresClause); 8516 8517 } else if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXDeductionGuideName) { 8518 if (TrailingRequiresClause) 8519 SemaRef.Diag(TrailingRequiresClause->getBeginLoc(), 8520 diag::err_trailing_requires_clause_on_deduction_guide) 8521 << TrailingRequiresClause->getSourceRange(); 8522 SemaRef.CheckDeductionGuideDeclarator(D, R, SC); 8523 8524 return CXXDeductionGuideDecl::Create(SemaRef.Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), 8525 ExplicitSpecifier, NameInfo, R, TInfo, 8526 D.getEndLoc()); 8527 } else if (DC->isRecord()) { 8528 // If the name of the function is the same as the name of the record, 8529 // then this must be an invalid constructor that has a return type. 8530 // (The parser checks for a return type and makes the declarator a 8531 // constructor if it has no return type). 8532 if (Name.getAsIdentifierInfo() && 8533 Name.getAsIdentifierInfo() == cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->getIdentifier()){ 8534 SemaRef.Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_constructor_return_type) 8535 << SourceRange(D.getDeclSpec().getTypeSpecTypeLoc()) 8536 << SourceRange(D.getIdentifierLoc()); 8537 return nullptr; 8538 } 8539 8540 // This is a C++ method declaration. 8541 CXXMethodDecl *Ret = CXXMethodDecl::Create( 8542 SemaRef.Context, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC), D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R, 8543 TInfo, SC, isInline, ConstexprKind, SourceLocation(), 8544 TrailingRequiresClause); 8545 IsVirtualOkay = !Ret->isStatic(); 8546 return Ret; 8547 } else { 8548 bool isFriend = 8549 SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified(); 8550 if (!isFriend && SemaRef.CurContext->isRecord()) 8551 return nullptr; 8552 8553 // Determine whether the function was written with a 8554 // prototype. This true when: 8555 // - we're in C++ (where every function has a prototype), 8556 return FunctionDecl::Create(SemaRef.Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, 8557 R, TInfo, SC, isInline, true /*HasPrototype*/, 8558 ConstexprKind, TrailingRequiresClause); 8559 } 8560 } 8561 8562 enum OpenCLParamType { 8563 ValidKernelParam, 8564 PtrPtrKernelParam, 8565 PtrKernelParam, 8566 InvalidAddrSpacePtrKernelParam, 8567 InvalidKernelParam, 8568 RecordKernelParam 8569 }; 8570 8571 static bool isOpenCLSizeDependentType(ASTContext &C, QualType Ty) { 8572 // Size dependent types are just typedefs to normal integer types 8573 // (e.g. unsigned long), so we cannot distinguish them from other typedefs to 8574 // integers other than by their names. 8575 StringRef SizeTypeNames[] = {"size_t", "intptr_t", "uintptr_t", "ptrdiff_t"}; 8576 8577 // Remove typedefs one by one until we reach a typedef 8578 // for a size dependent type. 8579 QualType DesugaredTy = Ty; 8580 do { 8581 ArrayRef<StringRef> Names(SizeTypeNames); 8582 auto Match = llvm::find(Names, DesugaredTy.getUnqualifiedType().getAsString()); 8583 if (Names.end() != Match) 8584 return true; 8585 8586 Ty = DesugaredTy; 8587 DesugaredTy = Ty.getSingleStepDesugaredType(C); 8588 } while (DesugaredTy != Ty); 8589 8590 return false; 8591 } 8592 8593 static OpenCLParamType getOpenCLKernelParameterType(Sema &S, QualType PT) { 8594 if (PT->isPointerType()) { 8595 QualType PointeeType = PT->getPointeeType(); 8596 if (PointeeType->isPointerType()) 8597 return PtrPtrKernelParam; 8598 if (PointeeType.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_generic || 8599 PointeeType.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_private || 8600 PointeeType.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::Default) 8601 return InvalidAddrSpacePtrKernelParam; 8602 return PtrKernelParam; 8603 } 8604 8605 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.k: 8606 // Arguments to kernel functions in a program cannot be declared with the 8607 // built-in scalar types bool, half, size_t, ptrdiff_t, intptr_t, and 8608 // uintptr_t or a struct and/or union that contain fields declared to be one 8609 // of these built-in scalar types. 8610 if (isOpenCLSizeDependentType(S.getASTContext(), PT)) 8611 return InvalidKernelParam; 8612 8613 if (PT->isImageType()) 8614 return PtrKernelParam; 8615 8616 if (PT->isBooleanType() || PT->isEventT() || PT->isReserveIDT()) 8617 return InvalidKernelParam; 8618 8619 // OpenCL extension spec v1.2 s9.5: 8620 // This extension adds support for half scalar and vector types as built-in 8621 // types that can be used for arithmetic operations, conversions etc. 8622 if (!S.getOpenCLOptions().isEnabled("cl_khr_fp16") && PT->isHalfType()) 8623 return InvalidKernelParam; 8624 8625 if (PT->isRecordType()) 8626 return RecordKernelParam; 8627 8628 // Look into an array argument to check if it has a forbidden type. 8629 if (PT->isArrayType()) { 8630 const Type *UnderlyingTy = PT->getPointeeOrArrayElementType(); 8631 // Call ourself to check an underlying type of an array. Since the 8632 // getPointeeOrArrayElementType returns an innermost type which is not an 8633 // array, this recursive call only happens once. 8634 return getOpenCLKernelParameterType(S, QualType(UnderlyingTy, 0)); 8635 } 8636 8637 return ValidKernelParam; 8638 } 8639 8640 static void checkIsValidOpenCLKernelParameter( 8641 Sema &S, 8642 Declarator &D, 8643 ParmVarDecl *Param, 8644 llvm::SmallPtrSetImpl<const Type *> &ValidTypes) { 8645 QualType PT = Param->getType(); 8646 8647 // Cache the valid types we encounter to avoid rechecking structs that are 8648 // used again 8649 if (ValidTypes.count(PT.getTypePtr())) 8650 return; 8651 8652 switch (getOpenCLKernelParameterType(S, PT)) { 8653 case PtrPtrKernelParam: 8654 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.a: 8655 // A kernel function argument cannot be declared as a 8656 // pointer to a pointer type. 8657 S.Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_ptrptr_kernel_param); 8658 D.setInvalidType(); 8659 return; 8660 8661 case InvalidAddrSpacePtrKernelParam: 8662 // OpenCL v1.0 s6.5: 8663 // __kernel function arguments declared to be a pointer of a type can point 8664 // to one of the following address spaces only : __global, __local or 8665 // __constant. 8666 S.Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_kernel_arg_address_space); 8667 D.setInvalidType(); 8668 return; 8669 8670 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.k: 8671 // Arguments to kernel functions in a program cannot be declared with the 8672 // built-in scalar types bool, half, size_t, ptrdiff_t, intptr_t, and 8673 // uintptr_t or a struct and/or union that contain fields declared to be 8674 // one of these built-in scalar types. 8675 8676 case InvalidKernelParam: 8677 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.8 n: 8678 // A kernel function argument cannot be declared 8679 // of event_t type. 8680 // Do not diagnose half type since it is diagnosed as invalid argument 8681 // type for any function elsewhere. 8682 if (!PT->isHalfType()) { 8683 S.Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_bad_kernel_param_type) << PT; 8684 8685 // Explain what typedefs are involved. 8686 const TypedefType *Typedef = nullptr; 8687 while ((Typedef = PT->getAs<TypedefType>())) { 8688 SourceLocation Loc = Typedef->getDecl()->getLocation(); 8689 // SourceLocation may be invalid for a built-in type. 8690 if (Loc.isValid()) 8691 S.Diag(Loc, diag::note_entity_declared_at) << PT; 8692 PT = Typedef->desugar(); 8693 } 8694 } 8695 8696 D.setInvalidType(); 8697 return; 8698 8699 case PtrKernelParam: 8700 case ValidKernelParam: 8701 ValidTypes.insert(PT.getTypePtr()); 8702 return; 8703 8704 case RecordKernelParam: 8705 break; 8706 } 8707 8708 // Track nested structs we will inspect 8709 SmallVector<const Decl *, 4> VisitStack; 8710 8711 // Track where we are in the nested structs. Items will migrate from 8712 // VisitStack to HistoryStack as we do the DFS for bad field. 8713 SmallVector<const FieldDecl *, 4> HistoryStack; 8714 HistoryStack.push_back(nullptr); 8715 8716 // At this point we already handled everything except of a RecordType or 8717 // an ArrayType of a RecordType. 8718 assert((PT->isArrayType() || PT->isRecordType()) && "Unexpected type."); 8719 const RecordType *RecTy = 8720 PT->getPointeeOrArrayElementType()->getAs<RecordType>(); 8721 const RecordDecl *OrigRecDecl = RecTy->getDecl(); 8722 8723 VisitStack.push_back(RecTy->getDecl()); 8724 assert(VisitStack.back() && "First decl null?"); 8725 8726 do { 8727 const Decl *Next = VisitStack.pop_back_val(); 8728 if (!Next) { 8729 assert(!HistoryStack.empty()); 8730 // Found a marker, we have gone up a level 8731 if (const FieldDecl *Hist = HistoryStack.pop_back_val()) 8732 ValidTypes.insert(Hist->getType().getTypePtr()); 8733 8734 continue; 8735 } 8736 8737 // Adds everything except the original parameter declaration (which is not a 8738 // field itself) to the history stack. 8739 const RecordDecl *RD; 8740 if (const FieldDecl *Field = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(Next)) { 8741 HistoryStack.push_back(Field); 8742 8743 QualType FieldTy = Field->getType(); 8744 // Other field types (known to be valid or invalid) are handled while we 8745 // walk around RecordDecl::fields(). 8746 assert((FieldTy->isArrayType() || FieldTy->isRecordType()) && 8747 "Unexpected type."); 8748 const Type *FieldRecTy = FieldTy->getPointeeOrArrayElementType(); 8749 8750 RD = FieldRecTy->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl(); 8751 } else { 8752 RD = cast<RecordDecl>(Next); 8753 } 8754 8755 // Add a null marker so we know when we've gone back up a level 8756 VisitStack.push_back(nullptr); 8757 8758 for (const auto *FD : RD->fields()) { 8759 QualType QT = FD->getType(); 8760 8761 if (ValidTypes.count(QT.getTypePtr())) 8762 continue; 8763 8764 OpenCLParamType ParamType = getOpenCLKernelParameterType(S, QT); 8765 if (ParamType == ValidKernelParam) 8766 continue; 8767 8768 if (ParamType == RecordKernelParam) { 8769 VisitStack.push_back(FD); 8770 continue; 8771 } 8772 8773 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.p: 8774 // Arguments to kernel functions that are declared to be a struct or union 8775 // do not allow OpenCL objects to be passed as elements of the struct or 8776 // union. 8777 if (ParamType == PtrKernelParam || ParamType == PtrPtrKernelParam || 8778 ParamType == InvalidAddrSpacePtrKernelParam) { 8779 S.Diag(Param->getLocation(), 8780 diag::err_record_with_pointers_kernel_param) 8781 << PT->isUnionType() 8782 << PT; 8783 } else { 8784 S.Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_bad_kernel_param_type) << PT; 8785 } 8786 8787 S.Diag(OrigRecDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_within_field_of_type) 8788 << OrigRecDecl->getDeclName(); 8789 8790 // We have an error, now let's go back up through history and show where 8791 // the offending field came from 8792 for (ArrayRef<const FieldDecl *>::const_iterator 8793 I = HistoryStack.begin() + 1, 8794 E = HistoryStack.end(); 8795 I != E; ++I) { 8796 const FieldDecl *OuterField = *I; 8797 S.Diag(OuterField->getLocation(), diag::note_within_field_of_type) 8798 << OuterField->getType(); 8799 } 8800 8801 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_illegal_field_declared_here) 8802 << QT->isPointerType() 8803 << QT; 8804 D.setInvalidType(); 8805 return; 8806 } 8807 } while (!VisitStack.empty()); 8808 } 8809 8810 /// Find the DeclContext in which a tag is implicitly declared if we see an 8811 /// elaborated type specifier in the specified context, and lookup finds 8812 /// nothing. 8813 static DeclContext *getTagInjectionContext(DeclContext *DC) { 8814 while (!DC->isFileContext() && !DC->isFunctionOrMethod()) 8815 DC = DC->getParent(); 8816 return DC; 8817 } 8818 8819 /// Find the Scope in which a tag is implicitly declared if we see an 8820 /// elaborated type specifier in the specified context, and lookup finds 8821 /// nothing. 8822 static Scope *getTagInjectionScope(Scope *S, const LangOptions &LangOpts) { 8823 while (S->isClassScope() || 8824 (LangOpts.CPlusPlus && 8825 S->isFunctionPrototypeScope()) || 8826 ((S->getFlags() & Scope::DeclScope) == 0) || 8827 (S->getEntity() && S->getEntity()->isTransparentContext())) 8828 S = S->getParent(); 8829 return S; 8830 } 8831 8832 NamedDecl* 8833 Sema::ActOnFunctionDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D, DeclContext *DC, 8834 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, LookupResult &Previous, 8835 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParamListsRef, 8836 bool &AddToScope) { 8837 QualType R = TInfo->getType(); 8838 8839 assert(R->isFunctionType()); 8840 if (R.getCanonicalType()->castAs<FunctionType>()->getCmseNSCallAttr()) 8841 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_function_decl_cmse_ns_call); 8842 8843 SmallVector<TemplateParameterList *, 4> TemplateParamLists; 8844 for (TemplateParameterList *TPL : TemplateParamListsRef) 8845 TemplateParamLists.push_back(TPL); 8846 if (TemplateParameterList *Invented = D.getInventedTemplateParameterList()) { 8847 if (!TemplateParamLists.empty() && 8848 Invented->getDepth() == TemplateParamLists.back()->getDepth()) 8849 TemplateParamLists.back() = Invented; 8850 else 8851 TemplateParamLists.push_back(Invented); 8852 } 8853 8854 // TODO: consider using NameInfo for diagnostic. 8855 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo = GetNameForDeclarator(D); 8856 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName(); 8857 StorageClass SC = getFunctionStorageClass(*this, D); 8858 8859 if (DeclSpec::TSCS TSCS = D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpec()) 8860 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), 8861 diag::err_invalid_thread) 8862 << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSCS); 8863 8864 if (D.isFirstDeclarationOfMember()) 8865 adjustMemberFunctionCC(R, D.isStaticMember(), D.isCtorOrDtor(), 8866 D.getIdentifierLoc()); 8867 8868 bool isFriend = false; 8869 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate = nullptr; 8870 bool isMemberSpecialization = false; 8871 bool isFunctionTemplateSpecialization = false; 8872 8873 bool isDependentClassScopeExplicitSpecialization = false; 8874 bool HasExplicitTemplateArgs = false; 8875 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgs; 8876 8877 bool isVirtualOkay = false; 8878 8879 DeclContext *OriginalDC = DC; 8880 bool IsLocalExternDecl = adjustContextForLocalExternDecl(DC); 8881 8882 FunctionDecl *NewFD = CreateNewFunctionDecl(*this, D, DC, R, TInfo, SC, 8883 isVirtualOkay); 8884 if (!NewFD) return nullptr; 8885 8886 if (OriginalLexicalContext && OriginalLexicalContext->isObjCContainer()) 8887 NewFD->setTopLevelDeclInObjCContainer(); 8888 8889 // Set the lexical context. If this is a function-scope declaration, or has a 8890 // C++ scope specifier, or is the object of a friend declaration, the lexical 8891 // context will be different from the semantic context. 8892 NewFD->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext); 8893 8894 if (IsLocalExternDecl) 8895 NewFD->setLocalExternDecl(); 8896 8897 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 8898 bool isInline = D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified(); 8899 bool isVirtual = D.getDeclSpec().isVirtualSpecified(); 8900 bool hasExplicit = D.getDeclSpec().hasExplicitSpecifier(); 8901 isFriend = D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified(); 8902 if (isFriend && !isInline && D.isFunctionDefinition()) { 8903 // C++ [class.friend]p5 8904 // A function can be defined in a friend declaration of a 8905 // class . . . . Such a function is implicitly inline. 8906 NewFD->setImplicitlyInline(); 8907 } 8908 8909 // If this is a method defined in an __interface, and is not a constructor 8910 // or an overloaded operator, then set the pure flag (isVirtual will already 8911 // return true). 8912 if (const CXXRecordDecl *Parent = 8913 dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(NewFD->getDeclContext())) { 8914 if (Parent->isInterface() && cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD)->isUserProvided()) 8915 NewFD->setPure(true); 8916 8917 // C++ [class.union]p2 8918 // A union can have member functions, but not virtual functions. 8919 if (isVirtual && Parent->isUnion()) 8920 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc(), diag::err_virtual_in_union); 8921 } 8922 8923 SetNestedNameSpecifier(*this, NewFD, D); 8924 isMemberSpecialization = false; 8925 isFunctionTemplateSpecialization = false; 8926 if (D.isInvalidType()) 8927 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 8928 8929 // Match up the template parameter lists with the scope specifier, then 8930 // determine whether we have a template or a template specialization. 8931 bool Invalid = false; 8932 TemplateParameterList *TemplateParams = 8933 MatchTemplateParametersToScopeSpecifier( 8934 D.getDeclSpec().getBeginLoc(), D.getIdentifierLoc(), 8935 D.getCXXScopeSpec(), 8936 D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId 8937 ? D.getName().TemplateId 8938 : nullptr, 8939 TemplateParamLists, isFriend, isMemberSpecialization, 8940 Invalid); 8941 if (TemplateParams) { 8942 // Check that we can declare a template here. 8943 if (CheckTemplateDeclScope(S, TemplateParams)) 8944 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 8945 8946 if (TemplateParams->size() > 0) { 8947 // This is a function template 8948 8949 // A destructor cannot be a template. 8950 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) { 8951 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_destructor_template); 8952 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 8953 } 8954 8955 // If we're adding a template to a dependent context, we may need to 8956 // rebuilding some of the types used within the template parameter list, 8957 // now that we know what the current instantiation is. 8958 if (DC->isDependentContext()) { 8959 ContextRAII SavedContext(*this, DC); 8960 if (RebuildTemplateParamsInCurrentInstantiation(TemplateParams)) 8961 Invalid = true; 8962 } 8963 8964 FunctionTemplate = FunctionTemplateDecl::Create(Context, DC, 8965 NewFD->getLocation(), 8966 Name, TemplateParams, 8967 NewFD); 8968 FunctionTemplate->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext); 8969 NewFD->setDescribedFunctionTemplate(FunctionTemplate); 8970 8971 // For source fidelity, store the other template param lists. 8972 if (TemplateParamLists.size() > 1) { 8973 NewFD->setTemplateParameterListsInfo(Context, 8974 ArrayRef<TemplateParameterList *>(TemplateParamLists) 8975 .drop_back(1)); 8976 } 8977 } else { 8978 // This is a function template specialization. 8979 isFunctionTemplateSpecialization = true; 8980 // For source fidelity, store all the template param lists. 8981 if (TemplateParamLists.size() > 0) 8982 NewFD->setTemplateParameterListsInfo(Context, TemplateParamLists); 8983 8984 // C++0x [temp.expl.spec]p20 forbids "template<> friend void foo(int);". 8985 if (isFriend) { 8986 // We want to remove the "template<>", found here. 8987 SourceRange RemoveRange = TemplateParams->getSourceRange(); 8988 8989 // If we remove the template<> and the name is not a 8990 // template-id, we're actually silently creating a problem: 8991 // the friend declaration will refer to an untemplated decl, 8992 // and clearly the user wants a template specialization. So 8993 // we need to insert '<>' after the name. 8994 SourceLocation InsertLoc; 8995 if (D.getName().getKind() != UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId) { 8996 InsertLoc = D.getName().getSourceRange().getEnd(); 8997 InsertLoc = getLocForEndOfToken(InsertLoc); 8998 } 8999 9000 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_template_spec_decl_friend) 9001 << Name << RemoveRange 9002 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(RemoveRange) 9003 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(InsertLoc, "<>"); 9004 } 9005 } 9006 } else { 9007 // Check that we can declare a template here. 9008 if (!TemplateParamLists.empty() && isMemberSpecialization && 9009 CheckTemplateDeclScope(S, TemplateParamLists.back())) 9010 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9011 9012 // All template param lists were matched against the scope specifier: 9013 // this is NOT (an explicit specialization of) a template. 9014 if (TemplateParamLists.size() > 0) 9015 // For source fidelity, store all the template param lists. 9016 NewFD->setTemplateParameterListsInfo(Context, TemplateParamLists); 9017 } 9018 9019 if (Invalid) { 9020 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9021 if (FunctionTemplate) 9022 FunctionTemplate->setInvalidDecl(); 9023 } 9024 9025 // C++ [dcl.fct.spec]p5: 9026 // The virtual specifier shall only be used in declarations of 9027 // nonstatic class member functions that appear within a 9028 // member-specification of a class declaration; see 10.3. 9029 // 9030 if (isVirtual && !NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) { 9031 if (!isVirtualOkay) { 9032 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc(), 9033 diag::err_virtual_non_function); 9034 } else if (!CurContext->isRecord()) { 9035 // 'virtual' was specified outside of the class. 9036 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc(), 9037 diag::err_virtual_out_of_class) 9038 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc()); 9039 } else if (NewFD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) { 9040 // C++ [temp.mem]p3: 9041 // A member function template shall not be virtual. 9042 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc(), 9043 diag::err_virtual_member_function_template) 9044 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc()); 9045 } else { 9046 // Okay: Add virtual to the method. 9047 NewFD->setVirtualAsWritten(true); 9048 } 9049 9050 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && 9051 NewFD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType()) 9052 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc(), diag::err_auto_fn_virtual); 9053 } 9054 9055 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && 9056 (NewFD->isDependentContext() || 9057 (isFriend && CurContext->isDependentContext())) && 9058 NewFD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType()) { 9059 // If the function template is referenced directly (for instance, as a 9060 // member of the current instantiation), pretend it has a dependent type. 9061 // This is not really justified by the standard, but is the only sane 9062 // thing to do. 9063 // FIXME: For a friend function, we have not marked the function as being 9064 // a friend yet, so 'isDependentContext' on the FD doesn't work. 9065 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = 9066 NewFD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 9067 QualType Result = 9068 SubstAutoType(FPT->getReturnType(), Context.DependentTy); 9069 NewFD->setType(Context.getFunctionType(Result, FPT->getParamTypes(), 9070 FPT->getExtProtoInfo())); 9071 } 9072 9073 // C++ [dcl.fct.spec]p3: 9074 // The inline specifier shall not appear on a block scope function 9075 // declaration. 9076 if (isInline && !NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) { 9077 if (CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod()) { 9078 // 'inline' is not allowed on block scope function declaration. 9079 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), 9080 diag::err_inline_declaration_block_scope) << Name 9081 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc()); 9082 } 9083 } 9084 9085 // C++ [dcl.fct.spec]p6: 9086 // The explicit specifier shall be used only in the declaration of a 9087 // constructor or conversion function within its class definition; 9088 // see 12.3.1 and 12.3.2. 9089 if (hasExplicit && !NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && 9090 !isa<CXXDeductionGuideDecl>(NewFD)) { 9091 if (!CurContext->isRecord()) { 9092 // 'explicit' was specified outside of the class. 9093 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getExplicitSpecLoc(), 9094 diag::err_explicit_out_of_class) 9095 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getExplicitSpecRange()); 9096 } else if (!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewFD) && 9097 !isa<CXXConversionDecl>(NewFD)) { 9098 // 'explicit' was specified on a function that wasn't a constructor 9099 // or conversion function. 9100 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getExplicitSpecLoc(), 9101 diag::err_explicit_non_ctor_or_conv_function) 9102 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getExplicitSpecRange()); 9103 } 9104 } 9105 9106 if (ConstexprSpecKind ConstexprKind = 9107 D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier()) { 9108 // C++11 [dcl.constexpr]p2: constexpr functions and constexpr constructors 9109 // are implicitly inline. 9110 NewFD->setImplicitlyInline(); 9111 9112 // C++11 [dcl.constexpr]p3: functions declared constexpr are required to 9113 // be either constructors or to return a literal type. Therefore, 9114 // destructors cannot be declared constexpr. 9115 if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(NewFD) && 9116 (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20 || ConstexprKind == CSK_consteval)) { 9117 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_constexpr_dtor) 9118 << ConstexprKind; 9119 NewFD->setConstexprKind(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20 ? CSK_unspecified : CSK_constexpr); 9120 } 9121 // C++20 [dcl.constexpr]p2: An allocation function, or a 9122 // deallocation function shall not be declared with the consteval 9123 // specifier. 9124 if (ConstexprKind == CSK_consteval && 9125 (NewFD->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_New || 9126 NewFD->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Array_New || 9127 NewFD->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Delete || 9128 NewFD->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Array_Delete)) { 9129 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(), 9130 diag::err_invalid_consteval_decl_kind) 9131 << NewFD; 9132 NewFD->setConstexprKind(CSK_constexpr); 9133 } 9134 } 9135 9136 // If __module_private__ was specified, mark the function accordingly. 9137 if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified()) { 9138 if (isFunctionTemplateSpecialization) { 9139 SourceLocation ModulePrivateLoc 9140 = D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc(); 9141 Diag(ModulePrivateLoc, diag::err_module_private_specialization) 9142 << 0 9143 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ModulePrivateLoc); 9144 } else { 9145 NewFD->setModulePrivate(); 9146 if (FunctionTemplate) 9147 FunctionTemplate->setModulePrivate(); 9148 } 9149 } 9150 9151 if (isFriend) { 9152 if (FunctionTemplate) { 9153 FunctionTemplate->setObjectOfFriendDecl(); 9154 FunctionTemplate->setAccess(AS_public); 9155 } 9156 NewFD->setObjectOfFriendDecl(); 9157 NewFD->setAccess(AS_public); 9158 } 9159 9160 // If a function is defined as defaulted or deleted, mark it as such now. 9161 // We'll do the relevant checks on defaulted / deleted functions later. 9162 switch (D.getFunctionDefinitionKind()) { 9163 case FDK_Declaration: 9164 case FDK_Definition: 9165 break; 9166 9167 case FDK_Defaulted: 9168 NewFD->setDefaulted(); 9169 break; 9170 9171 case FDK_Deleted: 9172 NewFD->setDeletedAsWritten(); 9173 break; 9174 } 9175 9176 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD) && DC == CurContext && 9177 D.isFunctionDefinition()) { 9178 // C++ [class.mfct]p2: 9179 // A member function may be defined (8.4) in its class definition, in 9180 // which case it is an inline member function (7.1.2) 9181 NewFD->setImplicitlyInline(); 9182 } 9183 9184 if (SC == SC_Static && isa<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD) && 9185 !CurContext->isRecord()) { 9186 // C++ [class.static]p1: 9187 // A data or function member of a class may be declared static 9188 // in a class definition, in which case it is a static member of 9189 // the class. 9190 9191 // Complain about the 'static' specifier if it's on an out-of-line 9192 // member function definition. 9193 9194 // MSVC permits the use of a 'static' storage specifier on an out-of-line 9195 // member function template declaration and class member template 9196 // declaration (MSVC versions before 2015), warn about this. 9197 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 9198 ((!getLangOpts().isCompatibleWithMSVC(LangOptions::MSVC2015) && 9199 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->getDescribedClassTemplate()) || 9200 (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && NewFD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate())) 9201 ? diag::ext_static_out_of_line : diag::err_static_out_of_line) 9202 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 9203 } 9204 9205 // C++11 [except.spec]p15: 9206 // A deallocation function with no exception-specification is treated 9207 // as if it were specified with noexcept(true). 9208 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = R->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 9209 if ((Name.getCXXOverloadedOperator() == OO_Delete || 9210 Name.getCXXOverloadedOperator() == OO_Array_Delete) && 9211 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && FPT && !FPT->hasExceptionSpec()) 9212 NewFD->setType(Context.getFunctionType( 9213 FPT->getReturnType(), FPT->getParamTypes(), 9214 FPT->getExtProtoInfo().withExceptionSpec(EST_BasicNoexcept))); 9215 } 9216 9217 // Filter out previous declarations that don't match the scope. 9218 FilterLookupForScope(Previous, OriginalDC, S, shouldConsiderLinkage(NewFD), 9219 D.getCXXScopeSpec().isNotEmpty() || 9220 isMemberSpecialization || 9221 isFunctionTemplateSpecialization); 9222 9223 // Handle GNU asm-label extension (encoded as an attribute). 9224 if (Expr *E = (Expr*) D.getAsmLabel()) { 9225 // The parser guarantees this is a string. 9226 StringLiteral *SE = cast<StringLiteral>(E); 9227 NewFD->addAttr(AsmLabelAttr::Create(Context, SE->getString(), 9228 /*IsLiteralLabel=*/true, 9229 SE->getStrTokenLoc(0))); 9230 } else if (!ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.empty()) { 9231 llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*,AsmLabelAttr*>::iterator I = 9232 ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.find(NewFD->getIdentifier()); 9233 if (I != ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.end()) { 9234 if (isDeclExternC(NewFD)) { 9235 NewFD->addAttr(I->second); 9236 ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.erase(I); 9237 } else 9238 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::warn_redefine_extname_not_applied) 9239 << /*Variable*/0 << NewFD; 9240 } 9241 } 9242 9243 // Copy the parameter declarations from the declarator D to the function 9244 // declaration NewFD, if they are available. First scavenge them into Params. 9245 SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 16> Params; 9246 unsigned FTIIdx; 9247 if (D.isFunctionDeclarator(FTIIdx)) { 9248 DeclaratorChunk::FunctionTypeInfo &FTI = D.getTypeObject(FTIIdx).Fun; 9249 9250 // Check for C99 6.7.5.3p10 - foo(void) is a non-varargs 9251 // function that takes no arguments, not a function that takes a 9252 // single void argument. 9253 // We let through "const void" here because Sema::GetTypeForDeclarator 9254 // already checks for that case. 9255 if (FTIHasNonVoidParameters(FTI) && FTI.Params[0].Param) { 9256 for (unsigned i = 0, e = FTI.NumParams; i != e; ++i) { 9257 ParmVarDecl *Param = cast<ParmVarDecl>(FTI.Params[i].Param); 9258 assert(Param->getDeclContext() != NewFD && "Was set before ?"); 9259 Param->setDeclContext(NewFD); 9260 Params.push_back(Param); 9261 9262 if (Param->isInvalidDecl()) 9263 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9264 } 9265 } 9266 9267 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 9268 // In C, find all the tag declarations from the prototype and move them 9269 // into the function DeclContext. Remove them from the surrounding tag 9270 // injection context of the function, which is typically but not always 9271 // the TU. 9272 DeclContext *PrototypeTagContext = 9273 getTagInjectionContext(NewFD->getLexicalDeclContext()); 9274 for (NamedDecl *NonParmDecl : FTI.getDeclsInPrototype()) { 9275 auto *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(NonParmDecl); 9276 9277 // We don't want to reparent enumerators. Look at their parent enum 9278 // instead. 9279 if (!TD) { 9280 if (auto *ECD = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(NonParmDecl)) 9281 TD = cast<EnumDecl>(ECD->getDeclContext()); 9282 } 9283 if (!TD) 9284 continue; 9285 DeclContext *TagDC = TD->getLexicalDeclContext(); 9286 if (!TagDC->containsDecl(TD)) 9287 continue; 9288 TagDC->removeDecl(TD); 9289 TD->setDeclContext(NewFD); 9290 NewFD->addDecl(TD); 9291 9292 // Preserve the lexical DeclContext if it is not the surrounding tag 9293 // injection context of the FD. In this example, the semantic context of 9294 // E will be f and the lexical context will be S, while both the 9295 // semantic and lexical contexts of S will be f: 9296 // void f(struct S { enum E { a } f; } s); 9297 if (TagDC != PrototypeTagContext) 9298 TD->setLexicalDeclContext(TagDC); 9299 } 9300 } 9301 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *FT = R->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) { 9302 // When we're declaring a function with a typedef, typeof, etc as in the 9303 // following example, we'll need to synthesize (unnamed) 9304 // parameters for use in the declaration. 9305 // 9306 // @code 9307 // typedef void fn(int); 9308 // fn f; 9309 // @endcode 9310 9311 // Synthesize a parameter for each argument type. 9312 for (const auto &AI : FT->param_types()) { 9313 ParmVarDecl *Param = 9314 BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(NewFD, D.getIdentifierLoc(), AI); 9315 Param->setScopeInfo(0, Params.size()); 9316 Params.push_back(Param); 9317 } 9318 } else { 9319 assert(R->isFunctionNoProtoType() && NewFD->getNumParams() == 0 && 9320 "Should not need args for typedef of non-prototype fn"); 9321 } 9322 9323 // Finally, we know we have the right number of parameters, install them. 9324 NewFD->setParams(Params); 9325 9326 if (D.getDeclSpec().isNoreturnSpecified()) 9327 NewFD->addAttr(C11NoReturnAttr::Create(Context, 9328 D.getDeclSpec().getNoreturnSpecLoc(), 9329 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Keyword)); 9330 9331 // Functions returning a variably modified type violate C99 6.7.5.2p2 9332 // because all functions have linkage. 9333 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && 9334 NewFD->getReturnType()->isVariablyModifiedType()) { 9335 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_vm_func_decl); 9336 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9337 } 9338 9339 // Apply an implicit SectionAttr if '#pragma clang section text' is active 9340 if (PragmaClangTextSection.Valid && D.isFunctionDefinition() && 9341 !NewFD->hasAttr<SectionAttr>()) 9342 NewFD->addAttr(PragmaClangTextSectionAttr::CreateImplicit( 9343 Context, PragmaClangTextSection.SectionName, 9344 PragmaClangTextSection.PragmaLocation, AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma)); 9345 9346 // Apply an implicit SectionAttr if #pragma code_seg is active. 9347 if (CodeSegStack.CurrentValue && D.isFunctionDefinition() && 9348 !NewFD->hasAttr<SectionAttr>()) { 9349 NewFD->addAttr(SectionAttr::CreateImplicit( 9350 Context, CodeSegStack.CurrentValue->getString(), 9351 CodeSegStack.CurrentPragmaLocation, AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma, 9352 SectionAttr::Declspec_allocate)); 9353 if (UnifySection(CodeSegStack.CurrentValue->getString(), 9354 ASTContext::PSF_Implicit | ASTContext::PSF_Execute | 9355 ASTContext::PSF_Read, 9356 NewFD)) 9357 NewFD->dropAttr<SectionAttr>(); 9358 } 9359 9360 // Apply an implicit CodeSegAttr from class declspec or 9361 // apply an implicit SectionAttr from #pragma code_seg if active. 9362 if (!NewFD->hasAttr<CodeSegAttr>()) { 9363 if (Attr *SAttr = getImplicitCodeSegOrSectionAttrForFunction(NewFD, 9364 D.isFunctionDefinition())) { 9365 NewFD->addAttr(SAttr); 9366 } 9367 } 9368 9369 // Handle attributes. 9370 ProcessDeclAttributes(S, NewFD, D); 9371 9372 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 9373 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.5: Using an address space qualifier in a function return 9374 // type declaration will generate a compilation error. 9375 LangAS AddressSpace = NewFD->getReturnType().getAddressSpace(); 9376 if (AddressSpace != LangAS::Default) { 9377 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), 9378 diag::err_opencl_return_value_with_address_space); 9379 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9380 } 9381 } 9382 9383 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 9384 // Perform semantic checking on the function declaration. 9385 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && NewFD->isMain()) 9386 CheckMain(NewFD, D.getDeclSpec()); 9387 9388 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && NewFD->isMSVCRTEntryPoint()) 9389 CheckMSVCRTEntryPoint(NewFD); 9390 9391 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) 9392 D.setRedeclaration(CheckFunctionDeclaration(S, NewFD, Previous, 9393 isMemberSpecialization)); 9394 else if (!Previous.empty()) 9395 // Recover gracefully from an invalid redeclaration. 9396 D.setRedeclaration(true); 9397 assert((NewFD->isInvalidDecl() || !D.isRedeclaration() || 9398 Previous.getResultKind() != LookupResult::FoundOverloaded) && 9399 "previous declaration set still overloaded"); 9400 9401 // Diagnose no-prototype function declarations with calling conventions that 9402 // don't support variadic calls. Only do this in C and do it after merging 9403 // possibly prototyped redeclarations. 9404 const FunctionType *FT = NewFD->getType()->castAs<FunctionType>(); 9405 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FT) && !D.isFunctionDefinition()) { 9406 CallingConv CC = FT->getExtInfo().getCC(); 9407 if (!supportsVariadicCall(CC)) { 9408 // Windows system headers sometimes accidentally use stdcall without 9409 // (void) parameters, so we relax this to a warning. 9410 int DiagID = 9411 CC == CC_X86StdCall ? diag::warn_cconv_knr : diag::err_cconv_knr; 9412 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), DiagID) 9413 << FunctionType::getNameForCallConv(CC); 9414 } 9415 } 9416 9417 if (NewFD->getReturnType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() || 9418 NewFD->getReturnType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()) 9419 checkNonTrivialCUnion(NewFD->getReturnType(), 9420 NewFD->getReturnTypeSourceRange().getBegin(), 9421 NTCUC_FunctionReturn, NTCUK_Destruct|NTCUK_Copy); 9422 } else { 9423 // C++11 [replacement.functions]p3: 9424 // The program's definitions shall not be specified as inline. 9425 // 9426 // N.B. We diagnose declarations instead of definitions per LWG issue 2340. 9427 // 9428 // Suppress the diagnostic if the function is __attribute__((used)), since 9429 // that forces an external definition to be emitted. 9430 if (D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified() && 9431 NewFD->isReplaceableGlobalAllocationFunction() && 9432 !NewFD->hasAttr<UsedAttr>()) 9433 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), 9434 diag::ext_operator_new_delete_declared_inline) 9435 << NewFD->getDeclName(); 9436 9437 // If the declarator is a template-id, translate the parser's template 9438 // argument list into our AST format. 9439 if (D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId) { 9440 TemplateIdAnnotation *TemplateId = D.getName().TemplateId; 9441 TemplateArgs.setLAngleLoc(TemplateId->LAngleLoc); 9442 TemplateArgs.setRAngleLoc(TemplateId->RAngleLoc); 9443 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(), 9444 TemplateId->NumArgs); 9445 translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, 9446 TemplateArgs); 9447 9448 HasExplicitTemplateArgs = true; 9449 9450 if (NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) { 9451 HasExplicitTemplateArgs = false; 9452 } else if (FunctionTemplate) { 9453 // Function template with explicit template arguments. 9454 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_function_template_partial_spec) 9455 << SourceRange(TemplateId->LAngleLoc, TemplateId->RAngleLoc); 9456 9457 HasExplicitTemplateArgs = false; 9458 } else { 9459 assert((isFunctionTemplateSpecialization || 9460 D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified()) && 9461 "should have a 'template<>' for this decl"); 9462 // "friend void foo<>(int);" is an implicit specialization decl. 9463 isFunctionTemplateSpecialization = true; 9464 } 9465 } else if (isFriend && isFunctionTemplateSpecialization) { 9466 // This combination is only possible in a recovery case; the user 9467 // wrote something like: 9468 // template <> friend void foo(int); 9469 // which we're recovering from as if the user had written: 9470 // friend void foo<>(int); 9471 // Go ahead and fake up a template id. 9472 HasExplicitTemplateArgs = true; 9473 TemplateArgs.setLAngleLoc(D.getIdentifierLoc()); 9474 TemplateArgs.setRAngleLoc(D.getIdentifierLoc()); 9475 } 9476 9477 // We do not add HD attributes to specializations here because 9478 // they may have different constexpr-ness compared to their 9479 // templates and, after maybeAddCUDAHostDeviceAttrs() is applied, 9480 // may end up with different effective targets. Instead, a 9481 // specialization inherits its target attributes from its template 9482 // in the CheckFunctionTemplateSpecialization() call below. 9483 if (getLangOpts().CUDA && !isFunctionTemplateSpecialization) 9484 maybeAddCUDAHostDeviceAttrs(NewFD, Previous); 9485 9486 // If it's a friend (and only if it's a friend), it's possible 9487 // that either the specialized function type or the specialized 9488 // template is dependent, and therefore matching will fail. In 9489 // this case, don't check the specialization yet. 9490 bool InstantiationDependent = false; 9491 if (isFunctionTemplateSpecialization && isFriend && 9492 (NewFD->getType()->isDependentType() || DC->isDependentContext() || 9493 TemplateSpecializationType::anyDependentTemplateArguments( 9494 TemplateArgs, 9495 InstantiationDependent))) { 9496 assert(HasExplicitTemplateArgs && 9497 "friend function specialization without template args"); 9498 if (CheckDependentFunctionTemplateSpecialization(NewFD, TemplateArgs, 9499 Previous)) 9500 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9501 } else if (isFunctionTemplateSpecialization) { 9502 if (CurContext->isDependentContext() && CurContext->isRecord() 9503 && !isFriend) { 9504 isDependentClassScopeExplicitSpecialization = true; 9505 } else if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && 9506 CheckFunctionTemplateSpecialization( 9507 NewFD, (HasExplicitTemplateArgs ? &TemplateArgs : nullptr), 9508 Previous)) 9509 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9510 9511 // C++ [dcl.stc]p1: 9512 // A storage-class-specifier shall not be specified in an explicit 9513 // specialization (14.7.3) 9514 FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *Info = 9515 NewFD->getTemplateSpecializationInfo(); 9516 if (Info && SC != SC_None) { 9517 if (SC != Info->getTemplate()->getTemplatedDecl()->getStorageClass()) 9518 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), 9519 diag::err_explicit_specialization_inconsistent_storage_class) 9520 << SC 9521 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval( 9522 D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 9523 9524 else 9525 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), 9526 diag::ext_explicit_specialization_storage_class) 9527 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval( 9528 D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 9529 } 9530 } else if (isMemberSpecialization && isa<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD)) { 9531 if (CheckMemberSpecialization(NewFD, Previous)) 9532 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 9533 } 9534 9535 // Perform semantic checking on the function declaration. 9536 if (!isDependentClassScopeExplicitSpecialization) { 9537 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && NewFD->isMain()) 9538 CheckMain(NewFD, D.getDeclSpec()); 9539 9540 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && NewFD->isMSVCRTEntryPoint()) 9541 CheckMSVCRTEntryPoint(NewFD); 9542 9543 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) 9544 D.setRedeclaration(CheckFunctionDeclaration(S, NewFD, Previous, 9545 isMemberSpecialization)); 9546 else if (!Previous.empty()) 9547 // Recover gracefully from an invalid redeclaration. 9548 D.setRedeclaration(true); 9549 } 9550 9551 assert((NewFD->isInvalidDecl() || !D.isRedeclaration() || 9552 Previous.getResultKind() != LookupResult::FoundOverloaded) && 9553 "previous declaration set still overloaded"); 9554 9555 NamedDecl *PrincipalDecl = (FunctionTemplate 9556 ? cast<NamedDecl>(FunctionTemplate) 9557 : NewFD); 9558 9559 if (isFriend && NewFD->getPreviousDecl()) { 9560 AccessSpecifier Access = AS_public; 9561 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) 9562 Access = NewFD->getPreviousDecl()->getAccess(); 9563 9564 NewFD->setAccess(Access); 9565 if (FunctionTemplate) FunctionTemplate->setAccess(Access); 9566 } 9567 9568 if (NewFD->isOverloadedOperator() && !DC->isRecord() && 9569 PrincipalDecl->isInIdentifierNamespace(Decl::IDNS_Ordinary)) 9570 PrincipalDecl->setNonMemberOperator(); 9571 9572 // If we have a function template, check the template parameter 9573 // list. This will check and merge default template arguments. 9574 if (FunctionTemplate) { 9575 FunctionTemplateDecl *PrevTemplate = 9576 FunctionTemplate->getPreviousDecl(); 9577 CheckTemplateParameterList(FunctionTemplate->getTemplateParameters(), 9578 PrevTemplate ? PrevTemplate->getTemplateParameters() 9579 : nullptr, 9580 D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified() 9581 ? (D.isFunctionDefinition() 9582 ? TPC_FriendFunctionTemplateDefinition 9583 : TPC_FriendFunctionTemplate) 9584 : (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet() && 9585 DC && DC->isRecord() && 9586 DC->isDependentContext()) 9587 ? TPC_ClassTemplateMember 9588 : TPC_FunctionTemplate); 9589 } 9590 9591 if (NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) { 9592 // Ignore all the rest of this. 9593 } else if (!D.isRedeclaration()) { 9594 struct ActOnFDArgs ExtraArgs = { S, D, TemplateParamLists, 9595 AddToScope }; 9596 // Fake up an access specifier if it's supposed to be a class member. 9597 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(NewFD->getDeclContext())) 9598 NewFD->setAccess(AS_public); 9599 9600 // Qualified decls generally require a previous declaration. 9601 if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) { 9602 // ...with the major exception of templated-scope or 9603 // dependent-scope friend declarations. 9604 9605 // TODO: we currently also suppress this check in dependent 9606 // contexts because (1) the parameter depth will be off when 9607 // matching friend templates and (2) we might actually be 9608 // selecting a friend based on a dependent factor. But there 9609 // are situations where these conditions don't apply and we 9610 // can actually do this check immediately. 9611 // 9612 // Unless the scope is dependent, it's always an error if qualified 9613 // redeclaration lookup found nothing at all. Diagnose that now; 9614 // nothing will diagnose that error later. 9615 if (isFriend && 9616 (D.getCXXScopeSpec().getScopeRep()->isDependent() || 9617 (!Previous.empty() && CurContext->isDependentContext()))) { 9618 // ignore these 9619 } else { 9620 // The user tried to provide an out-of-line definition for a 9621 // function that is a member of a class or namespace, but there 9622 // was no such member function declared (C++ [class.mfct]p2, 9623 // C++ [namespace.memdef]p2). For example: 9624 // 9625 // class X { 9626 // void f() const; 9627 // }; 9628 // 9629 // void X::f() { } // ill-formed 9630 // 9631 // Complain about this problem, and attempt to suggest close 9632 // matches (e.g., those that differ only in cv-qualifiers and 9633 // whether the parameter types are references). 9634 9635 if (NamedDecl *Result = DiagnoseInvalidRedeclaration( 9636 *this, Previous, NewFD, ExtraArgs, false, nullptr)) { 9637 AddToScope = ExtraArgs.AddToScope; 9638 return Result; 9639 } 9640 } 9641 9642 // Unqualified local friend declarations are required to resolve 9643 // to something. 9644 } else if (isFriend && cast<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext)->isLocalClass()) { 9645 if (NamedDecl *Result = DiagnoseInvalidRedeclaration( 9646 *this, Previous, NewFD, ExtraArgs, true, S)) { 9647 AddToScope = ExtraArgs.AddToScope; 9648 return Result; 9649 } 9650 } 9651 } else if (!D.isFunctionDefinition() && 9652 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD) && NewFD->isOutOfLine() && 9653 !isFriend && !isFunctionTemplateSpecialization && 9654 !isMemberSpecialization) { 9655 // An out-of-line member function declaration must also be a 9656 // definition (C++ [class.mfct]p2). 9657 // Note that this is not the case for explicit specializations of 9658 // function templates or member functions of class templates, per 9659 // C++ [temp.expl.spec]p2. We also allow these declarations as an 9660 // extension for compatibility with old SWIG code which likes to 9661 // generate them. 9662 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::ext_out_of_line_declaration) 9663 << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange(); 9664 } 9665 } 9666 9667 // If this is the first declaration of a library builtin function, add 9668 // attributes as appropriate. 9669 if (!D.isRedeclaration() && 9670 NewFD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isFileContext()) { 9671 if (IdentifierInfo *II = Previous.getLookupName().getAsIdentifierInfo()) { 9672 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) { 9673 if (NewFD->getLanguageLinkage() == CLanguageLinkage) { 9674 // Validate the type matches unless this builtin is specified as 9675 // matching regardless of its declared type. 9676 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.allowTypeMismatch(BuiltinID)) { 9677 NewFD->addAttr(BuiltinAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, BuiltinID)); 9678 } else { 9679 ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError Error; 9680 LookupNecessaryTypesForBuiltin(S, BuiltinID); 9681 QualType BuiltinType = Context.GetBuiltinType(BuiltinID, Error); 9682 9683 if (!Error && !BuiltinType.isNull() && 9684 Context.hasSameFunctionTypeIgnoringExceptionSpec( 9685 NewFD->getType(), BuiltinType)) 9686 NewFD->addAttr(BuiltinAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, BuiltinID)); 9687 } 9688 } else if (BuiltinID == Builtin::BI__GetExceptionInfo && 9689 Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()) { 9690 // FIXME: We should consider this a builtin only in the std namespace. 9691 NewFD->addAttr(BuiltinAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, BuiltinID)); 9692 } 9693 } 9694 } 9695 } 9696 9697 ProcessPragmaWeak(S, NewFD); 9698 checkAttributesAfterMerging(*this, *NewFD); 9699 9700 AddKnownFunctionAttributes(NewFD); 9701 9702 if (NewFD->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>() && 9703 !NewFD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) { 9704 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), 9705 diag::err_attribute_overloadable_no_prototype) 9706 << NewFD; 9707 9708 // Turn this into a variadic function with no parameters. 9709 const FunctionType *FT = NewFD->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>(); 9710 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI( 9711 Context.getDefaultCallingConvention(true, false)); 9712 EPI.Variadic = true; 9713 EPI.ExtInfo = FT->getExtInfo(); 9714 9715 QualType R = Context.getFunctionType(FT->getReturnType(), None, EPI); 9716 NewFD->setType(R); 9717 } 9718 9719 // If there's a #pragma GCC visibility in scope, and this isn't a class 9720 // member, set the visibility of this function. 9721 if (!DC->isRecord() && NewFD->isExternallyVisible()) 9722 AddPushedVisibilityAttribute(NewFD); 9723 9724 // If there's a #pragma clang arc_cf_code_audited in scope, consider 9725 // marking the function. 9726 AddCFAuditedAttribute(NewFD); 9727 9728 // If this is a function definition, check if we have to apply optnone due to 9729 // a pragma. 9730 if(D.isFunctionDefinition()) 9731 AddRangeBasedOptnone(NewFD); 9732 9733 // If this is the first declaration of an extern C variable, update 9734 // the map of such variables. 9735 if (NewFD->isFirstDecl() && !NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && 9736 isIncompleteDeclExternC(*this, NewFD)) 9737 RegisterLocallyScopedExternCDecl(NewFD, S); 9738 9739 // Set this FunctionDecl's range up to the right paren. 9740 NewFD->setRangeEnd(D.getSourceRange().getEnd()); 9741 9742 if (D.isRedeclaration() && !Previous.empty()) { 9743 NamedDecl *Prev = Previous.getRepresentativeDecl(); 9744 checkDLLAttributeRedeclaration(*this, Prev, NewFD, 9745 isMemberSpecialization || 9746 isFunctionTemplateSpecialization, 9747 D.isFunctionDefinition()); 9748 } 9749 9750 if (getLangOpts().CUDA) { 9751 IdentifierInfo *II = NewFD->getIdentifier(); 9752 if (II && II->isStr(getCudaConfigureFuncName()) && 9753 !NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && 9754 NewFD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) { 9755 if (!R->getAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType()->isScalarType()) 9756 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_config_scalar_return) 9757 << getCudaConfigureFuncName(); 9758 Context.setcudaConfigureCallDecl(NewFD); 9759 } 9760 9761 // Variadic functions, other than a *declaration* of printf, are not allowed 9762 // in device-side CUDA code, unless someone passed 9763 // -fcuda-allow-variadic-functions. 9764 if (!getLangOpts().CUDAAllowVariadicFunctions && NewFD->isVariadic() && 9765 (NewFD->hasAttr<CUDADeviceAttr>() || 9766 NewFD->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>()) && 9767 !(II && II->isStr("printf") && NewFD->isExternC() && 9768 !D.isFunctionDefinition())) { 9769 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_variadic_device_fn); 9770 } 9771 } 9772 9773 MarkUnusedFileScopedDecl(NewFD); 9774 9775 9776 9777 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && NewFD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>()) { 9778 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.8 static is invalid for kernel functions. 9779 if ((getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion >= 120) 9780 && (SC == SC_Static)) { 9781 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_static_kernel); 9782 D.setInvalidType(); 9783 } 9784 9785 // OpenCL v1.2, s6.9 -- Kernels can only have return type void. 9786 if (!NewFD->getReturnType()->isVoidType()) { 9787 SourceRange RTRange = NewFD->getReturnTypeSourceRange(); 9788 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_expected_kernel_void_return_type) 9789 << (RTRange.isValid() ? FixItHint::CreateReplacement(RTRange, "void") 9790 : FixItHint()); 9791 D.setInvalidType(); 9792 } 9793 9794 llvm::SmallPtrSet<const Type *, 16> ValidTypes; 9795 for (auto Param : NewFD->parameters()) 9796 checkIsValidOpenCLKernelParameter(*this, D, Param, ValidTypes); 9797 9798 if (getLangOpts().OpenCLCPlusPlus) { 9799 if (DC->isRecord()) { 9800 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_method_kernel); 9801 D.setInvalidType(); 9802 } 9803 if (FunctionTemplate) { 9804 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_template_kernel); 9805 D.setInvalidType(); 9806 } 9807 } 9808 } 9809 9810 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 9811 if (FunctionTemplate) { 9812 if (NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) 9813 FunctionTemplate->setInvalidDecl(); 9814 return FunctionTemplate; 9815 } 9816 9817 if (isMemberSpecialization && !NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) 9818 CompleteMemberSpecialization(NewFD, Previous); 9819 } 9820 9821 for (const ParmVarDecl *Param : NewFD->parameters()) { 9822 QualType PT = Param->getType(); 9823 9824 // OpenCL 2.0 pipe restrictions forbids pipe packet types to be non-value 9825 // types. 9826 if (getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion >= 200 || getLangOpts().OpenCLCPlusPlus) { 9827 if(const PipeType *PipeTy = PT->getAs<PipeType>()) { 9828 QualType ElemTy = PipeTy->getElementType(); 9829 if (ElemTy->isReferenceType() || ElemTy->isPointerType()) { 9830 Diag(Param->getTypeSpecStartLoc(), diag::err_reference_pipe_type ); 9831 D.setInvalidType(); 9832 } 9833 } 9834 } 9835 } 9836 9837 // Here we have an function template explicit specialization at class scope. 9838 // The actual specialization will be postponed to template instatiation 9839 // time via the ClassScopeFunctionSpecializationDecl node. 9840 if (isDependentClassScopeExplicitSpecialization) { 9841 ClassScopeFunctionSpecializationDecl *NewSpec = 9842 ClassScopeFunctionSpecializationDecl::Create( 9843 Context, CurContext, NewFD->getLocation(), 9844 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD), 9845 HasExplicitTemplateArgs, TemplateArgs); 9846 CurContext->addDecl(NewSpec); 9847 AddToScope = false; 9848 } 9849 9850 // Diagnose availability attributes. Availability cannot be used on functions 9851 // that are run during load/unload. 9852 if (const auto *attr = NewFD->getAttr<AvailabilityAttr>()) { 9853 if (NewFD->hasAttr<ConstructorAttr>()) { 9854 Diag(attr->getLocation(), diag::warn_availability_on_static_initializer) 9855 << 1; 9856 NewFD->dropAttr<AvailabilityAttr>(); 9857 } 9858 if (NewFD->hasAttr<DestructorAttr>()) { 9859 Diag(attr->getLocation(), diag::warn_availability_on_static_initializer) 9860 << 2; 9861 NewFD->dropAttr<AvailabilityAttr>(); 9862 } 9863 } 9864 9865 // Diagnose no_builtin attribute on function declaration that are not a 9866 // definition. 9867 // FIXME: We should really be doing this in 9868 // SemaDeclAttr.cpp::handleNoBuiltinAttr, unfortunately we only have access to 9869 // the FunctionDecl and at this point of the code 9870 // FunctionDecl::isThisDeclarationADefinition() which always returns `false` 9871 // because Sema::ActOnStartOfFunctionDef has not been called yet. 9872 if (const auto *NBA = NewFD->getAttr<NoBuiltinAttr>()) 9873 switch (D.getFunctionDefinitionKind()) { 9874 case FDK_Defaulted: 9875 case FDK_Deleted: 9876 Diag(NBA->getLocation(), 9877 diag::err_attribute_no_builtin_on_defaulted_deleted_function) 9878 << NBA->getSpelling(); 9879 break; 9880 case FDK_Declaration: 9881 Diag(NBA->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_no_builtin_on_non_definition) 9882 << NBA->getSpelling(); 9883 break; 9884 case FDK_Definition: 9885 break; 9886 } 9887 9888 return NewFD; 9889 } 9890 9891 /// Return a CodeSegAttr from a containing class. The Microsoft docs say 9892 /// when __declspec(code_seg) "is applied to a class, all member functions of 9893 /// the class and nested classes -- this includes compiler-generated special 9894 /// member functions -- are put in the specified segment." 9895 /// The actual behavior is a little more complicated. The Microsoft compiler 9896 /// won't check outer classes if there is an active value from #pragma code_seg. 9897 /// The CodeSeg is always applied from the direct parent but only from outer 9898 /// classes when the #pragma code_seg stack is empty. See: 9899 /// https://reviews.llvm.org/D22931, the Microsoft feedback page is no longer 9900 /// available since MS has removed the page. 9901 static Attr *getImplicitCodeSegAttrFromClass(Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *FD) { 9902 const auto *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD); 9903 if (!Method) 9904 return nullptr; 9905 const CXXRecordDecl *Parent = Method->getParent(); 9906 if (const auto *SAttr = Parent->getAttr<CodeSegAttr>()) { 9907 Attr *NewAttr = SAttr->clone(S.getASTContext()); 9908 NewAttr->setImplicit(true); 9909 return NewAttr; 9910 } 9911 9912 // The Microsoft compiler won't check outer classes for the CodeSeg 9913 // when the #pragma code_seg stack is active. 9914 if (S.CodeSegStack.CurrentValue) 9915 return nullptr; 9916 9917 while ((Parent = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Parent->getParent()))) { 9918 if (const auto *SAttr = Parent->getAttr<CodeSegAttr>()) { 9919 Attr *NewAttr = SAttr->clone(S.getASTContext()); 9920 NewAttr->setImplicit(true); 9921 return NewAttr; 9922 } 9923 } 9924 return nullptr; 9925 } 9926 9927 /// Returns an implicit CodeSegAttr if a __declspec(code_seg) is found on a 9928 /// containing class. Otherwise it will return implicit SectionAttr if the 9929 /// function is a definition and there is an active value on CodeSegStack 9930 /// (from the current #pragma code-seg value). 9931 /// 9932 /// \param FD Function being declared. 9933 /// \param IsDefinition Whether it is a definition or just a declarartion. 9934 /// \returns A CodeSegAttr or SectionAttr to apply to the function or 9935 /// nullptr if no attribute should be added. 9936 Attr *Sema::getImplicitCodeSegOrSectionAttrForFunction(const FunctionDecl *FD, 9937 bool IsDefinition) { 9938 if (Attr *A = getImplicitCodeSegAttrFromClass(*this, FD)) 9939 return A; 9940 if (!FD->hasAttr<SectionAttr>() && IsDefinition && 9941 CodeSegStack.CurrentValue) 9942 return SectionAttr::CreateImplicit( 9943 getASTContext(), CodeSegStack.CurrentValue->getString(), 9944 CodeSegStack.CurrentPragmaLocation, AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma, 9945 SectionAttr::Declspec_allocate); 9946 return nullptr; 9947 } 9948 9949 /// Determines if we can perform a correct type check for \p D as a 9950 /// redeclaration of \p PrevDecl. If not, we can generally still perform a 9951 /// best-effort check. 9952 /// 9953 /// \param NewD The new declaration. 9954 /// \param OldD The old declaration. 9955 /// \param NewT The portion of the type of the new declaration to check. 9956 /// \param OldT The portion of the type of the old declaration to check. 9957 bool Sema::canFullyTypeCheckRedeclaration(ValueDecl *NewD, ValueDecl *OldD, 9958 QualType NewT, QualType OldT) { 9959 if (!NewD->getLexicalDeclContext()->isDependentContext()) 9960 return true; 9961 9962 // For dependently-typed local extern declarations and friends, we can't 9963 // perform a correct type check in general until instantiation: 9964 // 9965 // int f(); 9966 // template<typename T> void g() { T f(); } 9967 // 9968 // (valid if g() is only instantiated with T = int). 9969 if (NewT->isDependentType() && 9970 (NewD->isLocalExternDecl() || NewD->getFriendObjectKind())) 9971 return false; 9972 9973 // Similarly, if the previous declaration was a dependent local extern 9974 // declaration, we don't really know its type yet. 9975 if (OldT->isDependentType() && OldD->isLocalExternDecl()) 9976 return false; 9977 9978 return true; 9979 } 9980 9981 /// Checks if the new declaration declared in dependent context must be 9982 /// put in the same redeclaration chain as the specified declaration. 9983 /// 9984 /// \param D Declaration that is checked. 9985 /// \param PrevDecl Previous declaration found with proper lookup method for the 9986 /// same declaration name. 9987 /// \returns True if D must be added to the redeclaration chain which PrevDecl 9988 /// belongs to. 9989 /// 9990 bool Sema::shouldLinkDependentDeclWithPrevious(Decl *D, Decl *PrevDecl) { 9991 if (!D->getLexicalDeclContext()->isDependentContext()) 9992 return true; 9993 9994 // Don't chain dependent friend function definitions until instantiation, to 9995 // permit cases like 9996 // 9997 // void func(); 9998 // template<typename T> class C1 { friend void func() {} }; 9999 // template<typename T> class C2 { friend void func() {} }; 10000 // 10001 // ... which is valid if only one of C1 and C2 is ever instantiated. 10002 // 10003 // FIXME: This need only apply to function definitions. For now, we proxy 10004 // this by checking for a file-scope function. We do not want this to apply 10005 // to friend declarations nominating member functions, because that gets in 10006 // the way of access checks. 10007 if (D->getFriendObjectKind() && D->getDeclContext()->isFileContext()) 10008 return false; 10009 10010 auto *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D); 10011 auto *PrevVD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(PrevDecl); 10012 return !VD || !PrevVD || 10013 canFullyTypeCheckRedeclaration(VD, PrevVD, VD->getType(), 10014 PrevVD->getType()); 10015 } 10016 10017 /// Check the target attribute of the function for MultiVersion 10018 /// validity. 10019 /// 10020 /// Returns true if there was an error, false otherwise. 10021 static bool CheckMultiVersionValue(Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *FD) { 10022 const auto *TA = FD->getAttr<TargetAttr>(); 10023 assert(TA && "MultiVersion Candidate requires a target attribute"); 10024 ParsedTargetAttr ParseInfo = TA->parse(); 10025 const TargetInfo &TargetInfo = S.Context.getTargetInfo(); 10026 enum ErrType { Feature = 0, Architecture = 1 }; 10027 10028 if (!ParseInfo.Architecture.empty() && 10029 !TargetInfo.validateCpuIs(ParseInfo.Architecture)) { 10030 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_bad_multiversion_option) 10031 << Architecture << ParseInfo.Architecture; 10032 return true; 10033 } 10034 10035 for (const auto &Feat : ParseInfo.Features) { 10036 auto BareFeat = StringRef{Feat}.substr(1); 10037 if (Feat[0] == '-') { 10038 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_bad_multiversion_option) 10039 << Feature << ("no-" + BareFeat).str(); 10040 return true; 10041 } 10042 10043 if (!TargetInfo.validateCpuSupports(BareFeat) || 10044 !TargetInfo.isValidFeatureName(BareFeat)) { 10045 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_bad_multiversion_option) 10046 << Feature << BareFeat; 10047 return true; 10048 } 10049 } 10050 return false; 10051 } 10052 10053 // Provide a white-list of attributes that are allowed to be combined with 10054 // multiversion functions. 10055 static bool AttrCompatibleWithMultiVersion(attr::Kind Kind, 10056 MultiVersionKind MVType) { 10057 // Note: this list/diagnosis must match the list in 10058 // checkMultiversionAttributesAllSame. 10059 switch (Kind) { 10060 default: 10061 return false; 10062 case attr::Used: 10063 return MVType == MultiVersionKind::Target; 10064 case attr::NonNull: 10065 case attr::NoThrow: 10066 return true; 10067 } 10068 } 10069 10070 static bool checkNonMultiVersionCompatAttributes(Sema &S, 10071 const FunctionDecl *FD, 10072 const FunctionDecl *CausedFD, 10073 MultiVersionKind MVType) { 10074 bool IsCPUSpecificCPUDispatchMVType = 10075 MVType == MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch || 10076 MVType == MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific; 10077 const auto Diagnose = [FD, CausedFD, IsCPUSpecificCPUDispatchMVType]( 10078 Sema &S, const Attr *A) { 10079 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_disallowed_other_attr) 10080 << IsCPUSpecificCPUDispatchMVType << A; 10081 if (CausedFD) 10082 S.Diag(CausedFD->getLocation(), diag::note_multiversioning_caused_here); 10083 return true; 10084 }; 10085 10086 for (const Attr *A : FD->attrs()) { 10087 switch (A->getKind()) { 10088 case attr::CPUDispatch: 10089 case attr::CPUSpecific: 10090 if (MVType != MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch && 10091 MVType != MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific) 10092 return Diagnose(S, A); 10093 break; 10094 case attr::Target: 10095 if (MVType != MultiVersionKind::Target) 10096 return Diagnose(S, A); 10097 break; 10098 default: 10099 if (!AttrCompatibleWithMultiVersion(A->getKind(), MVType)) 10100 return Diagnose(S, A); 10101 break; 10102 } 10103 } 10104 return false; 10105 } 10106 10107 bool Sema::areMultiversionVariantFunctionsCompatible( 10108 const FunctionDecl *OldFD, const FunctionDecl *NewFD, 10109 const PartialDiagnostic &NoProtoDiagID, 10110 const PartialDiagnosticAt &NoteCausedDiagIDAt, 10111 const PartialDiagnosticAt &NoSupportDiagIDAt, 10112 const PartialDiagnosticAt &DiffDiagIDAt, bool TemplatesSupported, 10113 bool ConstexprSupported, bool CLinkageMayDiffer) { 10114 enum DoesntSupport { 10115 FuncTemplates = 0, 10116 VirtFuncs = 1, 10117 DeducedReturn = 2, 10118 Constructors = 3, 10119 Destructors = 4, 10120 DeletedFuncs = 5, 10121 DefaultedFuncs = 6, 10122 ConstexprFuncs = 7, 10123 ConstevalFuncs = 8, 10124 }; 10125 enum Different { 10126 CallingConv = 0, 10127 ReturnType = 1, 10128 ConstexprSpec = 2, 10129 InlineSpec = 3, 10130 StorageClass = 4, 10131 Linkage = 5, 10132 }; 10133 10134 if (NoProtoDiagID.getDiagID() != 0 && OldFD && 10135 !OldFD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) { 10136 Diag(OldFD->getLocation(), NoProtoDiagID); 10137 Diag(NoteCausedDiagIDAt.first, NoteCausedDiagIDAt.second); 10138 return true; 10139 } 10140 10141 if (NoProtoDiagID.getDiagID() != 0 && 10142 !NewFD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 10143 return Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), NoProtoDiagID); 10144 10145 if (!TemplatesSupported && 10146 NewFD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_FunctionTemplate) 10147 return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second) 10148 << FuncTemplates; 10149 10150 if (const auto *NewCXXFD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD)) { 10151 if (NewCXXFD->isVirtual()) 10152 return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second) 10153 << VirtFuncs; 10154 10155 if (isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewCXXFD)) 10156 return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second) 10157 << Constructors; 10158 10159 if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(NewCXXFD)) 10160 return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second) 10161 << Destructors; 10162 } 10163 10164 if (NewFD->isDeleted()) 10165 return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second) 10166 << DeletedFuncs; 10167 10168 if (NewFD->isDefaulted()) 10169 return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second) 10170 << DefaultedFuncs; 10171 10172 if (!ConstexprSupported && NewFD->isConstexpr()) 10173 return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second) 10174 << (NewFD->isConsteval() ? ConstevalFuncs : ConstexprFuncs); 10175 10176 QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(NewFD->getType()); 10177 const auto *NewType = cast<FunctionType>(NewQType); 10178 QualType NewReturnType = NewType->getReturnType(); 10179 10180 if (NewReturnType->isUndeducedType()) 10181 return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second) 10182 << DeducedReturn; 10183 10184 // Ensure the return type is identical. 10185 if (OldFD) { 10186 QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(OldFD->getType()); 10187 const auto *OldType = cast<FunctionType>(OldQType); 10188 FunctionType::ExtInfo OldTypeInfo = OldType->getExtInfo(); 10189 FunctionType::ExtInfo NewTypeInfo = NewType->getExtInfo(); 10190 10191 if (OldTypeInfo.getCC() != NewTypeInfo.getCC()) 10192 return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << CallingConv; 10193 10194 QualType OldReturnType = OldType->getReturnType(); 10195 10196 if (OldReturnType != NewReturnType) 10197 return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << ReturnType; 10198 10199 if (OldFD->getConstexprKind() != NewFD->getConstexprKind()) 10200 return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << ConstexprSpec; 10201 10202 if (OldFD->isInlineSpecified() != NewFD->isInlineSpecified()) 10203 return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << InlineSpec; 10204 10205 if (OldFD->getStorageClass() != NewFD->getStorageClass()) 10206 return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << StorageClass; 10207 10208 if (!CLinkageMayDiffer && OldFD->isExternC() != NewFD->isExternC()) 10209 return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << Linkage; 10210 10211 if (CheckEquivalentExceptionSpec( 10212 OldFD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(), OldFD->getLocation(), 10213 NewFD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(), NewFD->getLocation())) 10214 return true; 10215 } 10216 return false; 10217 } 10218 10219 static bool CheckMultiVersionAdditionalRules(Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *OldFD, 10220 const FunctionDecl *NewFD, 10221 bool CausesMV, 10222 MultiVersionKind MVType) { 10223 if (!S.getASTContext().getTargetInfo().supportsMultiVersioning()) { 10224 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_not_supported); 10225 if (OldFD) 10226 S.Diag(OldFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 10227 return true; 10228 } 10229 10230 bool IsCPUSpecificCPUDispatchMVType = 10231 MVType == MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch || 10232 MVType == MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific; 10233 10234 if (CausesMV && OldFD && 10235 checkNonMultiVersionCompatAttributes(S, OldFD, NewFD, MVType)) 10236 return true; 10237 10238 if (checkNonMultiVersionCompatAttributes(S, NewFD, nullptr, MVType)) 10239 return true; 10240 10241 // Only allow transition to MultiVersion if it hasn't been used. 10242 if (OldFD && CausesMV && OldFD->isUsed(false)) 10243 return S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_after_used); 10244 10245 return S.areMultiversionVariantFunctionsCompatible( 10246 OldFD, NewFD, S.PDiag(diag::err_multiversion_noproto), 10247 PartialDiagnosticAt(NewFD->getLocation(), 10248 S.PDiag(diag::note_multiversioning_caused_here)), 10249 PartialDiagnosticAt(NewFD->getLocation(), 10250 S.PDiag(diag::err_multiversion_doesnt_support) 10251 << IsCPUSpecificCPUDispatchMVType), 10252 PartialDiagnosticAt(NewFD->getLocation(), 10253 S.PDiag(diag::err_multiversion_diff)), 10254 /*TemplatesSupported=*/false, 10255 /*ConstexprSupported=*/!IsCPUSpecificCPUDispatchMVType, 10256 /*CLinkageMayDiffer=*/false); 10257 } 10258 10259 /// Check the validity of a multiversion function declaration that is the 10260 /// first of its kind. Also sets the multiversion'ness' of the function itself. 10261 /// 10262 /// This sets NewFD->isInvalidDecl() to true if there was an error. 10263 /// 10264 /// Returns true if there was an error, false otherwise. 10265 static bool CheckMultiVersionFirstFunction(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *FD, 10266 MultiVersionKind MVType, 10267 const TargetAttr *TA) { 10268 assert(MVType != MultiVersionKind::None && 10269 "Function lacks multiversion attribute"); 10270 10271 // Target only causes MV if it is default, otherwise this is a normal 10272 // function. 10273 if (MVType == MultiVersionKind::Target && !TA->isDefaultVersion()) 10274 return false; 10275 10276 if (MVType == MultiVersionKind::Target && CheckMultiVersionValue(S, FD)) { 10277 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 10278 return true; 10279 } 10280 10281 if (CheckMultiVersionAdditionalRules(S, nullptr, FD, true, MVType)) { 10282 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 10283 return true; 10284 } 10285 10286 FD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10287 return false; 10288 } 10289 10290 static bool PreviousDeclsHaveMultiVersionAttribute(const FunctionDecl *FD) { 10291 for (const Decl *D = FD->getPreviousDecl(); D; D = D->getPreviousDecl()) { 10292 if (D->getAsFunction()->getMultiVersionKind() != MultiVersionKind::None) 10293 return true; 10294 } 10295 10296 return false; 10297 } 10298 10299 static bool CheckTargetCausesMultiVersioning( 10300 Sema &S, FunctionDecl *OldFD, FunctionDecl *NewFD, const TargetAttr *NewTA, 10301 bool &Redeclaration, NamedDecl *&OldDecl, bool &MergeTypeWithPrevious, 10302 LookupResult &Previous) { 10303 const auto *OldTA = OldFD->getAttr<TargetAttr>(); 10304 ParsedTargetAttr NewParsed = NewTA->parse(); 10305 // Sort order doesn't matter, it just needs to be consistent. 10306 llvm::sort(NewParsed.Features); 10307 10308 // If the old decl is NOT MultiVersioned yet, and we don't cause that 10309 // to change, this is a simple redeclaration. 10310 if (!NewTA->isDefaultVersion() && 10311 (!OldTA || OldTA->getFeaturesStr() == NewTA->getFeaturesStr())) 10312 return false; 10313 10314 // Otherwise, this decl causes MultiVersioning. 10315 if (!S.getASTContext().getTargetInfo().supportsMultiVersioning()) { 10316 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_not_supported); 10317 S.Diag(OldFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 10318 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10319 return true; 10320 } 10321 10322 if (CheckMultiVersionAdditionalRules(S, OldFD, NewFD, true, 10323 MultiVersionKind::Target)) { 10324 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10325 return true; 10326 } 10327 10328 if (CheckMultiVersionValue(S, NewFD)) { 10329 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10330 return true; 10331 } 10332 10333 // If this is 'default', permit the forward declaration. 10334 if (!OldFD->isMultiVersion() && !OldTA && NewTA->isDefaultVersion()) { 10335 Redeclaration = true; 10336 OldDecl = OldFD; 10337 OldFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10338 NewFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10339 return false; 10340 } 10341 10342 if (CheckMultiVersionValue(S, OldFD)) { 10343 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::note_multiversioning_caused_here); 10344 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10345 return true; 10346 } 10347 10348 ParsedTargetAttr OldParsed = OldTA->parse(std::less<std::string>()); 10349 10350 if (OldParsed == NewParsed) { 10351 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_duplicate); 10352 S.Diag(OldFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 10353 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10354 return true; 10355 } 10356 10357 for (const auto *FD : OldFD->redecls()) { 10358 const auto *CurTA = FD->getAttr<TargetAttr>(); 10359 // We allow forward declarations before ANY multiversioning attributes, but 10360 // nothing after the fact. 10361 if (PreviousDeclsHaveMultiVersionAttribute(FD) && 10362 (!CurTA || CurTA->isInherited())) { 10363 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_required_in_redecl) 10364 << 0; 10365 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::note_multiversioning_caused_here); 10366 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10367 return true; 10368 } 10369 } 10370 10371 OldFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10372 NewFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10373 Redeclaration = false; 10374 MergeTypeWithPrevious = false; 10375 OldDecl = nullptr; 10376 Previous.clear(); 10377 return false; 10378 } 10379 10380 /// Check the validity of a new function declaration being added to an existing 10381 /// multiversioned declaration collection. 10382 static bool CheckMultiVersionAdditionalDecl( 10383 Sema &S, FunctionDecl *OldFD, FunctionDecl *NewFD, 10384 MultiVersionKind NewMVType, const TargetAttr *NewTA, 10385 const CPUDispatchAttr *NewCPUDisp, const CPUSpecificAttr *NewCPUSpec, 10386 bool &Redeclaration, NamedDecl *&OldDecl, bool &MergeTypeWithPrevious, 10387 LookupResult &Previous) { 10388 10389 MultiVersionKind OldMVType = OldFD->getMultiVersionKind(); 10390 // Disallow mixing of multiversioning types. 10391 if ((OldMVType == MultiVersionKind::Target && 10392 NewMVType != MultiVersionKind::Target) || 10393 (NewMVType == MultiVersionKind::Target && 10394 OldMVType != MultiVersionKind::Target)) { 10395 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_types_mixed); 10396 S.Diag(OldFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 10397 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10398 return true; 10399 } 10400 10401 ParsedTargetAttr NewParsed; 10402 if (NewTA) { 10403 NewParsed = NewTA->parse(); 10404 llvm::sort(NewParsed.Features); 10405 } 10406 10407 bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules = 10408 S.CurContext->isRecord() && !NewFD->getFriendObjectKind(); 10409 10410 // Next, check ALL non-overloads to see if this is a redeclaration of a 10411 // previous member of the MultiVersion set. 10412 for (NamedDecl *ND : Previous) { 10413 FunctionDecl *CurFD = ND->getAsFunction(); 10414 if (!CurFD) 10415 continue; 10416 if (S.IsOverload(NewFD, CurFD, UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) 10417 continue; 10418 10419 if (NewMVType == MultiVersionKind::Target) { 10420 const auto *CurTA = CurFD->getAttr<TargetAttr>(); 10421 if (CurTA->getFeaturesStr() == NewTA->getFeaturesStr()) { 10422 NewFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10423 Redeclaration = true; 10424 OldDecl = ND; 10425 return false; 10426 } 10427 10428 ParsedTargetAttr CurParsed = CurTA->parse(std::less<std::string>()); 10429 if (CurParsed == NewParsed) { 10430 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_duplicate); 10431 S.Diag(CurFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 10432 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10433 return true; 10434 } 10435 } else { 10436 const auto *CurCPUSpec = CurFD->getAttr<CPUSpecificAttr>(); 10437 const auto *CurCPUDisp = CurFD->getAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>(); 10438 // Handle CPUDispatch/CPUSpecific versions. 10439 // Only 1 CPUDispatch function is allowed, this will make it go through 10440 // the redeclaration errors. 10441 if (NewMVType == MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch && 10442 CurFD->hasAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>()) { 10443 if (CurCPUDisp->cpus_size() == NewCPUDisp->cpus_size() && 10444 std::equal( 10445 CurCPUDisp->cpus_begin(), CurCPUDisp->cpus_end(), 10446 NewCPUDisp->cpus_begin(), 10447 [](const IdentifierInfo *Cur, const IdentifierInfo *New) { 10448 return Cur->getName() == New->getName(); 10449 })) { 10450 NewFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10451 Redeclaration = true; 10452 OldDecl = ND; 10453 return false; 10454 } 10455 10456 // If the declarations don't match, this is an error condition. 10457 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_cpu_dispatch_mismatch); 10458 S.Diag(CurFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 10459 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10460 return true; 10461 } 10462 if (NewMVType == MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific && CurCPUSpec) { 10463 10464 if (CurCPUSpec->cpus_size() == NewCPUSpec->cpus_size() && 10465 std::equal( 10466 CurCPUSpec->cpus_begin(), CurCPUSpec->cpus_end(), 10467 NewCPUSpec->cpus_begin(), 10468 [](const IdentifierInfo *Cur, const IdentifierInfo *New) { 10469 return Cur->getName() == New->getName(); 10470 })) { 10471 NewFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10472 Redeclaration = true; 10473 OldDecl = ND; 10474 return false; 10475 } 10476 10477 // Only 1 version of CPUSpecific is allowed for each CPU. 10478 for (const IdentifierInfo *CurII : CurCPUSpec->cpus()) { 10479 for (const IdentifierInfo *NewII : NewCPUSpec->cpus()) { 10480 if (CurII == NewII) { 10481 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_cpu_specific_multiple_defs) 10482 << NewII; 10483 S.Diag(CurFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 10484 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10485 return true; 10486 } 10487 } 10488 } 10489 } 10490 // If the two decls aren't the same MVType, there is no possible error 10491 // condition. 10492 } 10493 } 10494 10495 // Else, this is simply a non-redecl case. Checking the 'value' is only 10496 // necessary in the Target case, since The CPUSpecific/Dispatch cases are 10497 // handled in the attribute adding step. 10498 if (NewMVType == MultiVersionKind::Target && 10499 CheckMultiVersionValue(S, NewFD)) { 10500 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10501 return true; 10502 } 10503 10504 if (CheckMultiVersionAdditionalRules(S, OldFD, NewFD, 10505 !OldFD->isMultiVersion(), NewMVType)) { 10506 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10507 return true; 10508 } 10509 10510 // Permit forward declarations in the case where these two are compatible. 10511 if (!OldFD->isMultiVersion()) { 10512 OldFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10513 NewFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10514 Redeclaration = true; 10515 OldDecl = OldFD; 10516 return false; 10517 } 10518 10519 NewFD->setIsMultiVersion(); 10520 Redeclaration = false; 10521 MergeTypeWithPrevious = false; 10522 OldDecl = nullptr; 10523 Previous.clear(); 10524 return false; 10525 } 10526 10527 10528 /// Check the validity of a mulitversion function declaration. 10529 /// Also sets the multiversion'ness' of the function itself. 10530 /// 10531 /// This sets NewFD->isInvalidDecl() to true if there was an error. 10532 /// 10533 /// Returns true if there was an error, false otherwise. 10534 static bool CheckMultiVersionFunction(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *NewFD, 10535 bool &Redeclaration, NamedDecl *&OldDecl, 10536 bool &MergeTypeWithPrevious, 10537 LookupResult &Previous) { 10538 const auto *NewTA = NewFD->getAttr<TargetAttr>(); 10539 const auto *NewCPUDisp = NewFD->getAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>(); 10540 const auto *NewCPUSpec = NewFD->getAttr<CPUSpecificAttr>(); 10541 10542 // Mixing Multiversioning types is prohibited. 10543 if ((NewTA && NewCPUDisp) || (NewTA && NewCPUSpec) || 10544 (NewCPUDisp && NewCPUSpec)) { 10545 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_types_mixed); 10546 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10547 return true; 10548 } 10549 10550 MultiVersionKind MVType = NewFD->getMultiVersionKind(); 10551 10552 // Main isn't allowed to become a multiversion function, however it IS 10553 // permitted to have 'main' be marked with the 'target' optimization hint. 10554 if (NewFD->isMain()) { 10555 if ((MVType == MultiVersionKind::Target && NewTA->isDefaultVersion()) || 10556 MVType == MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch || 10557 MVType == MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific) { 10558 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_not_allowed_on_main); 10559 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10560 return true; 10561 } 10562 return false; 10563 } 10564 10565 if (!OldDecl || !OldDecl->getAsFunction() || 10566 OldDecl->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext() != 10567 NewFD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()) { 10568 // If there's no previous declaration, AND this isn't attempting to cause 10569 // multiversioning, this isn't an error condition. 10570 if (MVType == MultiVersionKind::None) 10571 return false; 10572 return CheckMultiVersionFirstFunction(S, NewFD, MVType, NewTA); 10573 } 10574 10575 FunctionDecl *OldFD = OldDecl->getAsFunction(); 10576 10577 if (!OldFD->isMultiVersion() && MVType == MultiVersionKind::None) 10578 return false; 10579 10580 if (OldFD->isMultiVersion() && MVType == MultiVersionKind::None) { 10581 S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_required_in_redecl) 10582 << (OldFD->getMultiVersionKind() != MultiVersionKind::Target); 10583 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10584 return true; 10585 } 10586 10587 // Handle the target potentially causes multiversioning case. 10588 if (!OldFD->isMultiVersion() && MVType == MultiVersionKind::Target) 10589 return CheckTargetCausesMultiVersioning(S, OldFD, NewFD, NewTA, 10590 Redeclaration, OldDecl, 10591 MergeTypeWithPrevious, Previous); 10592 10593 // At this point, we have a multiversion function decl (in OldFD) AND an 10594 // appropriate attribute in the current function decl. Resolve that these are 10595 // still compatible with previous declarations. 10596 return CheckMultiVersionAdditionalDecl( 10597 S, OldFD, NewFD, MVType, NewTA, NewCPUDisp, NewCPUSpec, Redeclaration, 10598 OldDecl, MergeTypeWithPrevious, Previous); 10599 } 10600 10601 /// Perform semantic checking of a new function declaration. 10602 /// 10603 /// Performs semantic analysis of the new function declaration 10604 /// NewFD. This routine performs all semantic checking that does not 10605 /// require the actual declarator involved in the declaration, and is 10606 /// used both for the declaration of functions as they are parsed 10607 /// (called via ActOnDeclarator) and for the declaration of functions 10608 /// that have been instantiated via C++ template instantiation (called 10609 /// via InstantiateDecl). 10610 /// 10611 /// \param IsMemberSpecialization whether this new function declaration is 10612 /// a member specialization (that replaces any definition provided by the 10613 /// previous declaration). 10614 /// 10615 /// This sets NewFD->isInvalidDecl() to true if there was an error. 10616 /// 10617 /// \returns true if the function declaration is a redeclaration. 10618 bool Sema::CheckFunctionDeclaration(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *NewFD, 10619 LookupResult &Previous, 10620 bool IsMemberSpecialization) { 10621 assert(!NewFD->getReturnType()->isVariablyModifiedType() && 10622 "Variably modified return types are not handled here"); 10623 10624 // Determine whether the type of this function should be merged with 10625 // a previous visible declaration. This never happens for functions in C++, 10626 // and always happens in C if the previous declaration was visible. 10627 bool MergeTypeWithPrevious = !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 10628 !Previous.isShadowed(); 10629 10630 bool Redeclaration = false; 10631 NamedDecl *OldDecl = nullptr; 10632 bool MayNeedOverloadableChecks = false; 10633 10634 // Merge or overload the declaration with an existing declaration of 10635 // the same name, if appropriate. 10636 if (!Previous.empty()) { 10637 // Determine whether NewFD is an overload of PrevDecl or 10638 // a declaration that requires merging. If it's an overload, 10639 // there's no more work to do here; we'll just add the new 10640 // function to the scope. 10641 if (!AllowOverloadingOfFunction(Previous, Context, NewFD)) { 10642 NamedDecl *Candidate = Previous.getRepresentativeDecl(); 10643 if (shouldLinkPossiblyHiddenDecl(Candidate, NewFD)) { 10644 Redeclaration = true; 10645 OldDecl = Candidate; 10646 } 10647 } else { 10648 MayNeedOverloadableChecks = true; 10649 switch (CheckOverload(S, NewFD, Previous, OldDecl, 10650 /*NewIsUsingDecl*/ false)) { 10651 case Ovl_Match: 10652 Redeclaration = true; 10653 break; 10654 10655 case Ovl_NonFunction: 10656 Redeclaration = true; 10657 break; 10658 10659 case Ovl_Overload: 10660 Redeclaration = false; 10661 break; 10662 } 10663 } 10664 } 10665 10666 // Check for a previous extern "C" declaration with this name. 10667 if (!Redeclaration && 10668 checkForConflictWithNonVisibleExternC(*this, NewFD, Previous)) { 10669 if (!Previous.empty()) { 10670 // This is an extern "C" declaration with the same name as a previous 10671 // declaration, and thus redeclares that entity... 10672 Redeclaration = true; 10673 OldDecl = Previous.getFoundDecl(); 10674 MergeTypeWithPrevious = false; 10675 10676 // ... except in the presence of __attribute__((overloadable)). 10677 if (OldDecl->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>() || 10678 NewFD->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>()) { 10679 if (IsOverload(NewFD, cast<FunctionDecl>(OldDecl), false)) { 10680 MayNeedOverloadableChecks = true; 10681 Redeclaration = false; 10682 OldDecl = nullptr; 10683 } 10684 } 10685 } 10686 } 10687 10688 if (CheckMultiVersionFunction(*this, NewFD, Redeclaration, OldDecl, 10689 MergeTypeWithPrevious, Previous)) 10690 return Redeclaration; 10691 10692 // PPC MMA non-pointer types are not allowed as function return types. 10693 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isPPC64() && 10694 CheckPPCMMAType(NewFD->getReturnType(), NewFD->getLocation())) { 10695 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10696 } 10697 10698 // C++11 [dcl.constexpr]p8: 10699 // A constexpr specifier for a non-static member function that is not 10700 // a constructor declares that member function to be const. 10701 // 10702 // This needs to be delayed until we know whether this is an out-of-line 10703 // definition of a static member function. 10704 // 10705 // This rule is not present in C++1y, so we produce a backwards 10706 // compatibility warning whenever it happens in C++11. 10707 CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD); 10708 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && MD && MD->isConstexpr() && 10709 !MD->isStatic() && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(MD) && 10710 !isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(MD) && !MD->getMethodQualifiers().hasConst()) { 10711 CXXMethodDecl *OldMD = nullptr; 10712 if (OldDecl) 10713 OldMD = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(OldDecl->getAsFunction()); 10714 if (!OldMD || !OldMD->isStatic()) { 10715 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = 10716 MD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 10717 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo(); 10718 EPI.TypeQuals.addConst(); 10719 MD->setType(Context.getFunctionType(FPT->getReturnType(), 10720 FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI)); 10721 10722 // Warn that we did this, if we're not performing template instantiation. 10723 // In that case, we'll have warned already when the template was defined. 10724 if (!inTemplateInstantiation()) { 10725 SourceLocation AddConstLoc; 10726 if (FunctionTypeLoc FTL = MD->getTypeSourceInfo()->getTypeLoc() 10727 .IgnoreParens().getAs<FunctionTypeLoc>()) 10728 AddConstLoc = getLocForEndOfToken(FTL.getRParenLoc()); 10729 10730 Diag(MD->getLocation(), diag::warn_cxx14_compat_constexpr_not_const) 10731 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(AddConstLoc, " const"); 10732 } 10733 } 10734 } 10735 10736 if (Redeclaration) { 10737 // NewFD and OldDecl represent declarations that need to be 10738 // merged. 10739 if (MergeFunctionDecl(NewFD, OldDecl, S, MergeTypeWithPrevious)) { 10740 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10741 return Redeclaration; 10742 } 10743 10744 Previous.clear(); 10745 Previous.addDecl(OldDecl); 10746 10747 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *OldTemplateDecl = 10748 dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(OldDecl)) { 10749 auto *OldFD = OldTemplateDecl->getTemplatedDecl(); 10750 FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplateDecl 10751 = NewFD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate(); 10752 assert(NewTemplateDecl && "Template/non-template mismatch"); 10753 10754 // The call to MergeFunctionDecl above may have created some state in 10755 // NewTemplateDecl that needs to be merged with OldTemplateDecl before we 10756 // can add it as a redeclaration. 10757 NewTemplateDecl->mergePrevDecl(OldTemplateDecl); 10758 10759 NewFD->setPreviousDeclaration(OldFD); 10760 adjustDeclContextForDeclaratorDecl(NewFD, OldFD); 10761 if (NewFD->isCXXClassMember()) { 10762 NewFD->setAccess(OldTemplateDecl->getAccess()); 10763 NewTemplateDecl->setAccess(OldTemplateDecl->getAccess()); 10764 } 10765 10766 // If this is an explicit specialization of a member that is a function 10767 // template, mark it as a member specialization. 10768 if (IsMemberSpecialization && 10769 NewTemplateDecl->getInstantiatedFromMemberTemplate()) { 10770 NewTemplateDecl->setMemberSpecialization(); 10771 assert(OldTemplateDecl->isMemberSpecialization()); 10772 // Explicit specializations of a member template do not inherit deleted 10773 // status from the parent member template that they are specializing. 10774 if (OldFD->isDeleted()) { 10775 // FIXME: This assert will not hold in the presence of modules. 10776 assert(OldFD->getCanonicalDecl() == OldFD); 10777 // FIXME: We need an update record for this AST mutation. 10778 OldFD->setDeletedAsWritten(false); 10779 } 10780 } 10781 10782 } else { 10783 if (shouldLinkDependentDeclWithPrevious(NewFD, OldDecl)) { 10784 auto *OldFD = cast<FunctionDecl>(OldDecl); 10785 // This needs to happen first so that 'inline' propagates. 10786 NewFD->setPreviousDeclaration(OldFD); 10787 adjustDeclContextForDeclaratorDecl(NewFD, OldFD); 10788 if (NewFD->isCXXClassMember()) 10789 NewFD->setAccess(OldFD->getAccess()); 10790 } 10791 } 10792 } else if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && MayNeedOverloadableChecks && 10793 !NewFD->getAttr<OverloadableAttr>()) { 10794 assert((Previous.empty() || 10795 llvm::any_of(Previous, 10796 [](const NamedDecl *ND) { 10797 return ND->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>(); 10798 })) && 10799 "Non-redecls shouldn't happen without overloadable present"); 10800 10801 auto OtherUnmarkedIter = llvm::find_if(Previous, [](const NamedDecl *ND) { 10802 const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(ND); 10803 return FD && !FD->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>(); 10804 }); 10805 10806 if (OtherUnmarkedIter != Previous.end()) { 10807 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), 10808 diag::err_attribute_overloadable_multiple_unmarked_overloads); 10809 Diag((*OtherUnmarkedIter)->getLocation(), 10810 diag::note_attribute_overloadable_prev_overload) 10811 << false; 10812 10813 NewFD->addAttr(OverloadableAttr::CreateImplicit(Context)); 10814 } 10815 } 10816 10817 // Semantic checking for this function declaration (in isolation). 10818 10819 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 10820 // C++-specific checks. 10821 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewFD)) { 10822 CheckConstructor(Constructor); 10823 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = 10824 dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(NewFD)) { 10825 CXXRecordDecl *Record = Destructor->getParent(); 10826 QualType ClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Record); 10827 10828 // FIXME: Shouldn't we be able to perform this check even when the class 10829 // type is dependent? Both gcc and edg can handle that. 10830 if (!ClassType->isDependentType()) { 10831 DeclarationName Name 10832 = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXDestructorName( 10833 Context.getCanonicalType(ClassType)); 10834 if (NewFD->getDeclName() != Name) { 10835 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_destructor_name); 10836 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10837 return Redeclaration; 10838 } 10839 } 10840 } else if (auto *Guide = dyn_cast<CXXDeductionGuideDecl>(NewFD)) { 10841 if (auto *TD = Guide->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) 10842 CheckDeductionGuideTemplate(TD); 10843 10844 // A deduction guide is not on the list of entities that can be 10845 // explicitly specialized. 10846 if (Guide->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ExplicitSpecialization) 10847 Diag(Guide->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_deduction_guide_specialized) 10848 << /*explicit specialization*/ 1; 10849 } 10850 10851 // Find any virtual functions that this function overrides. 10852 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD)) { 10853 if (!Method->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization() && 10854 !Method->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() && 10855 Method->isCanonicalDecl()) { 10856 AddOverriddenMethods(Method->getParent(), Method); 10857 } 10858 if (Method->isVirtual() && NewFD->getTrailingRequiresClause()) 10859 // C++2a [class.virtual]p6 10860 // A virtual method shall not have a requires-clause. 10861 Diag(NewFD->getTrailingRequiresClause()->getBeginLoc(), 10862 diag::err_constrained_virtual_method); 10863 10864 if (Method->isStatic()) 10865 checkThisInStaticMemberFunctionType(Method); 10866 } 10867 10868 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(NewFD)) 10869 ActOnConversionDeclarator(Conversion); 10870 10871 // Extra checking for C++ overloaded operators (C++ [over.oper]). 10872 if (NewFD->isOverloadedOperator() && 10873 CheckOverloadedOperatorDeclaration(NewFD)) { 10874 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10875 return Redeclaration; 10876 } 10877 10878 // Extra checking for C++0x literal operators (C++0x [over.literal]). 10879 if (NewFD->getLiteralIdentifier() && 10880 CheckLiteralOperatorDeclaration(NewFD)) { 10881 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 10882 return Redeclaration; 10883 } 10884 10885 // In C++, check default arguments now that we have merged decls. Unless 10886 // the lexical context is the class, because in this case this is done 10887 // during delayed parsing anyway. 10888 if (!CurContext->isRecord()) 10889 CheckCXXDefaultArguments(NewFD); 10890 10891 // If this function declares a builtin function, check the type of this 10892 // declaration against the expected type for the builtin. 10893 if (unsigned BuiltinID = NewFD->getBuiltinID()) { 10894 ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError Error; 10895 LookupNecessaryTypesForBuiltin(S, BuiltinID); 10896 QualType T = Context.GetBuiltinType(BuiltinID, Error); 10897 // If the type of the builtin differs only in its exception 10898 // specification, that's OK. 10899 // FIXME: If the types do differ in this way, it would be better to 10900 // retain the 'noexcept' form of the type. 10901 if (!T.isNull() && 10902 !Context.hasSameFunctionTypeIgnoringExceptionSpec(T, 10903 NewFD->getType())) 10904 // The type of this function differs from the type of the builtin, 10905 // so forget about the builtin entirely. 10906 Context.BuiltinInfo.forgetBuiltin(BuiltinID, Context.Idents); 10907 } 10908 10909 // If this function is declared as being extern "C", then check to see if 10910 // the function returns a UDT (class, struct, or union type) that is not C 10911 // compatible, and if it does, warn the user. 10912 // But, issue any diagnostic on the first declaration only. 10913 if (Previous.empty() && NewFD->isExternC()) { 10914 QualType R = NewFD->getReturnType(); 10915 if (R->isIncompleteType() && !R->isVoidType()) 10916 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::warn_return_value_udt_incomplete) 10917 << NewFD << R; 10918 else if (!R.isPODType(Context) && !R->isVoidType() && 10919 !R->isObjCObjectPointerType()) 10920 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::warn_return_value_udt) << NewFD << R; 10921 } 10922 10923 // C++1z [dcl.fct]p6: 10924 // [...] whether the function has a non-throwing exception-specification 10925 // [is] part of the function type 10926 // 10927 // This results in an ABI break between C++14 and C++17 for functions whose 10928 // declared type includes an exception-specification in a parameter or 10929 // return type. (Exception specifications on the function itself are OK in 10930 // most cases, and exception specifications are not permitted in most other 10931 // contexts where they could make it into a mangling.) 10932 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 && !NewFD->getPrimaryTemplate()) { 10933 auto HasNoexcept = [&](QualType T) -> bool { 10934 // Strip off declarator chunks that could be between us and a function 10935 // type. We don't need to look far, exception specifications are very 10936 // restricted prior to C++17. 10937 if (auto *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 10938 T = RT->getPointeeType(); 10939 else if (T->isAnyPointerType()) 10940 T = T->getPointeeType(); 10941 else if (auto *MPT = T->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) 10942 T = MPT->getPointeeType(); 10943 if (auto *FPT = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 10944 if (FPT->isNothrow()) 10945 return true; 10946 return false; 10947 }; 10948 10949 auto *FPT = NewFD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 10950 bool AnyNoexcept = HasNoexcept(FPT->getReturnType()); 10951 for (QualType T : FPT->param_types()) 10952 AnyNoexcept |= HasNoexcept(T); 10953 if (AnyNoexcept) 10954 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), 10955 diag::warn_cxx17_compat_exception_spec_in_signature) 10956 << NewFD; 10957 } 10958 10959 if (!Redeclaration && LangOpts.CUDA) 10960 checkCUDATargetOverload(NewFD, Previous); 10961 } 10962 return Redeclaration; 10963 } 10964 10965 void Sema::CheckMain(FunctionDecl* FD, const DeclSpec& DS) { 10966 // C++11 [basic.start.main]p3: 10967 // A program that [...] declares main to be inline, static or 10968 // constexpr is ill-formed. 10969 // C11 6.7.4p4: In a hosted environment, no function specifier(s) shall 10970 // appear in a declaration of main. 10971 // static main is not an error under C99, but we should warn about it. 10972 // We accept _Noreturn main as an extension. 10973 if (FD->getStorageClass() == SC_Static) 10974 Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(), getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 10975 ? diag::err_static_main : diag::warn_static_main) 10976 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 10977 if (FD->isInlineSpecified()) 10978 Diag(DS.getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_main) 10979 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getInlineSpecLoc()); 10980 if (DS.isNoreturnSpecified()) { 10981 SourceLocation NoreturnLoc = DS.getNoreturnSpecLoc(); 10982 SourceRange NoreturnRange(NoreturnLoc, getLocForEndOfToken(NoreturnLoc)); 10983 Diag(NoreturnLoc, diag::ext_noreturn_main); 10984 Diag(NoreturnLoc, diag::note_main_remove_noreturn) 10985 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(NoreturnRange); 10986 } 10987 if (FD->isConstexpr()) { 10988 Diag(DS.getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_constexpr_main) 10989 << FD->isConsteval() 10990 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getConstexprSpecLoc()); 10991 FD->setConstexprKind(CSK_unspecified); 10992 } 10993 10994 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 10995 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_no_main) 10996 << FD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>(); 10997 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 10998 return; 10999 } 11000 11001 QualType T = FD->getType(); 11002 assert(T->isFunctionType() && "function decl is not of function type"); 11003 const FunctionType* FT = T->castAs<FunctionType>(); 11004 11005 // Set default calling convention for main() 11006 if (FT->getCallConv() != CC_C) { 11007 FT = Context.adjustFunctionType(FT, FT->getExtInfo().withCallingConv(CC_C)); 11008 FD->setType(QualType(FT, 0)); 11009 T = Context.getCanonicalType(FD->getType()); 11010 } 11011 11012 if (getLangOpts().GNUMode && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 11013 // In C with GNU extensions we allow main() to have non-integer return 11014 // type, but we should warn about the extension, and we disable the 11015 // implicit-return-zero rule. 11016 11017 // GCC in C mode accepts qualified 'int'. 11018 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FT->getReturnType(), Context.IntTy)) 11019 FD->setHasImplicitReturnZero(true); 11020 else { 11021 Diag(FD->getTypeSpecStartLoc(), diag::ext_main_returns_nonint); 11022 SourceRange RTRange = FD->getReturnTypeSourceRange(); 11023 if (RTRange.isValid()) 11024 Diag(RTRange.getBegin(), diag::note_main_change_return_type) 11025 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(RTRange, "int"); 11026 } 11027 } else { 11028 // In C and C++, main magically returns 0 if you fall off the end; 11029 // set the flag which tells us that. 11030 // This is C++ [basic.start.main]p5 and C99 5.1.2.2.3. 11031 11032 // All the standards say that main() should return 'int'. 11033 if (Context.hasSameType(FT->getReturnType(), Context.IntTy)) 11034 FD->setHasImplicitReturnZero(true); 11035 else { 11036 // Otherwise, this is just a flat-out error. 11037 SourceRange RTRange = FD->getReturnTypeSourceRange(); 11038 Diag(FD->getTypeSpecStartLoc(), diag::err_main_returns_nonint) 11039 << (RTRange.isValid() ? FixItHint::CreateReplacement(RTRange, "int") 11040 : FixItHint()); 11041 FD->setInvalidDecl(true); 11042 } 11043 } 11044 11045 // Treat protoless main() as nullary. 11046 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FT)) return; 11047 11048 const FunctionProtoType* FTP = cast<const FunctionProtoType>(FT); 11049 unsigned nparams = FTP->getNumParams(); 11050 assert(FD->getNumParams() == nparams); 11051 11052 bool HasExtraParameters = (nparams > 3); 11053 11054 if (FTP->isVariadic()) { 11055 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::ext_variadic_main); 11056 // FIXME: if we had information about the location of the ellipsis, we 11057 // could add a FixIt hint to remove it as a parameter. 11058 } 11059 11060 // Darwin passes an undocumented fourth argument of type char**. If 11061 // other platforms start sprouting these, the logic below will start 11062 // getting shifty. 11063 if (nparams == 4 && Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isOSDarwin()) 11064 HasExtraParameters = false; 11065 11066 if (HasExtraParameters) { 11067 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_main_surplus_args) << nparams; 11068 FD->setInvalidDecl(true); 11069 nparams = 3; 11070 } 11071 11072 // FIXME: a lot of the following diagnostics would be improved 11073 // if we had some location information about types. 11074 11075 QualType CharPP = 11076 Context.getPointerType(Context.getPointerType(Context.CharTy)); 11077 QualType Expected[] = { Context.IntTy, CharPP, CharPP, CharPP }; 11078 11079 for (unsigned i = 0; i < nparams; ++i) { 11080 QualType AT = FTP->getParamType(i); 11081 11082 bool mismatch = true; 11083 11084 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(AT, Expected[i])) 11085 mismatch = false; 11086 else if (Expected[i] == CharPP) { 11087 // As an extension, the following forms are okay: 11088 // char const ** 11089 // char const * const * 11090 // char * const * 11091 11092 QualifierCollector qs; 11093 const PointerType* PT; 11094 if ((PT = qs.strip(AT)->getAs<PointerType>()) && 11095 (PT = qs.strip(PT->getPointeeType())->getAs<PointerType>()) && 11096 Context.hasSameType(QualType(qs.strip(PT->getPointeeType()), 0), 11097 Context.CharTy)) { 11098 qs.removeConst(); 11099 mismatch = !qs.empty(); 11100 } 11101 } 11102 11103 if (mismatch) { 11104 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_main_arg_wrong) << i << Expected[i]; 11105 // TODO: suggest replacing given type with expected type 11106 FD->setInvalidDecl(true); 11107 } 11108 } 11109 11110 if (nparams == 1 && !FD->isInvalidDecl()) { 11111 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::warn_main_one_arg); 11112 } 11113 11114 if (!FD->isInvalidDecl() && FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) { 11115 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_mainlike_template_decl) << FD; 11116 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 11117 } 11118 } 11119 11120 void Sema::CheckMSVCRTEntryPoint(FunctionDecl *FD) { 11121 QualType T = FD->getType(); 11122 assert(T->isFunctionType() && "function decl is not of function type"); 11123 const FunctionType *FT = T->castAs<FunctionType>(); 11124 11125 // Set an implicit return of 'zero' if the function can return some integral, 11126 // enumeration, pointer or nullptr type. 11127 if (FT->getReturnType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() || 11128 FT->getReturnType()->isAnyPointerType() || 11129 FT->getReturnType()->isNullPtrType()) 11130 // DllMain is exempt because a return value of zero means it failed. 11131 if (FD->getName() != "DllMain") 11132 FD->setHasImplicitReturnZero(true); 11133 11134 if (!FD->isInvalidDecl() && FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) { 11135 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_mainlike_template_decl) << FD; 11136 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 11137 } 11138 } 11139 11140 bool Sema::CheckForConstantInitializer(Expr *Init, QualType DclT) { 11141 // FIXME: Need strict checking. In C89, we need to check for 11142 // any assignment, increment, decrement, function-calls, or 11143 // commas outside of a sizeof. In C99, it's the same list, 11144 // except that the aforementioned are allowed in unevaluated 11145 // expressions. Everything else falls under the 11146 // "may accept other forms of constant expressions" exception. 11147 // 11148 // Regular C++ code will not end up here (exceptions: language extensions, 11149 // OpenCL C++ etc), so the constant expression rules there don't matter. 11150 if (Init->isValueDependent()) { 11151 assert(Init->containsErrors() && 11152 "Dependent code should only occur in error-recovery path."); 11153 return true; 11154 } 11155 const Expr *Culprit; 11156 if (Init->isConstantInitializer(Context, false, &Culprit)) 11157 return false; 11158 Diag(Culprit->getExprLoc(), diag::err_init_element_not_constant) 11159 << Culprit->getSourceRange(); 11160 return true; 11161 } 11162 11163 namespace { 11164 // Visits an initialization expression to see if OrigDecl is evaluated in 11165 // its own initialization and throws a warning if it does. 11166 class SelfReferenceChecker 11167 : public EvaluatedExprVisitor<SelfReferenceChecker> { 11168 Sema &S; 11169 Decl *OrigDecl; 11170 bool isRecordType; 11171 bool isPODType; 11172 bool isReferenceType; 11173 11174 bool isInitList; 11175 llvm::SmallVector<unsigned, 4> InitFieldIndex; 11176 11177 public: 11178 typedef EvaluatedExprVisitor<SelfReferenceChecker> Inherited; 11179 11180 SelfReferenceChecker(Sema &S, Decl *OrigDecl) : Inherited(S.Context), 11181 S(S), OrigDecl(OrigDecl) { 11182 isPODType = false; 11183 isRecordType = false; 11184 isReferenceType = false; 11185 isInitList = false; 11186 if (ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(OrigDecl)) { 11187 isPODType = VD->getType().isPODType(S.Context); 11188 isRecordType = VD->getType()->isRecordType(); 11189 isReferenceType = VD->getType()->isReferenceType(); 11190 } 11191 } 11192 11193 // For most expressions, just call the visitor. For initializer lists, 11194 // track the index of the field being initialized since fields are 11195 // initialized in order allowing use of previously initialized fields. 11196 void CheckExpr(Expr *E) { 11197 InitListExpr *InitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(E); 11198 if (!InitList) { 11199 Visit(E); 11200 return; 11201 } 11202 11203 // Track and increment the index here. 11204 isInitList = true; 11205 InitFieldIndex.push_back(0); 11206 for (auto Child : InitList->children()) { 11207 CheckExpr(cast<Expr>(Child)); 11208 ++InitFieldIndex.back(); 11209 } 11210 InitFieldIndex.pop_back(); 11211 } 11212 11213 // Returns true if MemberExpr is checked and no further checking is needed. 11214 // Returns false if additional checking is required. 11215 bool CheckInitListMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E, bool CheckReference) { 11216 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Fields; 11217 Expr *Base = E; 11218 bool ReferenceField = false; 11219 11220 // Get the field members used. 11221 while (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Base)) { 11222 FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()); 11223 if (!FD) 11224 return false; 11225 Fields.push_back(FD); 11226 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) 11227 ReferenceField = true; 11228 Base = ME->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 11229 } 11230 11231 // Keep checking only if the base Decl is the same. 11232 DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Base); 11233 if (!DRE || DRE->getDecl() != OrigDecl) 11234 return false; 11235 11236 // A reference field can be bound to an unininitialized field. 11237 if (CheckReference && !ReferenceField) 11238 return true; 11239 11240 // Convert FieldDecls to their index number. 11241 llvm::SmallVector<unsigned, 4> UsedFieldIndex; 11242 for (const FieldDecl *I : llvm::reverse(Fields)) 11243 UsedFieldIndex.push_back(I->getFieldIndex()); 11244 11245 // See if a warning is needed by checking the first difference in index 11246 // numbers. If field being used has index less than the field being 11247 // initialized, then the use is safe. 11248 for (auto UsedIter = UsedFieldIndex.begin(), 11249 UsedEnd = UsedFieldIndex.end(), 11250 OrigIter = InitFieldIndex.begin(), 11251 OrigEnd = InitFieldIndex.end(); 11252 UsedIter != UsedEnd && OrigIter != OrigEnd; ++UsedIter, ++OrigIter) { 11253 if (*UsedIter < *OrigIter) 11254 return true; 11255 if (*UsedIter > *OrigIter) 11256 break; 11257 } 11258 11259 // TODO: Add a different warning which will print the field names. 11260 HandleDeclRefExpr(DRE); 11261 return true; 11262 } 11263 11264 // For most expressions, the cast is directly above the DeclRefExpr. 11265 // For conditional operators, the cast can be outside the conditional 11266 // operator if both expressions are DeclRefExpr's. 11267 void HandleValue(Expr *E) { 11268 E = E->IgnoreParens(); 11269 if (DeclRefExpr* DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) { 11270 HandleDeclRefExpr(DRE); 11271 return; 11272 } 11273 11274 if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(E)) { 11275 Visit(CO->getCond()); 11276 HandleValue(CO->getTrueExpr()); 11277 HandleValue(CO->getFalseExpr()); 11278 return; 11279 } 11280 11281 if (BinaryConditionalOperator *BCO = 11282 dyn_cast<BinaryConditionalOperator>(E)) { 11283 Visit(BCO->getCond()); 11284 HandleValue(BCO->getFalseExpr()); 11285 return; 11286 } 11287 11288 if (OpaqueValueExpr *OVE = dyn_cast<OpaqueValueExpr>(E)) { 11289 HandleValue(OVE->getSourceExpr()); 11290 return; 11291 } 11292 11293 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E)) { 11294 if (BO->getOpcode() == BO_Comma) { 11295 Visit(BO->getLHS()); 11296 HandleValue(BO->getRHS()); 11297 return; 11298 } 11299 } 11300 11301 if (isa<MemberExpr>(E)) { 11302 if (isInitList) { 11303 if (CheckInitListMemberExpr(cast<MemberExpr>(E), 11304 false /*CheckReference*/)) 11305 return; 11306 } 11307 11308 Expr *Base = E->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 11309 while (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Base)) { 11310 // Check for static member variables and don't warn on them. 11311 if (!isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) 11312 return; 11313 Base = ME->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 11314 } 11315 if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Base)) 11316 HandleDeclRefExpr(DRE); 11317 return; 11318 } 11319 11320 Visit(E); 11321 } 11322 11323 // Reference types not handled in HandleValue are handled here since all 11324 // uses of references are bad, not just r-value uses. 11325 void VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) { 11326 if (isReferenceType) 11327 HandleDeclRefExpr(E); 11328 } 11329 11330 void VisitImplicitCastExpr(ImplicitCastExpr *E) { 11331 if (E->getCastKind() == CK_LValueToRValue) { 11332 HandleValue(E->getSubExpr()); 11333 return; 11334 } 11335 11336 Inherited::VisitImplicitCastExpr(E); 11337 } 11338 11339 void VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) { 11340 if (isInitList) { 11341 if (CheckInitListMemberExpr(E, true /*CheckReference*/)) 11342 return; 11343 } 11344 11345 // Don't warn on arrays since they can be treated as pointers. 11346 if (E->getType()->canDecayToPointerType()) return; 11347 11348 // Warn when a non-static method call is followed by non-static member 11349 // field accesses, which is followed by a DeclRefExpr. 11350 CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(E->getMemberDecl()); 11351 bool Warn = (MD && !MD->isStatic()); 11352 Expr *Base = E->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 11353 while (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Base)) { 11354 if (!isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) 11355 Warn = false; 11356 Base = ME->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 11357 } 11358 11359 if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Base)) { 11360 if (Warn) 11361 HandleDeclRefExpr(DRE); 11362 return; 11363 } 11364 11365 // The base of a MemberExpr is not a MemberExpr or a DeclRefExpr. 11366 // Visit that expression. 11367 Visit(Base); 11368 } 11369 11370 void VisitCXXOperatorCallExpr(CXXOperatorCallExpr *E) { 11371 Expr *Callee = E->getCallee(); 11372 11373 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(Callee)) 11374 return Inherited::VisitCXXOperatorCallExpr(E); 11375 11376 Visit(Callee); 11377 for (auto Arg: E->arguments()) 11378 HandleValue(Arg->IgnoreParenImpCasts()); 11379 } 11380 11381 void VisitUnaryOperator(UnaryOperator *E) { 11382 // For POD record types, addresses of its own members are well-defined. 11383 if (E->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf && isRecordType && 11384 isa<MemberExpr>(E->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens())) { 11385 if (!isPODType) 11386 HandleValue(E->getSubExpr()); 11387 return; 11388 } 11389 11390 if (E->isIncrementDecrementOp()) { 11391 HandleValue(E->getSubExpr()); 11392 return; 11393 } 11394 11395 Inherited::VisitUnaryOperator(E); 11396 } 11397 11398 void VisitObjCMessageExpr(ObjCMessageExpr *E) {} 11399 11400 void VisitCXXConstructExpr(CXXConstructExpr *E) { 11401 if (E->getConstructor()->isCopyConstructor()) { 11402 Expr *ArgExpr = E->getArg(0); 11403 if (InitListExpr *ILE = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(ArgExpr)) 11404 if (ILE->getNumInits() == 1) 11405 ArgExpr = ILE->getInit(0); 11406 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(ArgExpr)) 11407 if (ICE->getCastKind() == CK_NoOp) 11408 ArgExpr = ICE->getSubExpr(); 11409 HandleValue(ArgExpr); 11410 return; 11411 } 11412 Inherited::VisitCXXConstructExpr(E); 11413 } 11414 11415 void VisitCallExpr(CallExpr *E) { 11416 // Treat std::move as a use. 11417 if (E->isCallToStdMove()) { 11418 HandleValue(E->getArg(0)); 11419 return; 11420 } 11421 11422 Inherited::VisitCallExpr(E); 11423 } 11424 11425 void VisitBinaryOperator(BinaryOperator *E) { 11426 if (E->isCompoundAssignmentOp()) { 11427 HandleValue(E->getLHS()); 11428 Visit(E->getRHS()); 11429 return; 11430 } 11431 11432 Inherited::VisitBinaryOperator(E); 11433 } 11434 11435 // A custom visitor for BinaryConditionalOperator is needed because the 11436 // regular visitor would check the condition and true expression separately 11437 // but both point to the same place giving duplicate diagnostics. 11438 void VisitBinaryConditionalOperator(BinaryConditionalOperator *E) { 11439 Visit(E->getCond()); 11440 Visit(E->getFalseExpr()); 11441 } 11442 11443 void HandleDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *DRE) { 11444 Decl* ReferenceDecl = DRE->getDecl(); 11445 if (OrigDecl != ReferenceDecl) return; 11446 unsigned diag; 11447 if (isReferenceType) { 11448 diag = diag::warn_uninit_self_reference_in_reference_init; 11449 } else if (cast<VarDecl>(OrigDecl)->isStaticLocal()) { 11450 diag = diag::warn_static_self_reference_in_init; 11451 } else if (isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(OrigDecl->getDeclContext()) || 11452 isa<NamespaceDecl>(OrigDecl->getDeclContext()) || 11453 DRE->getDecl()->getType()->isRecordType()) { 11454 diag = diag::warn_uninit_self_reference_in_init; 11455 } else { 11456 // Local variables will be handled by the CFG analysis. 11457 return; 11458 } 11459 11460 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(DRE->getBeginLoc(), DRE, 11461 S.PDiag(diag) 11462 << DRE->getDecl() << OrigDecl->getLocation() 11463 << DRE->getSourceRange()); 11464 } 11465 }; 11466 11467 /// CheckSelfReference - Warns if OrigDecl is used in expression E. 11468 static void CheckSelfReference(Sema &S, Decl* OrigDecl, Expr *E, 11469 bool DirectInit) { 11470 // Parameters arguments are occassionially constructed with itself, 11471 // for instance, in recursive functions. Skip them. 11472 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(OrigDecl)) 11473 return; 11474 11475 E = E->IgnoreParens(); 11476 11477 // Skip checking T a = a where T is not a record or reference type. 11478 // Doing so is a way to silence uninitialized warnings. 11479 if (!DirectInit && !cast<VarDecl>(OrigDecl)->getType()->isRecordType()) 11480 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) 11481 if (ICE->getCastKind() == CK_LValueToRValue) 11482 if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(ICE->getSubExpr())) 11483 if (DRE->getDecl() == OrigDecl) 11484 return; 11485 11486 SelfReferenceChecker(S, OrigDecl).CheckExpr(E); 11487 } 11488 } // end anonymous namespace 11489 11490 namespace { 11491 // Simple wrapper to add the name of a variable or (if no variable is 11492 // available) a DeclarationName into a diagnostic. 11493 struct VarDeclOrName { 11494 VarDecl *VDecl; 11495 DeclarationName Name; 11496 11497 friend const Sema::SemaDiagnosticBuilder & 11498 operator<<(const Sema::SemaDiagnosticBuilder &Diag, VarDeclOrName VN) { 11499 return VN.VDecl ? Diag << VN.VDecl : Diag << VN.Name; 11500 } 11501 }; 11502 } // end anonymous namespace 11503 11504 QualType Sema::deduceVarTypeFromInitializer(VarDecl *VDecl, 11505 DeclarationName Name, QualType Type, 11506 TypeSourceInfo *TSI, 11507 SourceRange Range, bool DirectInit, 11508 Expr *Init) { 11509 bool IsInitCapture = !VDecl; 11510 assert((!VDecl || !VDecl->isInitCapture()) && 11511 "init captures are expected to be deduced prior to initialization"); 11512 11513 VarDeclOrName VN{VDecl, Name}; 11514 11515 DeducedType *Deduced = Type->getContainedDeducedType(); 11516 assert(Deduced && "deduceVarTypeFromInitializer for non-deduced type"); 11517 11518 // C++11 [dcl.spec.auto]p3 11519 if (!Init) { 11520 assert(VDecl && "no init for init capture deduction?"); 11521 11522 // Except for class argument deduction, and then for an initializing 11523 // declaration only, i.e. no static at class scope or extern. 11524 if (!isa<DeducedTemplateSpecializationType>(Deduced) || 11525 VDecl->hasExternalStorage() || 11526 VDecl->isStaticDataMember()) { 11527 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_auto_var_requires_init) 11528 << VDecl->getDeclName() << Type; 11529 return QualType(); 11530 } 11531 } 11532 11533 ArrayRef<Expr*> DeduceInits; 11534 if (Init) 11535 DeduceInits = Init; 11536 11537 if (DirectInit) { 11538 if (auto *PL = dyn_cast_or_null<ParenListExpr>(Init)) 11539 DeduceInits = PL->exprs(); 11540 } 11541 11542 if (isa<DeducedTemplateSpecializationType>(Deduced)) { 11543 assert(VDecl && "non-auto type for init capture deduction?"); 11544 InitializedEntity Entity = InitializedEntity::InitializeVariable(VDecl); 11545 InitializationKind Kind = InitializationKind::CreateForInit( 11546 VDecl->getLocation(), DirectInit, Init); 11547 // FIXME: Initialization should not be taking a mutable list of inits. 11548 SmallVector<Expr*, 8> InitsCopy(DeduceInits.begin(), DeduceInits.end()); 11549 return DeduceTemplateSpecializationFromInitializer(TSI, Entity, Kind, 11550 InitsCopy); 11551 } 11552 11553 if (DirectInit) { 11554 if (auto *IL = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(Init)) 11555 DeduceInits = IL->inits(); 11556 } 11557 11558 // Deduction only works if we have exactly one source expression. 11559 if (DeduceInits.empty()) { 11560 // It isn't possible to write this directly, but it is possible to 11561 // end up in this situation with "auto x(some_pack...);" 11562 Diag(Init->getBeginLoc(), IsInitCapture 11563 ? diag::err_init_capture_no_expression 11564 : diag::err_auto_var_init_no_expression) 11565 << VN << Type << Range; 11566 return QualType(); 11567 } 11568 11569 if (DeduceInits.size() > 1) { 11570 Diag(DeduceInits[1]->getBeginLoc(), 11571 IsInitCapture ? diag::err_init_capture_multiple_expressions 11572 : diag::err_auto_var_init_multiple_expressions) 11573 << VN << Type << Range; 11574 return QualType(); 11575 } 11576 11577 Expr *DeduceInit = DeduceInits[0]; 11578 if (DirectInit && isa<InitListExpr>(DeduceInit)) { 11579 Diag(Init->getBeginLoc(), IsInitCapture 11580 ? diag::err_init_capture_paren_braces 11581 : diag::err_auto_var_init_paren_braces) 11582 << isa<InitListExpr>(Init) << VN << Type << Range; 11583 return QualType(); 11584 } 11585 11586 // Expressions default to 'id' when we're in a debugger. 11587 bool DefaultedAnyToId = false; 11588 if (getLangOpts().DebuggerCastResultToId && 11589 Init->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy && !IsInitCapture) { 11590 ExprResult Result = forceUnknownAnyToType(Init, Context.getObjCIdType()); 11591 if (Result.isInvalid()) { 11592 return QualType(); 11593 } 11594 Init = Result.get(); 11595 DefaultedAnyToId = true; 11596 } 11597 11598 // C++ [dcl.decomp]p1: 11599 // If the assignment-expression [...] has array type A and no ref-qualifier 11600 // is present, e has type cv A 11601 if (VDecl && isa<DecompositionDecl>(VDecl) && 11602 Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Type, Context.getAutoDeductType()) && 11603 DeduceInit->getType()->isConstantArrayType()) 11604 return Context.getQualifiedType(DeduceInit->getType(), 11605 Type.getQualifiers()); 11606 11607 QualType DeducedType; 11608 if (DeduceAutoType(TSI, DeduceInit, DeducedType) == DAR_Failed) { 11609 if (!IsInitCapture) 11610 DiagnoseAutoDeductionFailure(VDecl, DeduceInit); 11611 else if (isa<InitListExpr>(Init)) 11612 Diag(Range.getBegin(), 11613 diag::err_init_capture_deduction_failure_from_init_list) 11614 << VN 11615 << (DeduceInit->getType().isNull() ? TSI->getType() 11616 : DeduceInit->getType()) 11617 << DeduceInit->getSourceRange(); 11618 else 11619 Diag(Range.getBegin(), diag::err_init_capture_deduction_failure) 11620 << VN << TSI->getType() 11621 << (DeduceInit->getType().isNull() ? TSI->getType() 11622 : DeduceInit->getType()) 11623 << DeduceInit->getSourceRange(); 11624 } 11625 11626 // Warn if we deduced 'id'. 'auto' usually implies type-safety, but using 11627 // 'id' instead of a specific object type prevents most of our usual 11628 // checks. 11629 // We only want to warn outside of template instantiations, though: 11630 // inside a template, the 'id' could have come from a parameter. 11631 if (!inTemplateInstantiation() && !DefaultedAnyToId && !IsInitCapture && 11632 !DeducedType.isNull() && DeducedType->isObjCIdType()) { 11633 SourceLocation Loc = TSI->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(); 11634 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_auto_var_is_id) << VN << Range; 11635 } 11636 11637 return DeducedType; 11638 } 11639 11640 bool Sema::DeduceVariableDeclarationType(VarDecl *VDecl, bool DirectInit, 11641 Expr *Init) { 11642 assert(!Init || !Init->containsErrors()); 11643 QualType DeducedType = deduceVarTypeFromInitializer( 11644 VDecl, VDecl->getDeclName(), VDecl->getType(), VDecl->getTypeSourceInfo(), 11645 VDecl->getSourceRange(), DirectInit, Init); 11646 if (DeducedType.isNull()) { 11647 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 11648 return true; 11649 } 11650 11651 VDecl->setType(DeducedType); 11652 assert(VDecl->isLinkageValid()); 11653 11654 // In ARC, infer lifetime. 11655 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && inferObjCARCLifetime(VDecl)) 11656 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 11657 11658 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) 11659 deduceOpenCLAddressSpace(VDecl); 11660 11661 // If this is a redeclaration, check that the type we just deduced matches 11662 // the previously declared type. 11663 if (VarDecl *Old = VDecl->getPreviousDecl()) { 11664 // We never need to merge the type, because we cannot form an incomplete 11665 // array of auto, nor deduce such a type. 11666 MergeVarDeclTypes(VDecl, Old, /*MergeTypeWithPrevious*/ false); 11667 } 11668 11669 // Check the deduced type is valid for a variable declaration. 11670 CheckVariableDeclarationType(VDecl); 11671 return VDecl->isInvalidDecl(); 11672 } 11673 11674 void Sema::checkNonTrivialCUnionInInitializer(const Expr *Init, 11675 SourceLocation Loc) { 11676 if (auto *EWC = dyn_cast<ExprWithCleanups>(Init)) 11677 Init = EWC->getSubExpr(); 11678 11679 if (auto *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Init)) 11680 Init = CE->getSubExpr(); 11681 11682 QualType InitType = Init->getType(); 11683 assert((InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion() || 11684 InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()) && 11685 "shouldn't be called if type doesn't have a non-trivial C struct"); 11686 if (auto *ILE = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(Init)) { 11687 for (auto I : ILE->inits()) { 11688 if (!I->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion() && 11689 !I->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()) 11690 continue; 11691 SourceLocation SL = I->getExprLoc(); 11692 checkNonTrivialCUnionInInitializer(I, SL.isValid() ? SL : Loc); 11693 } 11694 return; 11695 } 11696 11697 if (isa<ImplicitValueInitExpr>(Init)) { 11698 if (InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion()) 11699 checkNonTrivialCUnion(InitType, Loc, NTCUC_DefaultInitializedObject, 11700 NTCUK_Init); 11701 } else { 11702 // Assume all other explicit initializers involving copying some existing 11703 // object. 11704 // TODO: ignore any explicit initializers where we can guarantee 11705 // copy-elision. 11706 if (InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()) 11707 checkNonTrivialCUnion(InitType, Loc, NTCUC_CopyInit, NTCUK_Copy); 11708 } 11709 } 11710 11711 namespace { 11712 11713 bool shouldIgnoreForRecordTriviality(const FieldDecl *FD) { 11714 // Ignore unavailable fields. A field can be marked as unavailable explicitly 11715 // in the source code or implicitly by the compiler if it is in a union 11716 // defined in a system header and has non-trivial ObjC ownership 11717 // qualifications. We don't want those fields to participate in determining 11718 // whether the containing union is non-trivial. 11719 return FD->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>(); 11720 } 11721 11722 struct DiagNonTrivalCUnionDefaultInitializeVisitor 11723 : DefaultInitializedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionDefaultInitializeVisitor, 11724 void> { 11725 using Super = 11726 DefaultInitializedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionDefaultInitializeVisitor, 11727 void>; 11728 11729 DiagNonTrivalCUnionDefaultInitializeVisitor( 11730 QualType OrigTy, SourceLocation OrigLoc, 11731 Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext, Sema &S) 11732 : OrigTy(OrigTy), OrigLoc(OrigLoc), UseContext(UseContext), S(S) {} 11733 11734 void visitWithKind(QualType::PrimitiveDefaultInitializeKind PDIK, QualType QT, 11735 const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 11736 if (const auto *AT = S.Context.getAsArrayType(QT)) 11737 return this->asDerived().visit(S.Context.getBaseElementType(AT), FD, 11738 InNonTrivialUnion); 11739 return Super::visitWithKind(PDIK, QT, FD, InNonTrivialUnion); 11740 } 11741 11742 void visitARCStrong(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, 11743 bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 11744 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 11745 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 11746 << 1 << 0 << QT << FD->getName(); 11747 } 11748 11749 void visitARCWeak(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 11750 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 11751 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 11752 << 1 << 0 << QT << FD->getName(); 11753 } 11754 11755 void visitStruct(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 11756 const RecordDecl *RD = QT->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl(); 11757 if (RD->isUnion()) { 11758 if (OrigLoc.isValid()) { 11759 bool IsUnion = false; 11760 if (auto *OrigRD = OrigTy->getAsRecordDecl()) 11761 IsUnion = OrigRD->isUnion(); 11762 S.Diag(OrigLoc, diag::err_non_trivial_c_union_in_invalid_context) 11763 << 0 << OrigTy << IsUnion << UseContext; 11764 // Reset OrigLoc so that this diagnostic is emitted only once. 11765 OrigLoc = SourceLocation(); 11766 } 11767 InNonTrivialUnion = true; 11768 } 11769 11770 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 11771 S.Diag(RD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 11772 << 0 << 0 << QT.getUnqualifiedType() << ""; 11773 11774 for (const FieldDecl *FD : RD->fields()) 11775 if (!shouldIgnoreForRecordTriviality(FD)) 11776 asDerived().visit(FD->getType(), FD, InNonTrivialUnion); 11777 } 11778 11779 void visitTrivial(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {} 11780 11781 // The non-trivial C union type or the struct/union type that contains a 11782 // non-trivial C union. 11783 QualType OrigTy; 11784 SourceLocation OrigLoc; 11785 Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext; 11786 Sema &S; 11787 }; 11788 11789 struct DiagNonTrivalCUnionDestructedTypeVisitor 11790 : DestructedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionDestructedTypeVisitor, void> { 11791 using Super = 11792 DestructedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionDestructedTypeVisitor, void>; 11793 11794 DiagNonTrivalCUnionDestructedTypeVisitor( 11795 QualType OrigTy, SourceLocation OrigLoc, 11796 Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext, Sema &S) 11797 : OrigTy(OrigTy), OrigLoc(OrigLoc), UseContext(UseContext), S(S) {} 11798 11799 void visitWithKind(QualType::DestructionKind DK, QualType QT, 11800 const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 11801 if (const auto *AT = S.Context.getAsArrayType(QT)) 11802 return this->asDerived().visit(S.Context.getBaseElementType(AT), FD, 11803 InNonTrivialUnion); 11804 return Super::visitWithKind(DK, QT, FD, InNonTrivialUnion); 11805 } 11806 11807 void visitARCStrong(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, 11808 bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 11809 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 11810 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 11811 << 1 << 1 << QT << FD->getName(); 11812 } 11813 11814 void visitARCWeak(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 11815 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 11816 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 11817 << 1 << 1 << QT << FD->getName(); 11818 } 11819 11820 void visitStruct(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 11821 const RecordDecl *RD = QT->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl(); 11822 if (RD->isUnion()) { 11823 if (OrigLoc.isValid()) { 11824 bool IsUnion = false; 11825 if (auto *OrigRD = OrigTy->getAsRecordDecl()) 11826 IsUnion = OrigRD->isUnion(); 11827 S.Diag(OrigLoc, diag::err_non_trivial_c_union_in_invalid_context) 11828 << 1 << OrigTy << IsUnion << UseContext; 11829 // Reset OrigLoc so that this diagnostic is emitted only once. 11830 OrigLoc = SourceLocation(); 11831 } 11832 InNonTrivialUnion = true; 11833 } 11834 11835 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 11836 S.Diag(RD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 11837 << 0 << 1 << QT.getUnqualifiedType() << ""; 11838 11839 for (const FieldDecl *FD : RD->fields()) 11840 if (!shouldIgnoreForRecordTriviality(FD)) 11841 asDerived().visit(FD->getType(), FD, InNonTrivialUnion); 11842 } 11843 11844 void visitTrivial(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {} 11845 void visitCXXDestructor(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, 11846 bool InNonTrivialUnion) {} 11847 11848 // The non-trivial C union type or the struct/union type that contains a 11849 // non-trivial C union. 11850 QualType OrigTy; 11851 SourceLocation OrigLoc; 11852 Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext; 11853 Sema &S; 11854 }; 11855 11856 struct DiagNonTrivalCUnionCopyVisitor 11857 : CopiedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionCopyVisitor, false, void> { 11858 using Super = CopiedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionCopyVisitor, false, void>; 11859 11860 DiagNonTrivalCUnionCopyVisitor(QualType OrigTy, SourceLocation OrigLoc, 11861 Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext, 11862 Sema &S) 11863 : OrigTy(OrigTy), OrigLoc(OrigLoc), UseContext(UseContext), S(S) {} 11864 11865 void visitWithKind(QualType::PrimitiveCopyKind PCK, QualType QT, 11866 const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 11867 if (const auto *AT = S.Context.getAsArrayType(QT)) 11868 return this->asDerived().visit(S.Context.getBaseElementType(AT), FD, 11869 InNonTrivialUnion); 11870 return Super::visitWithKind(PCK, QT, FD, InNonTrivialUnion); 11871 } 11872 11873 void visitARCStrong(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, 11874 bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 11875 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 11876 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 11877 << 1 << 2 << QT << FD->getName(); 11878 } 11879 11880 void visitARCWeak(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 11881 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 11882 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 11883 << 1 << 2 << QT << FD->getName(); 11884 } 11885 11886 void visitStruct(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) { 11887 const RecordDecl *RD = QT->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl(); 11888 if (RD->isUnion()) { 11889 if (OrigLoc.isValid()) { 11890 bool IsUnion = false; 11891 if (auto *OrigRD = OrigTy->getAsRecordDecl()) 11892 IsUnion = OrigRD->isUnion(); 11893 S.Diag(OrigLoc, diag::err_non_trivial_c_union_in_invalid_context) 11894 << 2 << OrigTy << IsUnion << UseContext; 11895 // Reset OrigLoc so that this diagnostic is emitted only once. 11896 OrigLoc = SourceLocation(); 11897 } 11898 InNonTrivialUnion = true; 11899 } 11900 11901 if (InNonTrivialUnion) 11902 S.Diag(RD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union) 11903 << 0 << 2 << QT.getUnqualifiedType() << ""; 11904 11905 for (const FieldDecl *FD : RD->fields()) 11906 if (!shouldIgnoreForRecordTriviality(FD)) 11907 asDerived().visit(FD->getType(), FD, InNonTrivialUnion); 11908 } 11909 11910 void preVisit(QualType::PrimitiveCopyKind PCK, QualType QT, 11911 const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {} 11912 void visitTrivial(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {} 11913 void visitVolatileTrivial(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, 11914 bool InNonTrivialUnion) {} 11915 11916 // The non-trivial C union type or the struct/union type that contains a 11917 // non-trivial C union. 11918 QualType OrigTy; 11919 SourceLocation OrigLoc; 11920 Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext; 11921 Sema &S; 11922 }; 11923 11924 } // namespace 11925 11926 void Sema::checkNonTrivialCUnion(QualType QT, SourceLocation Loc, 11927 NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext, 11928 unsigned NonTrivialKind) { 11929 assert((QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion() || 11930 QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() || 11931 QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()) && 11932 "shouldn't be called if type doesn't have a non-trivial C union"); 11933 11934 if ((NonTrivialKind & NTCUK_Init) && 11935 QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion()) 11936 DiagNonTrivalCUnionDefaultInitializeVisitor(QT, Loc, UseContext, *this) 11937 .visit(QT, nullptr, false); 11938 if ((NonTrivialKind & NTCUK_Destruct) && 11939 QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion()) 11940 DiagNonTrivalCUnionDestructedTypeVisitor(QT, Loc, UseContext, *this) 11941 .visit(QT, nullptr, false); 11942 if ((NonTrivialKind & NTCUK_Copy) && QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()) 11943 DiagNonTrivalCUnionCopyVisitor(QT, Loc, UseContext, *this) 11944 .visit(QT, nullptr, false); 11945 } 11946 11947 /// AddInitializerToDecl - Adds the initializer Init to the 11948 /// declaration dcl. If DirectInit is true, this is C++ direct 11949 /// initialization rather than copy initialization. 11950 void Sema::AddInitializerToDecl(Decl *RealDecl, Expr *Init, bool DirectInit) { 11951 // If there is no declaration, there was an error parsing it. Just ignore 11952 // the initializer. 11953 if (!RealDecl || RealDecl->isInvalidDecl()) { 11954 CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(Init, dyn_cast_or_null<VarDecl>(RealDecl)); 11955 return; 11956 } 11957 11958 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(RealDecl)) { 11959 // Pure-specifiers are handled in ActOnPureSpecifier. 11960 Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::err_member_function_initialization) 11961 << Method->getDeclName() << Init->getSourceRange(); 11962 Method->setInvalidDecl(); 11963 return; 11964 } 11965 11966 VarDecl *VDecl = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(RealDecl); 11967 if (!VDecl) { 11968 assert(!isa<FieldDecl>(RealDecl) && "field init shouldn't get here"); 11969 Diag(RealDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_illegal_initializer); 11970 RealDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 11971 return; 11972 } 11973 11974 // C++11 [decl.spec.auto]p6. Deduce the type which 'auto' stands in for. 11975 if (VDecl->getType()->isUndeducedType()) { 11976 // Attempt typo correction early so that the type of the init expression can 11977 // be deduced based on the chosen correction if the original init contains a 11978 // TypoExpr. 11979 ExprResult Res = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(Init, VDecl); 11980 if (!Res.isUsable()) { 11981 // There are unresolved typos in Init, just drop them. 11982 // FIXME: improve the recovery strategy to preserve the Init. 11983 RealDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 11984 return; 11985 } 11986 if (Res.get()->containsErrors()) { 11987 // Invalidate the decl as we don't know the type for recovery-expr yet. 11988 RealDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 11989 VDecl->setInit(Res.get()); 11990 return; 11991 } 11992 Init = Res.get(); 11993 11994 if (DeduceVariableDeclarationType(VDecl, DirectInit, Init)) 11995 return; 11996 } 11997 11998 // dllimport cannot be used on variable definitions. 11999 if (VDecl->hasAttr<DLLImportAttr>() && !VDecl->isStaticDataMember()) { 12000 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_dllimport_data_definition); 12001 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12002 return; 12003 } 12004 12005 if (VDecl->isLocalVarDecl() && VDecl->hasExternalStorage()) { 12006 // C99 6.7.8p5. C++ has no such restriction, but that is a defect. 12007 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_block_extern_cant_init); 12008 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12009 return; 12010 } 12011 12012 if (!VDecl->getType()->isDependentType()) { 12013 // A definition must end up with a complete type, which means it must be 12014 // complete with the restriction that an array type might be completed by 12015 // the initializer; note that later code assumes this restriction. 12016 QualType BaseDeclType = VDecl->getType(); 12017 if (const ArrayType *Array = Context.getAsIncompleteArrayType(BaseDeclType)) 12018 BaseDeclType = Array->getElementType(); 12019 if (RequireCompleteType(VDecl->getLocation(), BaseDeclType, 12020 diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)) { 12021 RealDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12022 return; 12023 } 12024 12025 // The variable can not have an abstract class type. 12026 if (RequireNonAbstractType(VDecl->getLocation(), VDecl->getType(), 12027 diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, 12028 AbstractVariableType)) 12029 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12030 } 12031 12032 // If adding the initializer will turn this declaration into a definition, 12033 // and we already have a definition for this variable, diagnose or otherwise 12034 // handle the situation. 12035 VarDecl *Def; 12036 if ((Def = VDecl->getDefinition()) && Def != VDecl && 12037 (!VDecl->isStaticDataMember() || VDecl->isOutOfLine()) && 12038 !VDecl->isThisDeclarationADemotedDefinition() && 12039 checkVarDeclRedefinition(Def, VDecl)) 12040 return; 12041 12042 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 12043 // C++ [class.static.data]p4 12044 // If a static data member is of const integral or const 12045 // enumeration type, its declaration in the class definition can 12046 // specify a constant-initializer which shall be an integral 12047 // constant expression (5.19). In that case, the member can appear 12048 // in integral constant expressions. The member shall still be 12049 // defined in a namespace scope if it is used in the program and the 12050 // namespace scope definition shall not contain an initializer. 12051 // 12052 // We already performed a redefinition check above, but for static 12053 // data members we also need to check whether there was an in-class 12054 // declaration with an initializer. 12055 if (VDecl->isStaticDataMember() && VDecl->getCanonicalDecl()->hasInit()) { 12056 Diag(Init->getExprLoc(), diag::err_static_data_member_reinitialization) 12057 << VDecl->getDeclName(); 12058 Diag(VDecl->getCanonicalDecl()->getInit()->getExprLoc(), 12059 diag::note_previous_initializer) 12060 << 0; 12061 return; 12062 } 12063 12064 if (VDecl->hasLocalStorage()) 12065 setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope(); 12066 12067 if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(Init, UPPC_Initializer)) { 12068 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12069 return; 12070 } 12071 } 12072 12073 // OpenCL 1.1 6.5.2: "Variables allocated in the __local address space inside 12074 // a kernel function cannot be initialized." 12075 if (VDecl->getType().getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_local) { 12076 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_local_cant_init); 12077 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12078 return; 12079 } 12080 12081 // The LoaderUninitialized attribute acts as a definition (of undef). 12082 if (VDecl->hasAttr<LoaderUninitializedAttr>()) { 12083 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_loader_uninitialized_cant_init); 12084 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12085 return; 12086 } 12087 12088 // Get the decls type and save a reference for later, since 12089 // CheckInitializerTypes may change it. 12090 QualType DclT = VDecl->getType(), SavT = DclT; 12091 12092 // Expressions default to 'id' when we're in a debugger 12093 // and we are assigning it to a variable of Objective-C pointer type. 12094 if (getLangOpts().DebuggerCastResultToId && DclT->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 12095 Init->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) { 12096 ExprResult Result = forceUnknownAnyToType(Init, Context.getObjCIdType()); 12097 if (Result.isInvalid()) { 12098 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12099 return; 12100 } 12101 Init = Result.get(); 12102 } 12103 12104 // Perform the initialization. 12105 ParenListExpr *CXXDirectInit = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(Init); 12106 if (!VDecl->isInvalidDecl()) { 12107 InitializedEntity Entity = InitializedEntity::InitializeVariable(VDecl); 12108 InitializationKind Kind = InitializationKind::CreateForInit( 12109 VDecl->getLocation(), DirectInit, Init); 12110 12111 MultiExprArg Args = Init; 12112 if (CXXDirectInit) 12113 Args = MultiExprArg(CXXDirectInit->getExprs(), 12114 CXXDirectInit->getNumExprs()); 12115 12116 // Try to correct any TypoExprs in the initialization arguments. 12117 for (size_t Idx = 0; Idx < Args.size(); ++Idx) { 12118 ExprResult Res = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr( 12119 Args[Idx], VDecl, /*RecoverUncorrectedTypos=*/true, 12120 [this, Entity, Kind](Expr *E) { 12121 InitializationSequence Init(*this, Entity, Kind, MultiExprArg(E)); 12122 return Init.Failed() ? ExprError() : E; 12123 }); 12124 if (Res.isInvalid()) { 12125 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12126 } else if (Res.get() != Args[Idx]) { 12127 Args[Idx] = Res.get(); 12128 } 12129 } 12130 if (VDecl->isInvalidDecl()) 12131 return; 12132 12133 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, Args, 12134 /*TopLevelOfInitList=*/false, 12135 /*TreatUnavailableAsInvalid=*/false); 12136 ExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, Args, &DclT); 12137 if (Result.isInvalid()) { 12138 // If the provied initializer fails to initialize the var decl, 12139 // we attach a recovery expr for better recovery. 12140 auto RecoveryExpr = 12141 CreateRecoveryExpr(Init->getBeginLoc(), Init->getEndLoc(), Args); 12142 if (RecoveryExpr.get()) 12143 VDecl->setInit(RecoveryExpr.get()); 12144 return; 12145 } 12146 12147 Init = Result.getAs<Expr>(); 12148 } 12149 12150 // Check for self-references within variable initializers. 12151 // Variables declared within a function/method body (except for references) 12152 // are handled by a dataflow analysis. 12153 // This is undefined behavior in C++, but valid in C. 12154 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 12155 if (!VDecl->hasLocalStorage() || VDecl->getType()->isRecordType() || 12156 VDecl->getType()->isReferenceType()) { 12157 CheckSelfReference(*this, RealDecl, Init, DirectInit); 12158 } 12159 } 12160 12161 // If the type changed, it means we had an incomplete type that was 12162 // completed by the initializer. For example: 12163 // int ary[] = { 1, 3, 5 }; 12164 // "ary" transitions from an IncompleteArrayType to a ConstantArrayType. 12165 if (!VDecl->isInvalidDecl() && (DclT != SavT)) 12166 VDecl->setType(DclT); 12167 12168 if (!VDecl->isInvalidDecl()) { 12169 checkUnsafeAssigns(VDecl->getLocation(), VDecl->getType(), Init); 12170 12171 if (VDecl->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) 12172 checkRetainCycles(VDecl, Init); 12173 12174 // It is safe to assign a weak reference into a strong variable. 12175 // Although this code can still have problems: 12176 // id x = self.weakProp; 12177 // id y = self.weakProp; 12178 // we do not warn to warn spuriously when 'x' and 'y' are on separate 12179 // paths through the function. This should be revisited if 12180 // -Wrepeated-use-of-weak is made flow-sensitive. 12181 if (FunctionScopeInfo *FSI = getCurFunction()) 12182 if ((VDecl->getType().getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Strong || 12183 VDecl->getType().isNonWeakInMRRWithObjCWeak(Context)) && 12184 !Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_arc_repeated_use_of_weak, 12185 Init->getBeginLoc())) 12186 FSI->markSafeWeakUse(Init); 12187 } 12188 12189 // The initialization is usually a full-expression. 12190 // 12191 // FIXME: If this is a braced initialization of an aggregate, it is not 12192 // an expression, and each individual field initializer is a separate 12193 // full-expression. For instance, in: 12194 // 12195 // struct Temp { ~Temp(); }; 12196 // struct S { S(Temp); }; 12197 // struct T { S a, b; } t = { Temp(), Temp() } 12198 // 12199 // we should destroy the first Temp before constructing the second. 12200 ExprResult Result = 12201 ActOnFinishFullExpr(Init, VDecl->getLocation(), 12202 /*DiscardedValue*/ false, VDecl->isConstexpr()); 12203 if (Result.isInvalid()) { 12204 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12205 return; 12206 } 12207 Init = Result.get(); 12208 12209 // Attach the initializer to the decl. 12210 VDecl->setInit(Init); 12211 12212 if (VDecl->isLocalVarDecl()) { 12213 // Don't check the initializer if the declaration is malformed. 12214 if (VDecl->isInvalidDecl()) { 12215 // do nothing 12216 12217 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.5.3: __constant locals must be constant-initialized. 12218 // This is true even in C++ for OpenCL. 12219 } else if (VDecl->getType().getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant) { 12220 CheckForConstantInitializer(Init, DclT); 12221 12222 // Otherwise, C++ does not restrict the initializer. 12223 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 12224 // do nothing 12225 12226 // C99 6.7.8p4: All the expressions in an initializer for an object that has 12227 // static storage duration shall be constant expressions or string literals. 12228 } else if (VDecl->getStorageClass() == SC_Static) { 12229 CheckForConstantInitializer(Init, DclT); 12230 12231 // C89 is stricter than C99 for aggregate initializers. 12232 // C89 6.5.7p3: All the expressions [...] in an initializer list 12233 // for an object that has aggregate or union type shall be 12234 // constant expressions. 12235 } else if (!getLangOpts().C99 && VDecl->getType()->isAggregateType() && 12236 isa<InitListExpr>(Init)) { 12237 const Expr *Culprit; 12238 if (!Init->isConstantInitializer(Context, false, &Culprit)) { 12239 Diag(Culprit->getExprLoc(), 12240 diag::ext_aggregate_init_not_constant) 12241 << Culprit->getSourceRange(); 12242 } 12243 } 12244 12245 if (auto *E = dyn_cast<ExprWithCleanups>(Init)) 12246 if (auto *BE = dyn_cast<BlockExpr>(E->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens())) 12247 if (VDecl->hasLocalStorage()) 12248 BE->getBlockDecl()->setCanAvoidCopyToHeap(); 12249 } else if (VDecl->isStaticDataMember() && !VDecl->isInline() && 12250 VDecl->getLexicalDeclContext()->isRecord()) { 12251 // This is an in-class initialization for a static data member, e.g., 12252 // 12253 // struct S { 12254 // static const int value = 17; 12255 // }; 12256 12257 // C++ [class.mem]p4: 12258 // A member-declarator can contain a constant-initializer only 12259 // if it declares a static member (9.4) of const integral or 12260 // const enumeration type, see 9.4.2. 12261 // 12262 // C++11 [class.static.data]p3: 12263 // If a non-volatile non-inline const static data member is of integral 12264 // or enumeration type, its declaration in the class definition can 12265 // specify a brace-or-equal-initializer in which every initializer-clause 12266 // that is an assignment-expression is a constant expression. A static 12267 // data member of literal type can be declared in the class definition 12268 // with the constexpr specifier; if so, its declaration shall specify a 12269 // brace-or-equal-initializer in which every initializer-clause that is 12270 // an assignment-expression is a constant expression. 12271 12272 // Do nothing on dependent types. 12273 if (DclT->isDependentType()) { 12274 12275 // Allow any 'static constexpr' members, whether or not they are of literal 12276 // type. We separately check that every constexpr variable is of literal 12277 // type. 12278 } else if (VDecl->isConstexpr()) { 12279 12280 // Require constness. 12281 } else if (!DclT.isConstQualified()) { 12282 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_in_class_initializer_non_const) 12283 << Init->getSourceRange(); 12284 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12285 12286 // We allow integer constant expressions in all cases. 12287 } else if (DclT->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) { 12288 // Check whether the expression is a constant expression. 12289 SourceLocation Loc; 12290 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && DclT.isVolatileQualified()) 12291 // In C++11, a non-constexpr const static data member with an 12292 // in-class initializer cannot be volatile. 12293 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_in_class_initializer_volatile); 12294 else if (Init->isValueDependent()) 12295 ; // Nothing to check. 12296 else if (Init->isIntegerConstantExpr(Context, &Loc)) 12297 ; // Ok, it's an ICE! 12298 else if (Init->getType()->isScopedEnumeralType() && 12299 Init->isCXX11ConstantExpr(Context)) 12300 ; // Ok, it is a scoped-enum constant expression. 12301 else if (Init->isEvaluatable(Context)) { 12302 // If we can constant fold the initializer through heroics, accept it, 12303 // but report this as a use of an extension for -pedantic. 12304 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_in_class_initializer_non_constant) 12305 << Init->getSourceRange(); 12306 } else { 12307 // Otherwise, this is some crazy unknown case. Report the issue at the 12308 // location provided by the isIntegerConstantExpr failed check. 12309 Diag(Loc, diag::err_in_class_initializer_non_constant) 12310 << Init->getSourceRange(); 12311 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12312 } 12313 12314 // We allow foldable floating-point constants as an extension. 12315 } else if (DclT->isFloatingType()) { // also permits complex, which is ok 12316 // In C++98, this is a GNU extension. In C++11, it is not, but we support 12317 // it anyway and provide a fixit to add the 'constexpr'. 12318 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) { 12319 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), 12320 diag::ext_in_class_initializer_float_type_cxx11) 12321 << DclT << Init->getSourceRange(); 12322 Diag(VDecl->getBeginLoc(), 12323 diag::note_in_class_initializer_float_type_cxx11) 12324 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(VDecl->getBeginLoc(), "constexpr "); 12325 } else { 12326 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::ext_in_class_initializer_float_type) 12327 << DclT << Init->getSourceRange(); 12328 12329 if (!Init->isValueDependent() && !Init->isEvaluatable(Context)) { 12330 Diag(Init->getExprLoc(), diag::err_in_class_initializer_non_constant) 12331 << Init->getSourceRange(); 12332 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12333 } 12334 } 12335 12336 // Suggest adding 'constexpr' in C++11 for literal types. 12337 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && DclT->isLiteralType(Context)) { 12338 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_in_class_initializer_literal_type) 12339 << DclT << Init->getSourceRange() 12340 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(VDecl->getBeginLoc(), "constexpr "); 12341 VDecl->setConstexpr(true); 12342 12343 } else { 12344 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_in_class_initializer_bad_type) 12345 << DclT << Init->getSourceRange(); 12346 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 12347 } 12348 } else if (VDecl->isFileVarDecl()) { 12349 // In C, extern is typically used to avoid tentative definitions when 12350 // declaring variables in headers, but adding an intializer makes it a 12351 // definition. This is somewhat confusing, so GCC and Clang both warn on it. 12352 // In C++, extern is often used to give implictly static const variables 12353 // external linkage, so don't warn in that case. If selectany is present, 12354 // this might be header code intended for C and C++ inclusion, so apply the 12355 // C++ rules. 12356 if (VDecl->getStorageClass() == SC_Extern && 12357 ((!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !VDecl->hasAttr<SelectAnyAttr>()) || 12358 !Context.getBaseElementType(VDecl->getType()).isConstQualified()) && 12359 !(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && VDecl->isExternC()) && 12360 !isTemplateInstantiation(VDecl->getTemplateSpecializationKind())) 12361 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::warn_extern_init); 12362 12363 // In Microsoft C++ mode, a const variable defined in namespace scope has 12364 // external linkage by default if the variable is declared with 12365 // __declspec(dllexport). 12366 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() && 12367 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && VDecl->getType().isConstQualified() && 12368 VDecl->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>() && VDecl->getDefinition()) 12369 VDecl->setStorageClass(SC_Extern); 12370 12371 // C99 6.7.8p4. All file scoped initializers need to be constant. 12372 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !VDecl->isInvalidDecl()) 12373 CheckForConstantInitializer(Init, DclT); 12374 } 12375 12376 QualType InitType = Init->getType(); 12377 if (!InitType.isNull() && 12378 (InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion() || 12379 InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion())) 12380 checkNonTrivialCUnionInInitializer(Init, Init->getExprLoc()); 12381 12382 // We will represent direct-initialization similarly to copy-initialization: 12383 // int x(1); -as-> int x = 1; 12384 // ClassType x(a,b,c); -as-> ClassType x = ClassType(a,b,c); 12385 // 12386 // Clients that want to distinguish between the two forms, can check for 12387 // direct initializer using VarDecl::getInitStyle(). 12388 // A major benefit is that clients that don't particularly care about which 12389 // exactly form was it (like the CodeGen) can handle both cases without 12390 // special case code. 12391 12392 // C++ 8.5p11: 12393 // The form of initialization (using parentheses or '=') is generally 12394 // insignificant, but does matter when the entity being initialized has a 12395 // class type. 12396 if (CXXDirectInit) { 12397 assert(DirectInit && "Call-style initializer must be direct init."); 12398 VDecl->setInitStyle(VarDecl::CallInit); 12399 } else if (DirectInit) { 12400 // This must be list-initialization. No other way is direct-initialization. 12401 VDecl->setInitStyle(VarDecl::ListInit); 12402 } 12403 12404 if (LangOpts.OpenMP && VDecl->isFileVarDecl()) 12405 DeclsToCheckForDeferredDiags.push_back(VDecl); 12406 CheckCompleteVariableDeclaration(VDecl); 12407 } 12408 12409 /// ActOnInitializerError - Given that there was an error parsing an 12410 /// initializer for the given declaration, try to return to some form 12411 /// of sanity. 12412 void Sema::ActOnInitializerError(Decl *D) { 12413 // Our main concern here is re-establishing invariants like "a 12414 // variable's type is either dependent or complete". 12415 if (!D || D->isInvalidDecl()) return; 12416 12417 VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D); 12418 if (!VD) return; 12419 12420 // Bindings are not usable if we can't make sense of the initializer. 12421 if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(D)) 12422 for (auto *BD : DD->bindings()) 12423 BD->setInvalidDecl(); 12424 12425 // Auto types are meaningless if we can't make sense of the initializer. 12426 if (VD->getType()->isUndeducedType()) { 12427 D->setInvalidDecl(); 12428 return; 12429 } 12430 12431 QualType Ty = VD->getType(); 12432 if (Ty->isDependentType()) return; 12433 12434 // Require a complete type. 12435 if (RequireCompleteType(VD->getLocation(), 12436 Context.getBaseElementType(Ty), 12437 diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)) { 12438 VD->setInvalidDecl(); 12439 return; 12440 } 12441 12442 // Require a non-abstract type. 12443 if (RequireNonAbstractType(VD->getLocation(), Ty, 12444 diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, 12445 AbstractVariableType)) { 12446 VD->setInvalidDecl(); 12447 return; 12448 } 12449 12450 // Don't bother complaining about constructors or destructors, 12451 // though. 12452 } 12453 12454 void Sema::ActOnUninitializedDecl(Decl *RealDecl) { 12455 // If there is no declaration, there was an error parsing it. Just ignore it. 12456 if (!RealDecl) 12457 return; 12458 12459 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(RealDecl)) { 12460 QualType Type = Var->getType(); 12461 12462 // C++1z [dcl.dcl]p1 grammar implies that an initializer is mandatory. 12463 if (isa<DecompositionDecl>(RealDecl)) { 12464 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_decomp_decl_requires_init) << Var; 12465 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 12466 return; 12467 } 12468 12469 if (Type->isUndeducedType() && 12470 DeduceVariableDeclarationType(Var, false, nullptr)) 12471 return; 12472 12473 // C++11 [class.static.data]p3: A static data member can be declared with 12474 // the constexpr specifier; if so, its declaration shall specify 12475 // a brace-or-equal-initializer. 12476 // C++11 [dcl.constexpr]p1: The constexpr specifier shall be applied only to 12477 // the definition of a variable [...] or the declaration of a static data 12478 // member. 12479 if (Var->isConstexpr() && !Var->isThisDeclarationADefinition() && 12480 !Var->isThisDeclarationADemotedDefinition()) { 12481 if (Var->isStaticDataMember()) { 12482 // C++1z removes the relevant rule; the in-class declaration is always 12483 // a definition there. 12484 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 && 12485 !Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()) { 12486 Diag(Var->getLocation(), 12487 diag::err_constexpr_static_mem_var_requires_init) 12488 << Var; 12489 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 12490 return; 12491 } 12492 } else { 12493 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_invalid_constexpr_var_decl); 12494 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 12495 return; 12496 } 12497 } 12498 12499 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.5.3: variables declared in the constant address space must 12500 // be initialized. 12501 if (!Var->isInvalidDecl() && 12502 Var->getType().getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant && 12503 Var->getStorageClass() != SC_Extern && !Var->getInit()) { 12504 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_constant_no_init); 12505 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 12506 return; 12507 } 12508 12509 if (!Var->isInvalidDecl() && RealDecl->hasAttr<LoaderUninitializedAttr>()) { 12510 if (Var->getStorageClass() == SC_Extern) { 12511 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_loader_uninitialized_extern_decl) 12512 << Var; 12513 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 12514 return; 12515 } 12516 if (RequireCompleteType(Var->getLocation(), Var->getType(), 12517 diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)) { 12518 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 12519 return; 12520 } 12521 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = Var->getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) { 12522 if (!RD->hasTrivialDefaultConstructor()) { 12523 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_loader_uninitialized_trivial_ctor); 12524 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 12525 return; 12526 } 12527 } 12528 } 12529 12530 VarDecl::DefinitionKind DefKind = Var->isThisDeclarationADefinition(); 12531 if (!Var->isInvalidDecl() && DefKind != VarDecl::DeclarationOnly && 12532 Var->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion()) 12533 checkNonTrivialCUnion(Var->getType(), Var->getLocation(), 12534 NTCUC_DefaultInitializedObject, NTCUK_Init); 12535 12536 12537 switch (DefKind) { 12538 case VarDecl::Definition: 12539 if (!Var->isStaticDataMember() || !Var->getAnyInitializer()) 12540 break; 12541 12542 // We have an out-of-line definition of a static data member 12543 // that has an in-class initializer, so we type-check this like 12544 // a declaration. 12545 // 12546 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 12547 12548 case VarDecl::DeclarationOnly: 12549 // It's only a declaration. 12550 12551 // Block scope. C99 6.7p7: If an identifier for an object is 12552 // declared with no linkage (C99 6.2.2p6), the type for the 12553 // object shall be complete. 12554 if (!Type->isDependentType() && Var->isLocalVarDecl() && 12555 !Var->hasLinkage() && !Var->isInvalidDecl() && 12556 RequireCompleteType(Var->getLocation(), Type, 12557 diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)) 12558 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 12559 12560 // Make sure that the type is not abstract. 12561 if (!Type->isDependentType() && !Var->isInvalidDecl() && 12562 RequireNonAbstractType(Var->getLocation(), Type, 12563 diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, 12564 AbstractVariableType)) 12565 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 12566 if (!Type->isDependentType() && !Var->isInvalidDecl() && 12567 Var->getStorageClass() == SC_PrivateExtern) { 12568 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::warn_private_extern); 12569 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_private_extern); 12570 } 12571 12572 if (Context.getTargetInfo().allowDebugInfoForExternalVar() && 12573 !Var->isInvalidDecl() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 12574 ExternalDeclarations.push_back(Var); 12575 12576 return; 12577 12578 case VarDecl::TentativeDefinition: 12579 // File scope. C99 6.9.2p2: A declaration of an identifier for an 12580 // object that has file scope without an initializer, and without a 12581 // storage-class specifier or with the storage-class specifier "static", 12582 // constitutes a tentative definition. Note: A tentative definition with 12583 // external linkage is valid (C99 6.2.2p5). 12584 if (!Var->isInvalidDecl()) { 12585 if (const IncompleteArrayType *ArrayT 12586 = Context.getAsIncompleteArrayType(Type)) { 12587 if (RequireCompleteSizedType( 12588 Var->getLocation(), ArrayT->getElementType(), 12589 diag::err_array_incomplete_or_sizeless_type)) 12590 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 12591 } else if (Var->getStorageClass() == SC_Static) { 12592 // C99 6.9.2p3: If the declaration of an identifier for an object is 12593 // a tentative definition and has internal linkage (C99 6.2.2p3), the 12594 // declared type shall not be an incomplete type. 12595 // NOTE: code such as the following 12596 // static struct s; 12597 // struct s { int a; }; 12598 // is accepted by gcc. Hence here we issue a warning instead of 12599 // an error and we do not invalidate the static declaration. 12600 // NOTE: to avoid multiple warnings, only check the first declaration. 12601 if (Var->isFirstDecl()) 12602 RequireCompleteType(Var->getLocation(), Type, 12603 diag::ext_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type); 12604 } 12605 } 12606 12607 // Record the tentative definition; we're done. 12608 if (!Var->isInvalidDecl()) 12609 TentativeDefinitions.push_back(Var); 12610 return; 12611 } 12612 12613 // Provide a specific diagnostic for uninitialized variable 12614 // definitions with incomplete array type. 12615 if (Type->isIncompleteArrayType()) { 12616 Diag(Var->getLocation(), 12617 diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_array_needs_initializer); 12618 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 12619 return; 12620 } 12621 12622 // Provide a specific diagnostic for uninitialized variable 12623 // definitions with reference type. 12624 if (Type->isReferenceType()) { 12625 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_reference_var_requires_init) 12626 << Var << SourceRange(Var->getLocation(), Var->getLocation()); 12627 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 12628 return; 12629 } 12630 12631 // Do not attempt to type-check the default initializer for a 12632 // variable with dependent type. 12633 if (Type->isDependentType()) 12634 return; 12635 12636 if (Var->isInvalidDecl()) 12637 return; 12638 12639 if (!Var->hasAttr<AliasAttr>()) { 12640 if (RequireCompleteType(Var->getLocation(), 12641 Context.getBaseElementType(Type), 12642 diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)) { 12643 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 12644 return; 12645 } 12646 } else { 12647 return; 12648 } 12649 12650 // The variable can not have an abstract class type. 12651 if (RequireNonAbstractType(Var->getLocation(), Type, 12652 diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, 12653 AbstractVariableType)) { 12654 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 12655 return; 12656 } 12657 12658 // Check for jumps past the implicit initializer. C++0x 12659 // clarifies that this applies to a "variable with automatic 12660 // storage duration", not a "local variable". 12661 // C++11 [stmt.dcl]p3 12662 // A program that jumps from a point where a variable with automatic 12663 // storage duration is not in scope to a point where it is in scope is 12664 // ill-formed unless the variable has scalar type, class type with a 12665 // trivial default constructor and a trivial destructor, a cv-qualified 12666 // version of one of these types, or an array of one of the preceding 12667 // types and is declared without an initializer. 12668 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Var->hasLocalStorage()) { 12669 if (const RecordType *Record 12670 = Context.getBaseElementType(Type)->getAs<RecordType>()) { 12671 CXXRecordDecl *CXXRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getDecl()); 12672 // Mark the function (if we're in one) for further checking even if the 12673 // looser rules of C++11 do not require such checks, so that we can 12674 // diagnose incompatibilities with C++98. 12675 if (!CXXRecord->isPOD()) 12676 setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope(); 12677 } 12678 } 12679 // In OpenCL, we can't initialize objects in the __local address space, 12680 // even implicitly, so don't synthesize an implicit initializer. 12681 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && 12682 Var->getType().getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_local) 12683 return; 12684 // C++03 [dcl.init]p9: 12685 // If no initializer is specified for an object, and the 12686 // object is of (possibly cv-qualified) non-POD class type (or 12687 // array thereof), the object shall be default-initialized; if 12688 // the object is of const-qualified type, the underlying class 12689 // type shall have a user-declared default 12690 // constructor. Otherwise, if no initializer is specified for 12691 // a non- static object, the object and its subobjects, if 12692 // any, have an indeterminate initial value); if the object 12693 // or any of its subobjects are of const-qualified type, the 12694 // program is ill-formed. 12695 // C++0x [dcl.init]p11: 12696 // If no initializer is specified for an object, the object is 12697 // default-initialized; [...]. 12698 InitializedEntity Entity = InitializedEntity::InitializeVariable(Var); 12699 InitializationKind Kind 12700 = InitializationKind::CreateDefault(Var->getLocation()); 12701 12702 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, None); 12703 ExprResult Init = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, None); 12704 12705 if (Init.get()) { 12706 Var->setInit(MaybeCreateExprWithCleanups(Init.get())); 12707 // This is important for template substitution. 12708 Var->setInitStyle(VarDecl::CallInit); 12709 } else if (Init.isInvalid()) { 12710 // If default-init fails, attach a recovery-expr initializer to track 12711 // that initialization was attempted and failed. 12712 auto RecoveryExpr = 12713 CreateRecoveryExpr(Var->getLocation(), Var->getLocation(), {}); 12714 if (RecoveryExpr.get()) 12715 Var->setInit(RecoveryExpr.get()); 12716 } 12717 12718 CheckCompleteVariableDeclaration(Var); 12719 } 12720 } 12721 12722 void Sema::ActOnCXXForRangeDecl(Decl *D) { 12723 // If there is no declaration, there was an error parsing it. Ignore it. 12724 if (!D) 12725 return; 12726 12727 VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D); 12728 if (!VD) { 12729 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::err_for_range_decl_must_be_var); 12730 D->setInvalidDecl(); 12731 return; 12732 } 12733 12734 VD->setCXXForRangeDecl(true); 12735 12736 // for-range-declaration cannot be given a storage class specifier. 12737 int Error = -1; 12738 switch (VD->getStorageClass()) { 12739 case SC_None: 12740 break; 12741 case SC_Extern: 12742 Error = 0; 12743 break; 12744 case SC_Static: 12745 Error = 1; 12746 break; 12747 case SC_PrivateExtern: 12748 Error = 2; 12749 break; 12750 case SC_Auto: 12751 Error = 3; 12752 break; 12753 case SC_Register: 12754 Error = 4; 12755 break; 12756 } 12757 if (Error != -1) { 12758 Diag(VD->getOuterLocStart(), diag::err_for_range_storage_class) 12759 << VD << Error; 12760 D->setInvalidDecl(); 12761 } 12762 } 12763 12764 StmtResult 12765 Sema::ActOnCXXForRangeIdentifier(Scope *S, SourceLocation IdentLoc, 12766 IdentifierInfo *Ident, 12767 ParsedAttributes &Attrs, 12768 SourceLocation AttrEnd) { 12769 // C++1y [stmt.iter]p1: 12770 // A range-based for statement of the form 12771 // for ( for-range-identifier : for-range-initializer ) statement 12772 // is equivalent to 12773 // for ( auto&& for-range-identifier : for-range-initializer ) statement 12774 DeclSpec DS(Attrs.getPool().getFactory()); 12775 12776 const char *PrevSpec; 12777 unsigned DiagID; 12778 DS.SetTypeSpecType(DeclSpec::TST_auto, IdentLoc, PrevSpec, DiagID, 12779 getPrintingPolicy()); 12780 12781 Declarator D(DS, DeclaratorContext::ForContext); 12782 D.SetIdentifier(Ident, IdentLoc); 12783 D.takeAttributes(Attrs, AttrEnd); 12784 12785 D.AddTypeInfo(DeclaratorChunk::getReference(0, IdentLoc, /*lvalue*/ false), 12786 IdentLoc); 12787 Decl *Var = ActOnDeclarator(S, D); 12788 cast<VarDecl>(Var)->setCXXForRangeDecl(true); 12789 FinalizeDeclaration(Var); 12790 return ActOnDeclStmt(FinalizeDeclaratorGroup(S, DS, Var), IdentLoc, 12791 AttrEnd.isValid() ? AttrEnd : IdentLoc); 12792 } 12793 12794 void Sema::CheckCompleteVariableDeclaration(VarDecl *var) { 12795 if (var->isInvalidDecl()) return; 12796 12797 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 12798 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.12.5 - Every block variable declaration must have an 12799 // initialiser 12800 if (var->getTypeSourceInfo()->getType()->isBlockPointerType() && 12801 !var->hasInit()) { 12802 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_invalid_block_declaration) 12803 << 1 /*Init*/; 12804 var->setInvalidDecl(); 12805 return; 12806 } 12807 } 12808 12809 // In Objective-C, don't allow jumps past the implicit initialization of a 12810 // local retaining variable. 12811 if (getLangOpts().ObjC && 12812 var->hasLocalStorage()) { 12813 switch (var->getType().getObjCLifetime()) { 12814 case Qualifiers::OCL_None: 12815 case Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone: 12816 case Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing: 12817 break; 12818 12819 case Qualifiers::OCL_Weak: 12820 case Qualifiers::OCL_Strong: 12821 setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope(); 12822 break; 12823 } 12824 } 12825 12826 if (var->hasLocalStorage() && 12827 var->getType().isDestructedType() == QualType::DK_nontrivial_c_struct) 12828 setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope(); 12829 12830 // Warn about externally-visible variables being defined without a 12831 // prior declaration. We only want to do this for global 12832 // declarations, but we also specifically need to avoid doing it for 12833 // class members because the linkage of an anonymous class can 12834 // change if it's later given a typedef name. 12835 if (var->isThisDeclarationADefinition() && 12836 var->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isFileContext() && 12837 var->isExternallyVisible() && var->hasLinkage() && 12838 !var->isInline() && !var->getDescribedVarTemplate() && 12839 !isa<VarTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(var) && 12840 !isTemplateInstantiation(var->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) && 12841 !getDiagnostics().isIgnored(diag::warn_missing_variable_declarations, 12842 var->getLocation())) { 12843 // Find a previous declaration that's not a definition. 12844 VarDecl *prev = var->getPreviousDecl(); 12845 while (prev && prev->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) 12846 prev = prev->getPreviousDecl(); 12847 12848 if (!prev) { 12849 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::warn_missing_variable_declarations) << var; 12850 Diag(var->getTypeSpecStartLoc(), diag::note_static_for_internal_linkage) 12851 << /* variable */ 0; 12852 } 12853 } 12854 12855 // Cache the result of checking for constant initialization. 12856 Optional<bool> CacheHasConstInit; 12857 const Expr *CacheCulprit = nullptr; 12858 auto checkConstInit = [&]() mutable { 12859 if (!CacheHasConstInit) 12860 CacheHasConstInit = var->getInit()->isConstantInitializer( 12861 Context, var->getType()->isReferenceType(), &CacheCulprit); 12862 return *CacheHasConstInit; 12863 }; 12864 12865 if (var->getTLSKind() == VarDecl::TLS_Static) { 12866 if (var->getType().isDestructedType()) { 12867 // GNU C++98 edits for __thread, [basic.start.term]p3: 12868 // The type of an object with thread storage duration shall not 12869 // have a non-trivial destructor. 12870 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::err_thread_nontrivial_dtor); 12871 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) 12872 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::note_use_thread_local); 12873 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && var->hasInit()) { 12874 if (!checkConstInit()) { 12875 // GNU C++98 edits for __thread, [basic.start.init]p4: 12876 // An object of thread storage duration shall not require dynamic 12877 // initialization. 12878 // FIXME: Need strict checking here. 12879 Diag(CacheCulprit->getExprLoc(), diag::err_thread_dynamic_init) 12880 << CacheCulprit->getSourceRange(); 12881 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) 12882 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::note_use_thread_local); 12883 } 12884 } 12885 } 12886 12887 // Apply section attributes and pragmas to global variables. 12888 bool GlobalStorage = var->hasGlobalStorage(); 12889 if (GlobalStorage && var->isThisDeclarationADefinition() && 12890 !inTemplateInstantiation()) { 12891 PragmaStack<StringLiteral *> *Stack = nullptr; 12892 int SectionFlags = ASTContext::PSF_Read; 12893 if (var->getType().isConstQualified()) 12894 Stack = &ConstSegStack; 12895 else if (!var->getInit()) { 12896 Stack = &BSSSegStack; 12897 SectionFlags |= ASTContext::PSF_Write; 12898 } else { 12899 Stack = &DataSegStack; 12900 SectionFlags |= ASTContext::PSF_Write; 12901 } 12902 if (const SectionAttr *SA = var->getAttr<SectionAttr>()) { 12903 if (SA->getSyntax() == AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Declspec) 12904 SectionFlags |= ASTContext::PSF_Implicit; 12905 UnifySection(SA->getName(), SectionFlags, var); 12906 } else if (Stack->CurrentValue) { 12907 SectionFlags |= ASTContext::PSF_Implicit; 12908 auto SectionName = Stack->CurrentValue->getString(); 12909 var->addAttr(SectionAttr::CreateImplicit( 12910 Context, SectionName, Stack->CurrentPragmaLocation, 12911 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma, SectionAttr::Declspec_allocate)); 12912 if (UnifySection(SectionName, SectionFlags, var)) 12913 var->dropAttr<SectionAttr>(); 12914 } 12915 12916 // Apply the init_seg attribute if this has an initializer. If the 12917 // initializer turns out to not be dynamic, we'll end up ignoring this 12918 // attribute. 12919 if (CurInitSeg && var->getInit()) 12920 var->addAttr(InitSegAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, CurInitSeg->getString(), 12921 CurInitSegLoc, 12922 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma)); 12923 } 12924 12925 if (!var->getType()->isStructureType() && var->hasInit() && 12926 isa<InitListExpr>(var->getInit())) { 12927 const auto *ILE = cast<InitListExpr>(var->getInit()); 12928 unsigned NumInits = ILE->getNumInits(); 12929 if (NumInits > 2) 12930 for (unsigned I = 0; I < NumInits; ++I) { 12931 const auto *Init = ILE->getInit(I); 12932 if (!Init) 12933 break; 12934 const auto *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(Init->IgnoreImpCasts()); 12935 if (!SL) 12936 break; 12937 12938 unsigned NumConcat = SL->getNumConcatenated(); 12939 // Diagnose missing comma in string array initialization. 12940 // Do not warn when all the elements in the initializer are concatenated 12941 // together. Do not warn for macros too. 12942 if (NumConcat == 2 && !SL->getBeginLoc().isMacroID()) { 12943 bool OnlyOneMissingComma = true; 12944 for (unsigned J = I + 1; J < NumInits; ++J) { 12945 const auto *Init = ILE->getInit(J); 12946 if (!Init) 12947 break; 12948 const auto *SLJ = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(Init->IgnoreImpCasts()); 12949 if (!SLJ || SLJ->getNumConcatenated() > 1) { 12950 OnlyOneMissingComma = false; 12951 break; 12952 } 12953 } 12954 12955 if (OnlyOneMissingComma) { 12956 SmallVector<FixItHint, 1> Hints; 12957 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumConcat - 1; ++i) 12958 Hints.push_back(FixItHint::CreateInsertion( 12959 PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SL->getStrTokenLoc(i)), ",")); 12960 12961 Diag(SL->getStrTokenLoc(1), 12962 diag::warn_concatenated_literal_array_init) 12963 << Hints; 12964 Diag(SL->getBeginLoc(), 12965 diag::note_concatenated_string_literal_silence); 12966 } 12967 // In any case, stop now. 12968 break; 12969 } 12970 } 12971 } 12972 12973 // All the following checks are C++ only. 12974 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 12975 // If this variable must be emitted, add it as an initializer for the 12976 // current module. 12977 if (Context.DeclMustBeEmitted(var) && !ModuleScopes.empty()) 12978 Context.addModuleInitializer(ModuleScopes.back().Module, var); 12979 return; 12980 } 12981 12982 QualType type = var->getType(); 12983 12984 if (var->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) 12985 getCurFunction()->addByrefBlockVar(var); 12986 12987 Expr *Init = var->getInit(); 12988 bool IsGlobal = GlobalStorage && !var->isStaticLocal(); 12989 QualType baseType = Context.getBaseElementType(type); 12990 12991 // Check whether the initializer is sufficiently constant. 12992 if (!type->isDependentType() && Init && !Init->isValueDependent() && 12993 (GlobalStorage || var->isConstexpr() || 12994 var->mightBeUsableInConstantExpressions(Context))) { 12995 // If this variable might have a constant initializer or might be usable in 12996 // constant expressions, check whether or not it actually is now. We can't 12997 // do this lazily, because the result might depend on things that change 12998 // later, such as which constexpr functions happen to be defined. 12999 SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes; 13000 bool HasConstInit; 13001 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) { 13002 // Prior to C++11, in contexts where a constant initializer is required, 13003 // the set of valid constant initializers is described by syntactic rules 13004 // in [expr.const]p2-6. 13005 // FIXME: Stricter checking for these rules would be useful for constinit / 13006 // -Wglobal-constructors. 13007 HasConstInit = checkConstInit(); 13008 13009 // Compute and cache the constant value, and remember that we have a 13010 // constant initializer. 13011 if (HasConstInit) { 13012 (void)var->checkForConstantInitialization(Notes); 13013 Notes.clear(); 13014 } else if (CacheCulprit) { 13015 Notes.emplace_back(CacheCulprit->getExprLoc(), 13016 PDiag(diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr)); 13017 Notes.back().second << CacheCulprit->getSourceRange(); 13018 } 13019 } else { 13020 // Evaluate the initializer to see if it's a constant initializer. 13021 HasConstInit = var->checkForConstantInitialization(Notes); 13022 } 13023 13024 if (HasConstInit) { 13025 // FIXME: Consider replacing the initializer with a ConstantExpr. 13026 } else if (var->isConstexpr()) { 13027 SourceLocation DiagLoc = var->getLocation(); 13028 // If the note doesn't add any useful information other than a source 13029 // location, fold it into the primary diagnostic. 13030 if (Notes.size() == 1 && Notes[0].second.getDiagID() == 13031 diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr) { 13032 DiagLoc = Notes[0].first; 13033 Notes.clear(); 13034 } 13035 Diag(DiagLoc, diag::err_constexpr_var_requires_const_init) 13036 << var << Init->getSourceRange(); 13037 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Notes.size(); I != N; ++I) 13038 Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second); 13039 } else if (GlobalStorage && var->hasAttr<ConstInitAttr>()) { 13040 auto *Attr = var->getAttr<ConstInitAttr>(); 13041 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::err_require_constant_init_failed) 13042 << Init->getSourceRange(); 13043 Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_required_constant_init_here) 13044 << Attr->getRange() << Attr->isConstinit(); 13045 for (auto &it : Notes) 13046 Diag(it.first, it.second); 13047 } else if (IsGlobal && 13048 !getDiagnostics().isIgnored(diag::warn_global_constructor, 13049 var->getLocation())) { 13050 // Warn about globals which don't have a constant initializer. Don't 13051 // warn about globals with a non-trivial destructor because we already 13052 // warned about them. 13053 CXXRecordDecl *RD = baseType->getAsCXXRecordDecl(); 13054 if (!(RD && !RD->hasTrivialDestructor())) { 13055 // checkConstInit() here permits trivial default initialization even in 13056 // C++11 onwards, where such an initializer is not a constant initializer 13057 // but nonetheless doesn't require a global constructor. 13058 if (!checkConstInit()) 13059 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::warn_global_constructor) 13060 << Init->getSourceRange(); 13061 } 13062 } 13063 } 13064 13065 // Require the destructor. 13066 if (!type->isDependentType()) 13067 if (const RecordType *recordType = baseType->getAs<RecordType>()) 13068 FinalizeVarWithDestructor(var, recordType); 13069 13070 // If this variable must be emitted, add it as an initializer for the current 13071 // module. 13072 if (Context.DeclMustBeEmitted(var) && !ModuleScopes.empty()) 13073 Context.addModuleInitializer(ModuleScopes.back().Module, var); 13074 13075 // Build the bindings if this is a structured binding declaration. 13076 if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(var)) 13077 CheckCompleteDecompositionDeclaration(DD); 13078 } 13079 13080 /// Determines if a variable's alignment is dependent. 13081 static bool hasDependentAlignment(VarDecl *VD) { 13082 if (VD->getType()->isDependentType()) 13083 return true; 13084 for (auto *I : VD->specific_attrs<AlignedAttr>()) 13085 if (I->isAlignmentDependent()) 13086 return true; 13087 return false; 13088 } 13089 13090 /// Check if VD needs to be dllexport/dllimport due to being in a 13091 /// dllexport/import function. 13092 void Sema::CheckStaticLocalForDllExport(VarDecl *VD) { 13093 assert(VD->isStaticLocal()); 13094 13095 auto *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(VD->getParentFunctionOrMethod()); 13096 13097 // Find outermost function when VD is in lambda function. 13098 while (FD && !getDLLAttr(FD) && 13099 !FD->hasAttr<DLLExportStaticLocalAttr>() && 13100 !FD->hasAttr<DLLImportStaticLocalAttr>()) { 13101 FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(FD->getParentFunctionOrMethod()); 13102 } 13103 13104 if (!FD) 13105 return; 13106 13107 // Static locals inherit dll attributes from their function. 13108 if (Attr *A = getDLLAttr(FD)) { 13109 auto *NewAttr = cast<InheritableAttr>(A->clone(getASTContext())); 13110 NewAttr->setInherited(true); 13111 VD->addAttr(NewAttr); 13112 } else if (Attr *A = FD->getAttr<DLLExportStaticLocalAttr>()) { 13113 auto *NewAttr = DLLExportAttr::CreateImplicit(getASTContext(), *A); 13114 NewAttr->setInherited(true); 13115 VD->addAttr(NewAttr); 13116 13117 // Export this function to enforce exporting this static variable even 13118 // if it is not used in this compilation unit. 13119 if (!FD->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) 13120 FD->addAttr(NewAttr); 13121 13122 } else if (Attr *A = FD->getAttr<DLLImportStaticLocalAttr>()) { 13123 auto *NewAttr = DLLImportAttr::CreateImplicit(getASTContext(), *A); 13124 NewAttr->setInherited(true); 13125 VD->addAttr(NewAttr); 13126 } 13127 } 13128 13129 /// FinalizeDeclaration - called by ParseDeclarationAfterDeclarator to perform 13130 /// any semantic actions necessary after any initializer has been attached. 13131 void Sema::FinalizeDeclaration(Decl *ThisDecl) { 13132 // Note that we are no longer parsing the initializer for this declaration. 13133 ParsingInitForAutoVars.erase(ThisDecl); 13134 13135 VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast_or_null<VarDecl>(ThisDecl); 13136 if (!VD) 13137 return; 13138 13139 // Apply an implicit SectionAttr if '#pragma clang section bss|data|rodata' is active 13140 if (VD->hasGlobalStorage() && VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() && 13141 !inTemplateInstantiation() && !VD->hasAttr<SectionAttr>()) { 13142 if (PragmaClangBSSSection.Valid) 13143 VD->addAttr(PragmaClangBSSSectionAttr::CreateImplicit( 13144 Context, PragmaClangBSSSection.SectionName, 13145 PragmaClangBSSSection.PragmaLocation, 13146 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma)); 13147 if (PragmaClangDataSection.Valid) 13148 VD->addAttr(PragmaClangDataSectionAttr::CreateImplicit( 13149 Context, PragmaClangDataSection.SectionName, 13150 PragmaClangDataSection.PragmaLocation, 13151 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma)); 13152 if (PragmaClangRodataSection.Valid) 13153 VD->addAttr(PragmaClangRodataSectionAttr::CreateImplicit( 13154 Context, PragmaClangRodataSection.SectionName, 13155 PragmaClangRodataSection.PragmaLocation, 13156 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma)); 13157 if (PragmaClangRelroSection.Valid) 13158 VD->addAttr(PragmaClangRelroSectionAttr::CreateImplicit( 13159 Context, PragmaClangRelroSection.SectionName, 13160 PragmaClangRelroSection.PragmaLocation, 13161 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma)); 13162 } 13163 13164 if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(ThisDecl)) { 13165 for (auto *BD : DD->bindings()) { 13166 FinalizeDeclaration(BD); 13167 } 13168 } 13169 13170 checkAttributesAfterMerging(*this, *VD); 13171 13172 // Perform TLS alignment check here after attributes attached to the variable 13173 // which may affect the alignment have been processed. Only perform the check 13174 // if the target has a maximum TLS alignment (zero means no constraints). 13175 if (unsigned MaxAlign = Context.getTargetInfo().getMaxTLSAlign()) { 13176 // Protect the check so that it's not performed on dependent types and 13177 // dependent alignments (we can't determine the alignment in that case). 13178 if (VD->getTLSKind() && !hasDependentAlignment(VD) && 13179 !VD->isInvalidDecl()) { 13180 CharUnits MaxAlignChars = Context.toCharUnitsFromBits(MaxAlign); 13181 if (Context.getDeclAlign(VD) > MaxAlignChars) { 13182 Diag(VD->getLocation(), diag::err_tls_var_aligned_over_maximum) 13183 << (unsigned)Context.getDeclAlign(VD).getQuantity() << VD 13184 << (unsigned)MaxAlignChars.getQuantity(); 13185 } 13186 } 13187 } 13188 13189 if (VD->isStaticLocal()) 13190 CheckStaticLocalForDllExport(VD); 13191 13192 // Perform check for initializers of device-side global variables. 13193 // CUDA allows empty constructors as initializers (see E.2.3.1, CUDA 13194 // 7.5). We must also apply the same checks to all __shared__ 13195 // variables whether they are local or not. CUDA also allows 13196 // constant initializers for __constant__ and __device__ variables. 13197 if (getLangOpts().CUDA) 13198 checkAllowedCUDAInitializer(VD); 13199 13200 // Grab the dllimport or dllexport attribute off of the VarDecl. 13201 const InheritableAttr *DLLAttr = getDLLAttr(VD); 13202 13203 // Imported static data members cannot be defined out-of-line. 13204 if (const auto *IA = dyn_cast_or_null<DLLImportAttr>(DLLAttr)) { 13205 if (VD->isStaticDataMember() && VD->isOutOfLine() && 13206 VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) { 13207 // We allow definitions of dllimport class template static data members 13208 // with a warning. 13209 CXXRecordDecl *Context = 13210 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(VD->getFirstDecl()->getDeclContext()); 13211 bool IsClassTemplateMember = 13212 isa<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(Context) || 13213 Context->getDescribedClassTemplate(); 13214 13215 Diag(VD->getLocation(), 13216 IsClassTemplateMember 13217 ? diag::warn_attribute_dllimport_static_field_definition 13218 : diag::err_attribute_dllimport_static_field_definition); 13219 Diag(IA->getLocation(), diag::note_attribute); 13220 if (!IsClassTemplateMember) 13221 VD->setInvalidDecl(); 13222 } 13223 } 13224 13225 // dllimport/dllexport variables cannot be thread local, their TLS index 13226 // isn't exported with the variable. 13227 if (DLLAttr && VD->getTLSKind()) { 13228 auto *F = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(VD->getParentFunctionOrMethod()); 13229 if (F && getDLLAttr(F)) { 13230 assert(VD->isStaticLocal()); 13231 // But if this is a static local in a dlimport/dllexport function, the 13232 // function will never be inlined, which means the var would never be 13233 // imported, so having it marked import/export is safe. 13234 } else { 13235 Diag(VD->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_dll_thread_local) << VD 13236 << DLLAttr; 13237 VD->setInvalidDecl(); 13238 } 13239 } 13240 13241 if (UsedAttr *Attr = VD->getAttr<UsedAttr>()) { 13242 if (!Attr->isInherited() && !VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) { 13243 Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::warn_attribute_ignored) << Attr; 13244 VD->dropAttr<UsedAttr>(); 13245 } 13246 } 13247 13248 const DeclContext *DC = VD->getDeclContext(); 13249 // If there's a #pragma GCC visibility in scope, and this isn't a class 13250 // member, set the visibility of this variable. 13251 if (DC->getRedeclContext()->isFileContext() && VD->isExternallyVisible()) 13252 AddPushedVisibilityAttribute(VD); 13253 13254 // FIXME: Warn on unused var template partial specializations. 13255 if (VD->isFileVarDecl() && !isa<VarTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(VD)) 13256 MarkUnusedFileScopedDecl(VD); 13257 13258 // Now we have parsed the initializer and can update the table of magic 13259 // tag values. 13260 if (!VD->hasAttr<TypeTagForDatatypeAttr>() || 13261 !VD->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) 13262 return; 13263 13264 for (const auto *I : ThisDecl->specific_attrs<TypeTagForDatatypeAttr>()) { 13265 const Expr *MagicValueExpr = VD->getInit(); 13266 if (!MagicValueExpr) { 13267 continue; 13268 } 13269 Optional<llvm::APSInt> MagicValueInt; 13270 if (!(MagicValueInt = MagicValueExpr->getIntegerConstantExpr(Context))) { 13271 Diag(I->getRange().getBegin(), 13272 diag::err_type_tag_for_datatype_not_ice) 13273 << LangOpts.CPlusPlus << MagicValueExpr->getSourceRange(); 13274 continue; 13275 } 13276 if (MagicValueInt->getActiveBits() > 64) { 13277 Diag(I->getRange().getBegin(), 13278 diag::err_type_tag_for_datatype_too_large) 13279 << LangOpts.CPlusPlus << MagicValueExpr->getSourceRange(); 13280 continue; 13281 } 13282 uint64_t MagicValue = MagicValueInt->getZExtValue(); 13283 RegisterTypeTagForDatatype(I->getArgumentKind(), 13284 MagicValue, 13285 I->getMatchingCType(), 13286 I->getLayoutCompatible(), 13287 I->getMustBeNull()); 13288 } 13289 } 13290 13291 static bool hasDeducedAuto(DeclaratorDecl *DD) { 13292 auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(DD); 13293 return VD && !VD->getType()->hasAutoForTrailingReturnType(); 13294 } 13295 13296 Sema::DeclGroupPtrTy Sema::FinalizeDeclaratorGroup(Scope *S, const DeclSpec &DS, 13297 ArrayRef<Decl *> Group) { 13298 SmallVector<Decl*, 8> Decls; 13299 13300 if (DS.isTypeSpecOwned()) 13301 Decls.push_back(DS.getRepAsDecl()); 13302 13303 DeclaratorDecl *FirstDeclaratorInGroup = nullptr; 13304 DecompositionDecl *FirstDecompDeclaratorInGroup = nullptr; 13305 bool DiagnosedMultipleDecomps = false; 13306 DeclaratorDecl *FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup = nullptr; 13307 bool DiagnosedNonDeducedAuto = false; 13308 13309 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Group.size(); i != e; ++i) { 13310 if (Decl *D = Group[i]) { 13311 // For declarators, there are some additional syntactic-ish checks we need 13312 // to perform. 13313 if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<DeclaratorDecl>(D)) { 13314 if (!FirstDeclaratorInGroup) 13315 FirstDeclaratorInGroup = DD; 13316 if (!FirstDecompDeclaratorInGroup) 13317 FirstDecompDeclaratorInGroup = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(D); 13318 if (!FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup && DS.hasAutoTypeSpec() && 13319 !hasDeducedAuto(DD)) 13320 FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup = DD; 13321 13322 if (FirstDeclaratorInGroup != DD) { 13323 // A decomposition declaration cannot be combined with any other 13324 // declaration in the same group. 13325 if (FirstDecompDeclaratorInGroup && !DiagnosedMultipleDecomps) { 13326 Diag(FirstDecompDeclaratorInGroup->getLocation(), 13327 diag::err_decomp_decl_not_alone) 13328 << FirstDeclaratorInGroup->getSourceRange() 13329 << DD->getSourceRange(); 13330 DiagnosedMultipleDecomps = true; 13331 } 13332 13333 // A declarator that uses 'auto' in any way other than to declare a 13334 // variable with a deduced type cannot be combined with any other 13335 // declarator in the same group. 13336 if (FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup && !DiagnosedNonDeducedAuto) { 13337 Diag(FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup->getLocation(), 13338 diag::err_auto_non_deduced_not_alone) 13339 << FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup->getType() 13340 ->hasAutoForTrailingReturnType() 13341 << FirstDeclaratorInGroup->getSourceRange() 13342 << DD->getSourceRange(); 13343 DiagnosedNonDeducedAuto = true; 13344 } 13345 } 13346 } 13347 13348 Decls.push_back(D); 13349 } 13350 } 13351 13352 if (DeclSpec::isDeclRep(DS.getTypeSpecType())) { 13353 if (TagDecl *Tag = dyn_cast_or_null<TagDecl>(DS.getRepAsDecl())) { 13354 handleTagNumbering(Tag, S); 13355 if (FirstDeclaratorInGroup && !Tag->hasNameForLinkage() && 13356 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 13357 Context.addDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(Tag, FirstDeclaratorInGroup); 13358 } 13359 } 13360 13361 return BuildDeclaratorGroup(Decls); 13362 } 13363 13364 /// BuildDeclaratorGroup - convert a list of declarations into a declaration 13365 /// group, performing any necessary semantic checking. 13366 Sema::DeclGroupPtrTy 13367 Sema::BuildDeclaratorGroup(MutableArrayRef<Decl *> Group) { 13368 // C++14 [dcl.spec.auto]p7: (DR1347) 13369 // If the type that replaces the placeholder type is not the same in each 13370 // deduction, the program is ill-formed. 13371 if (Group.size() > 1) { 13372 QualType Deduced; 13373 VarDecl *DeducedDecl = nullptr; 13374 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Group.size(); i != e; ++i) { 13375 VarDecl *D = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Group[i]); 13376 if (!D || D->isInvalidDecl()) 13377 break; 13378 DeducedType *DT = D->getType()->getContainedDeducedType(); 13379 if (!DT || DT->getDeducedType().isNull()) 13380 continue; 13381 if (Deduced.isNull()) { 13382 Deduced = DT->getDeducedType(); 13383 DeducedDecl = D; 13384 } else if (!Context.hasSameType(DT->getDeducedType(), Deduced)) { 13385 auto *AT = dyn_cast<AutoType>(DT); 13386 auto Dia = Diag(D->getTypeSourceInfo()->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), 13387 diag::err_auto_different_deductions) 13388 << (AT ? (unsigned)AT->getKeyword() : 3) << Deduced 13389 << DeducedDecl->getDeclName() << DT->getDeducedType() 13390 << D->getDeclName(); 13391 if (DeducedDecl->hasInit()) 13392 Dia << DeducedDecl->getInit()->getSourceRange(); 13393 if (D->getInit()) 13394 Dia << D->getInit()->getSourceRange(); 13395 D->setInvalidDecl(); 13396 break; 13397 } 13398 } 13399 } 13400 13401 ActOnDocumentableDecls(Group); 13402 13403 return DeclGroupPtrTy::make( 13404 DeclGroupRef::Create(Context, Group.data(), Group.size())); 13405 } 13406 13407 void Sema::ActOnDocumentableDecl(Decl *D) { 13408 ActOnDocumentableDecls(D); 13409 } 13410 13411 void Sema::ActOnDocumentableDecls(ArrayRef<Decl *> Group) { 13412 // Don't parse the comment if Doxygen diagnostics are ignored. 13413 if (Group.empty() || !Group[0]) 13414 return; 13415 13416 if (Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_doc_param_not_found, 13417 Group[0]->getLocation()) && 13418 Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_unknown_comment_command_name, 13419 Group[0]->getLocation())) 13420 return; 13421 13422 if (Group.size() >= 2) { 13423 // This is a decl group. Normally it will contain only declarations 13424 // produced from declarator list. But in case we have any definitions or 13425 // additional declaration references: 13426 // 'typedef struct S {} S;' 13427 // 'typedef struct S *S;' 13428 // 'struct S *pS;' 13429 // FinalizeDeclaratorGroup adds these as separate declarations. 13430 Decl *MaybeTagDecl = Group[0]; 13431 if (MaybeTagDecl && isa<TagDecl>(MaybeTagDecl)) { 13432 Group = Group.slice(1); 13433 } 13434 } 13435 13436 // FIMXE: We assume every Decl in the group is in the same file. 13437 // This is false when preprocessor constructs the group from decls in 13438 // different files (e. g. macros or #include). 13439 Context.attachCommentsToJustParsedDecls(Group, &getPreprocessor()); 13440 } 13441 13442 /// Common checks for a parameter-declaration that should apply to both function 13443 /// parameters and non-type template parameters. 13444 void Sema::CheckFunctionOrTemplateParamDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D) { 13445 // Check that there are no default arguments inside the type of this 13446 // parameter. 13447 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 13448 CheckExtraCXXDefaultArguments(D); 13449 13450 // Parameter declarators cannot be qualified (C++ [dcl.meaning]p1). 13451 if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) { 13452 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_qualified_param_declarator) 13453 << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange(); 13454 } 13455 13456 // [dcl.meaning]p1: An unqualified-id occurring in a declarator-id shall be a 13457 // simple identifier except [...irrelevant cases...]. 13458 switch (D.getName().getKind()) { 13459 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_Identifier: 13460 break; 13461 13462 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_OperatorFunctionId: 13463 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConversionFunctionId: 13464 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_LiteralOperatorId: 13465 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConstructorName: 13466 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_DestructorName: 13467 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ImplicitSelfParam: 13468 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_DeductionGuideName: 13469 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_bad_parameter_name) 13470 << GetNameForDeclarator(D).getName(); 13471 break; 13472 13473 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId: 13474 case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConstructorTemplateId: 13475 // GetNameForDeclarator would not produce a useful name in this case. 13476 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_bad_parameter_name_template_id); 13477 break; 13478 } 13479 } 13480 13481 /// ActOnParamDeclarator - Called from Parser::ParseFunctionDeclarator() 13482 /// to introduce parameters into function prototype scope. 13483 Decl *Sema::ActOnParamDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D) { 13484 const DeclSpec &DS = D.getDeclSpec(); 13485 13486 // Verify C99 6.7.5.3p2: The only SCS allowed is 'register'. 13487 13488 // C++03 [dcl.stc]p2 also permits 'auto'. 13489 StorageClass SC = SC_None; 13490 if (DS.getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_register) { 13491 SC = SC_Register; 13492 // In C++11, the 'register' storage class specifier is deprecated. 13493 // In C++17, it is not allowed, but we tolerate it as an extension. 13494 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) { 13495 Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 13496 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 ? diag::ext_register_storage_class 13497 : diag::warn_deprecated_register) 13498 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 13499 } 13500 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 13501 DS.getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_auto) { 13502 SC = SC_Auto; 13503 } else if (DS.getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified) { 13504 Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 13505 diag::err_invalid_storage_class_in_func_decl); 13506 D.getMutableDeclSpec().ClearStorageClassSpecs(); 13507 } 13508 13509 if (DeclSpec::TSCS TSCS = DS.getThreadStorageClassSpec()) 13510 Diag(DS.getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), diag::err_invalid_thread) 13511 << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSCS); 13512 if (DS.isInlineSpecified()) 13513 Diag(DS.getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_non_function) 13514 << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17; 13515 if (DS.hasConstexprSpecifier()) 13516 Diag(DS.getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_invalid_constexpr) 13517 << 0 << D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier(); 13518 13519 DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(DS); 13520 13521 CheckFunctionOrTemplateParamDeclarator(S, D); 13522 13523 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(D, S); 13524 QualType parmDeclType = TInfo->getType(); 13525 13526 // Check for redeclaration of parameters, e.g. int foo(int x, int x); 13527 IdentifierInfo *II = D.getIdentifier(); 13528 if (II) { 13529 LookupResult R(*this, II, D.getIdentifierLoc(), LookupOrdinaryName, 13530 ForVisibleRedeclaration); 13531 LookupName(R, S); 13532 if (R.isSingleResult()) { 13533 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = R.getFoundDecl(); 13534 if (PrevDecl->isTemplateParameter()) { 13535 // Maybe we will complain about the shadowed template parameter. 13536 DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow(D.getIdentifierLoc(), PrevDecl); 13537 // Just pretend that we didn't see the previous declaration. 13538 PrevDecl = nullptr; 13539 } else if (S->isDeclScope(PrevDecl)) { 13540 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_param_redefinition) << II; 13541 Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 13542 13543 // Recover by removing the name 13544 II = nullptr; 13545 D.SetIdentifier(nullptr, D.getIdentifierLoc()); 13546 D.setInvalidType(true); 13547 } 13548 } 13549 } 13550 13551 // Temporarily put parameter variables in the translation unit, not 13552 // the enclosing context. This prevents them from accidentally 13553 // looking like class members in C++. 13554 ParmVarDecl *New = 13555 CheckParameter(Context.getTranslationUnitDecl(), D.getBeginLoc(), 13556 D.getIdentifierLoc(), II, parmDeclType, TInfo, SC); 13557 13558 if (D.isInvalidType()) 13559 New->setInvalidDecl(); 13560 13561 assert(S->isFunctionPrototypeScope()); 13562 assert(S->getFunctionPrototypeDepth() >= 1); 13563 New->setScopeInfo(S->getFunctionPrototypeDepth() - 1, 13564 S->getNextFunctionPrototypeIndex()); 13565 13566 // Add the parameter declaration into this scope. 13567 S->AddDecl(New); 13568 if (II) 13569 IdResolver.AddDecl(New); 13570 13571 ProcessDeclAttributes(S, New, D); 13572 13573 if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified()) 13574 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_local) 13575 << 1 << New << SourceRange(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()) 13576 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()); 13577 13578 if (New->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) { 13579 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_block_on_nonlocal); 13580 } 13581 13582 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) 13583 deduceOpenCLAddressSpace(New); 13584 13585 return New; 13586 } 13587 13588 /// Synthesizes a variable for a parameter arising from a 13589 /// typedef. 13590 ParmVarDecl *Sema::BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(DeclContext *DC, 13591 SourceLocation Loc, 13592 QualType T) { 13593 /* FIXME: setting StartLoc == Loc. 13594 Would it be worth to modify callers so as to provide proper source 13595 location for the unnamed parameters, embedding the parameter's type? */ 13596 ParmVarDecl *Param = ParmVarDecl::Create(Context, DC, Loc, Loc, nullptr, 13597 T, Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T, Loc), 13598 SC_None, nullptr); 13599 Param->setImplicit(); 13600 return Param; 13601 } 13602 13603 void Sema::DiagnoseUnusedParameters(ArrayRef<ParmVarDecl *> Parameters) { 13604 // Don't diagnose unused-parameter errors in template instantiations; we 13605 // will already have done so in the template itself. 13606 if (inTemplateInstantiation()) 13607 return; 13608 13609 for (const ParmVarDecl *Parameter : Parameters) { 13610 if (!Parameter->isReferenced() && Parameter->getDeclName() && 13611 !Parameter->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>()) { 13612 Diag(Parameter->getLocation(), diag::warn_unused_parameter) 13613 << Parameter->getDeclName(); 13614 } 13615 } 13616 } 13617 13618 void Sema::DiagnoseSizeOfParametersAndReturnValue( 13619 ArrayRef<ParmVarDecl *> Parameters, QualType ReturnTy, NamedDecl *D) { 13620 if (LangOpts.NumLargeByValueCopy == 0) // No check. 13621 return; 13622 13623 // Warn if the return value is pass-by-value and larger than the specified 13624 // threshold. 13625 if (!ReturnTy->isDependentType() && ReturnTy.isPODType(Context)) { 13626 unsigned Size = Context.getTypeSizeInChars(ReturnTy).getQuantity(); 13627 if (Size > LangOpts.NumLargeByValueCopy) 13628 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::warn_return_value_size) << D << Size; 13629 } 13630 13631 // Warn if any parameter is pass-by-value and larger than the specified 13632 // threshold. 13633 for (const ParmVarDecl *Parameter : Parameters) { 13634 QualType T = Parameter->getType(); 13635 if (T->isDependentType() || !T.isPODType(Context)) 13636 continue; 13637 unsigned Size = Context.getTypeSizeInChars(T).getQuantity(); 13638 if (Size > LangOpts.NumLargeByValueCopy) 13639 Diag(Parameter->getLocation(), diag::warn_parameter_size) 13640 << Parameter << Size; 13641 } 13642 } 13643 13644 ParmVarDecl *Sema::CheckParameter(DeclContext *DC, SourceLocation StartLoc, 13645 SourceLocation NameLoc, IdentifierInfo *Name, 13646 QualType T, TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo, 13647 StorageClass SC) { 13648 // In ARC, infer a lifetime qualifier for appropriate parameter types. 13649 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && 13650 T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_None && 13651 T->isObjCLifetimeType()) { 13652 13653 Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime lifetime; 13654 13655 // Special cases for arrays: 13656 // - if it's const, use __unsafe_unretained 13657 // - otherwise, it's an error 13658 if (T->isArrayType()) { 13659 if (!T.isConstQualified()) { 13660 if (DelayedDiagnostics.shouldDelayDiagnostics()) 13661 DelayedDiagnostics.add( 13662 sema::DelayedDiagnostic::makeForbiddenType( 13663 NameLoc, diag::err_arc_array_param_no_ownership, T, false)); 13664 else 13665 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_arc_array_param_no_ownership) 13666 << TSInfo->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange(); 13667 } 13668 lifetime = Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone; 13669 } else { 13670 lifetime = T->getObjCARCImplicitLifetime(); 13671 } 13672 T = Context.getLifetimeQualifiedType(T, lifetime); 13673 } 13674 13675 ParmVarDecl *New = ParmVarDecl::Create(Context, DC, StartLoc, NameLoc, Name, 13676 Context.getAdjustedParameterType(T), 13677 TSInfo, SC, nullptr); 13678 13679 // Make a note if we created a new pack in the scope of a lambda, so that 13680 // we know that references to that pack must also be expanded within the 13681 // lambda scope. 13682 if (New->isParameterPack()) 13683 if (auto *LSI = getEnclosingLambda()) 13684 LSI->LocalPacks.push_back(New); 13685 13686 if (New->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() || 13687 New->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()) 13688 checkNonTrivialCUnion(New->getType(), New->getLocation(), 13689 NTCUC_FunctionParam, NTCUK_Destruct|NTCUK_Copy); 13690 13691 // Parameters can not be abstract class types. 13692 // For record types, this is done by the AbstractClassUsageDiagnoser once 13693 // the class has been completely parsed. 13694 if (!CurContext->isRecord() && 13695 RequireNonAbstractType(NameLoc, T, diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, 13696 AbstractParamType)) 13697 New->setInvalidDecl(); 13698 13699 // Parameter declarators cannot be interface types. All ObjC objects are 13700 // passed by reference. 13701 if (T->isObjCObjectType()) { 13702 SourceLocation TypeEndLoc = 13703 getLocForEndOfToken(TSInfo->getTypeLoc().getEndLoc()); 13704 Diag(NameLoc, 13705 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 1 << T 13706 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(TypeEndLoc, "*"); 13707 T = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(T); 13708 New->setType(T); 13709 } 13710 13711 // ISO/IEC TR 18037 S6.7.3: "The type of an object with automatic storage 13712 // duration shall not be qualified by an address-space qualifier." 13713 // Since all parameters have automatic store duration, they can not have 13714 // an address space. 13715 if (T.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::Default && 13716 // OpenCL allows function arguments declared to be an array of a type 13717 // to be qualified with an address space. 13718 !(getLangOpts().OpenCL && 13719 (T->isArrayType() || T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_private))) { 13720 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_arg_with_address_space); 13721 New->setInvalidDecl(); 13722 } 13723 13724 // PPC MMA non-pointer types are not allowed as function argument types. 13725 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isPPC64() && 13726 CheckPPCMMAType(New->getOriginalType(), New->getLocation())) { 13727 New->setInvalidDecl(); 13728 } 13729 13730 return New; 13731 } 13732 13733 void Sema::ActOnFinishKNRParamDeclarations(Scope *S, Declarator &D, 13734 SourceLocation LocAfterDecls) { 13735 DeclaratorChunk::FunctionTypeInfo &FTI = D.getFunctionTypeInfo(); 13736 13737 // Verify 6.9.1p6: 'every identifier in the identifier list shall be declared' 13738 // for a K&R function. 13739 if (!FTI.hasPrototype) { 13740 for (int i = FTI.NumParams; i != 0; /* decrement in loop */) { 13741 --i; 13742 if (FTI.Params[i].Param == nullptr) { 13743 SmallString<256> Code; 13744 llvm::raw_svector_ostream(Code) 13745 << " int " << FTI.Params[i].Ident->getName() << ";\n"; 13746 Diag(FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc, diag::ext_param_not_declared) 13747 << FTI.Params[i].Ident 13748 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(LocAfterDecls, Code); 13749 13750 // Implicitly declare the argument as type 'int' for lack of a better 13751 // type. 13752 AttributeFactory attrs; 13753 DeclSpec DS(attrs); 13754 const char* PrevSpec; // unused 13755 unsigned DiagID; // unused 13756 DS.SetTypeSpecType(DeclSpec::TST_int, FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc, PrevSpec, 13757 DiagID, Context.getPrintingPolicy()); 13758 // Use the identifier location for the type source range. 13759 DS.SetRangeStart(FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc); 13760 DS.SetRangeEnd(FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc); 13761 Declarator ParamD(DS, DeclaratorContext::KNRTypeListContext); 13762 ParamD.SetIdentifier(FTI.Params[i].Ident, FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc); 13763 FTI.Params[i].Param = ActOnParamDeclarator(S, ParamD); 13764 } 13765 } 13766 } 13767 } 13768 13769 Decl * 13770 Sema::ActOnStartOfFunctionDef(Scope *FnBodyScope, Declarator &D, 13771 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParameterLists, 13772 SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody) { 13773 assert(getCurFunctionDecl() == nullptr && "Function parsing confused"); 13774 assert(D.isFunctionDeclarator() && "Not a function declarator!"); 13775 Scope *ParentScope = FnBodyScope->getParent(); 13776 13777 // Check if we are in an `omp begin/end declare variant` scope. If we are, and 13778 // we define a non-templated function definition, we will create a declaration 13779 // instead (=BaseFD), and emit the definition with a mangled name afterwards. 13780 // The base function declaration will have the equivalent of an `omp declare 13781 // variant` annotation which specifies the mangled definition as a 13782 // specialization function under the OpenMP context defined as part of the 13783 // `omp begin declare variant`. 13784 SmallVector<FunctionDecl *, 4> Bases; 13785 if (LangOpts.OpenMP && isInOpenMPDeclareVariantScope()) 13786 ActOnStartOfFunctionDefinitionInOpenMPDeclareVariantScope( 13787 ParentScope, D, TemplateParameterLists, Bases); 13788 13789 D.setFunctionDefinitionKind(FDK_Definition); 13790 Decl *DP = HandleDeclarator(ParentScope, D, TemplateParameterLists); 13791 Decl *Dcl = ActOnStartOfFunctionDef(FnBodyScope, DP, SkipBody); 13792 13793 if (!Bases.empty()) 13794 ActOnFinishedFunctionDefinitionInOpenMPDeclareVariantScope(Dcl, Bases); 13795 13796 return Dcl; 13797 } 13798 13799 void Sema::ActOnFinishInlineFunctionDef(FunctionDecl *D) { 13800 Consumer.HandleInlineFunctionDefinition(D); 13801 } 13802 13803 static bool 13804 ShouldWarnAboutMissingPrototype(const FunctionDecl *FD, 13805 const FunctionDecl *&PossiblePrototype) { 13806 // Don't warn about invalid declarations. 13807 if (FD->isInvalidDecl()) 13808 return false; 13809 13810 // Or declarations that aren't global. 13811 if (!FD->isGlobal()) 13812 return false; 13813 13814 // Don't warn about C++ member functions. 13815 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) 13816 return false; 13817 13818 // Don't warn about 'main'. 13819 if (isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(FD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext())) 13820 if (IdentifierInfo *II = FD->getIdentifier()) 13821 if (II->isStr("main")) 13822 return false; 13823 13824 // Don't warn about inline functions. 13825 if (FD->isInlined()) 13826 return false; 13827 13828 // Don't warn about function templates. 13829 if (FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) 13830 return false; 13831 13832 // Don't warn about function template specializations. 13833 if (FD->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization()) 13834 return false; 13835 13836 // Don't warn for OpenCL kernels. 13837 if (FD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>()) 13838 return false; 13839 13840 // Don't warn on explicitly deleted functions. 13841 if (FD->isDeleted()) 13842 return false; 13843 13844 for (const FunctionDecl *Prev = FD->getPreviousDecl(); 13845 Prev; Prev = Prev->getPreviousDecl()) { 13846 // Ignore any declarations that occur in function or method 13847 // scope, because they aren't visible from the header. 13848 if (Prev->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()) 13849 continue; 13850 13851 PossiblePrototype = Prev; 13852 return Prev->getType()->isFunctionNoProtoType(); 13853 } 13854 13855 return true; 13856 } 13857 13858 void 13859 Sema::CheckForFunctionRedefinition(FunctionDecl *FD, 13860 const FunctionDecl *EffectiveDefinition, 13861 SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody) { 13862 const FunctionDecl *Definition = EffectiveDefinition; 13863 if (!Definition && 13864 !FD->isDefined(Definition, /*CheckForPendingFriendDefinition*/ true)) 13865 return; 13866 13867 if (Definition->getFriendObjectKind() != Decl::FOK_None) { 13868 if (FunctionDecl *OrigDef = Definition->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction()) { 13869 if (FunctionDecl *OrigFD = FD->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction()) { 13870 // A merged copy of the same function, instantiated as a member of 13871 // the same class, is OK. 13872 if (declaresSameEntity(OrigFD, OrigDef) && 13873 declaresSameEntity(cast<Decl>(Definition->getLexicalDeclContext()), 13874 cast<Decl>(FD->getLexicalDeclContext()))) 13875 return; 13876 } 13877 } 13878 } 13879 13880 if (canRedefineFunction(Definition, getLangOpts())) 13881 return; 13882 13883 // Don't emit an error when this is redefinition of a typo-corrected 13884 // definition. 13885 if (TypoCorrectedFunctionDefinitions.count(Definition)) 13886 return; 13887 13888 // If we don't have a visible definition of the function, and it's inline or 13889 // a template, skip the new definition. 13890 if (SkipBody && !hasVisibleDefinition(Definition) && 13891 (Definition->getFormalLinkage() == InternalLinkage || 13892 Definition->isInlined() || 13893 Definition->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() || 13894 Definition->getNumTemplateParameterLists())) { 13895 SkipBody->ShouldSkip = true; 13896 SkipBody->Previous = const_cast<FunctionDecl*>(Definition); 13897 if (auto *TD = Definition->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) 13898 makeMergedDefinitionVisible(TD); 13899 makeMergedDefinitionVisible(const_cast<FunctionDecl*>(Definition)); 13900 return; 13901 } 13902 13903 if (getLangOpts().GNUMode && Definition->isInlineSpecified() && 13904 Definition->getStorageClass() == SC_Extern) 13905 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_extern_inline) 13906 << FD << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 13907 else 13908 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition) << FD; 13909 13910 Diag(Definition->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 13911 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 13912 } 13913 13914 static void RebuildLambdaScopeInfo(CXXMethodDecl *CallOperator, 13915 Sema &S) { 13916 CXXRecordDecl *const LambdaClass = CallOperator->getParent(); 13917 13918 LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = S.PushLambdaScope(); 13919 LSI->CallOperator = CallOperator; 13920 LSI->Lambda = LambdaClass; 13921 LSI->ReturnType = CallOperator->getReturnType(); 13922 const LambdaCaptureDefault LCD = LambdaClass->getLambdaCaptureDefault(); 13923 13924 if (LCD == LCD_None) 13925 LSI->ImpCaptureStyle = CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_None; 13926 else if (LCD == LCD_ByCopy) 13927 LSI->ImpCaptureStyle = CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_LambdaByval; 13928 else if (LCD == LCD_ByRef) 13929 LSI->ImpCaptureStyle = CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_LambdaByref; 13930 DeclarationNameInfo DNI = CallOperator->getNameInfo(); 13931 13932 LSI->IntroducerRange = DNI.getCXXOperatorNameRange(); 13933 LSI->Mutable = !CallOperator->isConst(); 13934 13935 // Add the captures to the LSI so they can be noted as already 13936 // captured within tryCaptureVar. 13937 auto I = LambdaClass->field_begin(); 13938 for (const auto &C : LambdaClass->captures()) { 13939 if (C.capturesVariable()) { 13940 VarDecl *VD = C.getCapturedVar(); 13941 if (VD->isInitCapture()) 13942 S.CurrentInstantiationScope->InstantiatedLocal(VD, VD); 13943 const bool ByRef = C.getCaptureKind() == LCK_ByRef; 13944 LSI->addCapture(VD, /*IsBlock*/false, ByRef, 13945 /*RefersToEnclosingVariableOrCapture*/true, C.getLocation(), 13946 /*EllipsisLoc*/C.isPackExpansion() 13947 ? C.getEllipsisLoc() : SourceLocation(), 13948 I->getType(), /*Invalid*/false); 13949 13950 } else if (C.capturesThis()) { 13951 LSI->addThisCapture(/*Nested*/ false, C.getLocation(), I->getType(), 13952 C.getCaptureKind() == LCK_StarThis); 13953 } else { 13954 LSI->addVLATypeCapture(C.getLocation(), I->getCapturedVLAType(), 13955 I->getType()); 13956 } 13957 ++I; 13958 } 13959 } 13960 13961 Decl *Sema::ActOnStartOfFunctionDef(Scope *FnBodyScope, Decl *D, 13962 SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody) { 13963 if (!D) { 13964 // Parsing the function declaration failed in some way. Push on a fake scope 13965 // anyway so we can try to parse the function body. 13966 PushFunctionScope(); 13967 PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExprEvalContexts.back().Context); 13968 return D; 13969 } 13970 13971 FunctionDecl *FD = nullptr; 13972 13973 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)) 13974 FD = FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl(); 13975 else 13976 FD = cast<FunctionDecl>(D); 13977 13978 // Do not push if it is a lambda because one is already pushed when building 13979 // the lambda in ActOnStartOfLambdaDefinition(). 13980 if (!isLambdaCallOperator(FD)) 13981 PushExpressionEvaluationContext( 13982 FD->isConsteval() ? ExpressionEvaluationContext::ConstantEvaluated 13983 : ExprEvalContexts.back().Context); 13984 13985 // Check for defining attributes before the check for redefinition. 13986 if (const auto *Attr = FD->getAttr<AliasAttr>()) { 13987 Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::err_alias_is_definition) << FD << 0; 13988 FD->dropAttr<AliasAttr>(); 13989 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 13990 } 13991 if (const auto *Attr = FD->getAttr<IFuncAttr>()) { 13992 Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::err_alias_is_definition) << FD << 1; 13993 FD->dropAttr<IFuncAttr>(); 13994 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 13995 } 13996 13997 // See if this is a redefinition. If 'will have body' (or similar) is already 13998 // set, then these checks were already performed when it was set. 13999 if (!FD->willHaveBody() && !FD->isLateTemplateParsed() && 14000 !FD->isThisDeclarationInstantiatedFromAFriendDefinition()) { 14001 CheckForFunctionRedefinition(FD, nullptr, SkipBody); 14002 14003 // If we're skipping the body, we're done. Don't enter the scope. 14004 if (SkipBody && SkipBody->ShouldSkip) 14005 return D; 14006 } 14007 14008 // Mark this function as "will have a body eventually". This lets users to 14009 // call e.g. isInlineDefinitionExternallyVisible while we're still parsing 14010 // this function. 14011 FD->setWillHaveBody(); 14012 14013 // If we are instantiating a generic lambda call operator, push 14014 // a LambdaScopeInfo onto the function stack. But use the information 14015 // that's already been calculated (ActOnLambdaExpr) to prime the current 14016 // LambdaScopeInfo. 14017 // When the template operator is being specialized, the LambdaScopeInfo, 14018 // has to be properly restored so that tryCaptureVariable doesn't try 14019 // and capture any new variables. In addition when calculating potential 14020 // captures during transformation of nested lambdas, it is necessary to 14021 // have the LSI properly restored. 14022 if (isGenericLambdaCallOperatorSpecialization(FD)) { 14023 assert(inTemplateInstantiation() && 14024 "There should be an active template instantiation on the stack " 14025 "when instantiating a generic lambda!"); 14026 RebuildLambdaScopeInfo(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D), *this); 14027 } else { 14028 // Enter a new function scope 14029 PushFunctionScope(); 14030 } 14031 14032 // Builtin functions cannot be defined. 14033 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FD->getBuiltinID()) { 14034 if (!Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID) && 14035 !Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedRuntimeFunction(BuiltinID)) { 14036 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_builtin_definition) << FD; 14037 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 14038 } 14039 } 14040 14041 // The return type of a function definition must be complete 14042 // (C99 6.9.1p3, C++ [dcl.fct]p6). 14043 QualType ResultType = FD->getReturnType(); 14044 if (!ResultType->isDependentType() && !ResultType->isVoidType() && 14045 !FD->isInvalidDecl() && 14046 RequireCompleteType(FD->getLocation(), ResultType, 14047 diag::err_func_def_incomplete_result)) 14048 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 14049 14050 if (FnBodyScope) 14051 PushDeclContext(FnBodyScope, FD); 14052 14053 // Check the validity of our function parameters 14054 CheckParmsForFunctionDef(FD->parameters(), 14055 /*CheckParameterNames=*/true); 14056 14057 // Add non-parameter declarations already in the function to the current 14058 // scope. 14059 if (FnBodyScope) { 14060 for (Decl *NPD : FD->decls()) { 14061 auto *NonParmDecl = dyn_cast<NamedDecl>(NPD); 14062 if (!NonParmDecl) 14063 continue; 14064 assert(!isa<ParmVarDecl>(NonParmDecl) && 14065 "parameters should not be in newly created FD yet"); 14066 14067 // If the decl has a name, make it accessible in the current scope. 14068 if (NonParmDecl->getDeclName()) 14069 PushOnScopeChains(NonParmDecl, FnBodyScope, /*AddToContext=*/false); 14070 14071 // Similarly, dive into enums and fish their constants out, making them 14072 // accessible in this scope. 14073 if (auto *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(NonParmDecl)) { 14074 for (auto *EI : ED->enumerators()) 14075 PushOnScopeChains(EI, FnBodyScope, /*AddToContext=*/false); 14076 } 14077 } 14078 } 14079 14080 // Introduce our parameters into the function scope 14081 for (auto Param : FD->parameters()) { 14082 Param->setOwningFunction(FD); 14083 14084 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack. 14085 if (Param->getIdentifier() && FnBodyScope) { 14086 CheckShadow(FnBodyScope, Param); 14087 14088 PushOnScopeChains(Param, FnBodyScope); 14089 } 14090 } 14091 14092 // Ensure that the function's exception specification is instantiated. 14093 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = FD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 14094 ResolveExceptionSpec(D->getLocation(), FPT); 14095 14096 // dllimport cannot be applied to non-inline function definitions. 14097 if (FD->hasAttr<DLLImportAttr>() && !FD->isInlined() && 14098 !FD->isTemplateInstantiation()) { 14099 assert(!FD->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()); 14100 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_dllimport_function_definition); 14101 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 14102 return D; 14103 } 14104 // We want to attach documentation to original Decl (which might be 14105 // a function template). 14106 ActOnDocumentableDecl(D); 14107 if (getCurLexicalContext()->isObjCContainer() && 14108 getCurLexicalContext()->getDeclKind() != Decl::ObjCCategoryImpl && 14109 getCurLexicalContext()->getDeclKind() != Decl::ObjCImplementation) 14110 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::warn_function_def_in_objc_container); 14111 14112 return D; 14113 } 14114 14115 /// Given the set of return statements within a function body, 14116 /// compute the variables that are subject to the named return value 14117 /// optimization. 14118 /// 14119 /// Each of the variables that is subject to the named return value 14120 /// optimization will be marked as NRVO variables in the AST, and any 14121 /// return statement that has a marked NRVO variable as its NRVO candidate can 14122 /// use the named return value optimization. 14123 /// 14124 /// This function applies a very simplistic algorithm for NRVO: if every return 14125 /// statement in the scope of a variable has the same NRVO candidate, that 14126 /// candidate is an NRVO variable. 14127 void Sema::computeNRVO(Stmt *Body, FunctionScopeInfo *Scope) { 14128 ReturnStmt **Returns = Scope->Returns.data(); 14129 14130 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Scope->Returns.size(); I != E; ++I) { 14131 if (const VarDecl *NRVOCandidate = Returns[I]->getNRVOCandidate()) { 14132 if (!NRVOCandidate->isNRVOVariable()) 14133 Returns[I]->setNRVOCandidate(nullptr); 14134 } 14135 } 14136 } 14137 14138 bool Sema::canDelayFunctionBody(const Declarator &D) { 14139 // We can't delay parsing the body of a constexpr function template (yet). 14140 if (D.getDeclSpec().hasConstexprSpecifier()) 14141 return false; 14142 14143 // We can't delay parsing the body of a function template with a deduced 14144 // return type (yet). 14145 if (D.getDeclSpec().hasAutoTypeSpec()) { 14146 // If the placeholder introduces a non-deduced trailing return type, 14147 // we can still delay parsing it. 14148 if (D.getNumTypeObjects()) { 14149 const auto &Outer = D.getTypeObject(D.getNumTypeObjects() - 1); 14150 if (Outer.Kind == DeclaratorChunk::Function && 14151 Outer.Fun.hasTrailingReturnType()) { 14152 QualType Ty = GetTypeFromParser(Outer.Fun.getTrailingReturnType()); 14153 return Ty.isNull() || !Ty->isUndeducedType(); 14154 } 14155 } 14156 return false; 14157 } 14158 14159 return true; 14160 } 14161 14162 bool Sema::canSkipFunctionBody(Decl *D) { 14163 // We cannot skip the body of a function (or function template) which is 14164 // constexpr, since we may need to evaluate its body in order to parse the 14165 // rest of the file. 14166 // We cannot skip the body of a function with an undeduced return type, 14167 // because any callers of that function need to know the type. 14168 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = D->getAsFunction()) { 14169 if (FD->isConstexpr()) 14170 return false; 14171 // We can't simply call Type::isUndeducedType here, because inside template 14172 // auto can be deduced to a dependent type, which is not considered 14173 // "undeduced". 14174 if (FD->getReturnType()->getContainedDeducedType()) 14175 return false; 14176 } 14177 return Consumer.shouldSkipFunctionBody(D); 14178 } 14179 14180 Decl *Sema::ActOnSkippedFunctionBody(Decl *Decl) { 14181 if (!Decl) 14182 return nullptr; 14183 if (FunctionDecl *FD = Decl->getAsFunction()) 14184 FD->setHasSkippedBody(); 14185 else if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(Decl)) 14186 MD->setHasSkippedBody(); 14187 return Decl; 14188 } 14189 14190 Decl *Sema::ActOnFinishFunctionBody(Decl *D, Stmt *BodyArg) { 14191 return ActOnFinishFunctionBody(D, BodyArg, false); 14192 } 14193 14194 /// RAII object that pops an ExpressionEvaluationContext when exiting a function 14195 /// body. 14196 class ExitFunctionBodyRAII { 14197 public: 14198 ExitFunctionBodyRAII(Sema &S, bool IsLambda) : S(S), IsLambda(IsLambda) {} 14199 ~ExitFunctionBodyRAII() { 14200 if (!IsLambda) 14201 S.PopExpressionEvaluationContext(); 14202 } 14203 14204 private: 14205 Sema &S; 14206 bool IsLambda = false; 14207 }; 14208 14209 static void diagnoseImplicitlyRetainedSelf(Sema &S) { 14210 llvm::DenseMap<const BlockDecl *, bool> EscapeInfo; 14211 14212 auto IsOrNestedInEscapingBlock = [&](const BlockDecl *BD) { 14213 if (EscapeInfo.count(BD)) 14214 return EscapeInfo[BD]; 14215 14216 bool R = false; 14217 const BlockDecl *CurBD = BD; 14218 14219 do { 14220 R = !CurBD->doesNotEscape(); 14221 if (R) 14222 break; 14223 CurBD = CurBD->getParent()->getInnermostBlockDecl(); 14224 } while (CurBD); 14225 14226 return EscapeInfo[BD] = R; 14227 }; 14228 14229 // If the location where 'self' is implicitly retained is inside a escaping 14230 // block, emit a diagnostic. 14231 for (const std::pair<SourceLocation, const BlockDecl *> &P : 14232 S.ImplicitlyRetainedSelfLocs) 14233 if (IsOrNestedInEscapingBlock(P.second)) 14234 S.Diag(P.first, diag::warn_implicitly_retains_self) 14235 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(P.first, "self->"); 14236 } 14237 14238 Decl *Sema::ActOnFinishFunctionBody(Decl *dcl, Stmt *Body, 14239 bool IsInstantiation) { 14240 FunctionScopeInfo *FSI = getCurFunction(); 14241 FunctionDecl *FD = dcl ? dcl->getAsFunction() : nullptr; 14242 14243 if (FSI->UsesFPIntrin && !FD->hasAttr<StrictFPAttr>()) 14244 FD->addAttr(StrictFPAttr::CreateImplicit(Context)); 14245 14246 sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy WP = AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy(); 14247 sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy *ActivePolicy = nullptr; 14248 14249 if (getLangOpts().Coroutines && FSI->isCoroutine()) 14250 CheckCompletedCoroutineBody(FD, Body); 14251 14252 // Do not call PopExpressionEvaluationContext() if it is a lambda because one 14253 // is already popped when finishing the lambda in BuildLambdaExpr(). This is 14254 // meant to pop the context added in ActOnStartOfFunctionDef(). 14255 ExitFunctionBodyRAII ExitRAII(*this, isLambdaCallOperator(FD)); 14256 14257 if (FD) { 14258 FD->setBody(Body); 14259 FD->setWillHaveBody(false); 14260 14261 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) { 14262 if (!FD->isInvalidDecl() && Body && !FD->isDependentContext() && 14263 FD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType()) { 14264 // If the function has a deduced result type but contains no 'return' 14265 // statements, the result type as written must be exactly 'auto', and 14266 // the deduced result type is 'void'. 14267 if (!FD->getReturnType()->getAs<AutoType>()) { 14268 Diag(dcl->getLocation(), diag::err_auto_fn_no_return_but_not_auto) 14269 << FD->getReturnType(); 14270 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 14271 } else { 14272 // Substitute 'void' for the 'auto' in the type. 14273 TypeLoc ResultType = getReturnTypeLoc(FD); 14274 Context.adjustDeducedFunctionResultType( 14275 FD, SubstAutoType(ResultType.getType(), Context.VoidTy)); 14276 } 14277 } 14278 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && isLambdaCallOperator(FD)) { 14279 // In C++11, we don't use 'auto' deduction rules for lambda call 14280 // operators because we don't support return type deduction. 14281 auto *LSI = getCurLambda(); 14282 if (LSI->HasImplicitReturnType) { 14283 deduceClosureReturnType(*LSI); 14284 14285 // C++11 [expr.prim.lambda]p4: 14286 // [...] if there are no return statements in the compound-statement 14287 // [the deduced type is] the type void 14288 QualType RetType = 14289 LSI->ReturnType.isNull() ? Context.VoidTy : LSI->ReturnType; 14290 14291 // Update the return type to the deduced type. 14292 const auto *Proto = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 14293 FD->setType(Context.getFunctionType(RetType, Proto->getParamTypes(), 14294 Proto->getExtProtoInfo())); 14295 } 14296 } 14297 14298 // If the function implicitly returns zero (like 'main') or is naked, 14299 // don't complain about missing return statements. 14300 if (FD->hasImplicitReturnZero() || FD->hasAttr<NakedAttr>()) 14301 WP.disableCheckFallThrough(); 14302 14303 // MSVC permits the use of pure specifier (=0) on function definition, 14304 // defined at class scope, warn about this non-standard construct. 14305 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && FD->isPure() && !FD->isOutOfLine()) 14306 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::ext_pure_function_definition); 14307 14308 if (!FD->isInvalidDecl()) { 14309 // Don't diagnose unused parameters of defaulted or deleted functions. 14310 if (!FD->isDeleted() && !FD->isDefaulted() && !FD->hasSkippedBody()) 14311 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(FD->parameters()); 14312 DiagnoseSizeOfParametersAndReturnValue(FD->parameters(), 14313 FD->getReturnType(), FD); 14314 14315 // If this is a structor, we need a vtable. 14316 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(FD)) 14317 MarkVTableUsed(FD->getLocation(), Constructor->getParent()); 14318 else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(FD)) 14319 MarkVTableUsed(FD->getLocation(), Destructor->getParent()); 14320 14321 // Try to apply the named return value optimization. We have to check 14322 // if we can do this here because lambdas keep return statements around 14323 // to deduce an implicit return type. 14324 if (FD->getReturnType()->isRecordType() && 14325 (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !FD->isDependentContext())) 14326 computeNRVO(Body, FSI); 14327 } 14328 14329 // GNU warning -Wmissing-prototypes: 14330 // Warn if a global function is defined without a previous 14331 // prototype declaration. This warning is issued even if the 14332 // definition itself provides a prototype. The aim is to detect 14333 // global functions that fail to be declared in header files. 14334 const FunctionDecl *PossiblePrototype = nullptr; 14335 if (ShouldWarnAboutMissingPrototype(FD, PossiblePrototype)) { 14336 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::warn_missing_prototype) << FD; 14337 14338 if (PossiblePrototype) { 14339 // We found a declaration that is not a prototype, 14340 // but that could be a zero-parameter prototype 14341 if (TypeSourceInfo *TI = PossiblePrototype->getTypeSourceInfo()) { 14342 TypeLoc TL = TI->getTypeLoc(); 14343 if (FunctionNoProtoTypeLoc FTL = TL.getAs<FunctionNoProtoTypeLoc>()) 14344 Diag(PossiblePrototype->getLocation(), 14345 diag::note_declaration_not_a_prototype) 14346 << (FD->getNumParams() != 0) 14347 << (FD->getNumParams() == 0 14348 ? FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FTL.getRParenLoc(), "void") 14349 : FixItHint{}); 14350 } 14351 } else { 14352 // Returns true if the token beginning at this Loc is `const`. 14353 auto isLocAtConst = [&](SourceLocation Loc, const SourceManager &SM, 14354 const LangOptions &LangOpts) { 14355 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> LocInfo = SM.getDecomposedLoc(Loc); 14356 if (LocInfo.first.isInvalid()) 14357 return false; 14358 14359 bool Invalid = false; 14360 StringRef Buffer = SM.getBufferData(LocInfo.first, &Invalid); 14361 if (Invalid) 14362 return false; 14363 14364 if (LocInfo.second > Buffer.size()) 14365 return false; 14366 14367 const char *LexStart = Buffer.data() + LocInfo.second; 14368 StringRef StartTok(LexStart, Buffer.size() - LocInfo.second); 14369 14370 return StartTok.consume_front("const") && 14371 (StartTok.empty() || isWhitespace(StartTok[0]) || 14372 StartTok.startswith("/*") || StartTok.startswith("//")); 14373 }; 14374 14375 auto findBeginLoc = [&]() { 14376 // If the return type has `const` qualifier, we want to insert 14377 // `static` before `const` (and not before the typename). 14378 if ((FD->getReturnType()->isAnyPointerType() && 14379 FD->getReturnType()->getPointeeType().isConstQualified()) || 14380 FD->getReturnType().isConstQualified()) { 14381 // But only do this if we can determine where the `const` is. 14382 14383 if (isLocAtConst(FD->getBeginLoc(), getSourceManager(), 14384 getLangOpts())) 14385 14386 return FD->getBeginLoc(); 14387 } 14388 return FD->getTypeSpecStartLoc(); 14389 }; 14390 Diag(FD->getTypeSpecStartLoc(), diag::note_static_for_internal_linkage) 14391 << /* function */ 1 14392 << (FD->getStorageClass() == SC_None 14393 ? FixItHint::CreateInsertion(findBeginLoc(), "static ") 14394 : FixItHint{}); 14395 } 14396 14397 // GNU warning -Wstrict-prototypes 14398 // Warn if K&R function is defined without a previous declaration. 14399 // This warning is issued only if the definition itself does not provide 14400 // a prototype. Only K&R definitions do not provide a prototype. 14401 if (!FD->hasWrittenPrototype()) { 14402 TypeSourceInfo *TI = FD->getTypeSourceInfo(); 14403 TypeLoc TL = TI->getTypeLoc(); 14404 FunctionTypeLoc FTL = TL.getAsAdjusted<FunctionTypeLoc>(); 14405 Diag(FTL.getLParenLoc(), diag::warn_strict_prototypes) << 2; 14406 } 14407 } 14408 14409 // Warn on CPUDispatch with an actual body. 14410 if (FD->isMultiVersion() && FD->hasAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>() && Body) 14411 if (const auto *CmpndBody = dyn_cast<CompoundStmt>(Body)) 14412 if (!CmpndBody->body_empty()) 14413 Diag(CmpndBody->body_front()->getBeginLoc(), 14414 diag::warn_dispatch_body_ignored); 14415 14416 if (auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) { 14417 const CXXMethodDecl *KeyFunction; 14418 if (MD->isOutOfLine() && (MD = MD->getCanonicalDecl()) && 14419 MD->isVirtual() && 14420 (KeyFunction = Context.getCurrentKeyFunction(MD->getParent())) && 14421 MD == KeyFunction->getCanonicalDecl()) { 14422 // Update the key-function state if necessary for this ABI. 14423 if (FD->isInlined() && 14424 !Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().canKeyFunctionBeInline()) { 14425 Context.setNonKeyFunction(MD); 14426 14427 // If the newly-chosen key function is already defined, then we 14428 // need to mark the vtable as used retroactively. 14429 KeyFunction = Context.getCurrentKeyFunction(MD->getParent()); 14430 const FunctionDecl *Definition; 14431 if (KeyFunction && KeyFunction->isDefined(Definition)) 14432 MarkVTableUsed(Definition->getLocation(), MD->getParent(), true); 14433 } else { 14434 // We just defined they key function; mark the vtable as used. 14435 MarkVTableUsed(FD->getLocation(), MD->getParent(), true); 14436 } 14437 } 14438 } 14439 14440 assert((FD == getCurFunctionDecl() || getCurLambda()->CallOperator == FD) && 14441 "Function parsing confused"); 14442 } else if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCMethodDecl>(dcl)) { 14443 assert(MD == getCurMethodDecl() && "Method parsing confused"); 14444 MD->setBody(Body); 14445 if (!MD->isInvalidDecl()) { 14446 DiagnoseSizeOfParametersAndReturnValue(MD->parameters(), 14447 MD->getReturnType(), MD); 14448 14449 if (Body) 14450 computeNRVO(Body, FSI); 14451 } 14452 if (FSI->ObjCShouldCallSuper) { 14453 Diag(MD->getEndLoc(), diag::warn_objc_missing_super_call) 14454 << MD->getSelector().getAsString(); 14455 FSI->ObjCShouldCallSuper = false; 14456 } 14457 if (FSI->ObjCWarnForNoDesignatedInitChain) { 14458 const ObjCMethodDecl *InitMethod = nullptr; 14459 bool isDesignated = 14460 MD->isDesignatedInitializerForTheInterface(&InitMethod); 14461 assert(isDesignated && InitMethod); 14462 (void)isDesignated; 14463 14464 auto superIsNSObject = [&](const ObjCMethodDecl *MD) { 14465 auto IFace = MD->getClassInterface(); 14466 if (!IFace) 14467 return false; 14468 auto SuperD = IFace->getSuperClass(); 14469 if (!SuperD) 14470 return false; 14471 return SuperD->getIdentifier() == 14472 NSAPIObj->getNSClassId(NSAPI::ClassId_NSObject); 14473 }; 14474 // Don't issue this warning for unavailable inits or direct subclasses 14475 // of NSObject. 14476 if (!MD->isUnavailable() && !superIsNSObject(MD)) { 14477 Diag(MD->getLocation(), 14478 diag::warn_objc_designated_init_missing_super_call); 14479 Diag(InitMethod->getLocation(), 14480 diag::note_objc_designated_init_marked_here); 14481 } 14482 FSI->ObjCWarnForNoDesignatedInitChain = false; 14483 } 14484 if (FSI->ObjCWarnForNoInitDelegation) { 14485 // Don't issue this warning for unavaialable inits. 14486 if (!MD->isUnavailable()) 14487 Diag(MD->getLocation(), 14488 diag::warn_objc_secondary_init_missing_init_call); 14489 FSI->ObjCWarnForNoInitDelegation = false; 14490 } 14491 14492 diagnoseImplicitlyRetainedSelf(*this); 14493 } else { 14494 // Parsing the function declaration failed in some way. Pop the fake scope 14495 // we pushed on. 14496 PopFunctionScopeInfo(ActivePolicy, dcl); 14497 return nullptr; 14498 } 14499 14500 if (Body && FSI->HasPotentialAvailabilityViolations) 14501 DiagnoseUnguardedAvailabilityViolations(dcl); 14502 14503 assert(!FSI->ObjCShouldCallSuper && 14504 "This should only be set for ObjC methods, which should have been " 14505 "handled in the block above."); 14506 14507 // Verify and clean out per-function state. 14508 if (Body && (!FD || !FD->isDefaulted())) { 14509 // C++ constructors that have function-try-blocks can't have return 14510 // statements in the handlers of that block. (C++ [except.handle]p14) 14511 // Verify this. 14512 if (FD && isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(FD) && isa<CXXTryStmt>(Body)) 14513 DiagnoseReturnInConstructorExceptionHandler(cast<CXXTryStmt>(Body)); 14514 14515 // Verify that gotos and switch cases don't jump into scopes illegally. 14516 if (FSI->NeedsScopeChecking() && 14517 !PP.isCodeCompletionEnabled()) 14518 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(Body); 14519 14520 if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(dcl)) { 14521 if (!Destructor->getParent()->isDependentType()) 14522 CheckDestructor(Destructor); 14523 14524 MarkBaseAndMemberDestructorsReferenced(Destructor->getLocation(), 14525 Destructor->getParent()); 14526 } 14527 14528 // If any errors have occurred, clear out any temporaries that may have 14529 // been leftover. This ensures that these temporaries won't be picked up for 14530 // deletion in some later function. 14531 if (hasUncompilableErrorOccurred() || 14532 getDiagnostics().getSuppressAllDiagnostics()) { 14533 DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext(); 14534 } 14535 if (!hasUncompilableErrorOccurred() && 14536 !isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) { 14537 // Since the body is valid, issue any analysis-based warnings that are 14538 // enabled. 14539 ActivePolicy = &WP; 14540 } 14541 14542 if (!IsInstantiation && FD && FD->isConstexpr() && !FD->isInvalidDecl() && 14543 !CheckConstexprFunctionDefinition(FD, CheckConstexprKind::Diagnose)) 14544 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 14545 14546 if (FD && FD->hasAttr<NakedAttr>()) { 14547 for (const Stmt *S : Body->children()) { 14548 // Allow local register variables without initializer as they don't 14549 // require prologue. 14550 bool RegisterVariables = false; 14551 if (auto *DS = dyn_cast<DeclStmt>(S)) { 14552 for (const auto *Decl : DS->decls()) { 14553 if (const auto *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Decl)) { 14554 RegisterVariables = 14555 Var->hasAttr<AsmLabelAttr>() && !Var->hasInit(); 14556 if (!RegisterVariables) 14557 break; 14558 } 14559 } 14560 } 14561 if (RegisterVariables) 14562 continue; 14563 if (!isa<AsmStmt>(S) && !isa<NullStmt>(S)) { 14564 Diag(S->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_non_asm_stmt_in_naked_function); 14565 Diag(FD->getAttr<NakedAttr>()->getLocation(), diag::note_attribute); 14566 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 14567 break; 14568 } 14569 } 14570 } 14571 14572 assert(ExprCleanupObjects.size() == 14573 ExprEvalContexts.back().NumCleanupObjects && 14574 "Leftover temporaries in function"); 14575 assert(!Cleanup.exprNeedsCleanups() && "Unaccounted cleanups in function"); 14576 assert(MaybeODRUseExprs.empty() && 14577 "Leftover expressions for odr-use checking"); 14578 } 14579 14580 if (!IsInstantiation) 14581 PopDeclContext(); 14582 14583 PopFunctionScopeInfo(ActivePolicy, dcl); 14584 // If any errors have occurred, clear out any temporaries that may have 14585 // been leftover. This ensures that these temporaries won't be picked up for 14586 // deletion in some later function. 14587 if (hasUncompilableErrorOccurred()) { 14588 DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext(); 14589 } 14590 14591 if (LangOpts.OpenMP || LangOpts.CUDA || LangOpts.SYCLIsDevice) { 14592 auto ES = getEmissionStatus(FD); 14593 if (ES == Sema::FunctionEmissionStatus::Emitted || 14594 ES == Sema::FunctionEmissionStatus::Unknown) 14595 DeclsToCheckForDeferredDiags.push_back(FD); 14596 } 14597 14598 return dcl; 14599 } 14600 14601 /// When we finish delayed parsing of an attribute, we must attach it to the 14602 /// relevant Decl. 14603 void Sema::ActOnFinishDelayedAttribute(Scope *S, Decl *D, 14604 ParsedAttributes &Attrs) { 14605 // Always attach attributes to the underlying decl. 14606 if (TemplateDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) 14607 D = TD->getTemplatedDecl(); 14608 ProcessDeclAttributeList(S, D, Attrs); 14609 14610 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) 14611 if (Method->isStatic()) 14612 checkThisInStaticMemberFunctionAttributes(Method); 14613 } 14614 14615 /// ImplicitlyDefineFunction - An undeclared identifier was used in a function 14616 /// call, forming a call to an implicitly defined function (per C99 6.5.1p2). 14617 NamedDecl *Sema::ImplicitlyDefineFunction(SourceLocation Loc, 14618 IdentifierInfo &II, Scope *S) { 14619 // Find the scope in which the identifier is injected and the corresponding 14620 // DeclContext. 14621 // FIXME: C89 does not say what happens if there is no enclosing block scope. 14622 // In that case, we inject the declaration into the translation unit scope 14623 // instead. 14624 Scope *BlockScope = S; 14625 while (!BlockScope->isCompoundStmtScope() && BlockScope->getParent()) 14626 BlockScope = BlockScope->getParent(); 14627 14628 Scope *ContextScope = BlockScope; 14629 while (!ContextScope->getEntity()) 14630 ContextScope = ContextScope->getParent(); 14631 ContextRAII SavedContext(*this, ContextScope->getEntity()); 14632 14633 // Before we produce a declaration for an implicitly defined 14634 // function, see whether there was a locally-scoped declaration of 14635 // this name as a function or variable. If so, use that 14636 // (non-visible) declaration, and complain about it. 14637 NamedDecl *ExternCPrev = findLocallyScopedExternCDecl(&II); 14638 if (ExternCPrev) { 14639 // We still need to inject the function into the enclosing block scope so 14640 // that later (non-call) uses can see it. 14641 PushOnScopeChains(ExternCPrev, BlockScope, /*AddToContext*/false); 14642 14643 // C89 footnote 38: 14644 // If in fact it is not defined as having type "function returning int", 14645 // the behavior is undefined. 14646 if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(ExternCPrev) || 14647 !Context.typesAreCompatible( 14648 cast<FunctionDecl>(ExternCPrev)->getType(), 14649 Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Context.IntTy))) { 14650 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_use_out_of_scope_declaration) 14651 << ExternCPrev << !getLangOpts().C99; 14652 Diag(ExternCPrev->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 14653 return ExternCPrev; 14654 } 14655 } 14656 14657 // Extension in C99. Legal in C90, but warn about it. 14658 unsigned diag_id; 14659 if (II.getName().startswith("__builtin_")) 14660 diag_id = diag::warn_builtin_unknown; 14661 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.9.u - Implicit function declaration is not supported. 14662 else if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) 14663 diag_id = diag::err_opencl_implicit_function_decl; 14664 else if (getLangOpts().C99) 14665 diag_id = diag::ext_implicit_function_decl; 14666 else 14667 diag_id = diag::warn_implicit_function_decl; 14668 Diag(Loc, diag_id) << &II; 14669 14670 // If we found a prior declaration of this function, don't bother building 14671 // another one. We've already pushed that one into scope, so there's nothing 14672 // more to do. 14673 if (ExternCPrev) 14674 return ExternCPrev; 14675 14676 // Because typo correction is expensive, only do it if the implicit 14677 // function declaration is going to be treated as an error. 14678 if (Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag_id, Loc) >= DiagnosticsEngine::Error) { 14679 TypoCorrection Corrected; 14680 DeclFilterCCC<FunctionDecl> CCC{}; 14681 if (S && (Corrected = 14682 CorrectTypo(DeclarationNameInfo(&II, Loc), LookupOrdinaryName, 14683 S, nullptr, CCC, CTK_NonError))) 14684 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(diag::note_function_suggestion), 14685 /*ErrorRecovery*/false); 14686 } 14687 14688 // Set a Declarator for the implicit definition: int foo(); 14689 const char *Dummy; 14690 AttributeFactory attrFactory; 14691 DeclSpec DS(attrFactory); 14692 unsigned DiagID; 14693 bool Error = DS.SetTypeSpecType(DeclSpec::TST_int, Loc, Dummy, DiagID, 14694 Context.getPrintingPolicy()); 14695 (void)Error; // Silence warning. 14696 assert(!Error && "Error setting up implicit decl!"); 14697 SourceLocation NoLoc; 14698 Declarator D(DS, DeclaratorContext::BlockContext); 14699 D.AddTypeInfo(DeclaratorChunk::getFunction(/*HasProto=*/false, 14700 /*IsAmbiguous=*/false, 14701 /*LParenLoc=*/NoLoc, 14702 /*Params=*/nullptr, 14703 /*NumParams=*/0, 14704 /*EllipsisLoc=*/NoLoc, 14705 /*RParenLoc=*/NoLoc, 14706 /*RefQualifierIsLvalueRef=*/true, 14707 /*RefQualifierLoc=*/NoLoc, 14708 /*MutableLoc=*/NoLoc, EST_None, 14709 /*ESpecRange=*/SourceRange(), 14710 /*Exceptions=*/nullptr, 14711 /*ExceptionRanges=*/nullptr, 14712 /*NumExceptions=*/0, 14713 /*NoexceptExpr=*/nullptr, 14714 /*ExceptionSpecTokens=*/nullptr, 14715 /*DeclsInPrototype=*/None, Loc, 14716 Loc, D), 14717 std::move(DS.getAttributes()), SourceLocation()); 14718 D.SetIdentifier(&II, Loc); 14719 14720 // Insert this function into the enclosing block scope. 14721 FunctionDecl *FD = cast<FunctionDecl>(ActOnDeclarator(BlockScope, D)); 14722 FD->setImplicit(); 14723 14724 AddKnownFunctionAttributes(FD); 14725 14726 return FD; 14727 } 14728 14729 /// If this function is a C++ replaceable global allocation function 14730 /// (C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation], C++2a [new.delete]), 14731 /// adds any function attributes that we know a priori based on the standard. 14732 /// 14733 /// We need to check for duplicate attributes both here and where user-written 14734 /// attributes are applied to declarations. 14735 void Sema::AddKnownFunctionAttributesForReplaceableGlobalAllocationFunction( 14736 FunctionDecl *FD) { 14737 if (FD->isInvalidDecl()) 14738 return; 14739 14740 if (FD->getDeclName().getCXXOverloadedOperator() != OO_New && 14741 FD->getDeclName().getCXXOverloadedOperator() != OO_Array_New) 14742 return; 14743 14744 Optional<unsigned> AlignmentParam; 14745 bool IsNothrow = false; 14746 if (!FD->isReplaceableGlobalAllocationFunction(&AlignmentParam, &IsNothrow)) 14747 return; 14748 14749 // C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation]p4: 14750 // An allocation function that has a non-throwing exception specification 14751 // indicates failure by returning a null pointer value. Any other allocation 14752 // function never returns a null pointer value and indicates failure only by 14753 // throwing an exception [...] 14754 if (!IsNothrow && !FD->hasAttr<ReturnsNonNullAttr>()) 14755 FD->addAttr(ReturnsNonNullAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 14756 14757 // C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation]p2: 14758 // An allocation function attempts to allocate the requested amount of 14759 // storage. [...] If the request succeeds, the value returned by a 14760 // replaceable allocation function is a [...] pointer value p0 different 14761 // from any previously returned value p1 [...] 14762 // 14763 // However, this particular information is being added in codegen, 14764 // because there is an opt-out switch for it (-fno-assume-sane-operator-new) 14765 14766 // C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation]p2: 14767 // An allocation function attempts to allocate the requested amount of 14768 // storage. If it is successful, it returns the address of the start of a 14769 // block of storage whose length in bytes is at least as large as the 14770 // requested size. 14771 if (!FD->hasAttr<AllocSizeAttr>()) { 14772 FD->addAttr(AllocSizeAttr::CreateImplicit( 14773 Context, /*ElemSizeParam=*/ParamIdx(1, FD), 14774 /*NumElemsParam=*/ParamIdx(), FD->getLocation())); 14775 } 14776 14777 // C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation]p3: 14778 // For an allocation function [...], the pointer returned on a successful 14779 // call shall represent the address of storage that is aligned as follows: 14780 // (3.1) If the allocation function takes an argument of type 14781 // std::align_val_t, the storage will have the alignment 14782 // specified by the value of this argument. 14783 if (AlignmentParam.hasValue() && !FD->hasAttr<AllocAlignAttr>()) { 14784 FD->addAttr(AllocAlignAttr::CreateImplicit( 14785 Context, ParamIdx(AlignmentParam.getValue(), FD), FD->getLocation())); 14786 } 14787 14788 // FIXME: 14789 // C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation]p3: 14790 // For an allocation function [...], the pointer returned on a successful 14791 // call shall represent the address of storage that is aligned as follows: 14792 // (3.2) Otherwise, if the allocation function is named operator new[], 14793 // the storage is aligned for any object that does not have 14794 // new-extended alignment ([basic.align]) and is no larger than the 14795 // requested size. 14796 // (3.3) Otherwise, the storage is aligned for any object that does not 14797 // have new-extended alignment and is of the requested size. 14798 } 14799 14800 /// Adds any function attributes that we know a priori based on 14801 /// the declaration of this function. 14802 /// 14803 /// These attributes can apply both to implicitly-declared builtins 14804 /// (like __builtin___printf_chk) or to library-declared functions 14805 /// like NSLog or printf. 14806 /// 14807 /// We need to check for duplicate attributes both here and where user-written 14808 /// attributes are applied to declarations. 14809 void Sema::AddKnownFunctionAttributes(FunctionDecl *FD) { 14810 if (FD->isInvalidDecl()) 14811 return; 14812 14813 // If this is a built-in function, map its builtin attributes to 14814 // actual attributes. 14815 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FD->getBuiltinID()) { 14816 // Handle printf-formatting attributes. 14817 unsigned FormatIdx; 14818 bool HasVAListArg; 14819 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isPrintfLike(BuiltinID, FormatIdx, HasVAListArg)) { 14820 if (!FD->hasAttr<FormatAttr>()) { 14821 const char *fmt = "printf"; 14822 unsigned int NumParams = FD->getNumParams(); 14823 if (FormatIdx < NumParams && // NumParams may be 0 (e.g. vfprintf) 14824 FD->getParamDecl(FormatIdx)->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) 14825 fmt = "NSString"; 14826 FD->addAttr(FormatAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, 14827 &Context.Idents.get(fmt), 14828 FormatIdx+1, 14829 HasVAListArg ? 0 : FormatIdx+2, 14830 FD->getLocation())); 14831 } 14832 } 14833 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isScanfLike(BuiltinID, FormatIdx, 14834 HasVAListArg)) { 14835 if (!FD->hasAttr<FormatAttr>()) 14836 FD->addAttr(FormatAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, 14837 &Context.Idents.get("scanf"), 14838 FormatIdx+1, 14839 HasVAListArg ? 0 : FormatIdx+2, 14840 FD->getLocation())); 14841 } 14842 14843 // Handle automatically recognized callbacks. 14844 SmallVector<int, 4> Encoding; 14845 if (!FD->hasAttr<CallbackAttr>() && 14846 Context.BuiltinInfo.performsCallback(BuiltinID, Encoding)) 14847 FD->addAttr(CallbackAttr::CreateImplicit( 14848 Context, Encoding.data(), Encoding.size(), FD->getLocation())); 14849 14850 // Mark const if we don't care about errno and that is the only thing 14851 // preventing the function from being const. This allows IRgen to use LLVM 14852 // intrinsics for such functions. 14853 if (!getLangOpts().MathErrno && !FD->hasAttr<ConstAttr>() && 14854 Context.BuiltinInfo.isConstWithoutErrno(BuiltinID)) 14855 FD->addAttr(ConstAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 14856 14857 // We make "fma" on some platforms const because we know it does not set 14858 // errno in those environments even though it could set errno based on the 14859 // C standard. 14860 const llvm::Triple &Trip = Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple(); 14861 if ((Trip.isGNUEnvironment() || Trip.isAndroid() || Trip.isOSMSVCRT()) && 14862 !FD->hasAttr<ConstAttr>()) { 14863 switch (BuiltinID) { 14864 case Builtin::BI__builtin_fma: 14865 case Builtin::BI__builtin_fmaf: 14866 case Builtin::BI__builtin_fmal: 14867 case Builtin::BIfma: 14868 case Builtin::BIfmaf: 14869 case Builtin::BIfmal: 14870 FD->addAttr(ConstAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 14871 break; 14872 default: 14873 break; 14874 } 14875 } 14876 14877 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isReturnsTwice(BuiltinID) && 14878 !FD->hasAttr<ReturnsTwiceAttr>()) 14879 FD->addAttr(ReturnsTwiceAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, 14880 FD->getLocation())); 14881 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isNoThrow(BuiltinID) && !FD->hasAttr<NoThrowAttr>()) 14882 FD->addAttr(NoThrowAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 14883 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isPure(BuiltinID) && !FD->hasAttr<PureAttr>()) 14884 FD->addAttr(PureAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 14885 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isConst(BuiltinID) && !FD->hasAttr<ConstAttr>()) 14886 FD->addAttr(ConstAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 14887 if (getLangOpts().CUDA && Context.BuiltinInfo.isTSBuiltin(BuiltinID) && 14888 !FD->hasAttr<CUDADeviceAttr>() && !FD->hasAttr<CUDAHostAttr>()) { 14889 // Add the appropriate attribute, depending on the CUDA compilation mode 14890 // and which target the builtin belongs to. For example, during host 14891 // compilation, aux builtins are __device__, while the rest are __host__. 14892 if (getLangOpts().CUDAIsDevice != 14893 Context.BuiltinInfo.isAuxBuiltinID(BuiltinID)) 14894 FD->addAttr(CUDADeviceAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 14895 else 14896 FD->addAttr(CUDAHostAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 14897 } 14898 } 14899 14900 AddKnownFunctionAttributesForReplaceableGlobalAllocationFunction(FD); 14901 14902 // If C++ exceptions are enabled but we are told extern "C" functions cannot 14903 // throw, add an implicit nothrow attribute to any extern "C" function we come 14904 // across. 14905 if (getLangOpts().CXXExceptions && getLangOpts().ExternCNoUnwind && 14906 FD->isExternC() && !FD->hasAttr<NoThrowAttr>()) { 14907 const auto *FPT = FD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 14908 if (!FPT || FPT->getExceptionSpecType() == EST_None) 14909 FD->addAttr(NoThrowAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 14910 } 14911 14912 IdentifierInfo *Name = FD->getIdentifier(); 14913 if (!Name) 14914 return; 14915 if ((!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 14916 FD->getDeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) || 14917 (isa<LinkageSpecDecl>(FD->getDeclContext()) && 14918 cast<LinkageSpecDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getLanguage() == 14919 LinkageSpecDecl::lang_c)) { 14920 // Okay: this could be a libc/libm/Objective-C function we know 14921 // about. 14922 } else 14923 return; 14924 14925 if (Name->isStr("asprintf") || Name->isStr("vasprintf")) { 14926 // FIXME: asprintf and vasprintf aren't C99 functions. Should they be 14927 // target-specific builtins, perhaps? 14928 if (!FD->hasAttr<FormatAttr>()) 14929 FD->addAttr(FormatAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, 14930 &Context.Idents.get("printf"), 2, 14931 Name->isStr("vasprintf") ? 0 : 3, 14932 FD->getLocation())); 14933 } 14934 14935 if (Name->isStr("__CFStringMakeConstantString")) { 14936 // We already have a __builtin___CFStringMakeConstantString, 14937 // but builds that use -fno-constant-cfstrings don't go through that. 14938 if (!FD->hasAttr<FormatArgAttr>()) 14939 FD->addAttr(FormatArgAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, ParamIdx(1, FD), 14940 FD->getLocation())); 14941 } 14942 } 14943 14944 TypedefDecl *Sema::ParseTypedefDecl(Scope *S, Declarator &D, QualType T, 14945 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) { 14946 assert(D.getIdentifier() && "Wrong callback for declspec without declarator"); 14947 assert(!T.isNull() && "GetTypeForDeclarator() returned null type"); 14948 14949 if (!TInfo) { 14950 assert(D.isInvalidType() && "no declarator info for valid type"); 14951 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T); 14952 } 14953 14954 // Scope manipulation handled by caller. 14955 TypedefDecl *NewTD = 14956 TypedefDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, D.getBeginLoc(), 14957 D.getIdentifierLoc(), D.getIdentifier(), TInfo); 14958 14959 // Bail out immediately if we have an invalid declaration. 14960 if (D.isInvalidType()) { 14961 NewTD->setInvalidDecl(); 14962 return NewTD; 14963 } 14964 14965 if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified()) { 14966 if (CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod()) 14967 Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_local) 14968 << 2 << NewTD 14969 << SourceRange(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()) 14970 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval( 14971 D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()); 14972 else 14973 NewTD->setModulePrivate(); 14974 } 14975 14976 // C++ [dcl.typedef]p8: 14977 // If the typedef declaration defines an unnamed class (or 14978 // enum), the first typedef-name declared by the declaration 14979 // to be that class type (or enum type) is used to denote the 14980 // class type (or enum type) for linkage purposes only. 14981 // We need to check whether the type was declared in the declaration. 14982 switch (D.getDeclSpec().getTypeSpecType()) { 14983 case TST_enum: 14984 case TST_struct: 14985 case TST_interface: 14986 case TST_union: 14987 case TST_class: { 14988 TagDecl *tagFromDeclSpec = cast<TagDecl>(D.getDeclSpec().getRepAsDecl()); 14989 setTagNameForLinkagePurposes(tagFromDeclSpec, NewTD); 14990 break; 14991 } 14992 14993 default: 14994 break; 14995 } 14996 14997 return NewTD; 14998 } 14999 15000 /// Check that this is a valid underlying type for an enum declaration. 15001 bool Sema::CheckEnumUnderlyingType(TypeSourceInfo *TI) { 15002 SourceLocation UnderlyingLoc = TI->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(); 15003 QualType T = TI->getType(); 15004 15005 if (T->isDependentType()) 15006 return false; 15007 15008 // This doesn't use 'isIntegralType' despite the error message mentioning 15009 // integral type because isIntegralType would also allow enum types in C. 15010 if (const BuiltinType *BT = T->getAs<BuiltinType>()) 15011 if (BT->isInteger()) 15012 return false; 15013 15014 if (T->isExtIntType()) 15015 return false; 15016 15017 return Diag(UnderlyingLoc, diag::err_enum_invalid_underlying) << T; 15018 } 15019 15020 /// Check whether this is a valid redeclaration of a previous enumeration. 15021 /// \return true if the redeclaration was invalid. 15022 bool Sema::CheckEnumRedeclaration(SourceLocation EnumLoc, bool IsScoped, 15023 QualType EnumUnderlyingTy, bool IsFixed, 15024 const EnumDecl *Prev) { 15025 if (IsScoped != Prev->isScoped()) { 15026 Diag(EnumLoc, diag::err_enum_redeclare_scoped_mismatch) 15027 << Prev->isScoped(); 15028 Diag(Prev->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 15029 return true; 15030 } 15031 15032 if (IsFixed && Prev->isFixed()) { 15033 if (!EnumUnderlyingTy->isDependentType() && 15034 !Prev->getIntegerType()->isDependentType() && 15035 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(EnumUnderlyingTy, 15036 Prev->getIntegerType())) { 15037 // TODO: Highlight the underlying type of the redeclaration. 15038 Diag(EnumLoc, diag::err_enum_redeclare_type_mismatch) 15039 << EnumUnderlyingTy << Prev->getIntegerType(); 15040 Diag(Prev->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration) 15041 << Prev->getIntegerTypeRange(); 15042 return true; 15043 } 15044 } else if (IsFixed != Prev->isFixed()) { 15045 Diag(EnumLoc, diag::err_enum_redeclare_fixed_mismatch) 15046 << Prev->isFixed(); 15047 Diag(Prev->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 15048 return true; 15049 } 15050 15051 return false; 15052 } 15053 15054 /// Get diagnostic %select index for tag kind for 15055 /// redeclaration diagnostic message. 15056 /// WARNING: Indexes apply to particular diagnostics only! 15057 /// 15058 /// \returns diagnostic %select index. 15059 static unsigned getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(TagTypeKind Tag) { 15060 switch (Tag) { 15061 case TTK_Struct: return 0; 15062 case TTK_Interface: return 1; 15063 case TTK_Class: return 2; 15064 default: llvm_unreachable("Invalid tag kind for redecl diagnostic!"); 15065 } 15066 } 15067 15068 /// Determine if tag kind is a class-key compatible with 15069 /// class for redeclaration (class, struct, or __interface). 15070 /// 15071 /// \returns true iff the tag kind is compatible. 15072 static bool isClassCompatTagKind(TagTypeKind Tag) 15073 { 15074 return Tag == TTK_Struct || Tag == TTK_Class || Tag == TTK_Interface; 15075 } 15076 15077 Sema::NonTagKind Sema::getNonTagTypeDeclKind(const Decl *PrevDecl, 15078 TagTypeKind TTK) { 15079 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(PrevDecl)) 15080 return NTK_Typedef; 15081 else if (isa<TypeAliasDecl>(PrevDecl)) 15082 return NTK_TypeAlias; 15083 else if (isa<ClassTemplateDecl>(PrevDecl)) 15084 return NTK_Template; 15085 else if (isa<TypeAliasTemplateDecl>(PrevDecl)) 15086 return NTK_TypeAliasTemplate; 15087 else if (isa<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(PrevDecl)) 15088 return NTK_TemplateTemplateArgument; 15089 switch (TTK) { 15090 case TTK_Struct: 15091 case TTK_Interface: 15092 case TTK_Class: 15093 return getLangOpts().CPlusPlus ? NTK_NonClass : NTK_NonStruct; 15094 case TTK_Union: 15095 return NTK_NonUnion; 15096 case TTK_Enum: 15097 return NTK_NonEnum; 15098 } 15099 llvm_unreachable("invalid TTK"); 15100 } 15101 15102 /// Determine whether a tag with a given kind is acceptable 15103 /// as a redeclaration of the given tag declaration. 15104 /// 15105 /// \returns true if the new tag kind is acceptable, false otherwise. 15106 bool Sema::isAcceptableTagRedeclaration(const TagDecl *Previous, 15107 TagTypeKind NewTag, bool isDefinition, 15108 SourceLocation NewTagLoc, 15109 const IdentifierInfo *Name) { 15110 // C++ [dcl.type.elab]p3: 15111 // The class-key or enum keyword present in the 15112 // elaborated-type-specifier shall agree in kind with the 15113 // declaration to which the name in the elaborated-type-specifier 15114 // refers. This rule also applies to the form of 15115 // elaborated-type-specifier that declares a class-name or 15116 // friend class since it can be construed as referring to the 15117 // definition of the class. Thus, in any 15118 // elaborated-type-specifier, the enum keyword shall be used to 15119 // refer to an enumeration (7.2), the union class-key shall be 15120 // used to refer to a union (clause 9), and either the class or 15121 // struct class-key shall be used to refer to a class (clause 9) 15122 // declared using the class or struct class-key. 15123 TagTypeKind OldTag = Previous->getTagKind(); 15124 if (OldTag != NewTag && 15125 !(isClassCompatTagKind(OldTag) && isClassCompatTagKind(NewTag))) 15126 return false; 15127 15128 // Tags are compatible, but we might still want to warn on mismatched tags. 15129 // Non-class tags can't be mismatched at this point. 15130 if (!isClassCompatTagKind(NewTag)) 15131 return true; 15132 15133 // Declarations for which -Wmismatched-tags is disabled are entirely ignored 15134 // by our warning analysis. We don't want to warn about mismatches with (eg) 15135 // declarations in system headers that are designed to be specialized, but if 15136 // a user asks us to warn, we should warn if their code contains mismatched 15137 // declarations. 15138 auto IsIgnoredLoc = [&](SourceLocation Loc) { 15139 return getDiagnostics().isIgnored(diag::warn_struct_class_tag_mismatch, 15140 Loc); 15141 }; 15142 if (IsIgnoredLoc(NewTagLoc)) 15143 return true; 15144 15145 auto IsIgnored = [&](const TagDecl *Tag) { 15146 return IsIgnoredLoc(Tag->getLocation()); 15147 }; 15148 while (IsIgnored(Previous)) { 15149 Previous = Previous->getPreviousDecl(); 15150 if (!Previous) 15151 return true; 15152 OldTag = Previous->getTagKind(); 15153 } 15154 15155 bool isTemplate = false; 15156 if (const CXXRecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Previous)) 15157 isTemplate = Record->getDescribedClassTemplate(); 15158 15159 if (inTemplateInstantiation()) { 15160 if (OldTag != NewTag) { 15161 // In a template instantiation, do not offer fix-its for tag mismatches 15162 // since they usually mess up the template instead of fixing the problem. 15163 Diag(NewTagLoc, diag::warn_struct_class_tag_mismatch) 15164 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(NewTag) << isTemplate << Name 15165 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(OldTag); 15166 // FIXME: Note previous location? 15167 } 15168 return true; 15169 } 15170 15171 if (isDefinition) { 15172 // On definitions, check all previous tags and issue a fix-it for each 15173 // one that doesn't match the current tag. 15174 if (Previous->getDefinition()) { 15175 // Don't suggest fix-its for redefinitions. 15176 return true; 15177 } 15178 15179 bool previousMismatch = false; 15180 for (const TagDecl *I : Previous->redecls()) { 15181 if (I->getTagKind() != NewTag) { 15182 // Ignore previous declarations for which the warning was disabled. 15183 if (IsIgnored(I)) 15184 continue; 15185 15186 if (!previousMismatch) { 15187 previousMismatch = true; 15188 Diag(NewTagLoc, diag::warn_struct_class_previous_tag_mismatch) 15189 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(NewTag) << isTemplate << Name 15190 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(I->getTagKind()); 15191 } 15192 Diag(I->getInnerLocStart(), diag::note_struct_class_suggestion) 15193 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(NewTag) 15194 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(I->getInnerLocStart(), 15195 TypeWithKeyword::getTagTypeKindName(NewTag)); 15196 } 15197 } 15198 return true; 15199 } 15200 15201 // Identify the prevailing tag kind: this is the kind of the definition (if 15202 // there is a non-ignored definition), or otherwise the kind of the prior 15203 // (non-ignored) declaration. 15204 const TagDecl *PrevDef = Previous->getDefinition(); 15205 if (PrevDef && IsIgnored(PrevDef)) 15206 PrevDef = nullptr; 15207 const TagDecl *Redecl = PrevDef ? PrevDef : Previous; 15208 if (Redecl->getTagKind() != NewTag) { 15209 Diag(NewTagLoc, diag::warn_struct_class_tag_mismatch) 15210 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(NewTag) << isTemplate << Name 15211 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(OldTag); 15212 Diag(Redecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_use); 15213 15214 // If there is a previous definition, suggest a fix-it. 15215 if (PrevDef) { 15216 Diag(NewTagLoc, diag::note_struct_class_suggestion) 15217 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(Redecl->getTagKind()) 15218 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(NewTagLoc), 15219 TypeWithKeyword::getTagTypeKindName(Redecl->getTagKind())); 15220 } 15221 } 15222 15223 return true; 15224 } 15225 15226 /// Add a minimal nested name specifier fixit hint to allow lookup of a tag name 15227 /// from an outer enclosing namespace or file scope inside a friend declaration. 15228 /// This should provide the commented out code in the following snippet: 15229 /// namespace N { 15230 /// struct X; 15231 /// namespace M { 15232 /// struct Y { friend struct /*N::*/ X; }; 15233 /// } 15234 /// } 15235 static FixItHint createFriendTagNNSFixIt(Sema &SemaRef, NamedDecl *ND, Scope *S, 15236 SourceLocation NameLoc) { 15237 // While the decl is in a namespace, do repeated lookup of that name and see 15238 // if we get the same namespace back. If we do not, continue until 15239 // translation unit scope, at which point we have a fully qualified NNS. 15240 SmallVector<IdentifierInfo *, 4> Namespaces; 15241 DeclContext *DC = ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 15242 for (; !DC->isTranslationUnit(); DC = DC->getParent()) { 15243 // This tag should be declared in a namespace, which can only be enclosed by 15244 // other namespaces. Bail if there's an anonymous namespace in the chain. 15245 NamespaceDecl *Namespace = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(DC); 15246 if (!Namespace || Namespace->isAnonymousNamespace()) 15247 return FixItHint(); 15248 IdentifierInfo *II = Namespace->getIdentifier(); 15249 Namespaces.push_back(II); 15250 NamedDecl *Lookup = SemaRef.LookupSingleName( 15251 S, II, NameLoc, Sema::LookupNestedNameSpecifierName); 15252 if (Lookup == Namespace) 15253 break; 15254 } 15255 15256 // Once we have all the namespaces, reverse them to go outermost first, and 15257 // build an NNS. 15258 SmallString<64> Insertion; 15259 llvm::raw_svector_ostream OS(Insertion); 15260 if (DC->isTranslationUnit()) 15261 OS << "::"; 15262 std::reverse(Namespaces.begin(), Namespaces.end()); 15263 for (auto *II : Namespaces) 15264 OS << II->getName() << "::"; 15265 return FixItHint::CreateInsertion(NameLoc, Insertion); 15266 } 15267 15268 /// Determine whether a tag originally declared in context \p OldDC can 15269 /// be redeclared with an unqualified name in \p NewDC (assuming name lookup 15270 /// found a declaration in \p OldDC as a previous decl, perhaps through a 15271 /// using-declaration). 15272 static bool isAcceptableTagRedeclContext(Sema &S, DeclContext *OldDC, 15273 DeclContext *NewDC) { 15274 OldDC = OldDC->getRedeclContext(); 15275 NewDC = NewDC->getRedeclContext(); 15276 15277 if (OldDC->Equals(NewDC)) 15278 return true; 15279 15280 // In MSVC mode, we allow a redeclaration if the contexts are related (either 15281 // encloses the other). 15282 if (S.getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && 15283 (OldDC->Encloses(NewDC) || NewDC->Encloses(OldDC))) 15284 return true; 15285 15286 return false; 15287 } 15288 15289 /// This is invoked when we see 'struct foo' or 'struct {'. In the 15290 /// former case, Name will be non-null. In the later case, Name will be null. 15291 /// TagSpec indicates what kind of tag this is. TUK indicates whether this is a 15292 /// reference/declaration/definition of a tag. 15293 /// 15294 /// \param IsTypeSpecifier \c true if this is a type-specifier (or 15295 /// trailing-type-specifier) other than one in an alias-declaration. 15296 /// 15297 /// \param SkipBody If non-null, will be set to indicate if the caller should 15298 /// skip the definition of this tag and treat it as if it were a declaration. 15299 Decl *Sema::ActOnTag(Scope *S, unsigned TagSpec, TagUseKind TUK, 15300 SourceLocation KWLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS, 15301 IdentifierInfo *Name, SourceLocation NameLoc, 15302 const ParsedAttributesView &Attrs, AccessSpecifier AS, 15303 SourceLocation ModulePrivateLoc, 15304 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParameterLists, 15305 bool &OwnedDecl, bool &IsDependent, 15306 SourceLocation ScopedEnumKWLoc, 15307 bool ScopedEnumUsesClassTag, TypeResult UnderlyingType, 15308 bool IsTypeSpecifier, bool IsTemplateParamOrArg, 15309 SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody) { 15310 // If this is not a definition, it must have a name. 15311 IdentifierInfo *OrigName = Name; 15312 assert((Name != nullptr || TUK == TUK_Definition) && 15313 "Nameless record must be a definition!"); 15314 assert(TemplateParameterLists.size() == 0 || TUK != TUK_Reference); 15315 15316 OwnedDecl = false; 15317 TagTypeKind Kind = TypeWithKeyword::getTagTypeKindForTypeSpec(TagSpec); 15318 bool ScopedEnum = ScopedEnumKWLoc.isValid(); 15319 15320 // FIXME: Check member specializations more carefully. 15321 bool isMemberSpecialization = false; 15322 bool Invalid = false; 15323 15324 // We only need to do this matching if we have template parameters 15325 // or a scope specifier, which also conveniently avoids this work 15326 // for non-C++ cases. 15327 if (TemplateParameterLists.size() > 0 || 15328 (SS.isNotEmpty() && TUK != TUK_Reference)) { 15329 if (TemplateParameterList *TemplateParams = 15330 MatchTemplateParametersToScopeSpecifier( 15331 KWLoc, NameLoc, SS, nullptr, TemplateParameterLists, 15332 TUK == TUK_Friend, isMemberSpecialization, Invalid)) { 15333 if (Kind == TTK_Enum) { 15334 Diag(KWLoc, diag::err_enum_template); 15335 return nullptr; 15336 } 15337 15338 if (TemplateParams->size() > 0) { 15339 // This is a declaration or definition of a class template (which may 15340 // be a member of another template). 15341 15342 if (Invalid) 15343 return nullptr; 15344 15345 OwnedDecl = false; 15346 DeclResult Result = CheckClassTemplate( 15347 S, TagSpec, TUK, KWLoc, SS, Name, NameLoc, Attrs, TemplateParams, 15348 AS, ModulePrivateLoc, 15349 /*FriendLoc*/ SourceLocation(), TemplateParameterLists.size() - 1, 15350 TemplateParameterLists.data(), SkipBody); 15351 return Result.get(); 15352 } else { 15353 // The "template<>" header is extraneous. 15354 Diag(TemplateParams->getTemplateLoc(), diag::err_template_tag_noparams) 15355 << TypeWithKeyword::getTagTypeKindName(Kind) << Name; 15356 isMemberSpecialization = true; 15357 } 15358 } 15359 15360 if (!TemplateParameterLists.empty() && isMemberSpecialization && 15361 CheckTemplateDeclScope(S, TemplateParameterLists.back())) 15362 return nullptr; 15363 } 15364 15365 // Figure out the underlying type if this a enum declaration. We need to do 15366 // this early, because it's needed to detect if this is an incompatible 15367 // redeclaration. 15368 llvm::PointerUnion<const Type*, TypeSourceInfo*> EnumUnderlying; 15369 bool IsFixed = !UnderlyingType.isUnset() || ScopedEnum; 15370 15371 if (Kind == TTK_Enum) { 15372 if (UnderlyingType.isInvalid() || (!UnderlyingType.get() && ScopedEnum)) { 15373 // No underlying type explicitly specified, or we failed to parse the 15374 // type, default to int. 15375 EnumUnderlying = Context.IntTy.getTypePtr(); 15376 } else if (UnderlyingType.get()) { 15377 // C++0x 7.2p2: The type-specifier-seq of an enum-base shall name an 15378 // integral type; any cv-qualification is ignored. 15379 TypeSourceInfo *TI = nullptr; 15380 GetTypeFromParser(UnderlyingType.get(), &TI); 15381 EnumUnderlying = TI; 15382 15383 if (CheckEnumUnderlyingType(TI)) 15384 // Recover by falling back to int. 15385 EnumUnderlying = Context.IntTy.getTypePtr(); 15386 15387 if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(TI->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), TI, 15388 UPPC_FixedUnderlyingType)) 15389 EnumUnderlying = Context.IntTy.getTypePtr(); 15390 15391 } else if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isWindowsMSVCEnvironment()) { 15392 // For MSVC ABI compatibility, unfixed enums must use an underlying type 15393 // of 'int'. However, if this is an unfixed forward declaration, don't set 15394 // the underlying type unless the user enables -fms-compatibility. This 15395 // makes unfixed forward declared enums incomplete and is more conforming. 15396 if (TUK == TUK_Definition || getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) 15397 EnumUnderlying = Context.IntTy.getTypePtr(); 15398 } 15399 } 15400 15401 DeclContext *SearchDC = CurContext; 15402 DeclContext *DC = CurContext; 15403 bool isStdBadAlloc = false; 15404 bool isStdAlignValT = false; 15405 15406 RedeclarationKind Redecl = forRedeclarationInCurContext(); 15407 if (TUK == TUK_Friend || TUK == TUK_Reference) 15408 Redecl = NotForRedeclaration; 15409 15410 /// Create a new tag decl in C/ObjC. Since the ODR-like semantics for ObjC/C 15411 /// implemented asks for structural equivalence checking, the returned decl 15412 /// here is passed back to the parser, allowing the tag body to be parsed. 15413 auto createTagFromNewDecl = [&]() -> TagDecl * { 15414 assert(!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "not meant for C++ usage"); 15415 // If there is an identifier, use the location of the identifier as the 15416 // location of the decl, otherwise use the location of the struct/union 15417 // keyword. 15418 SourceLocation Loc = NameLoc.isValid() ? NameLoc : KWLoc; 15419 TagDecl *New = nullptr; 15420 15421 if (Kind == TTK_Enum) { 15422 New = EnumDecl::Create(Context, SearchDC, KWLoc, Loc, Name, nullptr, 15423 ScopedEnum, ScopedEnumUsesClassTag, IsFixed); 15424 // If this is an undefined enum, bail. 15425 if (TUK != TUK_Definition && !Invalid) 15426 return nullptr; 15427 if (EnumUnderlying) { 15428 EnumDecl *ED = cast<EnumDecl>(New); 15429 if (TypeSourceInfo *TI = EnumUnderlying.dyn_cast<TypeSourceInfo *>()) 15430 ED->setIntegerTypeSourceInfo(TI); 15431 else 15432 ED->setIntegerType(QualType(EnumUnderlying.get<const Type *>(), 0)); 15433 ED->setPromotionType(ED->getIntegerType()); 15434 } 15435 } else { // struct/union 15436 New = RecordDecl::Create(Context, Kind, SearchDC, KWLoc, Loc, Name, 15437 nullptr); 15438 } 15439 15440 if (RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(New)) { 15441 // Add alignment attributes if necessary; these attributes are checked 15442 // when the ASTContext lays out the structure. 15443 // 15444 // It is important for implementing the correct semantics that this 15445 // happen here (in ActOnTag). The #pragma pack stack is 15446 // maintained as a result of parser callbacks which can occur at 15447 // many points during the parsing of a struct declaration (because 15448 // the #pragma tokens are effectively skipped over during the 15449 // parsing of the struct). 15450 if (TUK == TUK_Definition && (!SkipBody || !SkipBody->ShouldSkip)) { 15451 AddAlignmentAttributesForRecord(RD); 15452 AddMsStructLayoutForRecord(RD); 15453 } 15454 } 15455 New->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext); 15456 return New; 15457 }; 15458 15459 LookupResult Previous(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupTagName, Redecl); 15460 if (Name && SS.isNotEmpty()) { 15461 // We have a nested-name tag ('struct foo::bar'). 15462 15463 // Check for invalid 'foo::'. 15464 if (SS.isInvalid()) { 15465 Name = nullptr; 15466 goto CreateNewDecl; 15467 } 15468 15469 // If this is a friend or a reference to a class in a dependent 15470 // context, don't try to make a decl for it. 15471 if (TUK == TUK_Friend || TUK == TUK_Reference) { 15472 DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false); 15473 if (!DC) { 15474 IsDependent = true; 15475 return nullptr; 15476 } 15477 } else { 15478 DC = computeDeclContext(SS, true); 15479 if (!DC) { 15480 Diag(SS.getRange().getBegin(), diag::err_dependent_nested_name_spec) 15481 << SS.getRange(); 15482 return nullptr; 15483 } 15484 } 15485 15486 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) 15487 return nullptr; 15488 15489 SearchDC = DC; 15490 // Look-up name inside 'foo::'. 15491 LookupQualifiedName(Previous, DC); 15492 15493 if (Previous.isAmbiguous()) 15494 return nullptr; 15495 15496 if (Previous.empty()) { 15497 // Name lookup did not find anything. However, if the 15498 // nested-name-specifier refers to the current instantiation, 15499 // and that current instantiation has any dependent base 15500 // classes, we might find something at instantiation time: treat 15501 // this as a dependent elaborated-type-specifier. 15502 // But this only makes any sense for reference-like lookups. 15503 if (Previous.wasNotFoundInCurrentInstantiation() && 15504 (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend)) { 15505 IsDependent = true; 15506 return nullptr; 15507 } 15508 15509 // A tag 'foo::bar' must already exist. 15510 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_not_tag_in_scope) 15511 << Kind << Name << DC << SS.getRange(); 15512 Name = nullptr; 15513 Invalid = true; 15514 goto CreateNewDecl; 15515 } 15516 } else if (Name) { 15517 // C++14 [class.mem]p14: 15518 // If T is the name of a class, then each of the following shall have a 15519 // name different from T: 15520 // -- every member of class T that is itself a type 15521 if (TUK != TUK_Reference && TUK != TUK_Friend && 15522 DiagnoseClassNameShadow(SearchDC, DeclarationNameInfo(Name, NameLoc))) 15523 return nullptr; 15524 15525 // If this is a named struct, check to see if there was a previous forward 15526 // declaration or definition. 15527 // FIXME: We're looking into outer scopes here, even when we 15528 // shouldn't be. Doing so can result in ambiguities that we 15529 // shouldn't be diagnosing. 15530 LookupName(Previous, S); 15531 15532 // When declaring or defining a tag, ignore ambiguities introduced 15533 // by types using'ed into this scope. 15534 if (Previous.isAmbiguous() && 15535 (TUK == TUK_Definition || TUK == TUK_Declaration)) { 15536 LookupResult::Filter F = Previous.makeFilter(); 15537 while (F.hasNext()) { 15538 NamedDecl *ND = F.next(); 15539 if (!ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->Equals( 15540 SearchDC->getRedeclContext())) 15541 F.erase(); 15542 } 15543 F.done(); 15544 } 15545 15546 // C++11 [namespace.memdef]p3: 15547 // If the name in a friend declaration is neither qualified nor 15548 // a template-id and the declaration is a function or an 15549 // elaborated-type-specifier, the lookup to determine whether 15550 // the entity has been previously declared shall not consider 15551 // any scopes outside the innermost enclosing namespace. 15552 // 15553 // MSVC doesn't implement the above rule for types, so a friend tag 15554 // declaration may be a redeclaration of a type declared in an enclosing 15555 // scope. They do implement this rule for friend functions. 15556 // 15557 // Does it matter that this should be by scope instead of by 15558 // semantic context? 15559 if (!Previous.empty() && TUK == TUK_Friend) { 15560 DeclContext *EnclosingNS = SearchDC->getEnclosingNamespaceContext(); 15561 LookupResult::Filter F = Previous.makeFilter(); 15562 bool FriendSawTagOutsideEnclosingNamespace = false; 15563 while (F.hasNext()) { 15564 NamedDecl *ND = F.next(); 15565 DeclContext *DC = ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 15566 if (DC->isFileContext() && 15567 !EnclosingNS->Encloses(ND->getDeclContext())) { 15568 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) 15569 FriendSawTagOutsideEnclosingNamespace = true; 15570 else 15571 F.erase(); 15572 } 15573 } 15574 F.done(); 15575 15576 // Diagnose this MSVC extension in the easy case where lookup would have 15577 // unambiguously found something outside the enclosing namespace. 15578 if (Previous.isSingleResult() && FriendSawTagOutsideEnclosingNamespace) { 15579 NamedDecl *ND = Previous.getFoundDecl(); 15580 Diag(NameLoc, diag::ext_friend_tag_redecl_outside_namespace) 15581 << createFriendTagNNSFixIt(*this, ND, S, NameLoc); 15582 } 15583 } 15584 15585 // Note: there used to be some attempt at recovery here. 15586 if (Previous.isAmbiguous()) 15587 return nullptr; 15588 15589 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && TUK != TUK_Reference) { 15590 // FIXME: This makes sure that we ignore the contexts associated 15591 // with C structs, unions, and enums when looking for a matching 15592 // tag declaration or definition. See the similar lookup tweak 15593 // in Sema::LookupName; is there a better way to deal with this? 15594 while (isa<RecordDecl>(SearchDC) || isa<EnumDecl>(SearchDC)) 15595 SearchDC = SearchDC->getParent(); 15596 } 15597 } 15598 15599 if (Previous.isSingleResult() && 15600 Previous.getFoundDecl()->isTemplateParameter()) { 15601 // Maybe we will complain about the shadowed template parameter. 15602 DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow(NameLoc, Previous.getFoundDecl()); 15603 // Just pretend that we didn't see the previous declaration. 15604 Previous.clear(); 15605 } 15606 15607 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Name && DC && StdNamespace && 15608 DC->Equals(getStdNamespace())) { 15609 if (Name->isStr("bad_alloc")) { 15610 // This is a declaration of or a reference to "std::bad_alloc". 15611 isStdBadAlloc = true; 15612 15613 // If std::bad_alloc has been implicitly declared (but made invisible to 15614 // name lookup), fill in this implicit declaration as the previous 15615 // declaration, so that the declarations get chained appropriately. 15616 if (Previous.empty() && StdBadAlloc) 15617 Previous.addDecl(getStdBadAlloc()); 15618 } else if (Name->isStr("align_val_t")) { 15619 isStdAlignValT = true; 15620 if (Previous.empty() && StdAlignValT) 15621 Previous.addDecl(getStdAlignValT()); 15622 } 15623 } 15624 15625 // If we didn't find a previous declaration, and this is a reference 15626 // (or friend reference), move to the correct scope. In C++, we 15627 // also need to do a redeclaration lookup there, just in case 15628 // there's a shadow friend decl. 15629 if (Name && Previous.empty() && 15630 (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend || IsTemplateParamOrArg)) { 15631 if (Invalid) goto CreateNewDecl; 15632 assert(SS.isEmpty()); 15633 15634 if (TUK == TUK_Reference || IsTemplateParamOrArg) { 15635 // C++ [basic.scope.pdecl]p5: 15636 // -- for an elaborated-type-specifier of the form 15637 // 15638 // class-key identifier 15639 // 15640 // if the elaborated-type-specifier is used in the 15641 // decl-specifier-seq or parameter-declaration-clause of a 15642 // function defined in namespace scope, the identifier is 15643 // declared as a class-name in the namespace that contains 15644 // the declaration; otherwise, except as a friend 15645 // declaration, the identifier is declared in the smallest 15646 // non-class, non-function-prototype scope that contains the 15647 // declaration. 15648 // 15649 // C99 6.7.2.3p8 has a similar (but not identical!) provision for 15650 // C structs and unions. 15651 // 15652 // It is an error in C++ to declare (rather than define) an enum 15653 // type, including via an elaborated type specifier. We'll 15654 // diagnose that later; for now, declare the enum in the same 15655 // scope as we would have picked for any other tag type. 15656 // 15657 // GNU C also supports this behavior as part of its incomplete 15658 // enum types extension, while GNU C++ does not. 15659 // 15660 // Find the context where we'll be declaring the tag. 15661 // FIXME: We would like to maintain the current DeclContext as the 15662 // lexical context, 15663 SearchDC = getTagInjectionContext(SearchDC); 15664 15665 // Find the scope where we'll be declaring the tag. 15666 S = getTagInjectionScope(S, getLangOpts()); 15667 } else { 15668 assert(TUK == TUK_Friend); 15669 // C++ [namespace.memdef]p3: 15670 // If a friend declaration in a non-local class first declares a 15671 // class or function, the friend class or function is a member of 15672 // the innermost enclosing namespace. 15673 SearchDC = SearchDC->getEnclosingNamespaceContext(); 15674 } 15675 15676 // In C++, we need to do a redeclaration lookup to properly 15677 // diagnose some problems. 15678 // FIXME: redeclaration lookup is also used (with and without C++) to find a 15679 // hidden declaration so that we don't get ambiguity errors when using a 15680 // type declared by an elaborated-type-specifier. In C that is not correct 15681 // and we should instead merge compatible types found by lookup. 15682 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 15683 // FIXME: This can perform qualified lookups into function contexts, 15684 // which are meaningless. 15685 Previous.setRedeclarationKind(forRedeclarationInCurContext()); 15686 LookupQualifiedName(Previous, SearchDC); 15687 } else { 15688 Previous.setRedeclarationKind(forRedeclarationInCurContext()); 15689 LookupName(Previous, S); 15690 } 15691 } 15692 15693 // If we have a known previous declaration to use, then use it. 15694 if (Previous.empty() && SkipBody && SkipBody->Previous) 15695 Previous.addDecl(SkipBody->Previous); 15696 15697 if (!Previous.empty()) { 15698 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = Previous.getFoundDecl(); 15699 NamedDecl *DirectPrevDecl = Previous.getRepresentativeDecl(); 15700 15701 // It's okay to have a tag decl in the same scope as a typedef 15702 // which hides a tag decl in the same scope. Finding this 15703 // insanity with a redeclaration lookup can only actually happen 15704 // in C++. 15705 // 15706 // This is also okay for elaborated-type-specifiers, which is 15707 // technically forbidden by the current standard but which is 15708 // okay according to the likely resolution of an open issue; 15709 // see http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/cwg_active.html#407 15710 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 15711 if (TypedefNameDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(PrevDecl)) { 15712 if (const TagType *TT = TD->getUnderlyingType()->getAs<TagType>()) { 15713 TagDecl *Tag = TT->getDecl(); 15714 if (Tag->getDeclName() == Name && 15715 Tag->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext() 15716 ->Equals(TD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext())) { 15717 PrevDecl = Tag; 15718 Previous.clear(); 15719 Previous.addDecl(Tag); 15720 Previous.resolveKind(); 15721 } 15722 } 15723 } 15724 } 15725 15726 // If this is a redeclaration of a using shadow declaration, it must 15727 // declare a tag in the same context. In MSVC mode, we allow a 15728 // redefinition if either context is within the other. 15729 if (auto *Shadow = dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(DirectPrevDecl)) { 15730 auto *OldTag = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(PrevDecl); 15731 if (SS.isEmpty() && TUK != TUK_Reference && TUK != TUK_Friend && 15732 isDeclInScope(Shadow, SearchDC, S, isMemberSpecialization) && 15733 !(OldTag && isAcceptableTagRedeclContext( 15734 *this, OldTag->getDeclContext(), SearchDC))) { 15735 Diag(KWLoc, diag::err_using_decl_conflict_reverse); 15736 Diag(Shadow->getTargetDecl()->getLocation(), 15737 diag::note_using_decl_target); 15738 Diag(Shadow->getUsingDecl()->getLocation(), diag::note_using_decl) 15739 << 0; 15740 // Recover by ignoring the old declaration. 15741 Previous.clear(); 15742 goto CreateNewDecl; 15743 } 15744 } 15745 15746 if (TagDecl *PrevTagDecl = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(PrevDecl)) { 15747 // If this is a use of a previous tag, or if the tag is already declared 15748 // in the same scope (so that the definition/declaration completes or 15749 // rementions the tag), reuse the decl. 15750 if (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend || 15751 isDeclInScope(DirectPrevDecl, SearchDC, S, 15752 SS.isNotEmpty() || isMemberSpecialization)) { 15753 // Make sure that this wasn't declared as an enum and now used as a 15754 // struct or something similar. 15755 if (!isAcceptableTagRedeclaration(PrevTagDecl, Kind, 15756 TUK == TUK_Definition, KWLoc, 15757 Name)) { 15758 bool SafeToContinue 15759 = (PrevTagDecl->getTagKind() != TTK_Enum && 15760 Kind != TTK_Enum); 15761 if (SafeToContinue) 15762 Diag(KWLoc, diag::err_use_with_wrong_tag) 15763 << Name 15764 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(KWLoc), 15765 PrevTagDecl->getKindName()); 15766 else 15767 Diag(KWLoc, diag::err_use_with_wrong_tag) << Name; 15768 Diag(PrevTagDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_use); 15769 15770 if (SafeToContinue) 15771 Kind = PrevTagDecl->getTagKind(); 15772 else { 15773 // Recover by making this an anonymous redefinition. 15774 Name = nullptr; 15775 Previous.clear(); 15776 Invalid = true; 15777 } 15778 } 15779 15780 if (Kind == TTK_Enum && PrevTagDecl->getTagKind() == TTK_Enum) { 15781 const EnumDecl *PrevEnum = cast<EnumDecl>(PrevTagDecl); 15782 if (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend) 15783 return PrevTagDecl; 15784 15785 QualType EnumUnderlyingTy; 15786 if (TypeSourceInfo *TI = EnumUnderlying.dyn_cast<TypeSourceInfo*>()) 15787 EnumUnderlyingTy = TI->getType().getUnqualifiedType(); 15788 else if (const Type *T = EnumUnderlying.dyn_cast<const Type*>()) 15789 EnumUnderlyingTy = QualType(T, 0); 15790 15791 // All conflicts with previous declarations are recovered by 15792 // returning the previous declaration, unless this is a definition, 15793 // in which case we want the caller to bail out. 15794 if (CheckEnumRedeclaration(NameLoc.isValid() ? NameLoc : KWLoc, 15795 ScopedEnum, EnumUnderlyingTy, 15796 IsFixed, PrevEnum)) 15797 return TUK == TUK_Declaration ? PrevTagDecl : nullptr; 15798 } 15799 15800 // C++11 [class.mem]p1: 15801 // A member shall not be declared twice in the member-specification, 15802 // except that a nested class or member class template can be declared 15803 // and then later defined. 15804 if (TUK == TUK_Declaration && PrevDecl->isCXXClassMember() && 15805 S->isDeclScope(PrevDecl)) { 15806 Diag(NameLoc, diag::ext_member_redeclared); 15807 Diag(PrevTagDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 15808 } 15809 15810 if (!Invalid) { 15811 // If this is a use, just return the declaration we found, unless 15812 // we have attributes. 15813 if (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend) { 15814 if (!Attrs.empty()) { 15815 // FIXME: Diagnose these attributes. For now, we create a new 15816 // declaration to hold them. 15817 } else if (TUK == TUK_Reference && 15818 (PrevTagDecl->getFriendObjectKind() == 15819 Decl::FOK_Undeclared || 15820 PrevDecl->getOwningModule() != getCurrentModule()) && 15821 SS.isEmpty()) { 15822 // This declaration is a reference to an existing entity, but 15823 // has different visibility from that entity: it either makes 15824 // a friend visible or it makes a type visible in a new module. 15825 // In either case, create a new declaration. We only do this if 15826 // the declaration would have meant the same thing if no prior 15827 // declaration were found, that is, if it was found in the same 15828 // scope where we would have injected a declaration. 15829 if (!getTagInjectionContext(CurContext)->getRedeclContext() 15830 ->Equals(PrevDecl->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext())) 15831 return PrevTagDecl; 15832 // This is in the injected scope, create a new declaration in 15833 // that scope. 15834 S = getTagInjectionScope(S, getLangOpts()); 15835 } else { 15836 return PrevTagDecl; 15837 } 15838 } 15839 15840 // Diagnose attempts to redefine a tag. 15841 if (TUK == TUK_Definition) { 15842 if (NamedDecl *Def = PrevTagDecl->getDefinition()) { 15843 // If we're defining a specialization and the previous definition 15844 // is from an implicit instantiation, don't emit an error 15845 // here; we'll catch this in the general case below. 15846 bool IsExplicitSpecializationAfterInstantiation = false; 15847 if (isMemberSpecialization) { 15848 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Def)) 15849 IsExplicitSpecializationAfterInstantiation = 15850 RD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() != 15851 TSK_ExplicitSpecialization; 15852 else if (EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(Def)) 15853 IsExplicitSpecializationAfterInstantiation = 15854 ED->getTemplateSpecializationKind() != 15855 TSK_ExplicitSpecialization; 15856 } 15857 15858 // Note that clang allows ODR-like semantics for ObjC/C, i.e., do 15859 // not keep more that one definition around (merge them). However, 15860 // ensure the decl passes the structural compatibility check in 15861 // C11 6.2.7/1 (or 6.1.2.6/1 in C89). 15862 NamedDecl *Hidden = nullptr; 15863 if (SkipBody && !hasVisibleDefinition(Def, &Hidden)) { 15864 // There is a definition of this tag, but it is not visible. We 15865 // explicitly make use of C++'s one definition rule here, and 15866 // assume that this definition is identical to the hidden one 15867 // we already have. Make the existing definition visible and 15868 // use it in place of this one. 15869 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 15870 // Postpone making the old definition visible until after we 15871 // complete parsing the new one and do the structural 15872 // comparison. 15873 SkipBody->CheckSameAsPrevious = true; 15874 SkipBody->New = createTagFromNewDecl(); 15875 SkipBody->Previous = Def; 15876 return Def; 15877 } else { 15878 SkipBody->ShouldSkip = true; 15879 SkipBody->Previous = Def; 15880 makeMergedDefinitionVisible(Hidden); 15881 // Carry on and handle it like a normal definition. We'll 15882 // skip starting the definitiion later. 15883 } 15884 } else if (!IsExplicitSpecializationAfterInstantiation) { 15885 // A redeclaration in function prototype scope in C isn't 15886 // visible elsewhere, so merely issue a warning. 15887 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && S->containedInPrototypeScope()) 15888 Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_redefinition_in_param_list) << Name; 15889 else 15890 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_redefinition) << Name; 15891 notePreviousDefinition(Def, 15892 NameLoc.isValid() ? NameLoc : KWLoc); 15893 // If this is a redefinition, recover by making this 15894 // struct be anonymous, which will make any later 15895 // references get the previous definition. 15896 Name = nullptr; 15897 Previous.clear(); 15898 Invalid = true; 15899 } 15900 } else { 15901 // If the type is currently being defined, complain 15902 // about a nested redefinition. 15903 auto *TD = Context.getTagDeclType(PrevTagDecl)->getAsTagDecl(); 15904 if (TD->isBeingDefined()) { 15905 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_nested_redefinition) << Name; 15906 Diag(PrevTagDecl->getLocation(), 15907 diag::note_previous_definition); 15908 Name = nullptr; 15909 Previous.clear(); 15910 Invalid = true; 15911 } 15912 } 15913 15914 // Okay, this is definition of a previously declared or referenced 15915 // tag. We're going to create a new Decl for it. 15916 } 15917 15918 // Okay, we're going to make a redeclaration. If this is some kind 15919 // of reference, make sure we build the redeclaration in the same DC 15920 // as the original, and ignore the current access specifier. 15921 if (TUK == TUK_Friend || TUK == TUK_Reference) { 15922 SearchDC = PrevTagDecl->getDeclContext(); 15923 AS = AS_none; 15924 } 15925 } 15926 // If we get here we have (another) forward declaration or we 15927 // have a definition. Just create a new decl. 15928 15929 } else { 15930 // If we get here, this is a definition of a new tag type in a nested 15931 // scope, e.g. "struct foo; void bar() { struct foo; }", just create a 15932 // new decl/type. We set PrevDecl to NULL so that the entities 15933 // have distinct types. 15934 Previous.clear(); 15935 } 15936 // If we get here, we're going to create a new Decl. If PrevDecl 15937 // is non-NULL, it's a definition of the tag declared by 15938 // PrevDecl. If it's NULL, we have a new definition. 15939 15940 // Otherwise, PrevDecl is not a tag, but was found with tag 15941 // lookup. This is only actually possible in C++, where a few 15942 // things like templates still live in the tag namespace. 15943 } else { 15944 // Use a better diagnostic if an elaborated-type-specifier 15945 // found the wrong kind of type on the first 15946 // (non-redeclaration) lookup. 15947 if ((TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend) && 15948 !Previous.isForRedeclaration()) { 15949 NonTagKind NTK = getNonTagTypeDeclKind(PrevDecl, Kind); 15950 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_tag_reference_non_tag) << PrevDecl << NTK 15951 << Kind; 15952 Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at); 15953 Invalid = true; 15954 15955 // Otherwise, only diagnose if the declaration is in scope. 15956 } else if (!isDeclInScope(DirectPrevDecl, SearchDC, S, 15957 SS.isNotEmpty() || isMemberSpecialization)) { 15958 // do nothing 15959 15960 // Diagnose implicit declarations introduced by elaborated types. 15961 } else if (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend) { 15962 NonTagKind NTK = getNonTagTypeDeclKind(PrevDecl, Kind); 15963 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_tag_reference_conflict) << NTK; 15964 Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) << PrevDecl; 15965 Invalid = true; 15966 15967 // Otherwise it's a declaration. Call out a particularly common 15968 // case here. 15969 } else if (TypedefNameDecl *TND = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(PrevDecl)) { 15970 unsigned Kind = 0; 15971 if (isa<TypeAliasDecl>(PrevDecl)) Kind = 1; 15972 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_tag_definition_of_typedef) 15973 << Name << Kind << TND->getUnderlyingType(); 15974 Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) << PrevDecl; 15975 Invalid = true; 15976 15977 // Otherwise, diagnose. 15978 } else { 15979 // The tag name clashes with something else in the target scope, 15980 // issue an error and recover by making this tag be anonymous. 15981 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_redefinition_different_kind) << Name; 15982 notePreviousDefinition(PrevDecl, NameLoc); 15983 Name = nullptr; 15984 Invalid = true; 15985 } 15986 15987 // The existing declaration isn't relevant to us; we're in a 15988 // new scope, so clear out the previous declaration. 15989 Previous.clear(); 15990 } 15991 } 15992 15993 CreateNewDecl: 15994 15995 TagDecl *PrevDecl = nullptr; 15996 if (Previous.isSingleResult()) 15997 PrevDecl = cast<TagDecl>(Previous.getFoundDecl()); 15998 15999 // If there is an identifier, use the location of the identifier as the 16000 // location of the decl, otherwise use the location of the struct/union 16001 // keyword. 16002 SourceLocation Loc = NameLoc.isValid() ? NameLoc : KWLoc; 16003 16004 // Otherwise, create a new declaration. If there is a previous 16005 // declaration of the same entity, the two will be linked via 16006 // PrevDecl. 16007 TagDecl *New; 16008 16009 if (Kind == TTK_Enum) { 16010 // FIXME: Tag decls should be chained to any simultaneous vardecls, e.g.: 16011 // enum X { A, B, C } D; D should chain to X. 16012 New = EnumDecl::Create(Context, SearchDC, KWLoc, Loc, Name, 16013 cast_or_null<EnumDecl>(PrevDecl), ScopedEnum, 16014 ScopedEnumUsesClassTag, IsFixed); 16015 16016 if (isStdAlignValT && (!StdAlignValT || getStdAlignValT()->isImplicit())) 16017 StdAlignValT = cast<EnumDecl>(New); 16018 16019 // If this is an undefined enum, warn. 16020 if (TUK != TUK_Definition && !Invalid) { 16021 TagDecl *Def; 16022 if (IsFixed && cast<EnumDecl>(New)->isFixed()) { 16023 // C++0x: 7.2p2: opaque-enum-declaration. 16024 // Conflicts are diagnosed above. Do nothing. 16025 } 16026 else if (PrevDecl && (Def = cast<EnumDecl>(PrevDecl)->getDefinition())) { 16027 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_forward_ref_enum_def) 16028 << New; 16029 Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 16030 } else { 16031 unsigned DiagID = diag::ext_forward_ref_enum; 16032 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) 16033 DiagID = diag::ext_ms_forward_ref_enum; 16034 else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 16035 DiagID = diag::err_forward_ref_enum; 16036 Diag(Loc, DiagID); 16037 } 16038 } 16039 16040 if (EnumUnderlying) { 16041 EnumDecl *ED = cast<EnumDecl>(New); 16042 if (TypeSourceInfo *TI = EnumUnderlying.dyn_cast<TypeSourceInfo*>()) 16043 ED->setIntegerTypeSourceInfo(TI); 16044 else 16045 ED->setIntegerType(QualType(EnumUnderlying.get<const Type*>(), 0)); 16046 ED->setPromotionType(ED->getIntegerType()); 16047 assert(ED->isComplete() && "enum with type should be complete"); 16048 } 16049 } else { 16050 // struct/union/class 16051 16052 // FIXME: Tag decls should be chained to any simultaneous vardecls, e.g.: 16053 // struct X { int A; } D; D should chain to X. 16054 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 16055 // FIXME: Look for a way to use RecordDecl for simple structs. 16056 New = CXXRecordDecl::Create(Context, Kind, SearchDC, KWLoc, Loc, Name, 16057 cast_or_null<CXXRecordDecl>(PrevDecl)); 16058 16059 if (isStdBadAlloc && (!StdBadAlloc || getStdBadAlloc()->isImplicit())) 16060 StdBadAlloc = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(New); 16061 } else 16062 New = RecordDecl::Create(Context, Kind, SearchDC, KWLoc, Loc, Name, 16063 cast_or_null<RecordDecl>(PrevDecl)); 16064 } 16065 16066 // C++11 [dcl.type]p3: 16067 // A type-specifier-seq shall not define a class or enumeration [...]. 16068 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && (IsTypeSpecifier || IsTemplateParamOrArg) && 16069 TUK == TUK_Definition) { 16070 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_type_defined_in_type_specifier) 16071 << Context.getTagDeclType(New); 16072 Invalid = true; 16073 } 16074 16075 if (!Invalid && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && TUK == TUK_Definition && 16076 DC->getDeclKind() == Decl::Enum) { 16077 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_type_defined_in_enum) 16078 << Context.getTagDeclType(New); 16079 Invalid = true; 16080 } 16081 16082 // Maybe add qualifier info. 16083 if (SS.isNotEmpty()) { 16084 if (SS.isSet()) { 16085 // If this is either a declaration or a definition, check the 16086 // nested-name-specifier against the current context. 16087 if ((TUK == TUK_Definition || TUK == TUK_Declaration) && 16088 diagnoseQualifiedDeclaration(SS, DC, OrigName, Loc, 16089 isMemberSpecialization)) 16090 Invalid = true; 16091 16092 New->setQualifierInfo(SS.getWithLocInContext(Context)); 16093 if (TemplateParameterLists.size() > 0) { 16094 New->setTemplateParameterListsInfo(Context, TemplateParameterLists); 16095 } 16096 } 16097 else 16098 Invalid = true; 16099 } 16100 16101 if (RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(New)) { 16102 // Add alignment attributes if necessary; these attributes are checked when 16103 // the ASTContext lays out the structure. 16104 // 16105 // It is important for implementing the correct semantics that this 16106 // happen here (in ActOnTag). The #pragma pack stack is 16107 // maintained as a result of parser callbacks which can occur at 16108 // many points during the parsing of a struct declaration (because 16109 // the #pragma tokens are effectively skipped over during the 16110 // parsing of the struct). 16111 if (TUK == TUK_Definition && (!SkipBody || !SkipBody->ShouldSkip)) { 16112 AddAlignmentAttributesForRecord(RD); 16113 AddMsStructLayoutForRecord(RD); 16114 } 16115 } 16116 16117 if (ModulePrivateLoc.isValid()) { 16118 if (isMemberSpecialization) 16119 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_specialization) 16120 << 2 16121 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ModulePrivateLoc); 16122 // __module_private__ does not apply to local classes. However, we only 16123 // diagnose this as an error when the declaration specifiers are 16124 // freestanding. Here, we just ignore the __module_private__. 16125 else if (!SearchDC->isFunctionOrMethod()) 16126 New->setModulePrivate(); 16127 } 16128 16129 // If this is a specialization of a member class (of a class template), 16130 // check the specialization. 16131 if (isMemberSpecialization && CheckMemberSpecialization(New, Previous)) 16132 Invalid = true; 16133 16134 // If we're declaring or defining a tag in function prototype scope in C, 16135 // note that this type can only be used within the function and add it to 16136 // the list of decls to inject into the function definition scope. 16137 if ((Name || Kind == TTK_Enum) && 16138 getNonFieldDeclScope(S)->isFunctionPrototypeScope()) { 16139 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 16140 // C++ [dcl.fct]p6: 16141 // Types shall not be defined in return or parameter types. 16142 if (TUK == TUK_Definition && !IsTypeSpecifier) { 16143 Diag(Loc, diag::err_type_defined_in_param_type) 16144 << Name; 16145 Invalid = true; 16146 } 16147 } else if (!PrevDecl) { 16148 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_decl_in_param_list) << Context.getTagDeclType(New); 16149 } 16150 } 16151 16152 if (Invalid) 16153 New->setInvalidDecl(); 16154 16155 // Set the lexical context. If the tag has a C++ scope specifier, the 16156 // lexical context will be different from the semantic context. 16157 New->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext); 16158 16159 // Mark this as a friend decl if applicable. 16160 // In Microsoft mode, a friend declaration also acts as a forward 16161 // declaration so we always pass true to setObjectOfFriendDecl to make 16162 // the tag name visible. 16163 if (TUK == TUK_Friend) 16164 New->setObjectOfFriendDecl(getLangOpts().MSVCCompat); 16165 16166 // Set the access specifier. 16167 if (!Invalid && SearchDC->isRecord()) 16168 SetMemberAccessSpecifier(New, PrevDecl, AS); 16169 16170 if (PrevDecl) 16171 CheckRedeclarationModuleOwnership(New, PrevDecl); 16172 16173 if (TUK == TUK_Definition && (!SkipBody || !SkipBody->ShouldSkip)) 16174 New->startDefinition(); 16175 16176 ProcessDeclAttributeList(S, New, Attrs); 16177 AddPragmaAttributes(S, New); 16178 16179 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack. 16180 if (TUK == TUK_Friend) { 16181 // We might be replacing an existing declaration in the lookup tables; 16182 // if so, borrow its access specifier. 16183 if (PrevDecl) 16184 New->setAccess(PrevDecl->getAccess()); 16185 16186 DeclContext *DC = New->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 16187 DC->makeDeclVisibleInContext(New); 16188 if (Name) // can be null along some error paths 16189 if (Scope *EnclosingScope = getScopeForDeclContext(S, DC)) 16190 PushOnScopeChains(New, EnclosingScope, /* AddToContext = */ false); 16191 } else if (Name) { 16192 S = getNonFieldDeclScope(S); 16193 PushOnScopeChains(New, S, true); 16194 } else { 16195 CurContext->addDecl(New); 16196 } 16197 16198 // If this is the C FILE type, notify the AST context. 16199 if (IdentifierInfo *II = New->getIdentifier()) 16200 if (!New->isInvalidDecl() && 16201 New->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit() && 16202 II->isStr("FILE")) 16203 Context.setFILEDecl(New); 16204 16205 if (PrevDecl) 16206 mergeDeclAttributes(New, PrevDecl); 16207 16208 if (auto *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(New)) 16209 inferGslOwnerPointerAttribute(CXXRD); 16210 16211 // If there's a #pragma GCC visibility in scope, set the visibility of this 16212 // record. 16213 AddPushedVisibilityAttribute(New); 16214 16215 if (isMemberSpecialization && !New->isInvalidDecl()) 16216 CompleteMemberSpecialization(New, Previous); 16217 16218 OwnedDecl = true; 16219 // In C++, don't return an invalid declaration. We can't recover well from 16220 // the cases where we make the type anonymous. 16221 if (Invalid && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 16222 if (New->isBeingDefined()) 16223 if (auto RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(New)) 16224 RD->completeDefinition(); 16225 return nullptr; 16226 } else if (SkipBody && SkipBody->ShouldSkip) { 16227 return SkipBody->Previous; 16228 } else { 16229 return New; 16230 } 16231 } 16232 16233 void Sema::ActOnTagStartDefinition(Scope *S, Decl *TagD) { 16234 AdjustDeclIfTemplate(TagD); 16235 TagDecl *Tag = cast<TagDecl>(TagD); 16236 16237 // Enter the tag context. 16238 PushDeclContext(S, Tag); 16239 16240 ActOnDocumentableDecl(TagD); 16241 16242 // If there's a #pragma GCC visibility in scope, set the visibility of this 16243 // record. 16244 AddPushedVisibilityAttribute(Tag); 16245 } 16246 16247 bool Sema::ActOnDuplicateDefinition(DeclSpec &DS, Decl *Prev, 16248 SkipBodyInfo &SkipBody) { 16249 if (!hasStructuralCompatLayout(Prev, SkipBody.New)) 16250 return false; 16251 16252 // Make the previous decl visible. 16253 makeMergedDefinitionVisible(SkipBody.Previous); 16254 return true; 16255 } 16256 16257 Decl *Sema::ActOnObjCContainerStartDefinition(Decl *IDecl) { 16258 assert(isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(IDecl) && 16259 "ActOnObjCContainerStartDefinition - Not ObjCContainerDecl"); 16260 DeclContext *OCD = cast<DeclContext>(IDecl); 16261 assert(OCD->getLexicalParent() == CurContext && 16262 "The next DeclContext should be lexically contained in the current one."); 16263 CurContext = OCD; 16264 return IDecl; 16265 } 16266 16267 void Sema::ActOnStartCXXMemberDeclarations(Scope *S, Decl *TagD, 16268 SourceLocation FinalLoc, 16269 bool IsFinalSpelledSealed, 16270 SourceLocation LBraceLoc) { 16271 AdjustDeclIfTemplate(TagD); 16272 CXXRecordDecl *Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TagD); 16273 16274 FieldCollector->StartClass(); 16275 16276 if (!Record->getIdentifier()) 16277 return; 16278 16279 if (FinalLoc.isValid()) 16280 Record->addAttr(FinalAttr::Create( 16281 Context, FinalLoc, AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Keyword, 16282 static_cast<FinalAttr::Spelling>(IsFinalSpelledSealed))); 16283 16284 // C++ [class]p2: 16285 // [...] The class-name is also inserted into the scope of the 16286 // class itself; this is known as the injected-class-name. For 16287 // purposes of access checking, the injected-class-name is treated 16288 // as if it were a public member name. 16289 CXXRecordDecl *InjectedClassName = CXXRecordDecl::Create( 16290 Context, Record->getTagKind(), CurContext, Record->getBeginLoc(), 16291 Record->getLocation(), Record->getIdentifier(), 16292 /*PrevDecl=*/nullptr, 16293 /*DelayTypeCreation=*/true); 16294 Context.getTypeDeclType(InjectedClassName, Record); 16295 InjectedClassName->setImplicit(); 16296 InjectedClassName->setAccess(AS_public); 16297 if (ClassTemplateDecl *Template = Record->getDescribedClassTemplate()) 16298 InjectedClassName->setDescribedClassTemplate(Template); 16299 PushOnScopeChains(InjectedClassName, S); 16300 assert(InjectedClassName->isInjectedClassName() && 16301 "Broken injected-class-name"); 16302 } 16303 16304 void Sema::ActOnTagFinishDefinition(Scope *S, Decl *TagD, 16305 SourceRange BraceRange) { 16306 AdjustDeclIfTemplate(TagD); 16307 TagDecl *Tag = cast<TagDecl>(TagD); 16308 Tag->setBraceRange(BraceRange); 16309 16310 // Make sure we "complete" the definition even it is invalid. 16311 if (Tag->isBeingDefined()) { 16312 assert(Tag->isInvalidDecl() && "We should already have completed it"); 16313 if (RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Tag)) 16314 RD->completeDefinition(); 16315 } 16316 16317 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Tag)) { 16318 FieldCollector->FinishClass(); 16319 } 16320 16321 // Exit this scope of this tag's definition. 16322 PopDeclContext(); 16323 16324 if (getCurLexicalContext()->isObjCContainer() && 16325 Tag->getDeclContext()->isFileContext()) 16326 Tag->setTopLevelDeclInObjCContainer(); 16327 16328 // Notify the consumer that we've defined a tag. 16329 if (!Tag->isInvalidDecl()) 16330 Consumer.HandleTagDeclDefinition(Tag); 16331 } 16332 16333 void Sema::ActOnObjCContainerFinishDefinition() { 16334 // Exit this scope of this interface definition. 16335 PopDeclContext(); 16336 } 16337 16338 void Sema::ActOnObjCTemporaryExitContainerContext(DeclContext *DC) { 16339 assert(DC == CurContext && "Mismatch of container contexts"); 16340 OriginalLexicalContext = DC; 16341 ActOnObjCContainerFinishDefinition(); 16342 } 16343 16344 void Sema::ActOnObjCReenterContainerContext(DeclContext *DC) { 16345 ActOnObjCContainerStartDefinition(cast<Decl>(DC)); 16346 OriginalLexicalContext = nullptr; 16347 } 16348 16349 void Sema::ActOnTagDefinitionError(Scope *S, Decl *TagD) { 16350 AdjustDeclIfTemplate(TagD); 16351 TagDecl *Tag = cast<TagDecl>(TagD); 16352 Tag->setInvalidDecl(); 16353 16354 // Make sure we "complete" the definition even it is invalid. 16355 if (Tag->isBeingDefined()) { 16356 if (RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Tag)) 16357 RD->completeDefinition(); 16358 } 16359 16360 // We're undoing ActOnTagStartDefinition here, not 16361 // ActOnStartCXXMemberDeclarations, so we don't have to mess with 16362 // the FieldCollector. 16363 16364 PopDeclContext(); 16365 } 16366 16367 // Note that FieldName may be null for anonymous bitfields. 16368 ExprResult Sema::VerifyBitField(SourceLocation FieldLoc, 16369 IdentifierInfo *FieldName, 16370 QualType FieldTy, bool IsMsStruct, 16371 Expr *BitWidth, bool *ZeroWidth) { 16372 assert(BitWidth); 16373 if (BitWidth->containsErrors()) 16374 return ExprError(); 16375 16376 // Default to true; that shouldn't confuse checks for emptiness 16377 if (ZeroWidth) 16378 *ZeroWidth = true; 16379 16380 // C99 6.7.2.1p4 - verify the field type. 16381 // C++ 9.6p3: A bit-field shall have integral or enumeration type. 16382 if (!FieldTy->isDependentType() && !FieldTy->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) { 16383 // Handle incomplete and sizeless types with a specific error. 16384 if (RequireCompleteSizedType(FieldLoc, FieldTy, 16385 diag::err_field_incomplete_or_sizeless)) 16386 return ExprError(); 16387 if (FieldName) 16388 return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_not_integral_type_bitfield) 16389 << FieldName << FieldTy << BitWidth->getSourceRange(); 16390 return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_not_integral_type_anon_bitfield) 16391 << FieldTy << BitWidth->getSourceRange(); 16392 } else if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(const_cast<Expr *>(BitWidth), 16393 UPPC_BitFieldWidth)) 16394 return ExprError(); 16395 16396 // If the bit-width is type- or value-dependent, don't try to check 16397 // it now. 16398 if (BitWidth->isValueDependent() || BitWidth->isTypeDependent()) 16399 return BitWidth; 16400 16401 llvm::APSInt Value; 16402 ExprResult ICE = VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(BitWidth, &Value, AllowFold); 16403 if (ICE.isInvalid()) 16404 return ICE; 16405 BitWidth = ICE.get(); 16406 16407 if (Value != 0 && ZeroWidth) 16408 *ZeroWidth = false; 16409 16410 // Zero-width bitfield is ok for anonymous field. 16411 if (Value == 0 && FieldName) 16412 return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_bitfield_has_zero_width) << FieldName; 16413 16414 if (Value.isSigned() && Value.isNegative()) { 16415 if (FieldName) 16416 return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_bitfield_has_negative_width) 16417 << FieldName << Value.toString(10); 16418 return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_anon_bitfield_has_negative_width) 16419 << Value.toString(10); 16420 } 16421 16422 if (!FieldTy->isDependentType()) { 16423 uint64_t TypeStorageSize = Context.getTypeSize(FieldTy); 16424 uint64_t TypeWidth = Context.getIntWidth(FieldTy); 16425 bool BitfieldIsOverwide = Value.ugt(TypeWidth); 16426 16427 // Over-wide bitfields are an error in C or when using the MSVC bitfield 16428 // ABI. 16429 bool CStdConstraintViolation = 16430 BitfieldIsOverwide && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 16431 bool MSBitfieldViolation = 16432 Value.ugt(TypeStorageSize) && 16433 (IsMsStruct || Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()); 16434 if (CStdConstraintViolation || MSBitfieldViolation) { 16435 unsigned DiagWidth = 16436 CStdConstraintViolation ? TypeWidth : TypeStorageSize; 16437 if (FieldName) 16438 return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_bitfield_width_exceeds_type_width) 16439 << FieldName << (unsigned)Value.getZExtValue() 16440 << !CStdConstraintViolation << DiagWidth; 16441 16442 return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_anon_bitfield_width_exceeds_type_width) 16443 << (unsigned)Value.getZExtValue() << !CStdConstraintViolation 16444 << DiagWidth; 16445 } 16446 16447 // Warn on types where the user might conceivably expect to get all 16448 // specified bits as value bits: that's all integral types other than 16449 // 'bool'. 16450 if (BitfieldIsOverwide && !FieldTy->isBooleanType()) { 16451 if (FieldName) 16452 Diag(FieldLoc, diag::warn_bitfield_width_exceeds_type_width) 16453 << FieldName << (unsigned)Value.getZExtValue() 16454 << (unsigned)TypeWidth; 16455 else 16456 Diag(FieldLoc, diag::warn_anon_bitfield_width_exceeds_type_width) 16457 << (unsigned)Value.getZExtValue() << (unsigned)TypeWidth; 16458 } 16459 } 16460 16461 return BitWidth; 16462 } 16463 16464 /// ActOnField - Each field of a C struct/union is passed into this in order 16465 /// to create a FieldDecl object for it. 16466 Decl *Sema::ActOnField(Scope *S, Decl *TagD, SourceLocation DeclStart, 16467 Declarator &D, Expr *BitfieldWidth) { 16468 FieldDecl *Res = HandleField(S, cast_or_null<RecordDecl>(TagD), 16469 DeclStart, D, static_cast<Expr*>(BitfieldWidth), 16470 /*InitStyle=*/ICIS_NoInit, AS_public); 16471 return Res; 16472 } 16473 16474 /// HandleField - Analyze a field of a C struct or a C++ data member. 16475 /// 16476 FieldDecl *Sema::HandleField(Scope *S, RecordDecl *Record, 16477 SourceLocation DeclStart, 16478 Declarator &D, Expr *BitWidth, 16479 InClassInitStyle InitStyle, 16480 AccessSpecifier AS) { 16481 if (D.isDecompositionDeclarator()) { 16482 const DecompositionDeclarator &Decomp = D.getDecompositionDeclarator(); 16483 Diag(Decomp.getLSquareLoc(), diag::err_decomp_decl_context) 16484 << Decomp.getSourceRange(); 16485 return nullptr; 16486 } 16487 16488 IdentifierInfo *II = D.getIdentifier(); 16489 SourceLocation Loc = DeclStart; 16490 if (II) Loc = D.getIdentifierLoc(); 16491 16492 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(D, S); 16493 QualType T = TInfo->getType(); 16494 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 16495 CheckExtraCXXDefaultArguments(D); 16496 16497 if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(D.getIdentifierLoc(), TInfo, 16498 UPPC_DataMemberType)) { 16499 D.setInvalidType(); 16500 T = Context.IntTy; 16501 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T, Loc); 16502 } 16503 } 16504 16505 DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(D.getDeclSpec()); 16506 16507 if (D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified()) 16508 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_non_function) 16509 << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17; 16510 if (DeclSpec::TSCS TSCS = D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpec()) 16511 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), 16512 diag::err_invalid_thread) 16513 << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSCS); 16514 16515 // Check to see if this name was declared as a member previously 16516 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = nullptr; 16517 LookupResult Previous(*this, II, Loc, LookupMemberName, 16518 ForVisibleRedeclaration); 16519 LookupName(Previous, S); 16520 switch (Previous.getResultKind()) { 16521 case LookupResult::Found: 16522 case LookupResult::FoundUnresolvedValue: 16523 PrevDecl = Previous.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>(); 16524 break; 16525 16526 case LookupResult::FoundOverloaded: 16527 PrevDecl = Previous.getRepresentativeDecl(); 16528 break; 16529 16530 case LookupResult::NotFound: 16531 case LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation: 16532 case LookupResult::Ambiguous: 16533 break; 16534 } 16535 Previous.suppressDiagnostics(); 16536 16537 if (PrevDecl && PrevDecl->isTemplateParameter()) { 16538 // Maybe we will complain about the shadowed template parameter. 16539 DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow(D.getIdentifierLoc(), PrevDecl); 16540 // Just pretend that we didn't see the previous declaration. 16541 PrevDecl = nullptr; 16542 } 16543 16544 if (PrevDecl && !isDeclInScope(PrevDecl, Record, S)) 16545 PrevDecl = nullptr; 16546 16547 bool Mutable 16548 = (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_mutable); 16549 SourceLocation TSSL = D.getBeginLoc(); 16550 FieldDecl *NewFD 16551 = CheckFieldDecl(II, T, TInfo, Record, Loc, Mutable, BitWidth, InitStyle, 16552 TSSL, AS, PrevDecl, &D); 16553 16554 if (NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) 16555 Record->setInvalidDecl(); 16556 16557 if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified()) 16558 NewFD->setModulePrivate(); 16559 16560 if (NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && PrevDecl) { 16561 // Don't introduce NewFD into scope; there's already something 16562 // with the same name in the same scope. 16563 } else if (II) { 16564 PushOnScopeChains(NewFD, S); 16565 } else 16566 Record->addDecl(NewFD); 16567 16568 return NewFD; 16569 } 16570 16571 /// Build a new FieldDecl and check its well-formedness. 16572 /// 16573 /// This routine builds a new FieldDecl given the fields name, type, 16574 /// record, etc. \p PrevDecl should refer to any previous declaration 16575 /// with the same name and in the same scope as the field to be 16576 /// created. 16577 /// 16578 /// \returns a new FieldDecl. 16579 /// 16580 /// \todo The Declarator argument is a hack. It will be removed once 16581 FieldDecl *Sema::CheckFieldDecl(DeclarationName Name, QualType T, 16582 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, 16583 RecordDecl *Record, SourceLocation Loc, 16584 bool Mutable, Expr *BitWidth, 16585 InClassInitStyle InitStyle, 16586 SourceLocation TSSL, 16587 AccessSpecifier AS, NamedDecl *PrevDecl, 16588 Declarator *D) { 16589 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo(); 16590 bool InvalidDecl = false; 16591 if (D) InvalidDecl = D->isInvalidType(); 16592 16593 // If we receive a broken type, recover by assuming 'int' and 16594 // marking this declaration as invalid. 16595 if (T.isNull() || T->containsErrors()) { 16596 InvalidDecl = true; 16597 T = Context.IntTy; 16598 } 16599 16600 QualType EltTy = Context.getBaseElementType(T); 16601 if (!EltTy->isDependentType() && !EltTy->containsErrors()) { 16602 if (RequireCompleteSizedType(Loc, EltTy, 16603 diag::err_field_incomplete_or_sizeless)) { 16604 // Fields of incomplete type force their record to be invalid. 16605 Record->setInvalidDecl(); 16606 InvalidDecl = true; 16607 } else { 16608 NamedDecl *Def; 16609 EltTy->isIncompleteType(&Def); 16610 if (Def && Def->isInvalidDecl()) { 16611 Record->setInvalidDecl(); 16612 InvalidDecl = true; 16613 } 16614 } 16615 } 16616 16617 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address space 16618 if (T.hasAddressSpace() || T->isDependentAddressSpaceType() || 16619 T->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe()->isDependentAddressSpaceType()) { 16620 Diag(Loc, diag::err_field_with_address_space); 16621 Record->setInvalidDecl(); 16622 InvalidDecl = true; 16623 } 16624 16625 if (LangOpts.OpenCL) { 16626 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9b,r & OpenCL v2.0 s6.12.5 - The following types cannot be 16627 // used as structure or union field: image, sampler, event or block types. 16628 if (T->isEventT() || T->isImageType() || T->isSamplerT() || 16629 T->isBlockPointerType()) { 16630 Diag(Loc, diag::err_opencl_type_struct_or_union_field) << T; 16631 Record->setInvalidDecl(); 16632 InvalidDecl = true; 16633 } 16634 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.c: bitfields are not supported. 16635 if (BitWidth) { 16636 Diag(Loc, diag::err_opencl_bitfields); 16637 InvalidDecl = true; 16638 } 16639 } 16640 16641 // Anonymous bit-fields cannot be cv-qualified (CWG 2229). 16642 if (!InvalidDecl && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !II && BitWidth && 16643 T.hasQualifiers()) { 16644 InvalidDecl = true; 16645 Diag(Loc, diag::err_anon_bitfield_qualifiers); 16646 } 16647 16648 // C99 6.7.2.1p8: A member of a structure or union may have any type other 16649 // than a variably modified type. 16650 if (!InvalidDecl && T->isVariablyModifiedType()) { 16651 bool SizeIsNegative; 16652 llvm::APSInt Oversized; 16653 16654 TypeSourceInfo *FixedTInfo = 16655 TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeSourceInfo(TInfo, Context, 16656 SizeIsNegative, 16657 Oversized); 16658 if (FixedTInfo) { 16659 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_vla_folded_to_constant); 16660 TInfo = FixedTInfo; 16661 T = FixedTInfo->getType(); 16662 } else { 16663 if (SizeIsNegative) 16664 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_negative_array_size); 16665 else if (Oversized.getBoolValue()) 16666 Diag(Loc, diag::err_array_too_large) 16667 << Oversized.toString(10); 16668 else 16669 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_field_variable_size); 16670 InvalidDecl = true; 16671 } 16672 } 16673 16674 // Fields can not have abstract class types 16675 if (!InvalidDecl && RequireNonAbstractType(Loc, T, 16676 diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, 16677 AbstractFieldType)) 16678 InvalidDecl = true; 16679 16680 bool ZeroWidth = false; 16681 if (InvalidDecl) 16682 BitWidth = nullptr; 16683 // If this is declared as a bit-field, check the bit-field. 16684 if (BitWidth) { 16685 BitWidth = VerifyBitField(Loc, II, T, Record->isMsStruct(Context), BitWidth, 16686 &ZeroWidth).get(); 16687 if (!BitWidth) { 16688 InvalidDecl = true; 16689 BitWidth = nullptr; 16690 ZeroWidth = false; 16691 } 16692 } 16693 16694 // Check that 'mutable' is consistent with the type of the declaration. 16695 if (!InvalidDecl && Mutable) { 16696 unsigned DiagID = 0; 16697 if (T->isReferenceType()) 16698 DiagID = getLangOpts().MSVCCompat ? diag::ext_mutable_reference 16699 : diag::err_mutable_reference; 16700 else if (T.isConstQualified()) 16701 DiagID = diag::err_mutable_const; 16702 16703 if (DiagID) { 16704 SourceLocation ErrLoc = Loc; 16705 if (D && D->getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc().isValid()) 16706 ErrLoc = D->getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(); 16707 Diag(ErrLoc, DiagID); 16708 if (DiagID != diag::ext_mutable_reference) { 16709 Mutable = false; 16710 InvalidDecl = true; 16711 } 16712 } 16713 } 16714 16715 // C++11 [class.union]p8 (DR1460): 16716 // At most one variant member of a union may have a 16717 // brace-or-equal-initializer. 16718 if (InitStyle != ICIS_NoInit) 16719 checkDuplicateDefaultInit(*this, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record), Loc); 16720 16721 FieldDecl *NewFD = FieldDecl::Create(Context, Record, TSSL, Loc, II, T, TInfo, 16722 BitWidth, Mutable, InitStyle); 16723 if (InvalidDecl) 16724 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 16725 16726 if (PrevDecl && !isa<TagDecl>(PrevDecl)) { 16727 Diag(Loc, diag::err_duplicate_member) << II; 16728 Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 16729 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 16730 } 16731 16732 if (!InvalidDecl && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 16733 if (Record->isUnion()) { 16734 if (const RecordType *RT = EltTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { 16735 CXXRecordDecl* RDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RT->getDecl()); 16736 if (RDecl->getDefinition()) { 16737 // C++ [class.union]p1: An object of a class with a non-trivial 16738 // constructor, a non-trivial copy constructor, a non-trivial 16739 // destructor, or a non-trivial copy assignment operator 16740 // cannot be a member of a union, nor can an array of such 16741 // objects. 16742 if (CheckNontrivialField(NewFD)) 16743 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 16744 } 16745 } 16746 16747 // C++ [class.union]p1: If a union contains a member of reference type, 16748 // the program is ill-formed, except when compiling with MSVC extensions 16749 // enabled. 16750 if (EltTy->isReferenceType()) { 16751 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt ? 16752 diag::ext_union_member_of_reference_type : 16753 diag::err_union_member_of_reference_type) 16754 << NewFD->getDeclName() << EltTy; 16755 if (!getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt) 16756 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 16757 } 16758 } 16759 } 16760 16761 // FIXME: We need to pass in the attributes given an AST 16762 // representation, not a parser representation. 16763 if (D) { 16764 // FIXME: The current scope is almost... but not entirely... correct here. 16765 ProcessDeclAttributes(getCurScope(), NewFD, *D); 16766 16767 if (NewFD->hasAttrs()) 16768 CheckAlignasUnderalignment(NewFD); 16769 } 16770 16771 // In auto-retain/release, infer strong retension for fields of 16772 // retainable type. 16773 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && inferObjCARCLifetime(NewFD)) 16774 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 16775 16776 if (T.isObjCGCWeak()) 16777 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_attribute_weak_on_field); 16778 16779 // PPC MMA non-pointer types are not allowed as field types. 16780 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isPPC64() && 16781 CheckPPCMMAType(T, NewFD->getLocation())) 16782 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 16783 16784 NewFD->setAccess(AS); 16785 return NewFD; 16786 } 16787 16788 bool Sema::CheckNontrivialField(FieldDecl *FD) { 16789 assert(FD); 16790 assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "valid check only for C++"); 16791 16792 if (FD->isInvalidDecl() || FD->getType()->isDependentType()) 16793 return false; 16794 16795 QualType EltTy = Context.getBaseElementType(FD->getType()); 16796 if (const RecordType *RT = EltTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { 16797 CXXRecordDecl *RDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RT->getDecl()); 16798 if (RDecl->getDefinition()) { 16799 // We check for copy constructors before constructors 16800 // because otherwise we'll never get complaints about 16801 // copy constructors. 16802 16803 CXXSpecialMember member = CXXInvalid; 16804 // We're required to check for any non-trivial constructors. Since the 16805 // implicit default constructor is suppressed if there are any 16806 // user-declared constructors, we just need to check that there is a 16807 // trivial default constructor and a trivial copy constructor. (We don't 16808 // worry about move constructors here, since this is a C++98 check.) 16809 if (RDecl->hasNonTrivialCopyConstructor()) 16810 member = CXXCopyConstructor; 16811 else if (!RDecl->hasTrivialDefaultConstructor()) 16812 member = CXXDefaultConstructor; 16813 else if (RDecl->hasNonTrivialCopyAssignment()) 16814 member = CXXCopyAssignment; 16815 else if (RDecl->hasNonTrivialDestructor()) 16816 member = CXXDestructor; 16817 16818 if (member != CXXInvalid) { 16819 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && 16820 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && RDecl->hasObjectMember()) { 16821 // Objective-C++ ARC: it is an error to have a non-trivial field of 16822 // a union. However, system headers in Objective-C programs 16823 // occasionally have Objective-C lifetime objects within unions, 16824 // and rather than cause the program to fail, we make those 16825 // members unavailable. 16826 SourceLocation Loc = FD->getLocation(); 16827 if (getSourceManager().isInSystemHeader(Loc)) { 16828 if (!FD->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) 16829 FD->addAttr(UnavailableAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, "", 16830 UnavailableAttr::IR_ARCFieldWithOwnership, Loc)); 16831 return false; 16832 } 16833 } 16834 16835 Diag(FD->getLocation(), getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 ? 16836 diag::warn_cxx98_compat_nontrivial_union_or_anon_struct_member : 16837 diag::err_illegal_union_or_anon_struct_member) 16838 << FD->getParent()->isUnion() << FD->getDeclName() << member; 16839 DiagnoseNontrivial(RDecl, member); 16840 return !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11; 16841 } 16842 } 16843 } 16844 16845 return false; 16846 } 16847 16848 /// TranslateIvarVisibility - Translate visibility from a token ID to an 16849 /// AST enum value. 16850 static ObjCIvarDecl::AccessControl 16851 TranslateIvarVisibility(tok::ObjCKeywordKind ivarVisibility) { 16852 switch (ivarVisibility) { 16853 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown visitibility kind"); 16854 case tok::objc_private: return ObjCIvarDecl::Private; 16855 case tok::objc_public: return ObjCIvarDecl::Public; 16856 case tok::objc_protected: return ObjCIvarDecl::Protected; 16857 case tok::objc_package: return ObjCIvarDecl::Package; 16858 } 16859 } 16860 16861 /// ActOnIvar - Each ivar field of an objective-c class is passed into this 16862 /// in order to create an IvarDecl object for it. 16863 Decl *Sema::ActOnIvar(Scope *S, 16864 SourceLocation DeclStart, 16865 Declarator &D, Expr *BitfieldWidth, 16866 tok::ObjCKeywordKind Visibility) { 16867 16868 IdentifierInfo *II = D.getIdentifier(); 16869 Expr *BitWidth = (Expr*)BitfieldWidth; 16870 SourceLocation Loc = DeclStart; 16871 if (II) Loc = D.getIdentifierLoc(); 16872 16873 // FIXME: Unnamed fields can be handled in various different ways, for 16874 // example, unnamed unions inject all members into the struct namespace! 16875 16876 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(D, S); 16877 QualType T = TInfo->getType(); 16878 16879 if (BitWidth) { 16880 // 6.7.2.1p3, 6.7.2.1p4 16881 BitWidth = VerifyBitField(Loc, II, T, /*IsMsStruct*/false, BitWidth).get(); 16882 if (!BitWidth) 16883 D.setInvalidType(); 16884 } else { 16885 // Not a bitfield. 16886 16887 // validate II. 16888 16889 } 16890 if (T->isReferenceType()) { 16891 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ivar_reference_type); 16892 D.setInvalidType(); 16893 } 16894 // C99 6.7.2.1p8: A member of a structure or union may have any type other 16895 // than a variably modified type. 16896 else if (T->isVariablyModifiedType()) { 16897 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_ivar_variable_size); 16898 D.setInvalidType(); 16899 } 16900 16901 // Get the visibility (access control) for this ivar. 16902 ObjCIvarDecl::AccessControl ac = 16903 Visibility != tok::objc_not_keyword ? TranslateIvarVisibility(Visibility) 16904 : ObjCIvarDecl::None; 16905 // Must set ivar's DeclContext to its enclosing interface. 16906 ObjCContainerDecl *EnclosingDecl = cast<ObjCContainerDecl>(CurContext); 16907 if (!EnclosingDecl || EnclosingDecl->isInvalidDecl()) 16908 return nullptr; 16909 ObjCContainerDecl *EnclosingContext; 16910 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPDecl = 16911 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) { 16912 if (LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.isFragile()) { 16913 // Case of ivar declared in an implementation. Context is that of its class. 16914 EnclosingContext = IMPDecl->getClassInterface(); 16915 assert(EnclosingContext && "Implementation has no class interface!"); 16916 } 16917 else 16918 EnclosingContext = EnclosingDecl; 16919 } else { 16920 if (ObjCCategoryDecl *CDecl = 16921 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) { 16922 if (LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.isFragile() || !CDecl->IsClassExtension()) { 16923 Diag(Loc, diag::err_misplaced_ivar) << CDecl->IsClassExtension(); 16924 return nullptr; 16925 } 16926 } 16927 EnclosingContext = EnclosingDecl; 16928 } 16929 16930 // Construct the decl. 16931 ObjCIvarDecl *NewID = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(Context, EnclosingContext, 16932 DeclStart, Loc, II, T, 16933 TInfo, ac, (Expr *)BitfieldWidth); 16934 16935 if (II) { 16936 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = LookupSingleName(S, II, Loc, LookupMemberName, 16937 ForVisibleRedeclaration); 16938 if (PrevDecl && isDeclInScope(PrevDecl, EnclosingContext, S) 16939 && !isa<TagDecl>(PrevDecl)) { 16940 Diag(Loc, diag::err_duplicate_member) << II; 16941 Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 16942 NewID->setInvalidDecl(); 16943 } 16944 } 16945 16946 // Process attributes attached to the ivar. 16947 ProcessDeclAttributes(S, NewID, D); 16948 16949 if (D.isInvalidType()) 16950 NewID->setInvalidDecl(); 16951 16952 // In ARC, infer 'retaining' for ivars of retainable type. 16953 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && inferObjCARCLifetime(NewID)) 16954 NewID->setInvalidDecl(); 16955 16956 if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified()) 16957 NewID->setModulePrivate(); 16958 16959 if (II) { 16960 // FIXME: When interfaces are DeclContexts, we'll need to add 16961 // these to the interface. 16962 S->AddDecl(NewID); 16963 IdResolver.AddDecl(NewID); 16964 } 16965 16966 if (LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.isNonFragile() && 16967 !NewID->isInvalidDecl() && isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) 16968 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivars_in_interface); 16969 16970 return NewID; 16971 } 16972 16973 /// ActOnLastBitfield - This routine handles synthesized bitfields rules for 16974 /// class and class extensions. For every class \@interface and class 16975 /// extension \@interface, if the last ivar is a bitfield of any type, 16976 /// then add an implicit `char :0` ivar to the end of that interface. 16977 void Sema::ActOnLastBitfield(SourceLocation DeclLoc, 16978 SmallVectorImpl<Decl *> &AllIvarDecls) { 16979 if (LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.isFragile() || AllIvarDecls.empty()) 16980 return; 16981 16982 Decl *ivarDecl = AllIvarDecls[AllIvarDecls.size()-1]; 16983 ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = cast<ObjCIvarDecl>(ivarDecl); 16984 16985 if (!Ivar->isBitField() || Ivar->isZeroLengthBitField(Context)) 16986 return; 16987 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(CurContext); 16988 if (!ID) { 16989 if (ObjCCategoryDecl *CD = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(CurContext)) { 16990 if (!CD->IsClassExtension()) 16991 return; 16992 } 16993 // No need to add this to end of @implementation. 16994 else 16995 return; 16996 } 16997 // All conditions are met. Add a new bitfield to the tail end of ivars. 16998 llvm::APInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), 0); 16999 Expr * BW = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy, DeclLoc); 17000 17001 Ivar = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(Context, cast<ObjCContainerDecl>(CurContext), 17002 DeclLoc, DeclLoc, nullptr, 17003 Context.CharTy, 17004 Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(Context.CharTy, 17005 DeclLoc), 17006 ObjCIvarDecl::Private, BW, 17007 true); 17008 AllIvarDecls.push_back(Ivar); 17009 } 17010 17011 void Sema::ActOnFields(Scope *S, SourceLocation RecLoc, Decl *EnclosingDecl, 17012 ArrayRef<Decl *> Fields, SourceLocation LBrac, 17013 SourceLocation RBrac, 17014 const ParsedAttributesView &Attrs) { 17015 assert(EnclosingDecl && "missing record or interface decl"); 17016 17017 // If this is an Objective-C @implementation or category and we have 17018 // new fields here we should reset the layout of the interface since 17019 // it will now change. 17020 if (!Fields.empty() && isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) { 17021 ObjCContainerDecl *DC = cast<ObjCContainerDecl>(EnclosingDecl); 17022 switch (DC->getKind()) { 17023 default: break; 17024 case Decl::ObjCCategory: 17025 Context.ResetObjCLayout(cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(DC)->getClassInterface()); 17026 break; 17027 case Decl::ObjCImplementation: 17028 Context. 17029 ResetObjCLayout(cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(DC)->getClassInterface()); 17030 break; 17031 } 17032 } 17033 17034 RecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(EnclosingDecl); 17035 CXXRecordDecl *CXXRecord = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(EnclosingDecl); 17036 17037 // Start counting up the number of named members; make sure to include 17038 // members of anonymous structs and unions in the total. 17039 unsigned NumNamedMembers = 0; 17040 if (Record) { 17041 for (const auto *I : Record->decls()) { 17042 if (const auto *IFD = dyn_cast<IndirectFieldDecl>(I)) 17043 if (IFD->getDeclName()) 17044 ++NumNamedMembers; 17045 } 17046 } 17047 17048 // Verify that all the fields are okay. 17049 SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 32> RecFields; 17050 17051 for (ArrayRef<Decl *>::iterator i = Fields.begin(), end = Fields.end(); 17052 i != end; ++i) { 17053 FieldDecl *FD = cast<FieldDecl>(*i); 17054 17055 // Get the type for the field. 17056 const Type *FDTy = FD->getType().getTypePtr(); 17057 17058 if (!FD->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) { 17059 // Remember all fields written by the user. 17060 RecFields.push_back(FD); 17061 } 17062 17063 // If the field is already invalid for some reason, don't emit more 17064 // diagnostics about it. 17065 if (FD->isInvalidDecl()) { 17066 EnclosingDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 17067 continue; 17068 } 17069 17070 // C99 6.7.2.1p2: 17071 // A structure or union shall not contain a member with 17072 // incomplete or function type (hence, a structure shall not 17073 // contain an instance of itself, but may contain a pointer to 17074 // an instance of itself), except that the last member of a 17075 // structure with more than one named member may have incomplete 17076 // array type; such a structure (and any union containing, 17077 // possibly recursively, a member that is such a structure) 17078 // shall not be a member of a structure or an element of an 17079 // array. 17080 bool IsLastField = (i + 1 == Fields.end()); 17081 if (FDTy->isFunctionType()) { 17082 // Field declared as a function. 17083 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_field_declared_as_function) 17084 << FD->getDeclName(); 17085 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 17086 EnclosingDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 17087 continue; 17088 } else if (FDTy->isIncompleteArrayType() && 17089 (Record || isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(EnclosingDecl))) { 17090 if (Record) { 17091 // Flexible array member. 17092 // Microsoft and g++ is more permissive regarding flexible array. 17093 // It will accept flexible array in union and also 17094 // as the sole element of a struct/class. 17095 unsigned DiagID = 0; 17096 if (!Record->isUnion() && !IsLastField) { 17097 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_flexible_array_not_at_end) 17098 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType() << Record->getTagKind(); 17099 Diag((*(i + 1))->getLocation(), diag::note_next_field_declaration); 17100 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 17101 EnclosingDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 17102 continue; 17103 } else if (Record->isUnion()) 17104 DiagID = getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt 17105 ? diag::ext_flexible_array_union_ms 17106 : getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 17107 ? diag::ext_flexible_array_union_gnu 17108 : diag::err_flexible_array_union; 17109 else if (NumNamedMembers < 1) 17110 DiagID = getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt 17111 ? diag::ext_flexible_array_empty_aggregate_ms 17112 : getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 17113 ? diag::ext_flexible_array_empty_aggregate_gnu 17114 : diag::err_flexible_array_empty_aggregate; 17115 17116 if (DiagID) 17117 Diag(FD->getLocation(), DiagID) << FD->getDeclName() 17118 << Record->getTagKind(); 17119 // While the layout of types that contain virtual bases is not specified 17120 // by the C++ standard, both the Itanium and Microsoft C++ ABIs place 17121 // virtual bases after the derived members. This would make a flexible 17122 // array member declared at the end of an object not adjacent to the end 17123 // of the type. 17124 if (CXXRecord && CXXRecord->getNumVBases() != 0) 17125 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_flexible_array_virtual_base) 17126 << FD->getDeclName() << Record->getTagKind(); 17127 if (!getLangOpts().C99) 17128 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::ext_c99_flexible_array_member) 17129 << FD->getDeclName() << Record->getTagKind(); 17130 17131 // If the element type has a non-trivial destructor, we would not 17132 // implicitly destroy the elements, so disallow it for now. 17133 // 17134 // FIXME: GCC allows this. We should probably either implicitly delete 17135 // the destructor of the containing class, or just allow this. 17136 QualType BaseElem = Context.getBaseElementType(FD->getType()); 17137 if (!BaseElem->isDependentType() && BaseElem.isDestructedType()) { 17138 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_flexible_array_has_nontrivial_dtor) 17139 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType(); 17140 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 17141 EnclosingDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 17142 continue; 17143 } 17144 // Okay, we have a legal flexible array member at the end of the struct. 17145 Record->setHasFlexibleArrayMember(true); 17146 } else { 17147 // In ObjCContainerDecl ivars with incomplete array type are accepted, 17148 // unless they are followed by another ivar. That check is done 17149 // elsewhere, after synthesized ivars are known. 17150 } 17151 } else if (!FDTy->isDependentType() && 17152 RequireCompleteSizedType( 17153 FD->getLocation(), FD->getType(), 17154 diag::err_field_incomplete_or_sizeless)) { 17155 // Incomplete type 17156 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 17157 EnclosingDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 17158 continue; 17159 } else if (const RecordType *FDTTy = FDTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { 17160 if (Record && FDTTy->getDecl()->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) { 17161 // A type which contains a flexible array member is considered to be a 17162 // flexible array member. 17163 Record->setHasFlexibleArrayMember(true); 17164 if (!Record->isUnion()) { 17165 // If this is a struct/class and this is not the last element, reject 17166 // it. Note that GCC supports variable sized arrays in the middle of 17167 // structures. 17168 if (!IsLastField) 17169 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::ext_variable_sized_type_in_struct) 17170 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType(); 17171 else { 17172 // We support flexible arrays at the end of structs in 17173 // other structs as an extension. 17174 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::ext_flexible_array_in_struct) 17175 << FD->getDeclName(); 17176 } 17177 } 17178 } 17179 if (isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(EnclosingDecl) && 17180 RequireNonAbstractType(FD->getLocation(), FD->getType(), 17181 diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, 17182 AbstractIvarType)) { 17183 // Ivars can not have abstract class types 17184 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 17185 } 17186 if (Record && FDTTy->getDecl()->hasObjectMember()) 17187 Record->setHasObjectMember(true); 17188 if (Record && FDTTy->getDecl()->hasVolatileMember()) 17189 Record->setHasVolatileMember(true); 17190 } else if (FDTy->isObjCObjectType()) { 17191 /// A field cannot be an Objective-c object 17192 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_statically_allocated_object) 17193 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FD->getLocation(), "*"); 17194 QualType T = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(FD->getType()); 17195 FD->setType(T); 17196 } else if (Record && Record->isUnion() && 17197 FD->getType().hasNonTrivialObjCLifetime() && 17198 getSourceManager().isInSystemHeader(FD->getLocation()) && 17199 !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !FD->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>() && 17200 (FD->getType().getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Strong || 17201 !Context.hasDirectOwnershipQualifier(FD->getType()))) { 17202 // For backward compatibility, fields of C unions declared in system 17203 // headers that have non-trivial ObjC ownership qualifications are marked 17204 // as unavailable unless the qualifier is explicit and __strong. This can 17205 // break ABI compatibility between programs compiled with ARC and MRR, but 17206 // is a better option than rejecting programs using those unions under 17207 // ARC. 17208 FD->addAttr(UnavailableAttr::CreateImplicit( 17209 Context, "", UnavailableAttr::IR_ARCFieldWithOwnership, 17210 FD->getLocation())); 17211 } else if (getLangOpts().ObjC && 17212 getLangOpts().getGC() != LangOptions::NonGC && Record && 17213 !Record->hasObjectMember()) { 17214 if (FD->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() || 17215 FD->getType().isObjCGCStrong()) 17216 Record->setHasObjectMember(true); 17217 else if (Context.getAsArrayType(FD->getType())) { 17218 QualType BaseType = Context.getBaseElementType(FD->getType()); 17219 if (BaseType->isRecordType() && 17220 BaseType->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->hasObjectMember()) 17221 Record->setHasObjectMember(true); 17222 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || 17223 BaseType.isObjCGCStrong()) 17224 Record->setHasObjectMember(true); 17225 } 17226 } 17227 17228 if (Record && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 17229 !shouldIgnoreForRecordTriviality(FD)) { 17230 QualType FT = FD->getType(); 17231 if (FT.isNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitialize()) { 17232 Record->setNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitialize(true); 17233 if (FT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion() || 17234 Record->isUnion()) 17235 Record->setHasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion(true); 17236 } 17237 QualType::PrimitiveCopyKind PCK = FT.isNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopy(); 17238 if (PCK != QualType::PCK_Trivial && PCK != QualType::PCK_VolatileTrivial) { 17239 Record->setNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopy(true); 17240 if (FT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion() || Record->isUnion()) 17241 Record->setHasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion(true); 17242 } 17243 if (FT.isDestructedType()) { 17244 Record->setNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestroy(true); 17245 Record->setParamDestroyedInCallee(true); 17246 if (FT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() || Record->isUnion()) 17247 Record->setHasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion(true); 17248 } 17249 17250 if (const auto *RT = FT->getAs<RecordType>()) { 17251 if (RT->getDecl()->getArgPassingRestrictions() == 17252 RecordDecl::APK_CanNeverPassInRegs) 17253 Record->setArgPassingRestrictions(RecordDecl::APK_CanNeverPassInRegs); 17254 } else if (FT.getQualifiers().getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Weak) 17255 Record->setArgPassingRestrictions(RecordDecl::APK_CanNeverPassInRegs); 17256 } 17257 17258 if (Record && FD->getType().isVolatileQualified()) 17259 Record->setHasVolatileMember(true); 17260 // Keep track of the number of named members. 17261 if (FD->getIdentifier()) 17262 ++NumNamedMembers; 17263 } 17264 17265 // Okay, we successfully defined 'Record'. 17266 if (Record) { 17267 bool Completed = false; 17268 if (CXXRecord) { 17269 if (!CXXRecord->isInvalidDecl()) { 17270 // Set access bits correctly on the directly-declared conversions. 17271 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator 17272 I = CXXRecord->conversion_begin(), 17273 E = CXXRecord->conversion_end(); I != E; ++I) 17274 I.setAccess((*I)->getAccess()); 17275 } 17276 17277 // Add any implicitly-declared members to this class. 17278 AddImplicitlyDeclaredMembersToClass(CXXRecord); 17279 17280 if (!CXXRecord->isDependentType()) { 17281 if (!CXXRecord->isInvalidDecl()) { 17282 // If we have virtual base classes, we may end up finding multiple 17283 // final overriders for a given virtual function. Check for this 17284 // problem now. 17285 if (CXXRecord->getNumVBases()) { 17286 CXXFinalOverriderMap FinalOverriders; 17287 CXXRecord->getFinalOverriders(FinalOverriders); 17288 17289 for (CXXFinalOverriderMap::iterator M = FinalOverriders.begin(), 17290 MEnd = FinalOverriders.end(); 17291 M != MEnd; ++M) { 17292 for (OverridingMethods::iterator SO = M->second.begin(), 17293 SOEnd = M->second.end(); 17294 SO != SOEnd; ++SO) { 17295 assert(SO->second.size() > 0 && 17296 "Virtual function without overriding functions?"); 17297 if (SO->second.size() == 1) 17298 continue; 17299 17300 // C++ [class.virtual]p2: 17301 // In a derived class, if a virtual member function of a base 17302 // class subobject has more than one final overrider the 17303 // program is ill-formed. 17304 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::err_multiple_final_overriders) 17305 << (const NamedDecl *)M->first << Record; 17306 Diag(M->first->getLocation(), 17307 diag::note_overridden_virtual_function); 17308 for (OverridingMethods::overriding_iterator 17309 OM = SO->second.begin(), 17310 OMEnd = SO->second.end(); 17311 OM != OMEnd; ++OM) 17312 Diag(OM->Method->getLocation(), diag::note_final_overrider) 17313 << (const NamedDecl *)M->first << OM->Method->getParent(); 17314 17315 Record->setInvalidDecl(); 17316 } 17317 } 17318 CXXRecord->completeDefinition(&FinalOverriders); 17319 Completed = true; 17320 } 17321 } 17322 } 17323 } 17324 17325 if (!Completed) 17326 Record->completeDefinition(); 17327 17328 // Handle attributes before checking the layout. 17329 ProcessDeclAttributeList(S, Record, Attrs); 17330 17331 // We may have deferred checking for a deleted destructor. Check now. 17332 if (CXXRecord) { 17333 auto *Dtor = CXXRecord->getDestructor(); 17334 if (Dtor && Dtor->isImplicit() && 17335 ShouldDeleteSpecialMember(Dtor, CXXDestructor)) { 17336 CXXRecord->setImplicitDestructorIsDeleted(); 17337 SetDeclDeleted(Dtor, CXXRecord->getLocation()); 17338 } 17339 } 17340 17341 if (Record->hasAttrs()) { 17342 CheckAlignasUnderalignment(Record); 17343 17344 if (const MSInheritanceAttr *IA = Record->getAttr<MSInheritanceAttr>()) 17345 checkMSInheritanceAttrOnDefinition(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record), 17346 IA->getRange(), IA->getBestCase(), 17347 IA->getInheritanceModel()); 17348 } 17349 17350 // Check if the structure/union declaration is a type that can have zero 17351 // size in C. For C this is a language extension, for C++ it may cause 17352 // compatibility problems. 17353 bool CheckForZeroSize; 17354 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 17355 CheckForZeroSize = true; 17356 } else { 17357 // For C++ filter out types that cannot be referenced in C code. 17358 CXXRecordDecl *CXXRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record); 17359 CheckForZeroSize = 17360 CXXRecord->getLexicalDeclContext()->isExternCContext() && 17361 !CXXRecord->isDependentType() && !inTemplateInstantiation() && 17362 CXXRecord->isCLike(); 17363 } 17364 if (CheckForZeroSize) { 17365 bool ZeroSize = true; 17366 bool IsEmpty = true; 17367 unsigned NonBitFields = 0; 17368 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator I = Record->field_begin(), 17369 E = Record->field_end(); 17370 (NonBitFields == 0 || ZeroSize) && I != E; ++I) { 17371 IsEmpty = false; 17372 if (I->isUnnamedBitfield()) { 17373 if (!I->isZeroLengthBitField(Context)) 17374 ZeroSize = false; 17375 } else { 17376 ++NonBitFields; 17377 QualType FieldType = I->getType(); 17378 if (FieldType->isIncompleteType() || 17379 !Context.getTypeSizeInChars(FieldType).isZero()) 17380 ZeroSize = false; 17381 } 17382 } 17383 17384 // Empty structs are an extension in C (C99 6.7.2.1p7). They are 17385 // allowed in C++, but warn if its declaration is inside 17386 // extern "C" block. 17387 if (ZeroSize) { 17388 Diag(RecLoc, getLangOpts().CPlusPlus ? 17389 diag::warn_zero_size_struct_union_in_extern_c : 17390 diag::warn_zero_size_struct_union_compat) 17391 << IsEmpty << Record->isUnion() << (NonBitFields > 1); 17392 } 17393 17394 // Structs without named members are extension in C (C99 6.7.2.1p7), 17395 // but are accepted by GCC. 17396 if (NonBitFields == 0 && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 17397 Diag(RecLoc, IsEmpty ? diag::ext_empty_struct_union : 17398 diag::ext_no_named_members_in_struct_union) 17399 << Record->isUnion(); 17400 } 17401 } 17402 } else { 17403 ObjCIvarDecl **ClsFields = 17404 reinterpret_cast<ObjCIvarDecl**>(RecFields.data()); 17405 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) { 17406 ID->setEndOfDefinitionLoc(RBrac); 17407 // Add ivar's to class's DeclContext. 17408 for (unsigned i = 0, e = RecFields.size(); i != e; ++i) { 17409 ClsFields[i]->setLexicalDeclContext(ID); 17410 ID->addDecl(ClsFields[i]); 17411 } 17412 // Must enforce the rule that ivars in the base classes may not be 17413 // duplicates. 17414 if (ID->getSuperClass()) 17415 DiagnoseDuplicateIvars(ID, ID->getSuperClass()); 17416 } else if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPDecl = 17417 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) { 17418 assert(IMPDecl && "ActOnFields - missing ObjCImplementationDecl"); 17419 for (unsigned I = 0, N = RecFields.size(); I != N; ++I) 17420 // Ivar declared in @implementation never belongs to the implementation. 17421 // Only it is in implementation's lexical context. 17422 ClsFields[I]->setLexicalDeclContext(IMPDecl); 17423 CheckImplementationIvars(IMPDecl, ClsFields, RecFields.size(), RBrac); 17424 IMPDecl->setIvarLBraceLoc(LBrac); 17425 IMPDecl->setIvarRBraceLoc(RBrac); 17426 } else if (ObjCCategoryDecl *CDecl = 17427 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) { 17428 // case of ivars in class extension; all other cases have been 17429 // reported as errors elsewhere. 17430 // FIXME. Class extension does not have a LocEnd field. 17431 // CDecl->setLocEnd(RBrac); 17432 // Add ivar's to class extension's DeclContext. 17433 // Diagnose redeclaration of private ivars. 17434 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CDecl->getClassInterface(); 17435 for (unsigned i = 0, e = RecFields.size(); i != e; ++i) { 17436 if (IDecl) { 17437 if (const ObjCIvarDecl *ClsIvar = 17438 IDecl->getIvarDecl(ClsFields[i]->getIdentifier())) { 17439 Diag(ClsFields[i]->getLocation(), 17440 diag::err_duplicate_ivar_declaration); 17441 Diag(ClsIvar->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 17442 continue; 17443 } 17444 for (const auto *Ext : IDecl->known_extensions()) { 17445 if (const ObjCIvarDecl *ClsExtIvar 17446 = Ext->getIvarDecl(ClsFields[i]->getIdentifier())) { 17447 Diag(ClsFields[i]->getLocation(), 17448 diag::err_duplicate_ivar_declaration); 17449 Diag(ClsExtIvar->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 17450 continue; 17451 } 17452 } 17453 } 17454 ClsFields[i]->setLexicalDeclContext(CDecl); 17455 CDecl->addDecl(ClsFields[i]); 17456 } 17457 CDecl->setIvarLBraceLoc(LBrac); 17458 CDecl->setIvarRBraceLoc(RBrac); 17459 } 17460 } 17461 } 17462 17463 /// Determine whether the given integral value is representable within 17464 /// the given type T. 17465 static bool isRepresentableIntegerValue(ASTContext &Context, 17466 llvm::APSInt &Value, 17467 QualType T) { 17468 assert((T->isIntegralType(Context) || T->isEnumeralType()) && 17469 "Integral type required!"); 17470 unsigned BitWidth = Context.getIntWidth(T); 17471 17472 if (Value.isUnsigned() || Value.isNonNegative()) { 17473 if (T->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType()) 17474 --BitWidth; 17475 return Value.getActiveBits() <= BitWidth; 17476 } 17477 return Value.getMinSignedBits() <= BitWidth; 17478 } 17479 17480 // Given an integral type, return the next larger integral type 17481 // (or a NULL type of no such type exists). 17482 static QualType getNextLargerIntegralType(ASTContext &Context, QualType T) { 17483 // FIXME: Int128/UInt128 support, which also needs to be introduced into 17484 // enum checking below. 17485 assert((T->isIntegralType(Context) || 17486 T->isEnumeralType()) && "Integral type required!"); 17487 const unsigned NumTypes = 4; 17488 QualType SignedIntegralTypes[NumTypes] = { 17489 Context.ShortTy, Context.IntTy, Context.LongTy, Context.LongLongTy 17490 }; 17491 QualType UnsignedIntegralTypes[NumTypes] = { 17492 Context.UnsignedShortTy, Context.UnsignedIntTy, Context.UnsignedLongTy, 17493 Context.UnsignedLongLongTy 17494 }; 17495 17496 unsigned BitWidth = Context.getTypeSize(T); 17497 QualType *Types = T->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType()? SignedIntegralTypes 17498 : UnsignedIntegralTypes; 17499 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumTypes; ++I) 17500 if (Context.getTypeSize(Types[I]) > BitWidth) 17501 return Types[I]; 17502 17503 return QualType(); 17504 } 17505 17506 EnumConstantDecl *Sema::CheckEnumConstant(EnumDecl *Enum, 17507 EnumConstantDecl *LastEnumConst, 17508 SourceLocation IdLoc, 17509 IdentifierInfo *Id, 17510 Expr *Val) { 17511 unsigned IntWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth(); 17512 llvm::APSInt EnumVal(IntWidth); 17513 QualType EltTy; 17514 17515 if (Val && DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(Val, UPPC_EnumeratorValue)) 17516 Val = nullptr; 17517 17518 if (Val) 17519 Val = DefaultLvalueConversion(Val).get(); 17520 17521 if (Val) { 17522 if (Enum->isDependentType() || Val->isTypeDependent()) 17523 EltTy = Context.DependentTy; 17524 else { 17525 // FIXME: We don't allow folding in C++11 mode for an enum with a fixed 17526 // underlying type, but do allow it in all other contexts. 17527 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && Enum->isFixed()) { 17528 // C++11 [dcl.enum]p5: If the underlying type is fixed, [...] the 17529 // constant-expression in the enumerator-definition shall be a converted 17530 // constant expression of the underlying type. 17531 EltTy = Enum->getIntegerType(); 17532 ExprResult Converted = 17533 CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Val, EltTy, EnumVal, 17534 CCEK_Enumerator); 17535 if (Converted.isInvalid()) 17536 Val = nullptr; 17537 else 17538 Val = Converted.get(); 17539 } else if (!Val->isValueDependent() && 17540 !(Val = 17541 VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Val, &EnumVal, AllowFold) 17542 .get())) { 17543 // C99 6.7.2.2p2: Make sure we have an integer constant expression. 17544 } else { 17545 if (Enum->isComplete()) { 17546 EltTy = Enum->getIntegerType(); 17547 17548 // In Obj-C and Microsoft mode, require the enumeration value to be 17549 // representable in the underlying type of the enumeration. In C++11, 17550 // we perform a non-narrowing conversion as part of converted constant 17551 // expression checking. 17552 if (!isRepresentableIntegerValue(Context, EnumVal, EltTy)) { 17553 if (Context.getTargetInfo() 17554 .getTriple() 17555 .isWindowsMSVCEnvironment()) { 17556 Diag(IdLoc, diag::ext_enumerator_too_large) << EltTy; 17557 } else { 17558 Diag(IdLoc, diag::err_enumerator_too_large) << EltTy; 17559 } 17560 } 17561 17562 // Cast to the underlying type. 17563 Val = ImpCastExprToType(Val, EltTy, 17564 EltTy->isBooleanType() ? CK_IntegralToBoolean 17565 : CK_IntegralCast) 17566 .get(); 17567 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 17568 // C++11 [dcl.enum]p5: 17569 // If the underlying type is not fixed, the type of each enumerator 17570 // is the type of its initializing value: 17571 // - If an initializer is specified for an enumerator, the 17572 // initializing value has the same type as the expression. 17573 EltTy = Val->getType(); 17574 } else { 17575 // C99 6.7.2.2p2: 17576 // The expression that defines the value of an enumeration constant 17577 // shall be an integer constant expression that has a value 17578 // representable as an int. 17579 17580 // Complain if the value is not representable in an int. 17581 if (!isRepresentableIntegerValue(Context, EnumVal, Context.IntTy)) 17582 Diag(IdLoc, diag::ext_enum_value_not_int) 17583 << EnumVal.toString(10) << Val->getSourceRange() 17584 << (EnumVal.isUnsigned() || EnumVal.isNonNegative()); 17585 else if (!Context.hasSameType(Val->getType(), Context.IntTy)) { 17586 // Force the type of the expression to 'int'. 17587 Val = ImpCastExprToType(Val, Context.IntTy, CK_IntegralCast).get(); 17588 } 17589 EltTy = Val->getType(); 17590 } 17591 } 17592 } 17593 } 17594 17595 if (!Val) { 17596 if (Enum->isDependentType()) 17597 EltTy = Context.DependentTy; 17598 else if (!LastEnumConst) { 17599 // C++0x [dcl.enum]p5: 17600 // If the underlying type is not fixed, the type of each enumerator 17601 // is the type of its initializing value: 17602 // - If no initializer is specified for the first enumerator, the 17603 // initializing value has an unspecified integral type. 17604 // 17605 // GCC uses 'int' for its unspecified integral type, as does 17606 // C99 6.7.2.2p3. 17607 if (Enum->isFixed()) { 17608 EltTy = Enum->getIntegerType(); 17609 } 17610 else { 17611 EltTy = Context.IntTy; 17612 } 17613 } else { 17614 // Assign the last value + 1. 17615 EnumVal = LastEnumConst->getInitVal(); 17616 ++EnumVal; 17617 EltTy = LastEnumConst->getType(); 17618 17619 // Check for overflow on increment. 17620 if (EnumVal < LastEnumConst->getInitVal()) { 17621 // C++0x [dcl.enum]p5: 17622 // If the underlying type is not fixed, the type of each enumerator 17623 // is the type of its initializing value: 17624 // 17625 // - Otherwise the type of the initializing value is the same as 17626 // the type of the initializing value of the preceding enumerator 17627 // unless the incremented value is not representable in that type, 17628 // in which case the type is an unspecified integral type 17629 // sufficient to contain the incremented value. If no such type 17630 // exists, the program is ill-formed. 17631 QualType T = getNextLargerIntegralType(Context, EltTy); 17632 if (T.isNull() || Enum->isFixed()) { 17633 // There is no integral type larger enough to represent this 17634 // value. Complain, then allow the value to wrap around. 17635 EnumVal = LastEnumConst->getInitVal(); 17636 EnumVal = EnumVal.zext(EnumVal.getBitWidth() * 2); 17637 ++EnumVal; 17638 if (Enum->isFixed()) 17639 // When the underlying type is fixed, this is ill-formed. 17640 Diag(IdLoc, diag::err_enumerator_wrapped) 17641 << EnumVal.toString(10) 17642 << EltTy; 17643 else 17644 Diag(IdLoc, diag::ext_enumerator_increment_too_large) 17645 << EnumVal.toString(10); 17646 } else { 17647 EltTy = T; 17648 } 17649 17650 // Retrieve the last enumerator's value, extent that type to the 17651 // type that is supposed to be large enough to represent the incremented 17652 // value, then increment. 17653 EnumVal = LastEnumConst->getInitVal(); 17654 EnumVal.setIsSigned(EltTy->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType()); 17655 EnumVal = EnumVal.zextOrTrunc(Context.getIntWidth(EltTy)); 17656 ++EnumVal; 17657 17658 // If we're not in C++, diagnose the overflow of enumerator values, 17659 // which in C99 means that the enumerator value is not representable in 17660 // an int (C99 6.7.2.2p2). However, we support GCC's extension that 17661 // permits enumerator values that are representable in some larger 17662 // integral type. 17663 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !T.isNull()) 17664 Diag(IdLoc, diag::warn_enum_value_overflow); 17665 } else if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 17666 !isRepresentableIntegerValue(Context, EnumVal, EltTy)) { 17667 // Enforce C99 6.7.2.2p2 even when we compute the next value. 17668 Diag(IdLoc, diag::ext_enum_value_not_int) 17669 << EnumVal.toString(10) << 1; 17670 } 17671 } 17672 } 17673 17674 if (!EltTy->isDependentType()) { 17675 // Make the enumerator value match the signedness and size of the 17676 // enumerator's type. 17677 EnumVal = EnumVal.extOrTrunc(Context.getIntWidth(EltTy)); 17678 EnumVal.setIsSigned(EltTy->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType()); 17679 } 17680 17681 return EnumConstantDecl::Create(Context, Enum, IdLoc, Id, EltTy, 17682 Val, EnumVal); 17683 } 17684 17685 Sema::SkipBodyInfo Sema::shouldSkipAnonEnumBody(Scope *S, IdentifierInfo *II, 17686 SourceLocation IILoc) { 17687 if (!(getLangOpts().Modules || getLangOpts().ModulesLocalVisibility) || 17688 !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 17689 return SkipBodyInfo(); 17690 17691 // We have an anonymous enum definition. Look up the first enumerator to 17692 // determine if we should merge the definition with an existing one and 17693 // skip the body. 17694 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = LookupSingleName(S, II, IILoc, LookupOrdinaryName, 17695 forRedeclarationInCurContext()); 17696 auto *PrevECD = dyn_cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(PrevDecl); 17697 if (!PrevECD) 17698 return SkipBodyInfo(); 17699 17700 EnumDecl *PrevED = cast<EnumDecl>(PrevECD->getDeclContext()); 17701 NamedDecl *Hidden; 17702 if (!PrevED->getDeclName() && !hasVisibleDefinition(PrevED, &Hidden)) { 17703 SkipBodyInfo Skip; 17704 Skip.Previous = Hidden; 17705 return Skip; 17706 } 17707 17708 return SkipBodyInfo(); 17709 } 17710 17711 Decl *Sema::ActOnEnumConstant(Scope *S, Decl *theEnumDecl, Decl *lastEnumConst, 17712 SourceLocation IdLoc, IdentifierInfo *Id, 17713 const ParsedAttributesView &Attrs, 17714 SourceLocation EqualLoc, Expr *Val) { 17715 EnumDecl *TheEnumDecl = cast<EnumDecl>(theEnumDecl); 17716 EnumConstantDecl *LastEnumConst = 17717 cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(lastEnumConst); 17718 17719 // The scope passed in may not be a decl scope. Zip up the scope tree until 17720 // we find one that is. 17721 S = getNonFieldDeclScope(S); 17722 17723 // Verify that there isn't already something declared with this name in this 17724 // scope. 17725 LookupResult R(*this, Id, IdLoc, LookupOrdinaryName, ForVisibleRedeclaration); 17726 LookupName(R, S); 17727 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>(); 17728 17729 if (PrevDecl && PrevDecl->isTemplateParameter()) { 17730 // Maybe we will complain about the shadowed template parameter. 17731 DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow(IdLoc, PrevDecl); 17732 // Just pretend that we didn't see the previous declaration. 17733 PrevDecl = nullptr; 17734 } 17735 17736 // C++ [class.mem]p15: 17737 // If T is the name of a class, then each of the following shall have a name 17738 // different from T: 17739 // - every enumerator of every member of class T that is an unscoped 17740 // enumerated type 17741 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !TheEnumDecl->isScoped()) 17742 DiagnoseClassNameShadow(TheEnumDecl->getDeclContext(), 17743 DeclarationNameInfo(Id, IdLoc)); 17744 17745 EnumConstantDecl *New = 17746 CheckEnumConstant(TheEnumDecl, LastEnumConst, IdLoc, Id, Val); 17747 if (!New) 17748 return nullptr; 17749 17750 if (PrevDecl) { 17751 if (!TheEnumDecl->isScoped() && isa<ValueDecl>(PrevDecl)) { 17752 // Check for other kinds of shadowing not already handled. 17753 CheckShadow(New, PrevDecl, R); 17754 } 17755 17756 // When in C++, we may get a TagDecl with the same name; in this case the 17757 // enum constant will 'hide' the tag. 17758 assert((getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !isa<TagDecl>(PrevDecl)) && 17759 "Received TagDecl when not in C++!"); 17760 if (!isa<TagDecl>(PrevDecl) && isDeclInScope(PrevDecl, CurContext, S)) { 17761 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(PrevDecl)) 17762 Diag(IdLoc, diag::err_redefinition_of_enumerator) << Id; 17763 else 17764 Diag(IdLoc, diag::err_redefinition) << Id; 17765 notePreviousDefinition(PrevDecl, IdLoc); 17766 return nullptr; 17767 } 17768 } 17769 17770 // Process attributes. 17771 ProcessDeclAttributeList(S, New, Attrs); 17772 AddPragmaAttributes(S, New); 17773 17774 // Register this decl in the current scope stack. 17775 New->setAccess(TheEnumDecl->getAccess()); 17776 PushOnScopeChains(New, S); 17777 17778 ActOnDocumentableDecl(New); 17779 17780 return New; 17781 } 17782 17783 // Returns true when the enum initial expression does not trigger the 17784 // duplicate enum warning. A few common cases are exempted as follows: 17785 // Element2 = Element1 17786 // Element2 = Element1 + 1 17787 // Element2 = Element1 - 1 17788 // Where Element2 and Element1 are from the same enum. 17789 static bool ValidDuplicateEnum(EnumConstantDecl *ECD, EnumDecl *Enum) { 17790 Expr *InitExpr = ECD->getInitExpr(); 17791 if (!InitExpr) 17792 return true; 17793 InitExpr = InitExpr->IgnoreImpCasts(); 17794 17795 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(InitExpr)) { 17796 if (!BO->isAdditiveOp()) 17797 return true; 17798 IntegerLiteral *IL = dyn_cast<IntegerLiteral>(BO->getRHS()); 17799 if (!IL) 17800 return true; 17801 if (IL->getValue() != 1) 17802 return true; 17803 17804 InitExpr = BO->getLHS(); 17805 } 17806 17807 // This checks if the elements are from the same enum. 17808 DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(InitExpr); 17809 if (!DRE) 17810 return true; 17811 17812 EnumConstantDecl *EnumConstant = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(DRE->getDecl()); 17813 if (!EnumConstant) 17814 return true; 17815 17816 if (cast<EnumDecl>(TagDecl::castFromDeclContext(ECD->getDeclContext())) != 17817 Enum) 17818 return true; 17819 17820 return false; 17821 } 17822 17823 // Emits a warning when an element is implicitly set a value that 17824 // a previous element has already been set to. 17825 static void CheckForDuplicateEnumValues(Sema &S, ArrayRef<Decl *> Elements, 17826 EnumDecl *Enum, QualType EnumType) { 17827 // Avoid anonymous enums 17828 if (!Enum->getIdentifier()) 17829 return; 17830 17831 // Only check for small enums. 17832 if (Enum->getNumPositiveBits() > 63 || Enum->getNumNegativeBits() > 64) 17833 return; 17834 17835 if (S.Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_duplicate_enum_values, Enum->getLocation())) 17836 return; 17837 17838 typedef SmallVector<EnumConstantDecl *, 3> ECDVector; 17839 typedef SmallVector<std::unique_ptr<ECDVector>, 3> DuplicatesVector; 17840 17841 typedef llvm::PointerUnion<EnumConstantDecl*, ECDVector*> DeclOrVector; 17842 17843 // DenseMaps cannot contain the all ones int64_t value, so use unordered_map. 17844 typedef std::unordered_map<int64_t, DeclOrVector> ValueToVectorMap; 17845 17846 // Use int64_t as a key to avoid needing special handling for map keys. 17847 auto EnumConstantToKey = [](const EnumConstantDecl *D) { 17848 llvm::APSInt Val = D->getInitVal(); 17849 return Val.isSigned() ? Val.getSExtValue() : Val.getZExtValue(); 17850 }; 17851 17852 DuplicatesVector DupVector; 17853 ValueToVectorMap EnumMap; 17854 17855 // Populate the EnumMap with all values represented by enum constants without 17856 // an initializer. 17857 for (auto *Element : Elements) { 17858 EnumConstantDecl *ECD = cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(Element); 17859 17860 // Null EnumConstantDecl means a previous diagnostic has been emitted for 17861 // this constant. Skip this enum since it may be ill-formed. 17862 if (!ECD) { 17863 return; 17864 } 17865 17866 // Constants with initalizers are handled in the next loop. 17867 if (ECD->getInitExpr()) 17868 continue; 17869 17870 // Duplicate values are handled in the next loop. 17871 EnumMap.insert({EnumConstantToKey(ECD), ECD}); 17872 } 17873 17874 if (EnumMap.size() == 0) 17875 return; 17876 17877 // Create vectors for any values that has duplicates. 17878 for (auto *Element : Elements) { 17879 // The last loop returned if any constant was null. 17880 EnumConstantDecl *ECD = cast<EnumConstantDecl>(Element); 17881 if (!ValidDuplicateEnum(ECD, Enum)) 17882 continue; 17883 17884 auto Iter = EnumMap.find(EnumConstantToKey(ECD)); 17885 if (Iter == EnumMap.end()) 17886 continue; 17887 17888 DeclOrVector& Entry = Iter->second; 17889 if (EnumConstantDecl *D = Entry.dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl*>()) { 17890 // Ensure constants are different. 17891 if (D == ECD) 17892 continue; 17893 17894 // Create new vector and push values onto it. 17895 auto Vec = std::make_unique<ECDVector>(); 17896 Vec->push_back(D); 17897 Vec->push_back(ECD); 17898 17899 // Update entry to point to the duplicates vector. 17900 Entry = Vec.get(); 17901 17902 // Store the vector somewhere we can consult later for quick emission of 17903 // diagnostics. 17904 DupVector.emplace_back(std::move(Vec)); 17905 continue; 17906 } 17907 17908 ECDVector *Vec = Entry.get<ECDVector*>(); 17909 // Make sure constants are not added more than once. 17910 if (*Vec->begin() == ECD) 17911 continue; 17912 17913 Vec->push_back(ECD); 17914 } 17915 17916 // Emit diagnostics. 17917 for (const auto &Vec : DupVector) { 17918 assert(Vec->size() > 1 && "ECDVector should have at least 2 elements."); 17919 17920 // Emit warning for one enum constant. 17921 auto *FirstECD = Vec->front(); 17922 S.Diag(FirstECD->getLocation(), diag::warn_duplicate_enum_values) 17923 << FirstECD << FirstECD->getInitVal().toString(10) 17924 << FirstECD->getSourceRange(); 17925 17926 // Emit one note for each of the remaining enum constants with 17927 // the same value. 17928 for (auto *ECD : llvm::make_range(Vec->begin() + 1, Vec->end())) 17929 S.Diag(ECD->getLocation(), diag::note_duplicate_element) 17930 << ECD << ECD->getInitVal().toString(10) 17931 << ECD->getSourceRange(); 17932 } 17933 } 17934 17935 bool Sema::IsValueInFlagEnum(const EnumDecl *ED, const llvm::APInt &Val, 17936 bool AllowMask) const { 17937 assert(ED->isClosedFlag() && "looking for value in non-flag or open enum"); 17938 assert(ED->isCompleteDefinition() && "expected enum definition"); 17939 17940 auto R = FlagBitsCache.insert(std::make_pair(ED, llvm::APInt())); 17941 llvm::APInt &FlagBits = R.first->second; 17942 17943 if (R.second) { 17944 for (auto *E : ED->enumerators()) { 17945 const auto &EVal = E->getInitVal(); 17946 // Only single-bit enumerators introduce new flag values. 17947 if (EVal.isPowerOf2()) 17948 FlagBits = FlagBits.zextOrSelf(EVal.getBitWidth()) | EVal; 17949 } 17950 } 17951 17952 // A value is in a flag enum if either its bits are a subset of the enum's 17953 // flag bits (the first condition) or we are allowing masks and the same is 17954 // true of its complement (the second condition). When masks are allowed, we 17955 // allow the common idiom of ~(enum1 | enum2) to be a valid enum value. 17956 // 17957 // While it's true that any value could be used as a mask, the assumption is 17958 // that a mask will have all of the insignificant bits set. Anything else is 17959 // likely a logic error. 17960 llvm::APInt FlagMask = ~FlagBits.zextOrTrunc(Val.getBitWidth()); 17961 return !(FlagMask & Val) || (AllowMask && !(FlagMask & ~Val)); 17962 } 17963 17964 void Sema::ActOnEnumBody(SourceLocation EnumLoc, SourceRange BraceRange, 17965 Decl *EnumDeclX, ArrayRef<Decl *> Elements, Scope *S, 17966 const ParsedAttributesView &Attrs) { 17967 EnumDecl *Enum = cast<EnumDecl>(EnumDeclX); 17968 QualType EnumType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Enum); 17969 17970 ProcessDeclAttributeList(S, Enum, Attrs); 17971 17972 if (Enum->isDependentType()) { 17973 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Elements.size(); i != e; ++i) { 17974 EnumConstantDecl *ECD = 17975 cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(Elements[i]); 17976 if (!ECD) continue; 17977 17978 ECD->setType(EnumType); 17979 } 17980 17981 Enum->completeDefinition(Context.DependentTy, Context.DependentTy, 0, 0); 17982 return; 17983 } 17984 17985 // TODO: If the result value doesn't fit in an int, it must be a long or long 17986 // long value. ISO C does not support this, but GCC does as an extension, 17987 // emit a warning. 17988 unsigned IntWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth(); 17989 unsigned CharWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getCharWidth(); 17990 unsigned ShortWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getShortWidth(); 17991 17992 // Verify that all the values are okay, compute the size of the values, and 17993 // reverse the list. 17994 unsigned NumNegativeBits = 0; 17995 unsigned NumPositiveBits = 0; 17996 17997 // Keep track of whether all elements have type int. 17998 bool AllElementsInt = true; 17999 18000 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Elements.size(); i != e; ++i) { 18001 EnumConstantDecl *ECD = 18002 cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(Elements[i]); 18003 if (!ECD) continue; // Already issued a diagnostic. 18004 18005 const llvm::APSInt &InitVal = ECD->getInitVal(); 18006 18007 // Keep track of the size of positive and negative values. 18008 if (InitVal.isUnsigned() || InitVal.isNonNegative()) 18009 NumPositiveBits = std::max(NumPositiveBits, 18010 (unsigned)InitVal.getActiveBits()); 18011 else 18012 NumNegativeBits = std::max(NumNegativeBits, 18013 (unsigned)InitVal.getMinSignedBits()); 18014 18015 // Keep track of whether every enum element has type int (very common). 18016 if (AllElementsInt) 18017 AllElementsInt = ECD->getType() == Context.IntTy; 18018 } 18019 18020 // Figure out the type that should be used for this enum. 18021 QualType BestType; 18022 unsigned BestWidth; 18023 18024 // C++0x N3000 [conv.prom]p3: 18025 // An rvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying 18026 // type is not fixed can be converted to an rvalue of the first 18027 // of the following types that can represent all the values of 18028 // the enumeration: int, unsigned int, long int, unsigned long 18029 // int, long long int, or unsigned long long int. 18030 // C99 6.4.4.3p2: 18031 // An identifier declared as an enumeration constant has type int. 18032 // The C99 rule is modified by a gcc extension 18033 QualType BestPromotionType; 18034 18035 bool Packed = Enum->hasAttr<PackedAttr>(); 18036 // -fshort-enums is the equivalent to specifying the packed attribute on all 18037 // enum definitions. 18038 if (LangOpts.ShortEnums) 18039 Packed = true; 18040 18041 // If the enum already has a type because it is fixed or dictated by the 18042 // target, promote that type instead of analyzing the enumerators. 18043 if (Enum->isComplete()) { 18044 BestType = Enum->getIntegerType(); 18045 if (BestType->isPromotableIntegerType()) 18046 BestPromotionType = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(BestType); 18047 else 18048 BestPromotionType = BestType; 18049 18050 BestWidth = Context.getIntWidth(BestType); 18051 } 18052 else if (NumNegativeBits) { 18053 // If there is a negative value, figure out the smallest integer type (of 18054 // int/long/longlong) that fits. 18055 // If it's packed, check also if it fits a char or a short. 18056 if (Packed && NumNegativeBits <= CharWidth && NumPositiveBits < CharWidth) { 18057 BestType = Context.SignedCharTy; 18058 BestWidth = CharWidth; 18059 } else if (Packed && NumNegativeBits <= ShortWidth && 18060 NumPositiveBits < ShortWidth) { 18061 BestType = Context.ShortTy; 18062 BestWidth = ShortWidth; 18063 } else if (NumNegativeBits <= IntWidth && NumPositiveBits < IntWidth) { 18064 BestType = Context.IntTy; 18065 BestWidth = IntWidth; 18066 } else { 18067 BestWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongWidth(); 18068 18069 if (NumNegativeBits <= BestWidth && NumPositiveBits < BestWidth) { 18070 BestType = Context.LongTy; 18071 } else { 18072 BestWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth(); 18073 18074 if (NumNegativeBits > BestWidth || NumPositiveBits >= BestWidth) 18075 Diag(Enum->getLocation(), diag::ext_enum_too_large); 18076 BestType = Context.LongLongTy; 18077 } 18078 } 18079 BestPromotionType = (BestWidth <= IntWidth ? Context.IntTy : BestType); 18080 } else { 18081 // If there is no negative value, figure out the smallest type that fits 18082 // all of the enumerator values. 18083 // If it's packed, check also if it fits a char or a short. 18084 if (Packed && NumPositiveBits <= CharWidth) { 18085 BestType = Context.UnsignedCharTy; 18086 BestPromotionType = Context.IntTy; 18087 BestWidth = CharWidth; 18088 } else if (Packed && NumPositiveBits <= ShortWidth) { 18089 BestType = Context.UnsignedShortTy; 18090 BestPromotionType = Context.IntTy; 18091 BestWidth = ShortWidth; 18092 } else if (NumPositiveBits <= IntWidth) { 18093 BestType = Context.UnsignedIntTy; 18094 BestWidth = IntWidth; 18095 BestPromotionType 18096 = (NumPositiveBits == BestWidth || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 18097 ? Context.UnsignedIntTy : Context.IntTy; 18098 } else if (NumPositiveBits <= 18099 (BestWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongWidth())) { 18100 BestType = Context.UnsignedLongTy; 18101 BestPromotionType 18102 = (NumPositiveBits == BestWidth || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 18103 ? Context.UnsignedLongTy : Context.LongTy; 18104 } else { 18105 BestWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth(); 18106 assert(NumPositiveBits <= BestWidth && 18107 "How could an initializer get larger than ULL?"); 18108 BestType = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy; 18109 BestPromotionType 18110 = (NumPositiveBits == BestWidth || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 18111 ? Context.UnsignedLongLongTy : Context.LongLongTy; 18112 } 18113 } 18114 18115 // Loop over all of the enumerator constants, changing their types to match 18116 // the type of the enum if needed. 18117 for (auto *D : Elements) { 18118 auto *ECD = cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(D); 18119 if (!ECD) continue; // Already issued a diagnostic. 18120 18121 // Standard C says the enumerators have int type, but we allow, as an 18122 // extension, the enumerators to be larger than int size. If each 18123 // enumerator value fits in an int, type it as an int, otherwise type it the 18124 // same as the enumerator decl itself. This means that in "enum { X = 1U }" 18125 // that X has type 'int', not 'unsigned'. 18126 18127 // Determine whether the value fits into an int. 18128 llvm::APSInt InitVal = ECD->getInitVal(); 18129 18130 // If it fits into an integer type, force it. Otherwise force it to match 18131 // the enum decl type. 18132 QualType NewTy; 18133 unsigned NewWidth; 18134 bool NewSign; 18135 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 18136 !Enum->isFixed() && 18137 isRepresentableIntegerValue(Context, InitVal, Context.IntTy)) { 18138 NewTy = Context.IntTy; 18139 NewWidth = IntWidth; 18140 NewSign = true; 18141 } else if (ECD->getType() == BestType) { 18142 // Already the right type! 18143 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 18144 // C++ [dcl.enum]p4: Following the closing brace of an 18145 // enum-specifier, each enumerator has the type of its 18146 // enumeration. 18147 ECD->setType(EnumType); 18148 continue; 18149 } else { 18150 NewTy = BestType; 18151 NewWidth = BestWidth; 18152 NewSign = BestType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType(); 18153 } 18154 18155 // Adjust the APSInt value. 18156 InitVal = InitVal.extOrTrunc(NewWidth); 18157 InitVal.setIsSigned(NewSign); 18158 ECD->setInitVal(InitVal); 18159 18160 // Adjust the Expr initializer and type. 18161 if (ECD->getInitExpr() && 18162 !Context.hasSameType(NewTy, ECD->getInitExpr()->getType())) 18163 ECD->setInitExpr(ImplicitCastExpr::Create( 18164 Context, NewTy, CK_IntegralCast, ECD->getInitExpr(), 18165 /*base paths*/ nullptr, VK_RValue, FPOptionsOverride())); 18166 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 18167 // C++ [dcl.enum]p4: Following the closing brace of an 18168 // enum-specifier, each enumerator has the type of its 18169 // enumeration. 18170 ECD->setType(EnumType); 18171 else 18172 ECD->setType(NewTy); 18173 } 18174 18175 Enum->completeDefinition(BestType, BestPromotionType, 18176 NumPositiveBits, NumNegativeBits); 18177 18178 CheckForDuplicateEnumValues(*this, Elements, Enum, EnumType); 18179 18180 if (Enum->isClosedFlag()) { 18181 for (Decl *D : Elements) { 18182 EnumConstantDecl *ECD = cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(D); 18183 if (!ECD) continue; // Already issued a diagnostic. 18184 18185 llvm::APSInt InitVal = ECD->getInitVal(); 18186 if (InitVal != 0 && !InitVal.isPowerOf2() && 18187 !IsValueInFlagEnum(Enum, InitVal, true)) 18188 Diag(ECD->getLocation(), diag::warn_flag_enum_constant_out_of_range) 18189 << ECD << Enum; 18190 } 18191 } 18192 18193 // Now that the enum type is defined, ensure it's not been underaligned. 18194 if (Enum->hasAttrs()) 18195 CheckAlignasUnderalignment(Enum); 18196 } 18197 18198 Decl *Sema::ActOnFileScopeAsmDecl(Expr *expr, 18199 SourceLocation StartLoc, 18200 SourceLocation EndLoc) { 18201 StringLiteral *AsmString = cast<StringLiteral>(expr); 18202 18203 FileScopeAsmDecl *New = FileScopeAsmDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, 18204 AsmString, StartLoc, 18205 EndLoc); 18206 CurContext->addDecl(New); 18207 return New; 18208 } 18209 18210 void Sema::ActOnPragmaRedefineExtname(IdentifierInfo* Name, 18211 IdentifierInfo* AliasName, 18212 SourceLocation PragmaLoc, 18213 SourceLocation NameLoc, 18214 SourceLocation AliasNameLoc) { 18215 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = LookupSingleName(TUScope, Name, NameLoc, 18216 LookupOrdinaryName); 18217 AttributeCommonInfo Info(AliasName, SourceRange(AliasNameLoc), 18218 AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma); 18219 AsmLabelAttr *Attr = AsmLabelAttr::CreateImplicit( 18220 Context, AliasName->getName(), /*LiteralLabel=*/true, Info); 18221 18222 // If a declaration that: 18223 // 1) declares a function or a variable 18224 // 2) has external linkage 18225 // already exists, add a label attribute to it. 18226 if (PrevDecl && (isa<FunctionDecl>(PrevDecl) || isa<VarDecl>(PrevDecl))) { 18227 if (isDeclExternC(PrevDecl)) 18228 PrevDecl->addAttr(Attr); 18229 else 18230 Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::warn_redefine_extname_not_applied) 18231 << /*Variable*/(isa<FunctionDecl>(PrevDecl) ? 0 : 1) << PrevDecl; 18232 // Otherwise, add a label atttibute to ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers. 18233 } else 18234 (void)ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.insert(std::make_pair(Name, Attr)); 18235 } 18236 18237 void Sema::ActOnPragmaWeakID(IdentifierInfo* Name, 18238 SourceLocation PragmaLoc, 18239 SourceLocation NameLoc) { 18240 Decl *PrevDecl = LookupSingleName(TUScope, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 18241 18242 if (PrevDecl) { 18243 PrevDecl->addAttr(WeakAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, PragmaLoc, AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma)); 18244 } else { 18245 (void)WeakUndeclaredIdentifiers.insert( 18246 std::pair<IdentifierInfo*,WeakInfo> 18247 (Name, WeakInfo((IdentifierInfo*)nullptr, NameLoc))); 18248 } 18249 } 18250 18251 void Sema::ActOnPragmaWeakAlias(IdentifierInfo* Name, 18252 IdentifierInfo* AliasName, 18253 SourceLocation PragmaLoc, 18254 SourceLocation NameLoc, 18255 SourceLocation AliasNameLoc) { 18256 Decl *PrevDecl = LookupSingleName(TUScope, AliasName, AliasNameLoc, 18257 LookupOrdinaryName); 18258 WeakInfo W = WeakInfo(Name, NameLoc); 18259 18260 if (PrevDecl && (isa<FunctionDecl>(PrevDecl) || isa<VarDecl>(PrevDecl))) { 18261 if (!PrevDecl->hasAttr<AliasAttr>()) 18262 if (NamedDecl *ND = dyn_cast<NamedDecl>(PrevDecl)) 18263 DeclApplyPragmaWeak(TUScope, ND, W); 18264 } else { 18265 (void)WeakUndeclaredIdentifiers.insert( 18266 std::pair<IdentifierInfo*,WeakInfo>(AliasName, W)); 18267 } 18268 } 18269 18270 Decl *Sema::getObjCDeclContext() const { 18271 return (dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCContainerDecl>(CurContext)); 18272 } 18273 18274 Sema::FunctionEmissionStatus Sema::getEmissionStatus(FunctionDecl *FD, 18275 bool Final) { 18276 // SYCL functions can be template, so we check if they have appropriate 18277 // attribute prior to checking if it is a template. 18278 if (LangOpts.SYCLIsDevice && FD->hasAttr<SYCLKernelAttr>()) 18279 return FunctionEmissionStatus::Emitted; 18280 18281 // Templates are emitted when they're instantiated. 18282 if (FD->isDependentContext()) 18283 return FunctionEmissionStatus::TemplateDiscarded; 18284 18285 FunctionEmissionStatus OMPES = FunctionEmissionStatus::Unknown; 18286 if (LangOpts.OpenMPIsDevice) { 18287 Optional<OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::DevTypeTy> DevTy = 18288 OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::getDeviceType(FD->getCanonicalDecl()); 18289 if (DevTy.hasValue()) { 18290 if (*DevTy == OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::DT_Host) 18291 OMPES = FunctionEmissionStatus::OMPDiscarded; 18292 else if (*DevTy == OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::DT_NoHost || 18293 *DevTy == OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::DT_Any) { 18294 OMPES = FunctionEmissionStatus::Emitted; 18295 } 18296 } 18297 } else if (LangOpts.OpenMP) { 18298 // In OpenMP 4.5 all the functions are host functions. 18299 if (LangOpts.OpenMP <= 45) { 18300 OMPES = FunctionEmissionStatus::Emitted; 18301 } else { 18302 Optional<OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::DevTypeTy> DevTy = 18303 OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::getDeviceType(FD->getCanonicalDecl()); 18304 // In OpenMP 5.0 or above, DevTy may be changed later by 18305 // #pragma omp declare target to(*) device_type(*). Therefore DevTy 18306 // having no value does not imply host. The emission status will be 18307 // checked again at the end of compilation unit. 18308 if (DevTy.hasValue()) { 18309 if (*DevTy == OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::DT_NoHost) { 18310 OMPES = FunctionEmissionStatus::OMPDiscarded; 18311 } else if (*DevTy == OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::DT_Host || 18312 *DevTy == OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::DT_Any) 18313 OMPES = FunctionEmissionStatus::Emitted; 18314 } else if (Final) 18315 OMPES = FunctionEmissionStatus::Emitted; 18316 } 18317 } 18318 if (OMPES == FunctionEmissionStatus::OMPDiscarded || 18319 (OMPES == FunctionEmissionStatus::Emitted && !LangOpts.CUDA)) 18320 return OMPES; 18321 18322 if (LangOpts.CUDA) { 18323 // When compiling for device, host functions are never emitted. Similarly, 18324 // when compiling for host, device and global functions are never emitted. 18325 // (Technically, we do emit a host-side stub for global functions, but this 18326 // doesn't count for our purposes here.) 18327 Sema::CUDAFunctionTarget T = IdentifyCUDATarget(FD); 18328 if (LangOpts.CUDAIsDevice && T == Sema::CFT_Host) 18329 return FunctionEmissionStatus::CUDADiscarded; 18330 if (!LangOpts.CUDAIsDevice && 18331 (T == Sema::CFT_Device || T == Sema::CFT_Global)) 18332 return FunctionEmissionStatus::CUDADiscarded; 18333 18334 // Check whether this function is externally visible -- if so, it's 18335 // known-emitted. 18336 // 18337 // We have to check the GVA linkage of the function's *definition* -- if we 18338 // only have a declaration, we don't know whether or not the function will 18339 // be emitted, because (say) the definition could include "inline". 18340 FunctionDecl *Def = FD->getDefinition(); 18341 18342 if (Def && 18343 !isDiscardableGVALinkage(getASTContext().GetGVALinkageForFunction(Def)) 18344 && (!LangOpts.OpenMP || OMPES == FunctionEmissionStatus::Emitted)) 18345 return FunctionEmissionStatus::Emitted; 18346 } 18347 18348 // Otherwise, the function is known-emitted if it's in our set of 18349 // known-emitted functions. 18350 return FunctionEmissionStatus::Unknown; 18351 } 18352 18353 bool Sema::shouldIgnoreInHostDeviceCheck(FunctionDecl *Callee) { 18354 // Host-side references to a __global__ function refer to the stub, so the 18355 // function itself is never emitted and therefore should not be marked. 18356 // If we have host fn calls kernel fn calls host+device, the HD function 18357 // does not get instantiated on the host. We model this by omitting at the 18358 // call to the kernel from the callgraph. This ensures that, when compiling 18359 // for host, only HD functions actually called from the host get marked as 18360 // known-emitted. 18361 return LangOpts.CUDA && !LangOpts.CUDAIsDevice && 18362 IdentifyCUDATarget(Callee) == CFT_Global; 18363 } 18364